Use these links to rapidly review the document
TABLE OF CONTENTS
TABLE OF CONTENTS 2

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on January 12, 2007

Registration No. 333-138362



UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549


Amendment No. 1
to
FORM S-4
REGISTRATION STATEMENT
UNDER
THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933


National Mentor Holdings, Inc.
(Exact name of registrant issuer as specified in its charter)
(SEE TABLE OF ADDITIONAL REGISTRANTS)


Delaware
(State or other jurisdiction
of incorporation)
  8300
(Primary Standard Industrial
Classification Code Number)
  31-1757086
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification Number)

313 Congress Street
Sixth Floor
Boston, Massachusetts 02210
(617) 790-4800
(Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of registrants' principal executive offices)


Linda DeRenzo, Esq.
Senior Vice President and General Counsel
The Mentor Network
313 Congress Street
Sixth Floor
Boston, Massachusetts 02210
(617) 790-4800
(Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of agent for service)


With a copy to:
Michael Nathan, Esq.
Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP
425 Lexington Avenue
New York, New York 10017-3954
Tel: (212) 455-2000


Approximate date of commencement of proposed exchange offers: The exchange will occur as soon as practicable after the effective date of this registration statement.

        If the securities being registered on this form are being offered in connection with the formation of a holding company and there is compliance with General Instruction G, please check the following box.  o

        If this form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.  o

        If this form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.  o


CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE


Title of Each Class of
Securities to be Registered

  Amount to
be Registered

  Proposed Maximum
Offering Price
Per Note

  Proposed Maximum
Aggregate
Offering Price(1)

  Amount of
Registration Fee


11 1 / 4 % Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014   $180,000,000   100%(1)   $180,000,000(1)   $19,260(2)

Guarantees of 11 1 / 4 % Senior Notes due 2014(3)   (4)   (4)   (4)   (4)


(1)
Estimated solely for the purpose of calculating the registration fee under Rule 457 of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.
(2)
Previously paid.
(3)
See inside facing page for table of additional registrant guarantors.
(4)
Pursuant to Rule 457(n) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, no separate filing fee is required for the guarantees.

         The Registrants hereby amend this Registration Statement on such date or dates as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrants shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this Registration Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, or until the Registration Statement shall become effective on such date as the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.





TABLE OF ADDITIONAL REGISTRANT GUARANTORS

Exact Name of
Registrant Guarantor as
Specified in its Charter

  State or Other
Jurisdiction of
Incorporation or
Organization

  I.R.S. Employer
Identification Number

  Address, Including Zip Code
and Telephone Number,
Including Area Code,
of Registrant Guarantor's
Principal Executive Offices

 
Center for Comprehensive Services, Inc.   Illinois   37-1036318   (1 )
Cornerstone Living Skills, Inc.   California   68-0286512   (1 )
Family Advocacy Services, LLC   Delaware   03-0490299   (1 )
First Step Independent Living Program, Inc.   California   95-3574845   (1 )
Homework Center, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1332512   (1 )
Horrigan Cole Enterprises, Inc.   California   33-0152162   (1 )
Illinois Mentor, Inc.   Illinois   36-3643670   (1 )
Loyd's Liberty Homes, Inc.   California   77-0282781   (1 )
Massachusetts Mentor, Inc.   Massachusetts   04-2799071   (1 )
Mentor Management, Inc.   Delaware   80-0061183   (1 )
Mentor Maryland, Inc.   Maryland   01-0739432   (1 )
National Mentor Healthcare, LLC   Delaware   04-2893910   (1 )
National Mentor Holdings, LLC   Delaware   04-3250732   (1 )
National Mentor, LLC   Delaware   03-0490294   (1 )
National Mentor Services, Inc.   Delaware   80-0061181   (1 )
National Mentor Services, LLC   Delaware   03-0490296   (1 )
Ohio Mentor, Inc.   Ohio   31-1098345   (1 )
REM, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1425896   (1 )
REM Arizona Rehabilitation, Inc.   Arizona   41-1923484   (1 )
REM Arrowhead, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1910302   (1 )
REM Central Lakes, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1424026   (1 )
REM Colorado, Inc.   Colorado   41-1578483   (1 )
REM Community Options, Inc.   West Virginia   41-1756072   (1 )
REM Community Payroll Services, LLC   Minnesota   65-1243641   (1 )
REM Connecticut Community Services, Inc.   Connecticut   41-1895229   (1 )
REM Consulting & Services, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1270033   (1 )
REM Consulting of Ohio, Inc.   Ohio   41-1607786   (1 )
REM Developmental Services, Inc.   Iowa   41-1936672   (1 )
REM Health, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1623324   (1 )
REM Health of Iowa, Inc.   Iowa   41-1916703   (1 )
REM Health of Nebraska, LLC   Delaware   59-3816294   (1 )
REM Health of Wisconsin, Inc.   Wisconsin   39-1487935   (1 )
REM Health of Wisconsin II, Inc.   Wisconsin   39-1497152   (1 )
REM Heartland, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1245622   (1 )
REM Hennepin, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1509580   (1 )
REM Home Health, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1865748   (1 )
REM Indiana, Inc.   Indiana   41-1532587   (1 )
REM Indiana Community Services, Inc.   Indiana   94-3114223   (1 )
REM Indiana Community Services II, Inc.   Indiana   41-1787921   (1 )
REM Iowa Community Services, Inc.   Iowa   22-2929097   (1 )
REM Iowa, Inc.   Iowa   41-1499229   (1 )
REM Management, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1691043   (1 )
REM Maryland, Inc.   Maryland   41-1888678   (1 )
REM Minnesota Community Services, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1880610   (1 )
REM Minnesota, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1726312   (1 )
REM Nevada, Inc.   Nevada   41-1886461   (1 )
REM New Jersey, Inc.   New Jersey   41-1834352   (1 )
REM North Dakota, Inc.   North Dakota   41-1434382   (1 )
REM North Star, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1892341   (1 )
REM Ohio, Inc.   Ohio   41-1578484   (1 )
REM Ohio Waivered Services, Inc.   Ohio   41-1703065   (1 )
REM Pennsylvania Community Services, Inc.   Pennsylvania   41-1916701   (1 )
REM Ramsey, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1583903   (1 )
REM River Bluffs, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1655668   (1 )
REM South Central Services, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1509578   (1 )
REM Southwest Services, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1379478   (1 )
REM Utah, Inc.   Utah   87-0547552   (1 )
REM West Virginia, Inc.   West Virginia   41-1578482   (1 )
REM Wisconsin, Inc.   Wisconsin   41-1532591   (1 )
REM Wisconsin II, Inc.   Wisconsin   41-1784261   (1 )
REM Wisconsin III, Inc.   Wisconsin   41-1861498   (1 )
REM Woodvale, Inc.   Minnesota   41-1791260   (1 )
Rockland Child Development Services, Inc.   New York   13-4084562   (1 )
South Carolina Mentor, Inc.   South Carolina   57-0782160   (1 )
Unlimited Quest, Inc.   California   33-0067902   (1 )

(1)
The address of the principal executive offices of each of the Registrant Guarantors is 313 Congress Street 6th Floor, Boston, MA 02210. The telephone number of each of the registrant guarantors is (617) 790-4800.

The information in this prospectus is not complete and may be changed. We may not issue the exchange notes in the exchange offer until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This prospectus is not an offer to sell these securities and it is not soliciting an offer to buy these securities in any state or jurisdiction where such offer or sale is not permitted.

Subject to Completion, dated January 12, 2007

PRELIMINARY PROSPECTUS

National MENTOR Holdings, Inc.

OFFER TO EXCHANGE

         $180,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 11 1 / 4 % Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014, which have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933, for any and all outstanding 11 1 / 4 % Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014.

         The exchange notes will be fully and unconditionally guaranteed on an unsecured basis by certain of our domestic subsidiaries.


         We are conducting the exchange offer in order to provide you with an opportunity to exchange your unregistered outstanding notes for freely tradeable exchange notes that have been registered under the Securities Act.

The Exchange Offer


        All untendered outstanding notes will be continue to be subject to the restrictions on transfer set forth in the outstanding notes and in the indenture. In general, the outstanding notes may not be offered or sold, unless registered under the Securities Act, except pursuant to an exemption from, or in a transaction not subject to, the Securities Act and applicable state securities laws. Other than in connection with the exchange offer, we do not currently anticipate that we will register the outstanding notes under the Securities Act.

         You should carefully consider the "Risk Factors" beginning on page 21 of this prospectus before participating in the exchange offer.

Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of the exchange notes to be distributed in the exchange offer or passed upon the accuracy or adequacy of this prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.

The date of this prospectus is                        , 2007.



TABLE OF CONTENTS

 
  Page
Prospectus summary   1
Risk factors   21
The Transactions   36
Use of proceeds   38
Capitalization   39
Unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information   40
Selected historical consolidated financial data   43
Management's discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations   44
Industry overview   56
Business   59
Management   72
Security ownership of principal shareholders and management   81
Certain relationships and related party transactions   82
The exchange offer   86
Description of notes   93
Description of other indebtedness   152
Book-entry settlement and clearance   156
Certain United States federal income tax consequences   159
Certain ERISA considerations   160
Plan of distribution   162
Legal matters   163
Experts   163
Available information   163
Index to financial statements   F-1

         We have not authorized any dealer, salesperson or other person to give any information or represent anything to you other than the information contained in this prospectus. You must not rely on unauthorized information or representations.

         This prospectus does not offer to sell nor ask for offers to buy any of the securities in any jurisdiction where it is unlawful, where the person making the offer is not qualified to do so, or to any person who cannot legally be offered the securities. The information in this prospectus is current only as of the date on its cover, and may change after that date.


        National MENTOR Holdings, Inc. is incorporated in Delaware. Our principal executive offices are located at 313 Congress Street, 6th Floor, Boston, MA 02210 and our telephone number at that address is (617)-790-4800. Our website is located at www.thementornetwork.com. The information on our website is not part of this prospectus.

i



FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

        Some of the matters discussed in this prospectus may constitute forward-looking statements.

        These statements relate to future events or our future financial performance. In some cases, you can identify forward-looking statements by terminology such as "may," "will," "should," "expect," "plan," "anticipate," "believe," "estimate," "predict," "potential" or "continue," the negative of such terms or other comparable terminology. These statements are only predictions. Actual events or results may differ materially.

        The information in this prospectus is not a complete description of our business or the risks associated with an investment in the notes. There can be no assurance that other factors will not affect the accuracy of these forward-looking statements or that our actual results will not differ materially from the results anticipated in such forward-looking statements. While it is impossible to identify all such factors, factors which could cause actual results to differ materially from those estimated by us include, but are not limited to, those factors or conditions described under "Risk factors" in this prospectus as well as the following:

        Although we believe that the expectations reflected in the forward-looking statements are reasonable, we cannot guarantee future results, levels of activity, performance or achievements. Moreover, neither we nor any other person assumes responsibility for the accuracy and completeness of the forward-looking statements. All written and oral forward-looking statements made in connection with this prospectus which are attributable to us or persons acting on our behalf are expressly qualified in their entirety by the "risk factors" and other cautionary statements included herein. We are under no

ii



duty to update any of the forward-looking statements after the date of this prospectus to conform such statements to actual results or to changes in our expectations.


INDUSTRY AND MARKET DATA

        The data included in this prospectus regarding markets and ranking, including the size of certain markets and our position and the position of our competitors within these markets, are based on (1) published and unpublished industry sources, primarily "The State of the States in Developmental Disabilities" (Preliminary Report) a research report prepared by Dr. David Braddock, Executive Director of the Coleman Institute for Cognitive Disabilities and Associate Vice President of the University of Colorado (CU) System in 2005, and (2) on our estimates based on our management's knowledge and experience in the markets in which we operate. Our estimates have been based on these sources as well as information obtained from our customers, trade and business organizations and other contacts in the markets in which we operate. We believe these sources and estimates to be accurate as of the date of this prospectus. However, this information may prove to be inaccurate because of the method by which we obtained some of the data for our estimates or because this information cannot always be verified with complete certainty due to the limits on the availability and reliability of raw data, the voluntary nature of the data gathering process and other limitations and uncertainties.

iii



BASIS OF PRESENTATION

        As used in this prospectus, unless otherwise noted or the context otherwise requires, references to "MENTOR," the "Company," "we," "us" and "our" are to National MENTOR Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation, and its subsidiaries; references to the "Issuer" are to National MENTOR Holdings, Inc., exclusive of its subsidiaries; references to "MergerSub" are to NMH MergerSub, Inc., a Delaware corporation; references to "Parent" are to NMH Holdings, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company formed by Vestar (as defined below), exclusive of its subsidiaries; references to "NMH Investment" are to NMH Investment, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company formed by Vestar, exclusive of its subsidiaries; references to "Vestar" or the "Sponsor" are to Vestar Capital Partners V, L.P.; and references to "management investors" are to certain members of our management team and employees who will, together with Vestar, own all of the outstanding capital stock of the Issuer following the Merger (as defined below).

        On March 22, 2006, Parent entered into an agreement and plan of merger (the "Merger Agreement") with MergerSub, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Parent, and the Issuer. Pursuant to the Merger Agreement, on June 29, 2006, MergerSub merged with and into the Issuer (the "Merger"), with the Issuer being the surviving corporation. As a result of the Merger, Vestar, an affiliate of Vestar and the management investors own the Issuer through their ownership of NMH Investment and Parent. The Merger and the related financing and other transactions are referred to as the "Transactions." See "The Transactions."

        The term "successor" refers to the Company following the Transactions and the term "predecessor" refers to the Company prior to the Transactions. The Merger was accounted for under the purchase method of accounting in accordance with Financial Accounting Standard No. 141, Business Combinations (SFAS 141). Under purchase accounting, fixed assets and identifiable intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed are recorded at their respective fair values. We are in the process of completing valuations of certain real estate assets; thus, the allocation of the purchase price to our assets is subject to adjustment.

        Our fiscal year ends on September 30. We refer to the fiscal year ended September 30, 2006 as "fiscal 2006," the fiscal year ended September 30, 2005 as "fiscal 2005," the fiscal year ended September 30, 2004 as "fiscal 2004" and the fiscal year ended September 30, 2003 as "fiscal 2003." Financial information for the fiscal 2006 presented in this prospectus was derived by the mathematical addition of the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 (predecessor) and the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 (successor).

        Unless the context otherwise requires, the financial information of MENTOR presented herein is the financial information of the Issuer on a consolidated basis together with its subsidiaries. Unless otherwise noted, all information in this prospectus is as of September 30, 2006. Unless otherwise stated herein, our pro forma financial information reflects the effects of our consummation of the Transactions, as described under "The Transactions."

iv



PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

         This summary highlights information contained elsewhere in this prospectus. It does not contain all the information that you may consider important in making your investment decision. Therefore, you should read the entire prospectus carefully, including, in particular, the section entitled "Risk factors" and the financial statements and the related notes to those statements, before participating in the exchange offer.

Company Overview

        We are a leading provider of home and community-based human services to individuals with mental retardation and other developmental disabilities, at-risk youth and their families, and persons with acquired brain injury. Since our founding in 1980, we have grown to provide services to approximately 21,700 clients in 34 states. We design customized service plans to meet the unique needs of our clients in home and community-based settings. Most of our services involve residential support, typically in small group home or host home settings, designed to improve our clients' quality of life and to promote client independence and participation in community life. Services that we provide include day programs, vocational services, case management, early intervention, post-acute treatment and neurorehabilitation services, among others. Our customized services offer our clients, as well as the payors for these services, an attractive, cost-effective alternative to human services provided in large, institutional settings.

        We believe that our broad range of services, high-quality reputation and relationships with government agencies have made us one of the largest providers in the United States of home and community-based services. In the past three years, our management team has grown the Company organically through investment in new programs and geographies, census growth in existing programs and cross-selling programs within existing markets. In addition, since fiscal 2003, we have completed and successfully integrated more than 20 acquisitions.

        As of September 30, 2006, we provided our services through approximately 15,700 full-time equivalent employees, as well as approximately 3,900 independently contracted host home caregivers, or Mentors. We derive over 93% of our revenues from a diverse group of state and county governmental payors. We generated net revenues of approximately $789.2 million for fiscal 2006.

        Our services are offered through a variety of models, including (i) small group homes, most of which house six people or fewer, (ii) host homes, or the "Mentor" model, in which a client lives in the home of a trained Mentor, (iii) in-home settings, in which we support clients' independence with 24-hour services in their own homes, (iv) non-residential settings, consisting primarily of day programs and periodic services in various settings and (v) educational settings, in which we offer in-school, after-school and alternative educational services. We provide services in these settings to the following population groups:

        Individuals with Mental Retardation/Developmental Disabilities ("MR/DD").     The largest part of our business is the delivery of services to individuals with mental retardation or a developmental disability. Our MR/DD programs include residential support, day habilitation, vocational services, case management, home healthcare, personal care and early intervention. We provide services to these clients through small group homes, intermediate care facilities ("ICFs-MR"), host homes, in-home settings and non-residential settings. In 2003, we acquired REM, Inc. ("REM"), one of the largest providers of MR/DD services in the United States. The REM acquisition significantly increased the scope of our MR/DD services, provided us access to nine new markets and doubled our revenue. As of September 30, 2006, we provided MR/DD services to approximately 15,700 clients in 28 states. For fiscal 2006, our MR/DD services generated net revenues of $549.9 million, representing approximately 70% of our net revenues. We receive substantially all our revenues for MR/DD services from state and county governmental payors.

1



        At-Risk Youth ("ARY").     We provide a variety of services to children with severe emotional, developmental, medical and behavioral challenges, to youth involved in the juvenile justice system and to their families. Our ARY programs include therapeutic foster care, independent living, family reunification, family preservation, alternative schools and adoption services. Our individualized approach allows us to work with an ever-changing client population that is diverse in terms of age and gender as well as in type and severity of condition. We provide services to these clients through host homes, educational settings and non-residential settings. As of September 30, 2006, we provided ARY services to approximately 5,700 children, adolescents and their families in 23 states. For fiscal 2006, our ARY services generated net revenues of $146.2 million, representing approximately 18% of our net revenues. We receive substantially all our revenues for ARY services from state and county governmental payors.

        Individuals with an Acquired Brain Injury ("ABI").     We provide a range of post-acute treatment and longer-term care services to clients with an ABI, defined as an injury to the brain sustained after birth. Our ABI services range from post acute care to assisted independent living and include neurobehavioral rehabilitation, neurorehabilitation, adolescent integration, outpatient or day treatment and pre-vocational services. Our goal is to provide a continuum of care that allows our clients to achieve the highest level of function possible while enhancing their quality of life. We provide services to these clients primarily through small group homes, in-home settings and non-residential settings. In certain circumstances we provide services to clients with highly acute conditions in larger facilities as well as facilities affiliated with hospitals. As of September 30, 2006, we provided ABI services in 12 states and served approximately 360 clients nationally. For fiscal 2006, our ABI services generated net revenues of $56.9 million, representing approximately 7% of our net revenues. For fiscal 2006, we received approximately 48% of our ABI revenues from state and county governmental payors and approximately 52% from private payors.

        Other.     We derive revenues from other sources, including through the provision of home health services to individuals with physical disabilities and the elderly. Our services to these clients include skilled nursing, physical therapy, occupational therapy, personal care and homemaking services, among others. For fiscal 2006, these other sources of revenues generated net revenues of $36.2 million, representing approximately 5% of our net revenues. Our revenues for these services come from a diverse mix of governmental and private payors.

Industry Overview

        The human services industry provides services to people with a range of disabilities and special needs, including (i) individuals with mental retardation and developmental disabilities, (ii) at-risk youth and (iii) individuals with acquired brain injury. The market for these services remains highly fragmented, with the majority of service providers consisting of not-for-profit organizations, small or medium-size proprietary entities and publicly-owned entities. The services in these segments are funded primarily through Medicaid, a joint federal and state health insurance program under which eligible state expenditures are matched with federal funding. In addition, funds are also provided by other federal, state and local governmental programs and, to a lesser extent, private payors.

Mental Retardation and Developmental Disabilities

        Approximately 1.6% of the U.S. population, or 4.6 million people, are considered to have MR/DD, or a severe, chronic developmental disability attributable to a mental or physical impairment. These individuals live in supervised residential settings, including institutions, with family caregivers or on their own. Public spending on MR/DD services grew from an estimated $30.0 billion in 1998 to an estimated $38.6 billion in 2004, a rate of 4.3% per year. In 2004, approximately 492,000 individuals with MR/DD received care within a supervised residential setting, which represents only 11% of the MR/

2



DD population. Approximately 60% of the MR/DD population, or 2.8 million individuals, remain in the care of their family and approximately 28%, or 1.3 million individuals, live independently.

        Over the past two decades, the delivery of services to the MR/DD population in supervised residential settings has grown significantly and, at the same time, there has been a major shift from institutional settings to home and community-based settings, both in part due to the Americans with Disabilities Act ("ADA") and the U.S. Supreme Court Olmstead decision in 1999. We believe that community settings provide a higher quality and, in some cases, lower cost alternative to care provided in state institutions. Home and Community-Based Services ("HCBS") Waiver programs, Medicaid programs where the federal government has waived the requirement that services be delivered in institutional settings, are the primary funding vehicle for home and community-based services. Federal funding for HCBS Waiver programs for individuals with MR/DD, increased from $4.4 billion in 1998 to $9.2 billion in 2004, representing an annual increase of approximately 13.1%. Approximately 68% of these individuals with MR/DD that receive care in supervised residential settings live in small group homes paid for under the HCBS Waiver programs.

        In addition, the ICF-MR program, a Medicaid program established in 1971, is used by states to support MR/DD housing programs in both smaller (up to 16 residents) and larger (16 residents or more) institutional settings. In 2004, the ICF-MR program provided approximately $1.9 billion in federal funding to approximately 43,774 individuals living in public and private ICF-MR settings of up to 16 residents.

        We believe that the following factors will continue to benefit the sector, and in particular home and community-based programs:

At-Risk Youth

        The ARY service market includes children with severe emotional, developmental, medical, and behavioral challenges, as well as youth under the auspices of the juvenile justice system and their families. We believe that the market for ARY services is rapidly growing as a result of the increase in child welfare referrals and number of youth arrests as well as the expanding 10 to 19 year-old

3



population. The market for ARY services grew from $25 billion in 1998 to $39 billion in 2004, which represents an increase of approximately 8% annually. ARY services are funded from a variety of sources, including state and local government appropriations, Medicaid, and Title IV-E of the Social Security Act, or "The Adoption Assistance and Child Welfare Act of 1980."

        Similar to MR/DD programs, there has been an increased emphasis on home and community-based alternatives for the ARY population. More states are shifting funds to private providers of these services in an attempt to purchase cost-effective, evidence-based care.

Acquired Brain Injury

        Continued progress in medical technology is resulting in an increased number of individuals surviving an ABI. Currently, 5.3 million people in the U.S. are living with a permanent disability as a result of an ABI. In addition, more than 1.4 million new ABI cases, 85,000 of which result in permanent disabilities, are expected each year. The market for ABI services grew from $7.6 billion in 1998 to $9.5 billion in 2004, representing an annual increase of approximately 3.8%.

        Both the public and private sectors finance post-acute services for individuals with an ABI. Federal and state governments pay for a large portion of post-acute services, as private insurance plans limit post-acute services and typically do not pay for long-term care or community-based support. In recent years, the increase in state ABI Waiver programs that provide easier access to Medicaid funds has expanded the number of individuals who can afford ABI services. In addition, we believe that there has been a push by payors to move from high cost institution-based settings to lower cost outpatient and day treatment programs as soon as possible. This shift should benefit providers such as us, that offer a continuum of care from physical and neurological rehabilitation to more basic long-term care services in non-institutional settings.

Competitive Strengths

        We believe that the following competitive strengths have allowed us to achieve and maintain our position as a leading provider of home and community-based services to our target population groups:

        National Platform with Diverse Payor and Program Mix.     We serve clients in 34 states, which are home to approximately 80% of the United States population, although we do not operate in all regions of those states. We believe that we deliver a level of quality and responsiveness that smaller local service providers are not always able to offer and which has helped us forge strong relationships with state and county agencies. Our extensive history of serving children and adults with a range of challenges and needs has led to the development of operational expertise in quality assurance, customer satisfaction survey implementation and analysis, outcomes measurement and risk management. Our national platform has also enabled us to implement best practices across our organization and leverage economies of scale in various direct and indirect costs. For instance, we have been able to develop the expertise and systems to facilitate compliance with the increasingly complex and diverse billing requirements of our payors. In addition, our national platform, reputation and knowledge enable us to respond quickly and efficiently to new opportunities. As a result, we have successfully expanded our markets and entered a number of new service areas, including ABI, early childhood autism programs and non-residential therapeutic schools. Finally, the more than 30 different types of programs that we offer, coupled with our diverse base of state and county payors, stabilize our revenue base and mitigate the impact of changes in public policy, rates or reimbursement policies in any particular state, county or program.

        Client-Oriented Care Model.     We have the expertise to design customized service plans to meet the unique needs of our clients in community-based settings. We specialize in adapting our service offerings to a wide range of intensities of care and other client requirements, as well as in providing cost-effective services that are accountable to clients, their families and payors. For example, our

4



program for foster children with complex medical conditions includes individual plans of care that address each child's medical condition, as well as his or her physical and emotional needs. These children are cared for in a Mentor host home with the support of medical professionals, which we believe is better for the development of children and often a less expensive alternative for payors than hospital settings.

        Stable Revenue and Strong Cash Flow.     The extended length of care inherent in our MR/DD service line, which is the largest part of our business, provides us with a stable, recurring base of revenue. Clients with MR/DD live in our homes for an average of approximately eight years and the increased life expectancy of the MR/DD population, as described above, is extending the average length of stay in our homes. Life expectancy and the services available for individuals with ABI have also increased as a result of improved medical resources and technology, providing additional stability to our revenue base. Furthermore, our business model requires capital expenditures of approximately 2% of net revenues per year and has modest working capital needs.

        Flexible Fixed Cost Structure.     We believe that our fixed costs are lower than those of large institutional care providers, enabling us to respond quickly to market developments and regulatory changes. A substantial portion of our caregivers are hourly employees or independently contracted clinicians and Mentors, which allows us to quickly respond to changes in our staffing needs. Our group homes consist of a mix of owned residential real estate and leased real estate, including many leases with terms of two years or less. We believe that the structure of our real estate portfolio allows us to respond quickly to changes in our service levels.

        Experienced and Committed Management Team and Equity Sponsor.     Our management team, having served previously as policy makers, fiscal managers and service providers, has extensive public and private sector experience in human services. Our senior management team has been with us for an average of 11 years and averages approximately 21 years in the human services industry. Over the past ten years, members of our management team have helped to grow the Company from $88.3 million in revenues in 1997 to $789.2 million in net revenues for fiscal 2006 through organic growth and the integration of 37 acquisitions. In connection with the Merger, the management investors made a significant equity contribution of approximately $11.6 million. In addition, our equity sponsor, Vestar Capital Partners, has considerable experience making investments in a wide variety of industries, including healthcare.

Our Strategy

        We believe home and community-based human services that increase client independence and participation in community life while reducing payor costs will continue to grow in market share. We intend to continue to capitalize on these trends, both in existing markets and in new markets where we believe significant opportunities exist. The primary aspects of our strategy include the following:

        Grow Our Census and Expand Our Services in Existing Markets.     We intend to continue to expand our census in existing markets where we leverage our reputation for high-quality, innovative services and our relationships with referral sources to serve new individuals and families. We also intend to continue to cross-sell new services, which involve starting new service lines or offering new programs in markets where we already have a well-established base of operations and relationships with existing referral sources. For example, our acquisition of an ABI operation in Illinois in 1998 has provided us with the clinical and operational expertise to export a range of ABI programs to 12 states where we offered other services. Similarly, we have leveraged our experience in early intervention services in both California and Arizona to obtain a new contract for early intervention services in Nevada which will expand our services in that state. Finally, in South Carolina we plan to begin operating host home services for adults with MR/DD in a market where we have historically offered only group home services to this population.

5



        Expand Our Services in New Markets.     We also intend to continue to seek new opportunities to grow in each of our service lines by leveraging our current infrastructure to expand into new territories through new program starts, or new starts. We often seek new starts through the signing of an anchor contract in a new state or region with the intention of leveraging the initial contract to expand by service line or by model. For example, we increased our census in Illinois from 437 in fiscal 2002 to 651 in fiscal 2006 after establishing ARY programs in four new cities through the new start process. A new start typically requires a modest initial investment to fund operating losses but generally achieves profitability within 18-24 months. Since the inception of our new start program in fiscal 2002, as of September 30, 2006, we have successfully launched 91 new starts, including 23 which launched in fiscal 2006.

        Continue to Strengthen Our Third-Party Payor Relationships.     Much of our organic growth in recent years has resulted from the strength of our relationships with state and local government agencies. Our relationships with these payors have enabled us to gain contract referrals and to cross-sell new services into existing markets. We continue to strengthen these relationships by providing innovative quality assurance, reporting and billing programs designed to serve the needs of third-party payors. We seek to position ourselves as the provider of choice to state and county governments and other third-party payors by finding solutions to their most challenging human service delivery problems.

        Selectively Pursue Acquisitions.     Members of our management team have a proven track record of identifying, pursuing and successfully integrating acquisitions, having completed 37 acquisitions since 1997. We have selectively supplemented our organic growth through acquisitions which have allowed us to penetrate new geographies, enter new service lines, leverage our systems, operating costs and best practices, and pursue cross-selling opportunities. We monitor the market nationally for human service businesses that we can purchase at an attractive price and efficiently "tuck-in" to our existing operations. We believe we are often seen as a preferred acquiror in these situations due to our experience, relationships, infrastructure and reputation for quality. We intend to continue to pursue acquisitions that are philosophically compatible and can be readily integrated into our existing operations.

        Expand into Related Services and Programs.     We intend to continue to evaluate opportunities to provide services to additional population groups in the human services industry. We believe that our broad range of services, relationships with third-party payors, reputation for quality care and infrastructure give us the ability to expand the number of clients we serve in a cost-effective manner. We have successfully entered new service lines, including ABI, and program areas, including early childhood autism programs, non-residential therapeutic schools and home health care. As we continue to strengthen existing services, we will use our clinical skills, personnel and experience to provide new, related services.

Recent Developments

        Recent acquisitions.     On May 31, 2006, we acquired the business of CareMeridian, LLC in an asset sale for approximately $21.4 million, subject to increase based on earnout provisions. Established in 1989 in Orange County, California, CareMeridian is a provider of after-hospital services for catastrophically ill or injured patients in non-institutional, residential settings. CareMeridian specializes in rehabilitative nursing care for adult and pediatric patients who have traumatic brain or spinal cord injuries, pulmonary or neuromuscular disorders or congenital anomalies. Employing approximately 260 individuals, CareMeridian provides services to approximately 90 individuals at 11 sites, 10 of which are located in California, with the remaining facility located in Las Vegas, Nevada. For the twelve months ended December 31, 2005, CareMeridian generated net revenues of approximately $24.8 million.

        On September 29, 2006, we acquired the business of Behavioral Healthcare of the Carolinas, LLC ("BHC") in an asset sale for approximately $4.7 million. We took ownership of BHC on October 1,

6



2006. Based in Biscoe, North Carolina, BHC is a for-profit company that provides periodic (hourly) mental health services to children and families in a variety of settings. With a closely-knit network of eight offices, BHC's professional and paraprofessional staff currently serve approximately 400 children and families in its non-residential continuum of services through approximately 6,500 hours of service per week.

        On December 1, 2006, we acquired the business of Therapeutic Programs, Inc. ("TPI") in an asset sale for approximately $9 million, subject to increase based on earnout provisions. TPI is a proprietary therapeutic foster care company headquartered in Montgomery, Alabama. TPI operates a small family-based services program in Jefferson County. TPI provides services to approximately 380 children and adolescents statewide, employs 130 staff and generates approximately $13 million in annual gross revenue in the eleven locations acquired by Mentor.

        On December 1, 2006, we acquired the stock of Rockland Child Development Services, Inc. ("RCDS") for approximately $13 million, subject to increase based on earnout provisions. RCDS is an early intervention company located in Suffern, New York, that provides multilingual home-based developmental evaluation and clinical services to infants and toddlers with or at-risk for developmental delays, and children in the Committee on Preschool Education program. Established in 1999, RCDS provides services in Rockland and Orange Counties and the City of New York and generates approximately $11 million in annual gross revenues.

        Officer Resignation.     On September 30, 2006, John Gillespie, our Chief Financial Officer, resigned.

        Election of new Director.     On December 1, 2006, Jeffry Timmons was elected as a new independent member of our Board of Directors.

7


The Transactions; Corporate Structure

        On March 22, 2006, Parent entered into an agreement and plan of merger with MergerSub and the Issuer. Pursuant to the Merger Agreement, on June 29, 2006, MergerSub merged with and into the Issuer, with the Issuer being the surviving corporation. As a result of the Merger, Vestar, an affiliate of Vestar and the management investors, through Parent and NMH Investment, own the Issuer.

        The Merger, the offering of the notes, the initial borrowings under our new senior secured credit facilities, the equity investment and participation by the Sponsor and by the management investors, the repayment of all outstanding indebtedness under our old senior secured credit facility and the repurchase of outstanding old 9 5 / 8 % senior subordinated notes due 2012 ("old notes") of National Mentor, Inc. (which was converted into National Mentor Holdings, LLC on June 29, 2006) pursuant to the tender offer and consent solicitation are collectively referred to in this prospectus as the "Transactions." For a more complete description of the Transactions, see "The Transactions," "Description of notes," and "Description of other indebtedness."

        The following chart summarizes our organizational structure, equity ownership and our principal indebtedness immediately following the consummation of the Transactions:

GRAPHIC


(1)
Consists of a $242.0 million cash equity contribution by investment funds associated with Vestar and an approximately $11.6 million investment (including rollover equity) by the management investors.

8


(2)
Our new senior secured credit facilities consist of a $335.0 million seven-year senior secured term loan facility, a $125.0 million six-year senior secured revolving credit facility, and a $20.0 million seven-year senior secured synthetic letter of credit facility. At the closing of the Transactions, we borrowed $335.0 million under the senior secured term loan facility, had availability of $123.8 million under our new senior secured revolving credit facility and utilized the entire $20.0 million synthetic letter of credit facility. We did not borrow under the senior secured revolving credit facility as of September 30, 2006. At September 30, 2006, the availability under our senior secured revolving credit facility was reduced by $1.8 million as letters of credit in excess of $20.0 million under our synthetic letters of credit facility were outstanding.

(3)
The notes are guaranteed on a senior subordinated basis by all of our existing subsidiaries, except for our captive insurance subsidiary and our non-profit subsidiaries, and any of our future domestic subsidiaries that guarantee indebtedness under our new senior secured credit facilities. The guarantors of the notes also guarantee our new senior secured credit facilities on a senior secured basis.

(4)
An $8.0 million mortgage facility, dated as of May 20, 2005, between the Issuer, National MENTOR, Inc., certain subsidiaries of National MENTOR, Inc. and Bank of America, N.A., as lender. As of September 30, 2006, $5.5 million was outstanding under this facility.

Our Sponsor

        Vestar Capital Partners is a leading international private equity firm specializing in management buyouts and growth capital investments. Vestar Capital Partners' investment in National MENTOR Holdings, Inc. was funded by Vestar Capital Partners V, L.P., a $3.7 billion fund which closed in 2006, and an affiliate.

        Since the firm's founding in 1988, Vestar Capital Partners has completed over 55 investments in the U.S. and Europe in companies with a total value of over $20 billion. These companies have varied in size and geography and span a broad range of industries including healthcare, an area in which Vestar Capital Partners' principals have had meaningful experience. Vestar Capital Partners currently manages funds totaling approximately $7 billion and has offices or affiliates in New York, Denver, Boston, Paris, Milan and Tokyo. See "Certain relationships and related party transactions" and "Security ownership of principal shareholders and management" for more information with respect to our relationship with Vestar.

9



SUMMARY OF THE TERMS OF THE EXCHANGE OFFER

         On June 29, 2006, we completed the private offering of $180,000,000 aggregate principal amount of the outstanding notes. In this prospectus, the term "outstanding notes" refers to the 11 1 / 4 % Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014 issued in the private offering; the term "exchange notes" refers to the 11 1 / 4 % Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014 as registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the "Securities Act"); and the term "notes" refers to both the outstanding notes and the exchange notes.

General   In connection with the private offering, we entered into a registration rights agreement with J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., UBS Investment Bank and Banc of America Securities LLC (collectively, the "initial purchasers"), the initial purchasers of the outstanding notes, in which we and the guarantors agreed, among other things, to use our reasonable best efforts to complete the exchange offer for the outstanding notes within 270 days after the date of issuance of the outstanding notes.

 

 

You are entitled to exchange in the exchange offer your outstanding notes for exchange notes, which are identical in all material respects to the outstanding notes except:

 

 


 

the exchange notes have been registered under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, which we refer to as the "Securities Act";

 

 


 

the exchange notes are not entitled to certain registration rights, which are applicable to the outstanding notes under the registration rights agreement; and

 

 


 

certain additional interest rate provisions are no longer applicable.

The exchange offer

 

We are offering to exchange up to:

 

 


 

$180,000,000 aggregate principal amount of our 11 1 / 4 % Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014, which have been registered under the Securities Act, for a like aggregate principal amount of the outstanding 11 1 / 4 % Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014.

 

 

 

 

You may only exchange outstanding notes in denominations of $2,000 and integral multiples of $2,000.

 

 

 

 

Subject to the satisfaction or waiver of specified conditions, we will exchange the exchange notes for all outstanding notes that are validly tendered and not validly withdrawn prior to the expiration of the applicable exchange offer. We will cause the exchange to be effected promptly after the expiration of the exchange offer.

 

 

 

 

Upon completion of the exchange offer, there may be no market for the outstanding notes and you may have difficulty selling them.
             

10



Resales

 

Based on interpretations by the staff of the Securities and Exchange Commission, or the "SEC", set forth in no-action letters issued to third parties referred to below, we believe that you may resell or otherwise transfer exchange notes issued in the exchange offer without complying with the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act, if:

 

 

(1)

 

you are acquiring the exchange notes in the ordinary course of your business;

 

 

(2)

 

you do not have an arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in a distribution of the exchange notes;

 

 

(3)

 

you are not an "affiliate" of the Issuer within the meaning of Rule 405 under the Securities Act; and

 

 

(4)

 

you are not engaged in, and do not intend to engage in, a distribution of the exchange notes.

 

 

 

 

If you are not acquiring the exchange notes in the ordinary course of your business, or if you are engaging in, intend to engage in, or have any arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in, a distribution of the exchange notes, or if you are an affiliate of the Issuer, then:

 

 

 

 

(1)

 

you cannot rely on the position of the staff of the SEC enunciated in Morgan Stanley & Co., Inc. (available June 5, 1991), Exxon Capital Holdings Corporation (available May 13, 1988), as interpreted in the SEC's letter to Shearman & Sterling dated July 2, 1993, or similar no-action letters; and

 

 

 

 

(2)

 

in the absence of an exception from the position of the SEC stated in (1) above, you must comply with the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act in connection with any resale or other transfer of the exchange notes.

 

 

 

 

If you are a broker-dealer and receive exchange notes for your own account in exchange for outstanding notes that you acquired as a result of market-making or other trading activities, you must acknowledge that you will deliver a prospectus, as required by law, in connection with any resale or other transfer of the exchange notes that you receive in the exchange offer. See "Plan of distribution."
             

11



Expiration date

 

The exchange offer will expire at 5:00 p.m., New York City time, on            , which is the 21 st business day after the date of this prospectus, unless extended by us. We do not currently intend to extend the expiration date of the exchange offer.

Withdrawal

 

You may withdraw the tender of your outstanding notes at any time prior to the expiration date of the exchange offer. We will return to you any of your outstanding notes that are not accepted for any reason for exchange, without expense to you, promptly after the expiration or termination of the exchange offer.

Interest on the exchange notes and the outstanding notes

 

Each exchange note will bear interest at the rate per annum set forth on the cover page of this prospectus from the most recent date to which interest has been paid on the outstanding notes or, if no interest has been paid on the outstanding notes, from June 29, 2006. The interest will be payable semi-annually on each January 1 and July 1, beginning January 1, 2007. No interest will be paid on outstanding notes following their acceptance for exchange.

Conditions to the exchange offer

 

The exchange offer is subject to customary conditions, which we may assert or waive. See "The exchange offer—Conditions to the exchange offer."

Procedures for tendering outstanding notes

 

If you wish to participate in the exchange offer, you must complete, sign and date the accompanying letter of transmittal, or a facsimile of the letter of transmittal, according to the instructions contained in this prospectus and the letter of transmittal. You must then mail or otherwise deliver the letter of transmittal, or a facsimile of the letter of transmittal, together with the outstanding notes and any other required documents, to the exchange agent at the address set forth on the cover page of the letter of transmittal. If you hold outstanding notes through The Depository Trust Company, or "DTC", and wish to participate in the exchange offer for the outstanding notes, you must comply with the Automated Tender Offer Program procedures of DTC. By signing, or agreeing to be bound by, the letter of transmittal, you will represent to us that, among other things:

 

 

(1)

 

you are acquiring the exchange notes in the ordinary course of your business;

 

 

(2)

 

you do not have an arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in a distribution of the exchange notes;

 

 

(3)

 

you are not an "affiliate" of the Issuer within the meaning of Rule 405 under the Securities Act; and

 

 

(4)

 

you are not engaged in, and do not intend to engage in, a distribution of the exchange notes.
             

12



 

 

 

 

If you are a broker-dealer and receive exchange notes for your own account in exchange for outstanding notes that you acquired as a result of market-making or other trading activities, you must represent to us that you will deliver a prospectus, as required by law, in connection with any resale or other transfer of such exchange notes.

 

 

 

 

If you are not acquiring the exchange notes in the ordinary course of your business, or if you are engaged in, or intend to engage in, or have an arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in, a distribution of the exchange notes, or if you are an affiliate of the Issuer, then you cannot rely on the positions and interpretations of the staff of the SEC and you must comply with the registration and prospectus delivery requirements of the Securities Act in connection with any resale or other transfer of the exchange notes.

Special procedures for beneficial owners

 

If you are a beneficial owner of outstanding notes that are held in the name of a broker, dealer, commercial bank, trust company or other nominee, and you wish to tender those outstanding notes in the exchange offer, you should contact such person promptly and instruct such person to tender those outstanding notes on your behalf.

Guaranteed delivery procedures

 

If you wish to tender your outstanding notes and your outstanding notes are not immediately available or you cannot deliver your outstanding notes, the letter of transmittal and any other documents required by the letter of transmittal or you cannot comply with the DTC procedures for book-entry transfer prior to the expiration date, then you must tender your outstanding notes according to the guaranteed delivery procedures set forth in this prospectus under "The exchange offer—Guaranteed delivery procedures."

Effect on holders of outstanding notes

 

In connection with the sale of the outstanding notes, we entered into a registration rights agreement with the initial purchasers of the outstanding notes that grants the holders of outstanding notes registration rights. By making the exchange offer, we will have fulfilled most of our obligations under the registration rights agreement. Accordingly, we will not be obligated to pay additional interest as described in the registration rights agreement. If you do not tender your outstanding notes in the exchange offer, you will continue to be entitled to all the rights and limitations applicable to the outstanding notes as set forth in the indenture, except we will not have any further obligation to you to provide for the registration of the outstanding notes under the registration rights agreement and we will not be obligated to pay additional interest as described in the registration rights agreement, except in certain limited circumstances. See "Description of notes—registration rights."
             

13



 

 

 

 

 

To the extent that outstanding notes are tendered and accepted in the exchange offer, the trading market for outstanding notes could be adversely affected.

Consequences of failure to exchange

 

All untendered outstanding notes will continue to be subject to the restrictions on transfer set forth in the outstanding notes and in the indenture. In general, the outstanding notes may not be offered or sold, unless registered under the Securities Act, except pursuant to an exemption from, or in a transaction not subject to, the Securities Act and applicable state securities laws. Other than in connection with the exchange offer, we do not currently anticipate that we will register the outstanding notes under the Securities Act.

Material income tax considerations

 

The exchange of outstanding notes for exchange notes in the exchange offer will not be a taxable event for United States federal income tax purposes. See "Certain United States federal income tax consequences."

Use of proceeds

 

We will not receive any cash proceeds from the issuance of exchange notes in the exchange offer.

Exchange agent

 

U.S. Bank National Association, whose address and telephone number are set forth in the section captioned "The exchange offer—exchange agent" of this prospectus, is the exchange agent for the exchange offer.

14



SUMMARY OF THE TERMS OF THE EXCHANGE NOTES

         The terms of the exchange notes are identical in all material respects to the terms of the outstanding notes, except that the exchange notes will not contain terms with respect to transfer restrictions or additional interest upon a failure to fulfill certain of our obligations under the registration rights agreement. The exchange notes will evidence the same debt as the outstanding notes. The exchange notes will be governed by the same indenture under which the outstanding notes were issued, and the exchange notes and the outstanding notes will constitute a single class and series of notes for all purposes under the indenture. The following summary is not intended to be a complete description of the terms of the notes. For a more detailed description of the notes, see "Description of notes."

Issuer   National MENTOR Holdings, Inc.
Securities   $180,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 11 1 / 4 % Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014.
Maturity   July 1, 2014.
Interest payment dates   January 1 and July 1 of each year, commencing January 1, 2007.
Guarantees   The outstanding notes are, and the exchange notes will be guaranteed by all of our existing subsidiaries, except for our captive insurance subsidiary and our non-profit subsidiaries, each of which will also guarantee our obligations under our new senior secured credit facilities. We do not consolidate the results of our non-profit non-guarantor subsidiaries in our financial statements.
    Our consolidated non-guarantor captive insurance subsidiary did not make any contribution to our net revenues during fiscal 2006. This consolidated non-guarantor subsidiary accounted for approximately $3.3 million, or 0.3%, of our total assets and approximately $2.9 million, or 0.4%, of our total liabilities, in each case, as of September 30, 2006.
    Any subsidiaries that in the future guarantee indebtedness under our new senior secured credit facilities will also guarantee the notes. The guarantees will be released when the guarantees of our indebtedness are released.
    The guarantees with respect to the outstanding notes are, and the guarantees with respect to the exchange notes will be, unsecured senior subordinated indebtedness of the guarantors and have the same ranking with respect to indebtedness of our guarantors as the notes have with respect to our indebtedness.
Optional redemption   The notes will be redeemable at our option, in whole or in part, at any time prior to July 1, 2010, at a price equal to 100% of the principal amount of the notes, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the date of redemption, plus a "make-whole" premium (as described in "Description of notes—Optional redemption").
         

15


    The notes will be redeemable at our option, in whole or in part, on or after July 1, 2010, at the redemption prices set forth in this prospectus, plus accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. At any time prior to July 1, 2009, we may redeem up to 35% of the original principal amount of the notes with the proceeds of certain equity offerings at a redemption price of 111.25% of the principal amount of the notes, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the date of redemption as long as at least 65% of the aggregate principal amount of the notes remain outstanding.
Change of control   Upon the occurrence of a change of control, you will have the right to require us to repurchase all or a portion of your notes at a purchase price in cash equal to 101% of the principal amount of the notes, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the date of purchase.
Ranking   The outstanding notes are, and the exchange notes will be, our unsecured senior subordinated obligations and:
      are subordinated in right of payment to our existing and future senior debt, including our new senior secured credit facilities;
      rank equally in right of payment to all of our future senior subordinated debt;
      are effectively subordinated in right of payment to all of our existing and future secured debt (including our new senior secured credit facilities), to the extent of the value of the assets securing such debt, and are structurally subordinated to all obligations of any of our subsidiaries that is not a guarantor of the notes; and
      rank senior in right of payment to all of our future debt and other obligations that are, by their terms, expressly subordinated in right of payment to the notes.
    Similarly, the note guarantees with respect to the outstanding notes are, and the note guarantees with respect to the exchange notes will be, unsecured senior subordinated obligations of the guarantors and:
      are subordinated in right of payment to all of the applicable guarantor's existing and future senior debt, including such guarantor's guarantee under our new senior secured credit facilities;
      rank equally in right of payment to all of the applicable guarantor's future senior subordinated debt, any of National Mentor, Inc.'s old notes not repurchased pursuant to the tender offer and consent solicitation described under "The Transactions" and any guarantor's guarantee of such old notes;
         

16


      are effectively subordinated in right of payment to all of the applicable guarantor's existing and future secured debt (including such guarantor's guarantee under our new senior secured credit facilities), to the extent of the value of the assets securing such debt, and are structurally subordinated to all obligations of any subsidiary of a guarantor if that subsidiary is not also a guarantor of the notes; and
      rank senior in right of payment to all of the applicable guarantor's future subordinated debt and other obligations that are, by their terms, expressly subordinated in right of payment to the notes.
    As of September 30, 2006,
      we had approximately $520.4 million of total indebtedness;
      we had approximately $339.7 million of senior secured indebtedness to which the notes were subordinated, consisting of $334.2 million and $5.5 million under our new senior secured credit facilities and the mortgage facility, respectively, and we had additional availability of $123.2 million under our new $125.0 million revolving credit facility (our new senior credit facilities also include a $20.0 million synthetic letter of credit facility, all of which has been fully utilized);
      our guarantors did not have any senior indebtedness other than their respective guarantees under our new senior secured credit facilities and $5.5 million of borrowings (and guarantees thereof) under our mortgage facility; and
      we did not have any senior subordinated indebtedness other than the notes and $750,000 of our 9 5 / 8 % senior subordinated notes due 2012 ("old notes"), and the guarantors did not have any senior subordinated indebtedness other than their guarantees of the notes and of the old notes.
Covenants   We issued the outstanding notes, and will issue the exchange notes, under an indenture with U.S. Bank National Association, as trustee. The indenture contains covenants that, among other things, limit our ability and the ability of our restricted subsidiaries to:
      incur additional debt or issue certain preferred shares;
      pay dividends on or make distributions in respect of our capital stock or make other restricted payments;
      make certain investments;
      sell certain assets;
      create liens on certain assets to secure debt;
      enter into agreements that restrict dividends from subsidiaries;
      consolidate, merge, sell or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of our assets;
      enter into certain transactions with our affiliates; and
         

17


      designate our subsidiaries as unrestricted subsidiaries.
    These covenants are subject to a number of important exceptions and qualifications. For more details, see "Description of notes—Certain covenants."
No prior market   The exchange notes will generally be freely transferable (subject to certain restrictions discussed in "Description of notes—registration rights") but will be a new issue of securities for which there will not initially be a market. Accordingly, there can be no assurance as to the development or liquidity of any market for the exchange notes. The initial purchasers in the private offering of the outstanding notes have advised us that they currently intend to make a market for the exchange notes, as permitted by applicable laws and regulations. However, they are not obligated to do so and may discontinue any such market making activities at any time without notice. We do not intend to apply for a listing of the exchange notes on any securities exchange or automated dealer quotation system.
Use of proceeds   We will not receive any cash proceeds from the exchange offer.

Risk factors

        In evaluating an investment in the notes, prospective investors should carefully consider, along with the other information in this prospectus, the specific factors set forth under "Risk factors" for risks involved with an investment in the notes.

18



SUMMARY CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

        The following table sets forth historical consolidated financial data for the Company for the periods ended and at the dates indicated below. We have derived the historical consolidated financial data for fiscal 2004, fiscal 2005, the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 from the Company's audited consolidated financial statements, which are included elsewhere in this prospectus. The following summary consolidated financial information should be read in conjunction with "Selected historical consolidated financial data," "Management's discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations," "The Transactions," "Unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information" and the historical consolidated financial statements and the related notes thereto and pro forma financial information included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 
  Predecessor
  Successor
 
 
  Year Ended September 30,
  Period from
October 1 through
June 29,

  Period from
June 30 through
September 30,

 
(dollars in thousands)

  2004
  2005
  2006
  2006
 
Statement of operations data:                          
Net revenues   $ 648,493   $ 693,826   $ 580,356   $ 208,881  
Cost of revenues     491,884     524,618     439,878     160,164  
Gross profit     156,609     169,208     140,478     48,717  
Operating expenses:                          
  General and administrative     86,856     93,491     78,608     29,738  
  Stock option settlement             26,880      
  Transaction costs             9,136      
  Depreciation and amortization     21,484     21,743     17,539     11,714  
Income from operations     48,269     53,974     8,315     7,265  
  Management fee of related party     (257 )   (270 )   (198 )   (227 )
  Other (expense) income, net     (2,581 )   (192 )   (177 )   (60 )
  Interest income     68     661     646     256  
  Interest expense     (26,893 )   (29,905 )   (51,719 )   (13,120 )
Income (loss) before provision (benefit) for income taxes     18,606     24,268     (43,133 )   (5,886 )
Provision (benefit) for income taxes     8,423     10,270     (11,347 )   (2,222 )
Net income (loss)   $ 10,183   $ 13,998   $ (31,786 ) $ (3,664 )
Other financial data:                          
Cash flows provided by (used in):                          
  Operating activities   $ 37,671   $ 36,392   $ 37,710   $ (36,312 )
  Investing activities     (19,975 )   (19,687 )   (39,848 )   (382,153 )
  Financing activities     (9,084 )   (11,814 )   (13,022 )   433,333  
Capital expenditures     15,601     14,626     (9,976 )   (5,821 )
Program rent expense(1) (unaudited)     11,899     13,305     12,816     5,078  
EBITDA(2) (unaudited)     66,915     75,255     25,479     18,692  
 
   
   
   
  Successor
 
   
   
   
  As of
September 30, 2006

Balance sheet data:                  
Cash and cash equivalents   $ 29,015
Working capital(3)     55,423
Total assets     1,000,665
Total debt     520,365
Shareholders' equity     248,868

(1)
Program rent expense is defined as lease expenses related to buildings directly utilized in providing services to clients.

(2)
"EBITDA" represents income before interest expense and interest income, income taxes, depreciation and amortization. EBITDA is not intended to represent cash flow from operations as defined by GAAP and should not be used as an alternative to net income as indicators of operating performance or to cash flow as a measure of liquidity. EBITDA is included because it is the basis upon which our management assesses financial performance. While EBITDA is frequently used as a measure of operating performance and the ability to meet debt service requirements, it is not necessarily comparable to other similarly titled captions of other companies due to potential inconsistencies in the method of calculation.

19


 
  Predecessor
  Successor
 
 
  Year Ended
September 30,

  Period from October 1 through
June 29,

  Period from
June 30 through
September 30,

 
(dollars in thousands)

  2004
  2005
  2006
  2006
 
Net income (loss)   $ 10,183   $ 13,998   $ (31,786 ) $ (3,664 )
Provision (benefit) for income taxes     8,423     10,270     (11,347 )   (2,222 )
Interest income     (68 )   (661 )   (646 )   (256 )
Interest expense     26,893     29,905     51,719     13,120  
Depreciation and amortization     21,484     21,743     17,539     11,714  
   
 
 
 
 
EBITDA (unaudited)   $ 66,915   $ 75,255   $ 25,479   $ 18,692  
(3)
Working capital is calculated as current assets minus current liabilities.

20



RISK FACTORS

         You should carefully consider the following risk factors in addition to the other information contained in this prospectus before participating in the exchange offer. Any of the following risks could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flow, which in turn could adversely affect our ability to pay interest and/or principal on the notes. Additional risks and uncertainties not currently known to us or that we currently view as immaterial may also materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flow.

Risks Related to Our Business

Reductions or changes in Medicaid funding or changes in budgetary priorities by the state and county governments that pay for our services could have a material adverse effect on our revenues and profitability.

        We derive substantially all of our revenues from contracts with state and local governments. These governmental payors fund a significant portion of their payments to us through Medicaid, a joint federal/state health insurance program through which state expenditures are matched by federal dollars ranging from 50 percent to more than 77 percent of total costs, a number based largely on a state's per capita income. Our revenues, therefore, are determined by the size of federal, state and local governmental spending for the services we provide. Budgetary pressures, as well as economic, industry, political and other factors, could cause the federal and state governments to limit spending, which could significantly reduce our revenues, margins and profitability and adversely affect our growth strategy. Governmental agencies generally condition their contracts with us upon a sufficient budgetary appropriation. If a government agency does not receive an appropriation sufficient to cover its contractual obligations with us, it may terminate a contract or defer or reduce our reimbursement. In addition, there is risk that previously appropriated funds could be reduced through subsequent legislation. Many states in which we operate have experienced budgetary pressures from time to time and, during these times, some of these states have initiated service reductions, rate freezes and/or rate reductions. Similarly, programmatic changes such as conversions to managed care, governmental efforts to increase consumer autonomy and reduce provider oversight, coverage and other changes under state Medicaid plans, may cause unanticipated costs and risks to service delivery. The loss or reduction of or changes to reimbursement under our contracts could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and operating results.

Failure to obtain increases in reimbursement rates could adversely affect our revenues, cash flows and profitability.

        Our revenues and operating profitability depend on our ability to maintain our existing reimbursement levels and to obtain periodic increases in reimbursement rates to meet higher costs and demand for more services. Approximately 16% of our revenue is derived from contracts based on a cost reimbursement model where we are reimbursed for our services based on our costs plus an agreed-upon margin. If we do not receive or cannot negotiate increases in reimbursement rates at approximately the same time as our costs of providing services increase, including labor costs and rent, our margins and profitability could be adversely affected. Changes in how federal and state government agencies operate reimbursement programs can also affect our operating results and financial condition. Some states have, from time to time, revised their rate-setting methodologies in a manner that has resulted in rate decreases. In some instances, changes in rate-setting methodologies have resulted in third-party payors disallowing, in whole or in part, our requests for reimbursement. Any reduction in or the failure to maintain or increase our reimbursement rates could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Changes in the manner in which state agencies interpret program policies and procedures or review and audit billings and costs could also adversely

21



affect our business, financial condition and operating results and our ability to meet obligations under our indebtedness.

Our variable cost structure is directly related to our labor costs, which may be adversely affected by labor shortages or deterioration in labor relations.

        Our variable cost structure and operating profitability are directly related to our labor costs. Labor costs may be adversely affected by a variety of factors, including a limited supply of qualified personnel in any geographic area, local competitive forces, the ineffective utilization of our labor force, increases in minimum wages, health care costs and other personnel costs, and adverse changes in client service models. Some of our operating units have incurred higher labor costs in certain markets from time to time because of difficulty in hiring qualified direct service staff. These higher labor costs have resulted from increased wages and overtime and the costs associated with recruitment and retention, training programs and use of temporary staffing personnel. In part to help with the challenge of recruiting and retaining direct care employees, we offer these employees a full benefits package that includes paid time off, health insurance, dental insurance, vision coverage, life insurance and a 401(k) plan, and these costs can be significant.

        Our employees are generally not unionized. However, as of September 30, 2006, approximately 17 of our employees were represented by a labor union. We may not be able to negotiate labor agreements on satisfactory terms with our existing or any future labor unions. In addition, future unionization activities may result in an increase of our labor and other costs. If any of the employees covered in the future by collective bargaining agreements were to engage in a strike, work stoppage or other slowdown, we could experience a disruption of our operations and/or higher ongoing labor costs, which could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

The nature of our operations could subject us to substantial claims, some of which may not be fully insured against or reserved for.

        We are in the human services business and therefore we have been and continue to be subject to claims alleging that we, our Mentors or our employees failed to provide proper care for a client, as well as claims by our clients, our Mentors, our employees or community members against us for negligence or intentional misconduct. Included in our recent claims are claims alleging personal injury, assault, battery, abuse, wrongful death and other charges. Regulatory agencies may initiate administrative proceedings alleging that our programs, employees or agents violate statutes and regulations and seek to impose monetary penalties on us. We could be required to incur significant costs to respond to regulatory investigations or defend against civil lawsuits and, if we do not prevail, we could be required to pay substantial amounts of money in damages, settlement amounts or penalties arising from these legal proceedings. We currently self-insure for amounts of up to $1.0 million per claim and up to $2.0 million in the aggregate. Above these limits, we have limited additional third-party coverage. In connection with the Merger, we purchased additional insurance for certain claims relating to pre-Merger periods. An award in excess of our third-party insurance limits and self-insurance reserves could have a material adverse impact on our operations and cash flow and could adversely impact our ability to continue to purchase appropriate liability insurance. Even if we are successful in our defense, civil lawsuits or regulatory proceedings could also irreparably damage our reputation.

        We also are subject to potential lawsuits under the False Claims Act or other federal whistleblower statutes designed to combat fraud and abuse in the health care industry. These lawsuits can involve significant monetary awards and bounties to private plaintiffs who successfully bring these suits. Finally, we are also subject to employee related claims including wrongful discharge or discrimination, a violation of equal employment law and novel intentional tort claims.

22



The nature of services that we provide could subject us to significant worker's compensation related liability, some of which may not be fully reserved for.

        We use a combination of insurance and self-insurance plans to provide for potential liability for worker's compensation claims. Because of our high ratio of employees per client, and because of the inherent physical risk associated with the interaction of employees with MR/DD, ARY, and ABI clients, the potential for incidents giving rise to worker's compensation liability is very high.

        Liabilities associated with workers' compensation risk retained by us are estimated each quarter and reserves are established each quarter based on internal valuations, third-party actuarial input, historical loss development factors and other assumptions believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. Our results of operations could be adversely impacted if actual future occurrences and claims exceed our assumptions and historical trends.

If any of the state and county government agencies with whom we have contracts determines that we have not complied with our contracts or violated any applicable laws or regulations, our revenues may decrease, we may be subject to fines or penalties and we may be required to restructure our billing and collection methods.

        We derive virtually all of our revenues from state and local government agencies, and a substantial portion of these revenues is state-funded with federal Medicaid matching dollars. As a result of our participation in these government funded programs, we are often subject to governmental reviews, audits and investigations to verify our compliance with applicable laws and regulations. As a result of these reviews, audits and investigations, these governmental payors may be entitled to, in their discretion:

        As a result of past reviews and audits of our operations, we have been subject to some of these actions from time to time. While we do not currently believe that our existing audit proceedings will have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or significantly harm our reputation, we cannot assure you that similar actions in the future will not do so. In addition, such proceedings could have a material adverse impact on our results of operations in a future reporting period. In some states, we operate on a cost reimbursement model in which revenues are recognized at the time costs are incurred. In these states, payors audit our historical costs on a regular basis, and if it is determined that we do not have enough costs to justify our rates, our rates may be reduced, or we may be required to retroactively return fees paid to us. In some cases we have experienced negative audit adjustments which are based on subjective judgments of reasonableness, necessity or allocation of costs in our services provided to clients. These adjustments are generally required to be negotiated as part of the overall audit resolution and may result in paybacks to payors and adjustments of the rates. We cannot assure you that our rates will be maintained, or that we will be able to keep all payments made to us until an audit of the relevant period is complete.

23



If we fail to establish and maintain relationships with officials of government agencies, we may not be able to successfully procure or retain government-sponsored contracts, which could negatively impact our revenues.

        To facilitate our ability to procure or retain government-sponsored contracts, we rely in part on establishing and maintaining relationships with officials of various government agencies. These relationships enable us to maintain and renew existing contracts and obtain new contracts and referrals. The effectiveness of our relationships may be reduced or eliminated with changes in the personnel holding various government offices or staff positions. We also may lose key personnel who have these relationships and such personnel are generally not subject to non-compete or non-solicitation covenants. Any failure to establish, maintain or manage relationships with government and agency personnel may hinder our ability to procure or retain government-sponsored contracts.

Negative publicity or changes in public perception of our services may adversely affect our ability to obtain new contracts and renew existing ones.

        Our success in obtaining new contracts and renewals of our existing contracts depends upon maintaining our reputation as a quality service provider among governmental authorities, advocacy groups, families of our clients and the public. Negative publicity, changes in public perception and government investigations with respect to our operations could damage our reputation and hinder our ability to retain contracts, obtain new contracts, and could reduce referrals, increase government scrutiny and compliance costs, or generally discourage clients from using our services. Any of these events could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and operating results.

We face substantial competition in attracting and retaining experienced personnel, and we may be unable to maintain or grow our business if we cannot attract and retain qualified employees.

        Our success depends to a significant degree on our ability to attract and retain qualified and experienced social service professionals who possess the skills and experience necessary to deliver quality services to our clients. We face competition for certain categories of our employees, particularly service provider employees, based on the wages, benefits and other working conditions we offer. Contractual requirements and client needs determine the number, education and experience levels of social service professionals we hire. Our ability to attract and retain employees with the requisite credentials, experience and skills depends on several factors including, but not limited to, our ability to offer competitive wages, benefits and professional growth opportunities. The inability to attract and retain experienced personnel could have a material adverse effect on our business.

We may not realize the anticipated benefits of any future acquisitions and we may experience difficulties in integrating these acquisitions.

        As part of our growth strategy, we intend to make selective acquisitions. Growing our business through acquisitions involves risks because with any acquisition there is the possibility that:

24


        As a result of these risks, there can be no assurance that any future acquisition will be successful or that it will not have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

A loss of our status as a licensed service provider in any jurisdiction could result in the termination of existing services and our inability to market our services in that jurisdiction.

        We operate in numerous jurisdictions and are required to maintain licenses and certifications in order to conduct our operations in each of them. Each state and county has its own regulations, which can be complicated, and each of our service lines can be regulated differently within a particular jurisdiction. As a result, maintaining the necessary licenses and certifications to conduct our operations can be cumbersome. Our licenses and certifications could be suspended, revoked or terminated for a number of reasons, including:

        We have had some of our licenses or certifications temporarily placed on probationary status or suspended. If we lost our status as a licensed provider of human services in any jurisdiction or any other required certification, we would be unable to market our services in that jurisdiction, and the contracts under which we provide services in that jurisdiction would be subject to termination. Moreover, such an event could constitute a violation of provisions of contracts in other jurisdictions, resulting in other contract, license or certification terminations. Any of these events could have a material adverse effect on our operations.

We are subject to extensive governmental regulations, which require significant compliance expenditures, and a failure to comply with these regulations could adversely affect our business.

        We must comply with comprehensive government regulation of our business, including statutes, regulations and policies governing the licensing of our facilities, the maintenance and management of our work place for our employees, the quality of our service, the revenues we receive for our services, and reimbursement for the cost of our services. Compliance with these laws, regulations and policies is expensive, and if we fail to comply with these laws, regulations and policies, we could lose contracts and the related revenues, thereby harming our financial results. State and federal regulatory agencies

25



have broad discretionary powers over the administration and enforcement of laws and regulations that govern our operations. A material violation of a law or regulation could subject us to fines and penalties and in some circumstances could disqualify some or all of the facilities and programs under our control from future participation in Medicaid or other government programs. The Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996 ("HIPAA"), which requires the establishment of privacy standards for health care information storage, retrieval and dissemination as well as electronic transmission and security standards, could increase potential penalties in certain of our businesses if we fail to comply with these privacy and security standards.

        Expenses incurred under governmental agency contracts for any of our services, as well as management contracts with providers of record for such agencies, are subject to review by agencies administering the contracts and services. Representatives of those agencies visit our group homes to verify compliance with state and local regulations governing our home operations. A negative outcome from any of these examinations could increase government scrutiny, increase compliance costs or hinder our ability to obtain or retain contracts. Any of these events could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and operating results.

Compliance with the securities laws and regulations may increase our compliance costs and put significant demands on our management resources.

        The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, to the extent we are subject to it, will require changes in some of our corporate governance and compliance practices. We are in the process of evaluating, testing and implementing internal controls over financial reporting to enable management to report on, and our independent registered public accounting firm to attest to, such internal controls as required by Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. While we expect to be compliant with the requirements of Section 404 when required, we cannot be certain as to the timing of the completion of our evaluation, testing and remediation or the impact of the same on our operations. The decentralized nature of our operations makes compliance with the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act more challenging. If we are not able to implement the requirements of Section 404 in a timely manner or with adequate compliance, we may be subject to investigation and sanctions by regulatory authorities such as the SEC. As a result there could be a negative reaction in the financial markets due to a loss of confidence in the reliability of our financial statements. In addition, we may be required to incur costs in improving our internal controls and hiring additional personnel. Any such events could negatively affect our financial condition and operating results.

The high level of competition in our industry could adversely affect our contract and revenue base.

        We compete with a wide variety of competitors, ranging from small, local agencies to a few large, national organizations. Competitive factors may favor other providers and reduce our ability to obtain contracts, which would hinder our growth. Not-for-profit organizations are active in all states and range from small agencies serving a limited area with specific programs to multi-state organizations. Smaller local organizations may have a better understanding of the local conditions and may be better able to gain political and public acceptance. Not-for-profit providers may be affiliated with advocacy groups, health organizations or religious organizations that have substantial influence with legislators and government agencies. Increased competition may result in pricing pressures, loss of or failure to gain market share or loss of clients or payors, any of which could harm our business.

We rely on third parties to refer clients to our facilities and programs.

        We receive substantially all of our clients from third-party referrals and are governed by the anti-kickback/non-self referral statute. Our reputation and prior experience with agency staff, care workers and others in positions to make referrals to us are important for building and maintaining our

26



operations. Any event that harms our reputation or creates negative experiences with such third parties could impact our ability to receive referrals and grow our client base.

Home and community-based human services may become less popular among our targeted client populations and/or state and local governments, which would adversely affect our results of operations.

        Our growth depends on the continuation of trends in our industry toward providing services to individuals in smaller, community-based settings and increasing the percentage of individuals served by non-governmental providers. The continuation of these trends and our future success are subject to a variety of political, economic, social and legal pressures, virtually all of which are beyond our control. A reversal in the downsizing and privatization trends could reduce the demand for our services, which could adversely affect our revenues and profitability.

Regulations that require ARY services to be provided through not-for-profit organizations could harm our revenues or gross margin.

        Approximately 5% of our net revenues for fiscal 2006, was derived from contracts with subsidiaries of Alliance Health and Human Services, Inc. or "Alliance," an independent not-for-profit organization that has a license or contract from several state or local agencies to provide ARY services.

        Historically, some state governments have interpreted federal law to preclude them from receiving federal reimbursement under Title IV-E of the Social Security Act for ARY services provided under a contract with a proprietary organization. However, in 2005 the "Fair Access Foster Care Act of 2005" was signed into law, thereby allowing states to seek reimbursement from the federal government for ARY services provided by proprietary organizations. In some jurisdictions that interpreted the prior federal law to preclude them from seeking reimbursement for ARY services provided under a contract with a proprietary provider, or in others that prefer to contract with not-for-profit providers, we provide ARY services as a subcontractor of Alliance. We do not control Alliance, and none of our employees or agents has a role in the management of Alliance. Although Edward Murphy, our President and Chief Executive Officer, was an officer and director of Alliance immediately prior to becoming our President in September 2004, Mr. Murphy has no further role in the management of Alliance. Our ARY business could be harmed if Alliance chooses to discontinue all or a portion of its service agreements with us. Our ARY business could also be harmed if the state or local governments that prefer that ARY services be provided by not-for-profit organizations determine that they do not want the service performed indirectly by for-profit companies like us on behalf of not-for-profit organizations. We cannot assure you that our contracts with Alliance will continue, and if these contracts are terminated, it could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and operating results. Alliance and its subsidiaries are organized as non-profit corporations and are recognized as tax-exempt under section 501(c)(3) of the Internal Revenue Code. As such, Alliance is subject to the public charity regulations of the states in which it operates and to the regulations of the Internal Revenue Service governing tax-exempt entities. If Alliance fails to comply with the laws and regulations of the states in which it operates or with the rules of the Internal Revenue Service, it could be subject to penalties and sanctions, including the loss of tax-exempt status, which could preclude it from continuing to contract with certain state and local governments. Our business would be harmed if Alliance lost its contracts and was therefore unable to continue to contract with us.

Government reimbursement procedures are time-consuming and complex, and failure to comply with these procedures could adversely affect our liquidity, cash flows and operating results.

        The government reimbursement process is time consuming and complex, and there can be delays before we receive payment. Government reimbursement, group home credentialing and MR/DD client Medicaid eligibility and service authorization procedures are often complicated and burdensome, and delays can result from, among other reasons, securing documentation and coordinating necessary

27



eligibility paperwork between agencies. These reimbursement and procedural issues occasionally cause us to have to resubmit claims several times before payment is remitted. If there is a billing error, the process to resolve the error may be time consuming and costly. To the extent that complexity associated with billing for our services causes delays in our cash collections, we assume the financial risk of increased carrying costs associated with the aging of our accounts receivable as well as increased potential for write-offs. We can provide no assurance that we will be able to maintain our current levels of collectibility in future periods. The risks associated with third-party payors and the inability to monitor and manage accounts receivable successfully could have a material adverse effect on our liquidity, cash flows and operating results.

We conduct a significant percent of our operations in Minnesota and, as a result, we are particularly susceptible to any reduction in budget appropriations for our services or any other adverse developments in that state.

        For fiscal 2006, approximately 17% of our combined revenues was generated from contracts with government agencies in the state of Minnesota. Accordingly, any reduction in Minnesota's budgetary appropriations for our services, whether as a result of fiscal constraints due to recession, changes in policy or otherwise, could result in a reduction in our fees and possibly the loss of contracts. In the past, our operations in Minnesota were subject to rate reductions, although we have received rate increases in Minnesota for fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2007. The concentration of our operations in Minnesota also makes us particularly susceptible to many of the other risks described above occurring in this state, including:

        Any of these adverse developments occurring in Minnesota could result in a reduction in revenue or a loss of contracts, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations, financial position and cash flows.

We depend upon the continued services of certain members of our senior management team, without whom our business operations could be significantly disrupted.

        Our success depends, in part, on the continued contributions of our executive officers and other key employees. Our management team has significant industry experience and would be difficult to replace. If we lose or suffer an extended interruption in the service of one or more of our senior officers, our financial condition and operating results could be adversely affected. The market for qualified individuals is highly competitive and we may not be able to attract and retain qualified personnel to replace or succeed members of our senior management or other key employees, should the need arise.

Our success depends on our ability to manage growing and changing operations.

        Since 1998, our business has grown significantly in size and complexity. This growth has placed, and is expected to continue to place, significant demands on our management, systems, internal controls and financial and physical resources. Our operations are highly decentralized, with many billing, accounting, collection and payment functions being performed at the local level. This requires us to expend significant resources implementing and monitoring compliance at the local level. In addition, we expect that we will need to further develop our financial and managerial controls and reporting systems to accommodate future growth. This could require us to incur expenses for hiring additional qualified personnel, retaining professionals to assist in developing the appropriate control

28



systems and expanding our information technology infrastructure. The nature of our business is such that qualified management personnel can be difficult to find. Our inability to manage growth effectively could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations, financial position and cash flows.

We may be more vulnerable to the effects of a public health catastrophe than other businesses due to the nature of our clients.

        Our primary clients are individuals with developmental disabilities, brain injuries, or emotionally behavioral or medically complex challenges, many of whom may be more vulnerable than the general public in a public health catastrophe. For example, if a flu pandemic were to occur we could suffer significant losses to our client population and, at a high cost, be required to hire replacement staff and Mentors for workers who drop out of the workforce in very tight labor markets. Accordingly, certain public health catastrophes such as a flu pandemic could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

We are controlled by our principal equityholder, which has the power to take unilateral action.

        Vestar controls our business affairs and policies. Circumstances may occur in which the interests of Vestar could be in conflict with the interests of our debt holders. In addition, Vestar may have an interest in pursuing acquisitions, divestitures or other transactions that, in their judgment, could enhance their equity investment, even though such transactions might involve risks to our debt holders. Vestar is in the business of making investments in companies and may from time to time acquire and hold interests in businesses that compete directly or indirectly with us. Vestar may also pursue acquisition opportunities that may be complementary to our business and, as a result, those acquisition opportunities may not be available to us. So long as investment funds associated with or designated by Vestar continue to own a significant amount of our equity interests, even if such amount is less than 50%, Vestar will continue to be able to strongly influence or effectively control our decisions.

Risks Related to the Notes

Our level of indebtedness could adversely affect our ability to raise additional capital to fund our operations, limit our ability to react to changes in the economy or our industry and prevent us from meeting our obligations under the notes.

        We have a significant amount of indebtedness. As of September 30, 2006, we had total indebtedness of approximately $520.4 million and $123.2 million of availability under our new $125.0 million senior revolving credit facility. Our new senior credit facilities also include a $20.0 million synthetic letter of credit facility, all of which has been fully utilized.

        Our substantial degree of leverage could have important consequences, including the following:

29


        Subject to restrictions in the indenture governing the notes and the credit agreement governing our senior secured credit facilities, we may be able to incur more debt in the future, which may intensify the risks described in this prospectus. All of the borrowings under our new senior secured credit facilities are secured by substantially all of our assets and would rank senior to the notes and the guarantees.

        In addition to our high level of indebtedness, we have significant rental obligations under our operating leases for our group homes, other service facilities and administrative offices. For fiscal 2005 and fiscal 2006, our aggregate rental payments for these leases, including taxes and operating expenses, were approximately $24.6 million and $30.1 million, respectively. These obligations could further increase the risks described above.

We are a holding company and may not have access to sufficient cash to make payments on the notes.

        We are a holding company with no direct operations. Our principal assets are the direct and indirect equity interests we hold in our subsidiaries. As a result, we will be dependent upon dividends and other payments from our subsidiaries to generate the funds necessary to meet our outstanding debt service and other obligations. Our subsidiaries' earnings will depend on their financial and operating performance, which will be affected by prevailing economic and competitive conditions and by financial, business and other factors beyond our control. Our subsidiaries may not generate sufficient cash from operations to enable us to make principal and interest payments on our indebtedness, including the notes, or to fund our other cash obligations. In addition, any payments of dividends, distributions, loans or advances to us by our subsidiaries could be subject to restrictions on dividends under applicable local law in the jurisdictions in which our subsidiaries operate.

        Our subsidiaries are separate and distinct legal entities and, except for our existing and future subsidiaries that will be the guarantors of the notes, they will have no obligation, contingent or otherwise, to pay amounts due under the notes or to make any funds available to pay those amounts, whether by dividend, distribution, loan or other payment. The notes will be structurally subordinated to all indebtedness and other obligations of any non-guarantor subsidiaries. In addition, any guarantee of the notes will be subordinated to any senior indebtedness of a guarantor to the same extent that the notes are subordinated to our senior indebtedness.

        If we are unable to service our debt, we will be forced to take actions such as revising or delaying our strategic plans, reducing or delaying capital expenditures, selling assets, restructuring or refinancing our debt, including the notes, or seeking additional equity capital. We may be unable to effect any of these remedies on satisfactory terms, or at all. Our new senior secured credit facilities and the indenture that will govern the notes will restrict our ability to dispose of assets and use the proceeds from such dispositions. We may not be able to consummate those dispositions or to use those proceeds to meet any debt service obligations then due. See "Description of other indebtness—New senior secured credit facilities" and "Description of notes."

        If we cannot make scheduled payments on our debt, we will be in default and, as a result:

30



Covenants in our debt agreements restrict our business in many ways.

        The indenture governing the notes contains various covenants that limit our ability and/or our restricted subsidiaries' ability to, among other things:

        Our new senior secured credit facilities also contain restrictive covenants and require us to maintain specified financial ratios and satisfy other financial condition tests. Our ability to meet those financial ratios and tests can be affected by events beyond our control, and we cannot assure you that we will meet those tests. The breach of any of these covenants or financial ratios could result in a default under our new senior secured credit facilities and the lenders could elect to declare all amounts borrowed thereunder, together with accrued interest, to be due and payable and could proceed against the collateral securing that indebtedness.

If we default on our obligations to pay our indebtedness we may not be able to make payments on the notes.

        Any default under the agreements governing our indebtedness, including a default under our new senior secured credit facilities that is not waived by the required lenders, and the remedies sought by the holders of such indebtedness could render us unable to pay principal, premium, if any, and interest on the notes and substantially decrease the market value of the notes. If we are unable to generate sufficient cash flows and are otherwise unable to obtain funds necessary to meet required payments of principal, premium, if any, and interest on our indebtedness, or if we otherwise fail to comply with the various covenants, including financial and operating covenants, in the instruments governing our indebtedness (including covenants in the indenture governing the notes and our new senior secured credit facilities), we could be in default under the terms of the agreements governing such indebtedness, including our new senior secured credit facilities and the indenture governing the notes. In the event of such default, the holders of such indebtedness could elect to declare all the funds borrowed thereunder to be due and payable, together with accrued and unpaid interest, the lenders under our new senior secured credit facilities could elect to terminate their commitments thereunder, cease making further loans and foreclose against the assets securing their borrowings, and we could be forced into bankruptcy or liquidation. If our operating performance declines, we may in the future need to obtain waivers from the required lenders under our new senior secured credit facilities to avoid being in default. If we breach our covenants under our new senior secured credit facilities and seek a waiver, we may not be able to obtain a waiver from the required lenders. If this occurs, we would be in default under our new senior secured credit facilities, the lenders could exercise their rights, as

31



described above, and we could be forced into bankruptcy or liquidation. See "Description of other indebtedness—New senior secured credit facilities" and "Description of notes."

Your right to receive payments on the notes and the guarantees is junior to the obligations under our new senior secured credit facilities and possibly all our future borrowings.

        The notes and the related guarantees rank behind all of our and our guarantors' existing and future senior obligations, including indebtedness and guarantees under our new senior secured credit facilities. As a result, upon any distribution to our creditors or the creditors of the guarantors in a bankruptcy, liquidation or reorganization or similar proceeding relating to us or the guarantors or our or their property, the holders of senior indebtedness of ours and the guarantors will be entitled to be paid in full in cash before any payment may be made with respect to the notes or the related guarantees.

        All payments on the notes and the guarantees will be blocked in the event of a payment default on designated senior indebtedness and may be blocked for up to 179 consecutive days in the event of certain nonpayment defaults on designated senior indebtedness.

        In the event of a bankruptcy, liquidation, dissolution, reorganization or similar proceeding relating to us or the guarantors, holders of the notes will participate with all other holders of senior subordinated indebtedness in the assets remaining after we and the guarantors have paid all of our senior indebtedness. However, because the indenture requires that amounts otherwise payable to holders of the notes in a bankruptcy or similar proceeding be paid to holders of senior indebtedness instead, holders of the notes may receive less, ratably, than holders of trade payables in any bankruptcy or similar proceeding. In any of these cases, we and the guarantors may not have sufficient funds to pay all of our creditors, and holders of the notes may receive less, ratably, than the holders of senior indebtedness.

        As of September 30, 2006, we had approximately $339.7 million of senior secured indebtedness to which the notes were subordinated, consisting of $334.2 million and $5.5 million under our new senior secured credit facilities and the mortgage facility, respectively, and we had additional availability of $123.2 million under the new $125.0 million revolving credit facility. Our new senior credit facilities also include a $20.0 million synthetic letter of credit facility, all of which was fully utilized as of September 30, 2006. We may be permitted to borrow substantial additional indebtedness, including senior indebtedness, in the future under the terms of the indenture and the new senior secured credit facilities.

Our obligations under our new senior secured credit facilities are secured by certain of our assets.

        In addition to being contractually subordinated to all existing and future senior indebtedness, our obligations under the notes are unsecured while our obligations under our new senior secured credit facilities are secured by first-priority or equivalent security interests in substantially all of our assets, including all the capital stock of, or other equity interests in, certain of our existing and future domestic subsidiaries. If we or one of our significant subsidiaries are declared bankrupt or insolvent or if we default under our new senior secured credit facilities, all of the funds borrowed thereunder may immediately become due and payable, which would occur automatically in the case of certain bankruptcy and insolvency events with respect to us. If we were unable to repay those amounts, the lenders could foreclose on the assets (including the stock of our subsidiaries) in which they have been granted a security interest, in each case to your exclusion, even if an event of default exists under the indenture governing the notes at that time. In the event of any distribution or payment of our assets or the assets of any guarantor in any foreclosure, dissolution, winding up, liquidation, reorganization or other bankruptcy proceedings, holders of the notes will participate ratably with all holders of our senior subordinated indebtedness that is deemed to be of the same class as the notes, and potentially with all

32



of our other general creditors, based upon the respective amounts owed to each holder or creditor, in our remaining assets. In any of the foregoing events, we cannot assure you that there will be sufficient assets to pay amounts due on the notes. As a result, holders of notes may receive less, ratably, than holders of senior indebtedness or other creditors.

The lenders under the new senior credit facilities will have the discretion to release the guarantors under the new senior credit agreement in a variety of circumstances, which will cause those guarantors to be released from their guarantees of the notes.

        While any obligations under the new senior credit facilities remain outstanding, the lenders under the new senior credit facilities may release any of the guarantors from their guarantee of the new senior credit facilities. If a guarantor is released under the new senior credit facilities, the guarantor will automatically be released from its guarantee of the notes without action by, or consent of, any holder of the notes or the trustee under the indenture governing the notes. See "Description of notes." The lenders under the new senior credit facilities will have the discretion to release the guarantees under the new senior credit facilities in a variety of circumstances. You will not have a claim as a creditor against any subsidiary that is no longer a guarantor of the notes, and the indebtedness and other liabilities, including trade payables, whether secured or unsecured, of those subsidiaries will effectively be senior to claims of holders of the notes.

The exchange notes will be structurally subordinated to all indebtedness of our subsidiaries that do not guarantee the notes.

        You will not have any claim as a creditor against any of our subsidiaries that are not or do not become guarantors of the notes or that are no longer guarantors of the notes. Indebtedness and other liabilities, including trade payables, whether secured or unsecured, of those subsidiaries will be effectively senior to your claims against those subsidiaries. In addition, the indenture governing the notes will, subject to some limitations, permit these subsidiaries to incur additional indebtedness and will not contain any limitation on the amount of other liabilities, such as trade payables, that may be incurred by these subsidiaries. On the issue date, the exchange notes will be guaranteed on a senior subordinated basis by all of our existing subsidiaries, except for our captive insurance subsidiary and non-profit subsidiaries.

We may not be able to repurchase the notes upon a change of control.

        Upon the occurrence of specific kinds of change of control events, we will be required to offer to repurchase all outstanding notes at 101% of their principal amount plus accrued and unpaid interest. We may not be able to repurchase the notes upon a change of control because we may not have sufficient funds. Further, we may be contractually restricted under the terms of our new senior secured credit facilities or other future senior indebtedness from repurchasing all of the notes tendered by holders upon a change of control. Accordingly, we may not be able to satisfy our obligations to purchase your notes unless we are able to refinance or obtain waivers under our new senior secured credit facilities. Our failure to repurchase the notes upon a change of control would cause a default under the indenture and a cross-default under our new senior secured credit facilities. Our new senior secured credit facilities also provides that a change of control, as defined in such agreement, will be a default that permits lenders to accelerate the maturity of borrowings thereunder and, if such debt is not paid, to enforce security interests in the collateral securing such debt, thereby limiting our ability to raise cash to purchase the notes, and reducing the practical benefit of the offer-to-purchase provisions to the holders of the notes. Any of our future debt agreements may contain similar provisions.

        In addition, the change of control provisions in the indenture may not protect you from certain important corporate events, such as a leveraged recapitalization (which would increase the level of our indebtedness), reorganization, restructuring, merger or other similar transaction, unless such transaction

33



constitutes a "Change of Control" under the indenture. Such a transaction may not involve a change in voting power or beneficial ownership or, even if it does, may not involve a change that constitutes a "Change of Control" as defined in the indenture that would trigger our obligation to repurchase the notes. Therefore, if an event occurs that does not constitute a "Change of Control" as defined in the indenture, we will not be required to make an offer to repurchase the notes and you may be required to continue to hold your notes despite the event. See "Description of notes—Change of control."

Federal and state fraudulent transfer laws permit a court to void the notes and the guarantees, and, if that occurs, you may not receive any payments on the notes.

        The issuance of the notes and the guarantees may be subject to review under federal and state fraudulent transfer and conveyance statutes. While the relevant laws may vary from state to state, under such laws the payment of consideration will be a fraudulent conveyance if (i) we paid the consideration with the intent of hindering, delaying or defrauding creditors or (ii) we or any of our guarantors, as applicable, received less than reasonably equivalent value or fair consideration in return for issuing either the notes or a guarantee, and, in the case of (ii) only, one of the following is also true:


        If a court were to find that the issuance of the notes or a guarantee was a fraudulent conveyance, the court could void the payment obligations under the notes or such guarantee or further subordinate the notes or such guarantee to presently existing and future indebtedness of ours or such guarantor, or require the holders of the notes to repay any amounts received with respect to the notes or such guarantee. In the event of a finding that a fraudulent conveyance occurred, you may not receive any repayment on the notes. Further, the voidance of the notes could result in an event of default with respect to our other debt and that of our guarantors that could result in acceleration of such debt.

        Generally, an entity would be considered insolvent if, at the time it incurred indebtedness:

        We cannot be certain as to the standards a court would use to determine whether or not we or the guarantors were solvent at the relevant time, or regardless of the standard that a court uses, that the issuance of the notes and the guarantees would not be subordinated to our or any guarantor's other debt.

        If the guarantees were legally challenged, any guarantee could also be subject to the claim that, since the guarantee was incurred for our benefit, and only indirectly for the benefit of the guarantor, the obligations of the applicable guarantor were incurred for less than fair consideration. A court could thus void all or a part of the obligations under the guarantees, subordinate them to the applicable guarantor's other debt or take other action detrimental to the holders of the notes.

34



Risks Associated with the Exchange Offer

If you choose not to exchange your outstanding notes in the exchange offer, the transfer restrictions currently applicable to your outstanding notes will remain in force and the market price of your outstanding notes could decline.

        If you do not exchange your outstanding notes for exchange notes in the exchange offer, then you will continue to be subject to the transfer restrictions on the outstanding notes as set forth in the offering memorandum distributed in connection with the private offering of the outstanding notes. In general, the outstanding notes may not be offered or sold unless they are registered or exempt from registration under the Securities Act and applicable state securities laws. Except as required by the registration rights agreement, we do not intend to register resales of the outstanding notes under the Securities Act. You should refer to "Prospectus summary—Summary of the terms of the exchange offer" and "Description of notes—registration rights" for information about how to tender your outstanding notes.

        The tender of outstanding notes under the exchange offer will reduce the principal amount of the outstanding notes outstanding, which may have an adverse effect upon and increase the volatility of, the market price of the outstanding notes due to reduction in liquidity.

Your ability to transfer the notes may be limited by the absence of an active trading market, and an active trading market may not develop for the notes.

        The exchange notes are a new issue of securities for which there is no established trading market. We do not intend to have the exchange notes listed on a national securities exchange or to arrange for quotation on any automated quotation system, although we expect that the exchange notes will be eligible for trading in the PORTAL market. The initial purchasers have advised us that they intend to make a market in the exchange notes, as permitted by applicable laws and regulations; however, the initial purchasers are not obligated to make a market in the exchange notes, and they may discontinue their market-making activities at any time without notice. Therefore, we cannot assure you as to the development or liquidity of any trading market for the exchange notes. The liquidity of any market for the exchange notes will depend on a number of factors, including:

        Historically, the market for non-investment grade debt has been subject to disruptions that have caused substantial volatility in the prices of securities similar to the exchange notes. The market, if any, for the exchange notes may face similar disruptions that may adversely affect the prices at which you may sell your exchange notes. Therefore, you may not be able to sell your exchange notes at a particular time and the price that you receive when you sell may not be favorable.

35



THE TRANSACTIONS

The Merger

        On March 22, 2006, National MENTOR Holdings, Inc. (the "Issuer"), NMH Holdings, LLC ("Parent") and NMH MergerSub, Inc. ("MergerSub") entered into the Merger Agreement, pursuant to which the parties agreed to the Merger, subject to the terms and conditions contained therein.

        Pursuant to the Merger Agreement, on June 29, 2006, MergerSub merged with and into the Issuer, with the Issuer being the surviving corporation (the "Merger"). Pursuant to the Merger, each outstanding share of common stock of the Issuer, except those held in treasury or owned by Parent, was converted into the right to receive cash, without interest, subject to certain customary adjustments, and each outstanding share of common stock of MergerSub was converted into one share of common stock of the Issuer. Vested options to purchase common stock of the Issuer outstanding at the time of the Merger were converted into the right to receive cash, without interest, less the exercise price of such option, subject to certain customary adjustments. See "Use of proceeds."

        As described below and in "Management" and "Certain relationships and related party transactions—Post-Transactions arrangements," certain members of our management team and employees, referred to in this prospectus as the "management investors," agreed to exchange certain of their equity interests in the Issuer into common and preferred units of NMH Investment. In connection with the Transactions, the management investors also participated in the equity of NMH Investment through purchases or grants of additional units of NMH Investment. Vestar, an affiliate of Vestar and the management investors invested approximately $253.6 million in units of NMH Investment.

        In addition to the Merger Agreement, the parties entered into various ancillary agreements governing relationships between the parties after the Merger. See "Certain relationships and related party transactions."

        Parent owns all of the issued and outstanding common stock of the Issuer. Vestar and its affiliate own approximately 92% of the voting units in NMH Investment, which in turn, owns Parent. The remaining voting units in NMH Investment are owned by the management investors. See "Summary—The Transactions; Corporate structure" and "Security ownership of principal shareholders and management."

        In connection with the Merger, National Mentor Inc., the issuer of our old notes, was converted into a Delaware limited liability company and changed its name to National Mentor Holdings, LLC.

The Financing Transactions

        The following financing transactions occurred in connection with the closing of the Merger:

36


        In addition, we have terminated all commitments, repaid all outstanding borrowings, totaling $164.9 million, under the old senior secured credit facility and paid any accrued and unpaid interest thereon.

The Tender Offer

        In connection with the Merger, on May 25, 2006, National Mentor, Inc. commenced a tender offer and consent solicitation to purchase any and all of its old notes and to amend the related indenture and the old notes to eliminate substantially all of the restrictive covenants and certain events of default and to modify certain other provisions of the indenture and the old notes. The tender offer expired at 8 a.m., New York City time, on June 29, 2006, with $149.3 million of old notes tendered to National Mentor, Inc. The tender offer and the consent solicitation were conditioned on the consummation of the Merger.

        National Mentor, Inc. and the trustee for the old notes entered into a supplemental indenture, effective upon the closing of the tender offer and the consent solicitation, to amend the old notes and the related indenture to eliminate substantially all of the restrictive covenants and certain events of default and to modify certain other provisions of the indenture and the old notes. The holders of $149.3 million of old notes that were validly tendered by June 12, 2006 received total consideration of $1,134.68 per $1,000 principal amount, plus accrued and unpaid interest to but excluding the settlement date.

        We spent approximately $172.9 million to purchase all of the old notes in the tender offer and consent solicitation and to pay all accrued and unpaid interest on such old notes up to the settlement date.

37



USE OF PROCEEDS

        The exchange offer is intended to satisfy our obligations under the registration rights agreement that we entered into in connection with the private offering of the outstanding notes. We will not receive any cash proceeds from the issuance of the exchange notes in the exchange offer. As consideration for issuing the exchange notes as contemplated in this prospectus, we will receive in exchange a like principal amount of outstanding notes, the terms of which are identical in all material respects to the exchange notes, except that the exchange notes will not contain terms with respect to transfer restrictions or additional interest upon a failure to fulfill certain of our obligations under the registration rights agreement. The outstanding notes that are surrendered in exchange for the exchange notes will be retired and cancelled and cannot be reissued. As a result, the issuance of the exchange notes will not result in any increase or decrease in our capitalization.

38



CAPITALIZATION

        The following table sets forth our cash and cash equivalents and capitalization as of September 30, 2006 on an actual basis. You should read this table in conjunction with "Summary—Summary consolidated financial data," "Use of proceeds," "Unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information," "Selected historical consolidated financial data," "Management's discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations" and our historical and pro forma consolidated financial statements and the related notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 
  As of September 30, 2006
 
  Actual
 
  (Dollars in millions)

Cash and cash equivalents   $ 29.0
   
Long-term debt, including current portion:      
  New senior secured credit facilities:(1)      
    Term loan facility   $ 334.2
    Revolving credit facility    
  Old notes(2)     0.7
  Outstanding 11 1 / 4 % Senior subordinated notes     180.0
  Other debt(3)     5.5
   
Total consolidated long-term debt, including current portion     520.4
Total shareholders' equity     248.9
   
Total capitalization   $ 769.3
   

(1)
Our new senior secured credit facilities consist of a $335.0 million seven-year senior secured term loan facility, a $125.0 million six-year senior secured revolving credit facility, and a $20.0 million seven-year senior secured synthetic letter of credit facility. At the closing of the Merger, we borrowed $335.0 million under the senior secured term loan facility and utilized the entire $20.0 million synthetic letter of credit facility. The new senior secured credit facilities provide that, subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions and to the participation of lenders, the collateral securing the new senior secured credit facilities may also secure additional term loan facilities or synthetic letter of credit facilities or increased commitments under the senior secured revolving credit facility in an aggregate amount not exceeding $100.0 million. We did not borrow under the senior secured revolving credit facility as of September 30, 2006. The availability under our senior secured revolving credit facility was reduced by $1.8 million as letters of credit in excess of $20.0 million under our synthetic letters of credit facility were outstanding.

(2)
Consists of $750,000 aggregate principal amount of our 9 5 / 8 % senior subordinated notes due 2012 that remain outstanding.

(3)
Consists of $5.5 million outstanding under the mortgage facility.

39



UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL INFORMATION

        The following unaudited pro forma consolidated statement of operations has been developed by applying pro forma adjustments to the historical audited consolidated financial statements of the Company appearing elsewhere in this prospectus.

        The pro forma financial information for the periods presented gives effect to the Transactions, and assumes that for the statement of operations data, such transactions occurred as of October 1, 2005. Assumptions underlying the pro forma adjustments are described in the accompanying notes, which should be read in conjunction with these unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements.

        The unaudited pro forma adjustments are based upon available information and certain assumptions that we believe are reasonable under the circumstances. The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information is presented for informational purposes only. The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial information does not purport to represent what our results of operations or financial condition would have been had the Transactions actually occurred on the dates indicated and they do not purport to project our results of operations or financial condition for any future period or as of any future date. The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements should be read in conjunction with the information contained in "The Transactions," "Selected historical consolidated financial data," "Management's discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations" and the consolidated financial statements and related notes thereto appearing elsewhere in this prospectus.

        In addition, in connection with the Transactions the predecessor recorded a one-time compensation expense of approximately $26.9 million relating to the vesting of stock options, as well as fees and expenses relating to the Transactions, including approximately $22.5 million for the premium and related expenses paid in connection with the tender offer for our old notes. These amounts are reflected in the historical statement of operations for the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006.

        The Merger was accounted for under the purchase method of accounting in accordance with SFAS 141. Under purchase accounting, fixed assets and identifiable intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed are recorded at their respective fair values. We are in the process of completing valuations of certain real estate assets; thus, the allocation of the purchase price to our assets is subject to adjustment.

40



Unaudited pro forma consolidated statement of operations
for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006
and the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006
(dollars in thousands)

 
  Historical
   
   
 
 
  Successor
  Predecessor
   
   
 
 
  Period from June 30 through September 30, 2006
  Period from October 1 through June 29, 2006
  Transaction
Adjustments

  Pro Forma
 
Net revenues   $ 208,881   $ 580,356   $   $ 789,237  
Cost of revenues     160,164     439,878         600,042  
   
 
 
 
 
Gross profit     48,717     140,478         189,195  
Operating expenses:                          
  General and administrative     29,738     78,608         108,346  
  Stock option settlement         26,880     (26,880 )(1)    
  Transaction costs         9,136     (9,136 )(1)    
  Depreciation and amortization     11,714     17,539     16,644   (2)   45,897  
   
 
 
 
 
Total operating expenses     41,452     132,163     (19,372 )   154,243  
Income from operations     7,265     8,315     19,372     34,952  
Other income (expense):                          
  Management fee of related party     (227 )   (198 )   (425 )(3)   (850 )
  Other expense     (60 )   (177 )       (237 )
  Interest income     256     646         902  
  Interest expense     (13,120 )   (51,719 )   13,199   (4)   (51,640 )
   
 
 
 
 
(Loss) income before (benefit) provision for income taxes     (5,886 )   (43,133 )   32,146     (16,873 )
(Benefit) provision for income taxes     (2,222 )   (11,347 )   10,278   (5)   (3,291 )
   
 
 
 
 
Net (loss) income   $ (3,664 ) $ (31,786 ) $ 21,868   $ (13,582 )
   
 
 
 
 

See accompanying notes to unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements.

41



Notes to unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements

        The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial statements give effect to the following adjustments.

(1)
Reflects the elimination of the stock option settlement and transaction expenses of $26.9 million and $9.1 million, respectively, related to the Transactions.

(2)
Reflects the net effect of (1) estimated amortization expense of $30.4 million for the period from June 30 through September 30, 2006 and the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006, related to intangible assets identified and valued in connection with the Merger; (2) estimated depreciation expense of $15.5 million for the period from June 30 through September 30, 2006 and the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006, related to fixed assets valued in connection with the Merger; and (3) the elimination of $7.6 million and $7.3 million of amortization expense for the period from June 30 through September 30, 2006 and the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006, respectively, related to our existing intangible assets, and the elimination of $4.1 million and $10.3 million of depreciation expense related to our existing fixed assets.

(3)
Reflects the net effect of (1) the annual management fee of $850,000 to be paid to the Sponsor (see "Certain relationships and related party transactions"); and (2) the elimination of $198,000 associated with management fees paid to our former owner, Madison Dearborn Partners, Inc. ("Madison Dearborn") for the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and $227,000 associated with management fees paid to the Sponsor for the period June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006.

(4)
Reflects the net effect of (1) interest expense of $20.5 million associated with the $180.0 million of outstanding notes; (2) interest expense of $26.6 million associated with the $335.0 million of debt under the term loan facility portion of our new senior secured credit facilities at an assumed rate of LIBOR at September 30, 2006 plus 2.50%; (3) interest expense of $626,201 associated with the unused line of credit; (4) interest expense of $73,190 associated with the remaining $750,000 of old notes; (5) the elimination of $64.0 million of interest expense associated with our previously existing indebtedness (including $9.4 million for the amortization of deferred financing fees and $22.5 million related to the bond tender premium and related expenses); and (6) the amortization of deferred financing fees of $2.9 million associated with our new senior secured credit facilities and the outstanding notes.

(5)
Reflects the tax effect of the Transaction adjustments, including transaction bonuses and excluding other transaction costs, at a tax rate of 42.4%, which is the effective tax rate last utilized by the Company when it had income before provision for income taxes.

42



SELECTED HISTORICAL CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

        We have derived the selected historical consolidated financial data as of and for the years ended September 30, 2004 and 2005 and for the periods from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 from the historical consolidated financial statements of the Company and the related notes audited by Ernst & Young LLP and included elsewhere in this prospectus. We have derived the selected historical consolidated financial data as of and for the years ended September 30, 2002 and 2003 from the historical consolidated financial statements of the Company and the related notes audited by Ernst & Young LLP.

        The selected information below should be read in conjunction with "Capitalization," "Management's discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations" and the historical consolidated financial statements and notes thereto included elsewhere in this prospectus.

 
   
   
   
   
   
  Successor
 
 
  Predecessor(1)
 
 
  Period from
June 30
through

 
 
   
   
   
   
  Period from
October 1
through

 
 
  Year Ended September 30,
 
 
  September 30, 2006
 
 
  2002
  2003(2)
  2004
  2005
  June 29, 2006
 
 
  (dollars in thousands)

   
 
Statement of operations data:                                      
Net revenues   $ 241,441   $ 412,839   $ 648,493   $ 693,826   $ 580,356   $ 208,881  
Cost of revenues     167,560     305,311     491,884     524,618     439,878     160,164  
Gross profit     73,881     107,528     156,609     169,208     140,478     48,717  
General and administrative expenses     48,829     67,594     86,856     93,491     78,608     29,738  
Stock option settlement                     26,880      
Depreciation and amortization     15,603     13,071     21,484     21,743     17,539     11,714  
Transaction costs                     9,136      
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
Income from operations     9,449     26,863     48,269     53,974     8,315     7,265  
Management fee of related party     (254 )   (258 )   (257 )   (270 )   (198 )   (227 )
Other income (expense), net     196     (392 )   (2,581 )   (192 )   (177 )   (60 )
Interest income         10     68     661     646     256  
Interest expense     (7,575 )   (15,819 )   (26,893 )   (29,905 )   (51,719 )   (13,120 )
Income (loss) before provision (benefit) for income taxes     1,816     10,404     18,606     24,268     (43,133 )   (5,886 )
Provision (benefit) for income taxes     726     4,462     8,423     10,270     (11,347 )   (2,222 )
Net income (loss)   $ 1,090   $ 5,942   $ 10,183   $ 13,998   $ (31,786 ) $ (3,664 )

Balance sheet data (at end of period):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Cash and cash equivalents   $ 544   $ 15,804   $ 24,416   $ 29,307         (5) $ 29,015  
Working capital(3)     10,971     38,717     39,828     49,190         (5)   55,423  
Total assets     126,659     430,094     450,038     449,438         (5)   1,000,665  
Long-term debt     50,750     213,034     200,083     319,430         (5)   516,618  
Redeemable Class A preferred stock     42,217     101,283     116,381             (5)    
Shareholders' equity (deficit)     (2,788 )   30,632     25,769     36,310         (5)   248,868  
Other financial data:                                      
Ratio of earnings to fixed charges(4) (unaudited)     1.2x     1.6x     1.6x     1.7x          

(1)
On June 29, 2006, the Company changed ownership. The previous ownership periods are deemed to be predecessor periods pursuant to Rule 3-05 of Regulation S-X.

(2)
Results for fiscal 2003 include the results of operations related to REM, Inc. from the date of its acquisition on May 1, 2003.

(3)
Working capital is calculated as current assets minus current liabilities.

(4)
For purposes of calculating the ratio of earnings to fixed charges, (i) earnings is defined as income (loss) before provision for income taxes plus fixed charges and (ii) fixed charges is defined as interest expense (including capitalized interest, which we do not have, and amortization of debt issuance costs) and the estimated portion of operating lease expense determined by management to represent the interest component of rent expense. For the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006, earnings were insufficient to cover fixed charges by $43.1 million and $5.9 million, respectively.

(5)
Balance sheet data at June 29, 2006 is omitted as it is not required to be disclosed under the applicable SEC regulations.

43



MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

         The following discussion of our financial condition and results of operations should be read in conjunction with the "Selected historical consolidated financial data," and the historical consolidated financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this prospectus. This discussion contains forward-looking statements about our markets, the demand for our services and our future results. We based these statements on assumptions that we consider reasonable. Actual results may differ materially from those suggested by our forward-looking statements for various reasons, including those discussed in the "Risk factors" and "Forward-looking statements" sections of this prospectus.

         The results for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2006, which we refer to as "fiscal 2006," were derived by the mathematical addition of the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006. This presentation of financial information for fiscal 2006 herein may yield results that are not fully comparable on a period-to-period basis, particularly related to the depreciation and amortization, interest expense and tax provision accounts, primarily due to the impact of the Transactions. This presentation is consistent with the way management uses this information internally.

Overview

        Founded in 1980, we are a leading provider of home and community-based human services to individuals with mental retardation and other developmental disabilities, at-risk youth and their families, and persons with acquired brain injury. As of September 30, 2006, we provided our services to approximately 21,700 clients in 34 states through approximately 15,700 full-time equivalent employees. Most of our services involve residential support, typically in small group home, ICFs-MR or host home settings, designed to improve our clients' quality of life and to promote client independence and participation in community life. Our non-residential services consist primarily of day programs and periodic services in various settings. We derive most of our revenues from state and county governmental payors, as well as smaller amounts from private-sector payors, mostly in our acquired brain injury business.

        The largest part of our business is the delivery of services to individuals with mental retardation or a developmental disability. Our MR/DD programs include residential support, day habilitation, vocational services, case management, home healthcare, personal care and early intervention. We also provide a variety of services to children with severe emotional, developmental, medical and behavioral challenges, as well as youth involved in the juvenile justice system, all of whom we refer to as at-risk youth, and to their families. Our ARY services include therapeutic foster care, independent living, family reunification, family preservation, alternative schools and adoption services. We also provide a range of post-acute treatment and care services to individuals with acquired brain injury. Our ABI services range from post acute care to assisted independent living and include neurobehavioral rehabilitation, neurorehabilitation, adolescent integration, outpatient or day treatment and pre-vocational services.

        We operate our business as one human services reporting segment organized into three divisions, an Eastern Division, a Central Division and a Western Division. Our service lines do not represent operating segments per SFAS No. 131, Disclosures about Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information (SFAS 131) as management does not internally evaluate the operating performance or review the results of the service lines to assess performance or make decisions about allocating resources. Also, discrete financial information is not available by service line at the level necessary for management to assess the performance or make resource allocation decisions.

        The Merger was accounted for under the purchase method of accounting in accordance with SFAS 141. Under purchase accounting, fixed assets and identifiable intangible assets acquired and

44


liabilities assumed are recorded at their respective fair values. We are in the process of completing valuations of certain real estate assets; thus the allocation of the purchase price to our assets is subject to adjustment. We have accounted for the Merger in accordance with Securities and Exchange Commission Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 54 (SAB 54), Push Down Accounting , whereby the parent has "pushed down" the purchase price in revaluing the assets and liabilities of the Company.

Factors affecting our operating results

Demand for home and community-based human services

        Our growth in revenues has been directly related to increases in the number of individuals served. This growth has depended largely upon development-driven activities, including the maintenance and expansion of existing contracts and the award of new contracts, and upon acquisitions. We also attribute the continued growth in our client base to certain trends that are increasing demand in our industry, including demographic, medical and political developments.

        Demographic trends have a particular impact on our MR/DD business. Increases in the life expectancy of MR/DD individuals, we believe, have resulted in steady increases in the demand for MR/DD services. In addition, caregivers currently caring for their relatives at home are aging and may soon be unable to continue with these responsibilities. Each of these factors affects the size of the MR/DD population in need of services and, therefore, the amount of residential and non-residential MR/DD programs offered by governments in our markets. Similarly, our ARY service line has been driven by favorable demographics. In addition, our ABI service line has been positively affected by increased life expectancy resulting from faster emergency response and improved medical techniques that have resulted in more people surviving an ABI.

        Political trends can also affect our operations. In particular, budgetary changes can influence the overall level of payments for our services, the number of clients and the preferred settings for many of the services we provide. Pressure from client advocacy groups for the populations we serve has generally helped our business, as these groups generally seek to pressure governments to fund residential services that use our small group home or host home models, rather than large, institutional models. In addition, our ARY service line has been positively affected by the trend toward privatization of services. Furthermore, we believe that successful lobbying by these groups has preserved MR/DD and ARY services, and therefore our revenue base, from significant cutbacks as compared with certain other human services. In addition, a number of states have developed community-based waiver programs to support long-term care services for survivors of ABI.

Expansion

        We believe that our future growth will depend heavily on our ability to expand existing service contracts and to win new contracts. Our organic expansion activities can consist of both new program starts in existing markets or geographical expansion in new markets. Our new program starts typically require us to fund operating losses for a period of approximately 18 months. If a new program start does not become profitable during such period, we may terminate that new program start. During fiscal 2006, we had 23 new program starts. For fiscal 2006, losses on new program starts for programs started within the last 18 months that generated operating losses were $2.3 million.

        Much of our growth in existing markets comes in the form of "cross-selling" new services. Depending on the nature of the program and the state or county government involved, we will seek new programs through either unsolicited proposals to government agencies or by responding to a request, generally known as a request for proposal, from a public sector agency.

45



Acquisitions

        As of September 30, 2006, we have completed 37 acquisitions since 1997, including several acquisitions of rights to government contracts or fixed assets from small providers, which we refer to as "tuck-in" acquisitions. We have pursued strategic acquisitions in markets with significant opportunities. The following discussion summarizes some of our most significant acquisitions since 2002.

        On December 16, 2002, we acquired the assets of Family Advocacy Services ("FAS"). On February 28, 2003, we acquired certain assets of American Habilitation Services, Inc. ("AHS"). On May 1, 2003, we acquired REM, for approximately $240.2 million. The REM acquisition, which has been fully integrated into our operations, significantly increased our MR/DD market presence. We also acquired the assets of Foster America on April 30, 2004. On January 31, 2006, we acquired certain assets in Florida of American Habilitation Services, Inc. ("AHS Florida") for approximately $8.5 million. AHS Florida provides residential group home, day program and ICF-MR services to individuals with developmental disabilities. On May 31, 2006, we acquired substantially all the assets of CareMeridian for approximately $21.4 million, subject to increase based on earnout provisions. CareMeridian is a provider of after-hospital services for catastrophically ill or injured patients in non-institutional, residential settings. Our financial data includes operating results for each of the acquired businesses from the date of acquisition.

Net revenues

        Revenues are reported net of allowances for unauthorized sales, expected sales adjustments by business unit and changes in the allowance for doubtful accounts. Revenues are also reported net of any state provider taxes or gross receipts taxes levied on services we provide. For fiscal 2006, we derived approximately 93% of our net revenues from states, counties or regional entities (e.g., Departments of Mental Retardation). The payment terms and rates of these contracts vary widely by jurisdiction and service type, and may be based on per person per diems, rates established by the jurisdiction, cost-based reimbursement, hourly rates and/or units of service. In general, the rates we have received for our services have remained relatively constant since October 1, 2003 (other than pursuant to cost-based reimbursement contracts). We bill most of our residential services on a per diem basis, and we bill most of our non-residential services on an hourly basis. For fiscal 2006, we derived approximately 16% of our revenues pursuant to cost-based reimbursement contracts, under which the billed rate is tied to the underlying costs plus a margin. Lower than expected cost levels may require us to return previously received payments after cost reports are filed. In addition, our revenues may be affected by adjustments to our billed rates as well as write-offs of previously billed amounts. Revenues in the future may be affected by changes in rate-setting structures, methodologies or interpretations that may be proposed in states where we operate or by the federal government which provides matching funds. We cannot determine the impact of such changes or the effect of any possible governmental actions.

        Occasionally, timing of payment streams may be affected by delays by the state related to bill processing systems, staffing or other factors. While these delays have historically impacted our cash position in particular periods, they have not resulted in long-term collections problems. As of September 30, 2006, our consolidated days sales outstanding was 44.7 days as compared with 44.9 days as of September 30, 2005.

Expenses

        Expenses directly related to providing services are classified as cost of revenues. Direct costs and expenses principally include salaries and benefits for service provider employees, per diem payments to our Mentors, residential occupancy expenses, which primarily comprise rent and utilities related to facilities providing direct care, certain client expenses such as food and medicine and transportation

46



costs for clients requiring services. General and administrative expenses primarily include salaries and benefits for administrative employees, or employees that are not directly providing services, administrative occupancy, as well as professional expenses such as consulting and external auditing costs and insurance costs. Depreciation and amortization includes depreciation for fixed assets utilized in both facilities providing direct care and administrative offices, and amortization related to intangible assets.

        Wages and benefits to our employees and per diem payments to our Mentors, constitute the most significant operating cost in each of our operations. Most of our employee caregivers are paid on an hourly basis, with hours of work generally tied to client need. Our Mentors are paid on a per diem basis, but only if the Mentor is currently caring for a client. Our labor costs are generally influenced by levels of service and these costs can vary in material respects across regions.

        As of September 30, 2006, we owned 418 facilities and two offices, and we leased 730 facilities and 257 offices. Many of our leased group homes are operated under leases with terms of less than two years. We incur no facilities costs for services provided in the home of a Mentor.

        Expenses incurred in connection with regulatory compliance, liability insurance and third-party claims for professional and general liability totaled approximately 1.6% and 1.0% for fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. We have incurred professional and general liability claims and insurance expense for professional and general liability of $6.5 million and $3.2 million for fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. In fiscal 2006, we purchased additional insurance for certain claims relating to pre-Merger periods. Excluding this, we have incurred professional and general liability claims and insurance expense for professional and general liability of $3.9 million for fiscal 2006. Also, excluding this additional insurance, expenses incurred in connection with regulatory compliance, liability insurance and third-party claims for professional and general liability totaled approximately 1.2% for fiscal 2006. We currently self-insure professional and general liability claims for amounts of up to $1.0 million per claim and up to $2.0 million in the aggregate. Above these limits, we have limited additional third-party coverage.

        Our costs of revenues as a percentage of revenues for our different services may vary, with our ABI services, generally, having the highest margin (or lowest costs as a percentage of revenues). Cost of revenues and general and administrative expenses as a percentage of net revenues have remained relatively consistent over fiscal 2004, fiscal 2005 and fiscal 2006. We believe that although we have received only limited increases in rates in the aggregate during these periods and certain of our expenses have increased, we have been able to maintain these percentages by, among other things, modifying our overhead cost, controlling our workers' compensation expenses and decreasing our general and professional liability expense. Our ability to maintain our margin in the future is dependent upon obtaining increases in rates and/or controlling our expenses.

Transaction and related expenses

        In connection with the Transactions, during fiscal 2006, we recorded compensation expense of approximately $26.9 million relating to the vesting of stock options, fees and expenses of $9.1 million, and approximately $22.5 million for the premium and related expenses paid in connection with the tender offer for the old notes. The expense related to stock options of $26.9 million and fees and expenses of $9.1 million are recorded in separate line items on the statement of operations. If these expenses were not broken out separately they would have been included in general and administrative expenses. See "The Transactions."

47



Results of Operations

        The following table sets forth the percentages of net revenues that certain items of operating data constitute for the periods indicated:

 
  Predecessor
  Successor
 
 
   
   
  Period from
October 1
through

  Period from
June 30
through

 
 
  Fiscal Year
Ended
September 30,

 
 
  June 29, 2006
  September 30, 2006
 
 
  2004
  2005
 
Statement of operations data:                  

Net revenues

 

100.0

%

100.0

%

100.0

%

100.0

%
Cost of revenues   75.9   75.6   75.8   76.7  
General and administrative expenses   13.4   13.5   13.5   14.2  
Stock option settlement   0.0   0.0   4.6   0.0  
Depreciation and amortization   3.3   3.1   3.0   5.6  
Transaction costs   0.0   0.0   1.6   0.0  
Income from operations   7.4   7.8   1.5   3.5  
Management fee of related party   0.0   0.0   0.0   0.1  
Other expense, net   0.4   0.0   0.0   0.0  
Interest income   0.0   0.0   0.1   0.1  
Interest expense   4.1   4.3   8.9   6.3  
Income (loss) before provision (benefit) for income taxes   2.9   3.5   (7.4 ) (2.8 )
Provision (benefit) for income taxes   1.3   1.5   (2.0 ) (1.1 )
Net income (loss)   1.6   2.0   (5.5 ) (1.8 )

Fiscal Year Ended September 30, 2006 Compared to Fiscal Year Ended September 30, 2005

        The results for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2006, which we refer to as "fiscal 2006," were derived by the mathematical addition of the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006. This presentation of financial information for fiscal 2006 herein may yield results that are not fully comparable on a period-to-period basis, particularly related to the depreciation and amortization, interest expense and tax provision accounts, primarily due to the impact of the Transactions. This presentation is consistent with the way management uses this information internally.

Net revenues

        Net revenues for fiscal 2006 increased by $95.4 million or 13.8% over the prior fiscal year to $789.2 million. Approximately $55.2 million of the $95.4 million increase relates to acquisitions that closed after October 1, 2004. Excluding the revenue growth from acquisitions noted above, revenues increased $40.2 million or 5.8% over the prior fiscal year. Approximately $33.1 million of this increase was due to census increases in our existing programs and rate increases in our existing programs, including a 2.26% increase in Minnesota, our largest state, which became effective in the first quarter of fiscal 2006. The remaining increase of $7.1 million was due to revenues derived from new programs that began operations after October 1, 2004. Fiscal 2006 net revenues were not affected by the Transactions.

Cost of revenues

        Cost of revenues for fiscal 2006 increased by $75.4 million or 14.4% to $600.0 million. This represents a 0.4% increase as a percentage of net revenues from 75.6% for fiscal 2005 to 76.0% for fiscal 2006. Direct labor costs, which consist of wages and benefits for our direct care workers and payments to our contract mentors, increased by $58.6 million or 13.0% over the prior fiscal year to

48



$511.3 million. This represents a 0.4% decrease as a percentage of net revenues from 65.2% for fiscal 2005 to 64.8% for fiscal 2006. Other direct costs, which consist of occupancy costs, transportation and travel costs related to providing services to our clients and other costs directly related to providing care to our clients, increased by $16.8 million or 23.4% over the prior fiscal year to $88.7 million. This represents a 0.8% increase as a percentage of net revenues from 10.4% for fiscal 2005 to 11.2% for fiscal 2006. The majority of this increase was related to increases in occupancy costs, which increased by $10.1 million or 33.1% over the prior fiscal year to $40.4 million. Fiscal 2006 cost of revenues was not affected by the Transactions.

General and administrative expenses

        General and administrative expenses for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2006 increased by $14.9 million or 15.9% to $108.3 million. This represents a 0.2% increase as a percentage of net revenues from 13.5% for fiscal 2005 to 13.7% for fiscal 2006. During fiscal 2006, general and administrative expenses included some one-time merger related costs that occurred during the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006. These costs included $2.8 million of insurance costs related to the purchase of additional insurance for certain claims relating to pre-Merger periods, as well as $0.6 million in additional audit fees as the annual audit included two reporting periods; the predecessor period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and the successor period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006. Excluding these one-time merger related expenses, general and administrative expenses would have been $104.9 million or 13.3% of net revenues. General and administrative salaries and benefits increased by $6.7 million or 13.5% over the prior fiscal year to $56.5 million or 7.2% of net revenues. General and administrative salaries and benefits include $0.5 million of compensation expense related to the adoption of SFAS 123R. In addition, indirect occupancy costs increased $1.1 million or 5.8% over the prior fiscal year to $20.6 million. This represents a 0.2% decrease as a percentage of net revenues from 2.8% for fiscal 2005 to 2.6% for fiscal 2006.

Transaction costs

        Transaction costs were $9.1 million during the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006. Since these costs primarily consist of professional fees paid in connection with the Merger, there were no transaction costs incurred during the period from June 30, 2006 though September 30, 2006.

Stock option settlement

        The stock option settlement was $26.9 million for the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006. We accrued this expense as of June 29, 2006 in connection with the Merger, as all unvested stock options became vested in accordance with the change in control provision of the original stock option agreements. All stock options outstanding at the time of the Merger were cancelled, and holders of the options received an amount equal to the excess of the fair market value over the exercise price per share. Since all expenses were accrued as of June 29, 2006, there were no costs incurred during the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006.

49


Interest expense

        Interest expense for fiscal 2006 increased by $34.9 million or 117% over the prior fiscal year to $64.8 million. Interest expense for fiscal 2006 includes interest expense of $51.7 million for the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and interest expense of $13.1 million for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006.

        Interest expense for the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 included $22.5 million related to the tender premium and related expenses on the old senior subordinated notes, as well as $8.0 million related to the acceleration of deferred financing costs related to the old credit facility and old senior subordinated notes.

        Interest expense for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 reflects the interest expense of the new credit facility and the new senior subordinated notes. The amount of debt increased by $200.9 million and the weighted average interest rate increased by 0.3% as a result of the Transactions.

Depreciation and amortization

        Depreciation and amortization for fiscal 2006 increased by $7.5 million or 35% over the prior fiscal year to $29.3 million. Depreciation and amortization for fiscal 2006 includes depreciation and amortization of $17.5 million for the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and depreciation and amortization of $11.7 million for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006.

        Depreciation and amortization for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 of $11.7 million reflects the increase in the cost basis of the fixed assets and intangible assets related to the Transactions. Pursuant to SFAS 141, the fixed assets and intangible assets were revalued as of June 30, 2006 and the increased value will be depreciated and amortized over the useful lives of the assets.

(Benefit) provision for income taxes

        The benefit for income taxes of $2.2 million for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 was due to a loss before benefit for income taxes of $5.9 million generated during this period. The effective tax rate for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 was 38.0%.

        The benefit for income taxes of $11.3 million for the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 was due to a loss before benefit for income taxes of $43.1 million generated during this period. The effective tax rate for the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 was 26.3%. The effective tax rate for the period is lower than previous years' as certain expenses related to the Transactions were considered non-deductible for income tax purposes.

        The provision for income taxes for fiscal 2005 was $10.3 million or a 42.3% effective tax rate on the income before provision for income taxes of $24.3 million.

Fiscal Year Ended September 30, 2005 Compared to Fiscal Year Ended September 30, 2004

Net revenues

        Net revenues increased by $45.3 million, or 7%, from $648.5 million for fiscal 2004 to $693.8 million for fiscal 2005. The increase was primarily due to census growth in our existing service lines. In addition, approximately $4.6 million of the increase was primarily as a result of the acquisitions that occurred in fiscal 2005. New start revenue increased approximately $1.3 million in fiscal 2005.

50



Cost of revenues

        As a percentage of net revenues, cost of revenues remained consistent at 75.9% for fiscal 2004 and 75.6% for fiscal 2005. Cost of revenues increased by $32.7 million, or 6.6%, from $491.9 million for fiscal 2004 to $524.6 million for fiscal 2005. The majority of the increase was due to a $20.6 million increase in labor costs, in particular, direct care wages, taxes and fringe benefits. The increase in wages was mostly attributable to increases in our workforce to provide services for additional clients served. Payments to Mentors increased approximately $6.4 million in fiscal 2005, as the number of Mentors increased by approximately 1,000 due to our expanding client base as well as the acquisition of Foster America. Cost of revenues also increased due to a $3.3 million increase in rent and other occupancy expenses related to more homes leased in fiscal 2005, and a $2.1 million increase in transportation expenses.

General and administrative expenses

        As a percentage of net revenues, general and administrative expenses for fiscal 2005 and fiscal 2004 remained consistent at 13.5% and 13.4%, respectively. General and administrative expenses increased by $6.6 million, or 7.6%, from $86.9 million for fiscal 2004, to $93.5 million for fiscal 2005. The majority of the $6.6 million increase was due to increases in labor costs. The increase in labor costs consisted of a $4.0 million increase in administrative wages, $1.7 million of which related to severance for senior executives who left the Company. In addition, there was an increase of $1.2 million in facility related expenses due to an increase in office leases.

Interest expense

        Interest expense increased $3.0 million, from $26.9 million for fiscal 2004 to $29.9 million for fiscal 2005. The increase was principally due to the accelerated amortization of deferred financing costs of $1.3 million related to our 2003 credit facilities. We also incurred $1.5 million for fiscal 2005 related to a pre-payment fee on our 2003 credit facilities.

Provision for income taxes

        Provision for income taxes increased $1.9 million from $8.4 million for fiscal 2004 to $10.3 million for fiscal 2005. Although the effective tax rate decreased from 45.2% for fiscal 2004 to 42.3% for fiscal 2005, provision for income taxes increased due to a higher income before provision for income taxes. The effective tax rate decreased due to a change in our corporate structure, resulting in a reduction in the state effective tax rate.

Liquidity and Capital Resources

        Our principal uses of cash are to meet working capital requirements, to fund debt obligations and to finance capital expenditures and acquisitions. Cash flows from operations have historically been sufficient to meet our cash requirements.

        On June 29, 2006, in connection with the Transactions, we entered into new senior secured credit facilities, issued $180 million of senior subordinated notes, and entered into certain other transactions, as described under "The Transactions" in this prospectus. In addition, fiscal 2006 included certain one time cash flows related to the Transactions that are described below.

Operating activities

        Cash flows from operating activities for fiscal 2006 of $1.4 million included the following merger related items:

    Payment related to the stock option settlement of $26.9 million

    Payment of the bond tender premium of $22.5 million

    Payment of transaction costs of $9.1 million, which consisted primarily of professional service fees.

51


        Excluding these merger related items, cash flows from operations would have been $59.9 million. Our Days Sales Outstanding has remained relatively consistent with the prior year end at approximately 45 days. Fiscal 2006 also included the $3.3 million increase in working capital related to the AHS Florida acquisition, as well as, an increase in other assets primarily due to a $7.9 million increase in income tax receivable as a result of the year to date net loss. In addition, the health insurance accrual increased as we did not prepay health claims into the Voluntary Employee Beneficiary Association ("VEBA") during fiscal 2006 as we had done during fiscal 2005.

Investing activities

        Investing activities for fiscal 2006 include significant activity related to the Transactions. Cash used in investing activities for fiscal 2006 was $422.0 million and is primarily due to $371.2 cash paid for acquisitions of the predecessor company in the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006. Investing activities also include cash paid for acquisitions and purchases of property and equipment. Cash paid for property and equipment for fiscal 2006 was $15.8 million or 2.0% of fiscal 2006 net revenues compared to $14.6 million or 2.1% of net revenues for fiscal 2005. The increase is due to growth in the business and is slightly less than the prior year as a percent of net revenues. Cash paid for acquisitions for fiscal 2006 was $35.8 million reflecting the purchase price for six acquisitions paid for during fiscal 2006. This includes the purchase of Care Meridian for approximately $21.4 million and the purchase of AHS Florida for approximately $8.5 million.

Financing activities

        Cash provided by financing activities for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 were $433.3 million while cash used in financing activities for the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 were $13.0 million. The most significant portion of the cash outflow from financing activities during this period was the repayment of approximately $10.6 million of long-term debt, including the repayment of the note payable to Magellan of approximately $3.0 million. The Magellan note was paid in full on June 14, 2006.

        Cash provided by financing activities for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 included the following merger related items (dollars in millions):

  Repayment of long-term debt of the predecessor company     $ (314.1 )
  Proceeds from the issuance of long-term debt     $ 515.0  
  Parent capital contribution     $ 253.6  
  Payments of deferred debt financing costs     $ (19.7 )

        Excluding these merger related items, cash flows used in financing activities would have been $1.5 million for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006.

Contractual Commitments Summary

        The following table summarizes our contractual obligations and commitments as of September 30, 2006:

 
  Total
  2007
  2008-2009
  2010-2011
  2012 and
thereafter

 
  (dollars in thousands)

Long-term debt(1)   $ 520,365   $ 3,747   $ 7,494   $ 10,961   $ 498,163
Operating leases(2)     103,963     28,063     39,254     22,974     13,672
Capital leases     807     424     339     44    
Standby letters of credit     21,813     21,813            
   
 
 
 
 
Total obligations and commitments   $ 646,948   $ 54,047   $ 47,087   $ 33,979   $ 511,835
   
 
 
 
 

(1)
Does not include interest on long-term debt.

(2)
Includes the fixed rent payable under the leases and does not include additional amounts, such as taxes, payable under the leases.

52


Off-balance Sheet Arrangements

        We have no significant off-balance sheet transactions or interests.

Inflation

        We do not believe that general inflation in the U.S. economy has had a material impact on our financial position or results of operations.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

        We are exposed to changes in interest rates as a result of our outstanding variable rate debt. To reduce our interest rate exposure, the Company entered into interest rate swap agreements whereby the Company is fixing the interest rate on approximately $221.2 million of its $335.0 million term B loan to reduce the interest rate exposure, effective as of August 31, 2006. The rate and term of the interest rate swaps is 5.32% and four years, respectively. The amount of the term B loan subject to the interest rate swap agreements will reduce to $85.7 million at the end of the four year term. As a result of the interest rate swap agreements, the variable rate debt outstanding was reduced from $339.6 million outstanding to $118.4 million outstanding at September 30, 2006 compared to $178.0 million outstanding at September 30, 2005. The variable rate debt outstanding relates to the term loan, which has an interest rate based on LIBOR plus 2.50% or Prime plus 1.50%, the revolver, which has an interest rate based on LIBOR plus 2.50% or Prime plus 1.50%, and the term loan mortgage, which has an interest rate based on Prime plus 1.50%. An increase in the interest rate by 100 basis points on the debt balance outstanding as of September 30, 2006, would increase interest expense approximately $1.2 million annually.

Critical Accounting Policies

        Our discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations are based upon our consolidated financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (GAAP). The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires the appropriate application of certain accounting policies, many of which require us to make estimates and assumptions about future events and their impact on amounts reported in the financial statements and related notes. Since future events and the impact of those events cannot be determined with certainty, the actual results will inevitably differ from our estimates. These differences could be material to the financial statements.

        We believe our application of accounting policies, and the estimates inherently required therein, are reasonable. These accounting policies and estimates are constantly reevaluated, and adjustments are made when facts and circumstances dictate a change.

        The following critical accounting policies affect our more significant judgments and estimates used in the preparation of our financial statements.

Revenue Recognition

        Revenues are reported net of any state provider taxes or gross receipts taxes levied on services we provide. Revenues are also reported net of allowances for unauthorized sales and estimated sales adjustments by business unit. Sales adjustments are estimated based on an analysis of historical sales adjustments and recent developments in the payment trends in each business unit. We follow Staff Accounting Bulletin (SAB) 104, Revenue Recognition , which requires that revenue can only be recognized when evidence of an arrangement exists, the service has been provided, the price is fixed or determinable and collectibility is probable. We recognize revenues for services performed pursuant to contracts with various state and local government agencies and private health care agencies as follows: cost-reimbursement contract revenues are recognized at the time the service costs are incurred and units-of-service contract revenues are recognized at the time the service is provided. For our cost-reimbursement contracts, the rate provided by the payor is based on a certain level of service and types of costs incurred in delivering the service. From time to time, we receive payments under

53



cost-reimbursement contracts in excess of the allowable costs required to support those payments. In such instances, we estimate and record a liability for such excess payments. At the end of the contract period, any balance of excess payments is maintained as a liability until it is reimbursed to the payor. Revenues in the future may be affected by changes in rate-setting structures, methodologies or interpretations that may be enacted in states where we operate or by the federal government.

Accounts Receivable

        Accounts receivable primarily consist of amounts due from government agencies, not-for-profit providers, and commercial insurance companies. An estimated allowance for doubtful accounts is recorded to the extent it is probable that a portion or all of a particular account will not be collected. In evaluating the collectibility of accounts receivable, we consider a number of factors, including payment trends in individual states, age of the accounts, and the status of ongoing disputes with third-party payors. Complex rules and regulations regarding billing and timely filing requirements in various states are also a factor in our assessment of the collectibility of accounts receivable. Actual collections of accounts receivable in subsequent periods may require changes in the estimated allowance for doubtful accounts. Changes in these estimates are charged or credited to revenue in the statement of operations in the period of the change in estimate.

Accruals for Self-Insurance

        We self-insure a substantial portion of our health, workers compensation, automobile and professional and general liability ("PL/GL") programs. We record expenses related to claims on an incurred basis, which includes estimates of fully developed losses for both reported and unreported claims. The accruals for the health and workers compensation, automobile and PL/GL programs are based on analyses performed internally by management or actuarially determined estimates by independent third parties. Accruals relating to prior periods are periodically reevaluated and increased or decreased based on new information. As such, these changes in estimates are recorded as charges or credits to the statement of operations in a period subsequent to the change in estimate.

Goodwill and Intangible Assets

        Pursuant to SFAS No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets (SFAS 142), we review costs of purchased businesses in excess of net assets acquired (goodwill), and indefinite-life intangible assets for impairment at least annually, unless significant changes in circumstances indicate a potential impairment may have occurred sooner. We are required to test goodwill on a reporting unit basis. We use a fair value approach to test goodwill for impairment and recognize an impairment charge for the amount, if any, by which the carrying amount of goodwill exceeds fair value. The impairment test for indefinite-life intangible assets requires the determination of the fair value of the intangible asset. If the fair value of the intangible asset were less than its carrying value, an impairment loss would be recognized in an amount equal to the difference. Fair values are established using discounted cash flow and comparative market multiple methods. We conduct our annual impairment test on July 1 of each year, and as of the date of the last test, there was no impairment and there have been no indicators of impairment since the date of the test.

        Discounted cash flows are based on management's estimates of our future performance. As such, actual results may differ from these estimates and lead to a revaluation of our goodwill and intangible assets. If updated calculations indicate that the fair value of goodwill or any indefinite-life intangibles is less than the carrying value of the asset, an impairment charge would be recorded in the statement of operations in the period of the change in estimate.

        Pursuant to SFAS 141, fixed assets and identifiable intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed are recorded at their respective fair values. We are in the process of completing valuations of certain real estate assets; thus, the allocation of the purchase price to our assets is subject to adjustment.

54



Impairment of Long-Lived Assets

        Pursuant to SFAS No. 144, Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets (SFAS 144), we review long-lived assets for impairment when circumstances indicate the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable based on the undiscounted future cash flows of the asset. If the carrying amount of the asset is determined not to be recoverable, a write-down to fair value is recorded based upon various techniques to estimate fair value.

Income Taxes

        We account for income taxes in accordance with SFAS No. 109, Accounting for Income Taxes (SFAS 109). Under SFAS 109, the asset and liability method is used in accounting for income taxes. Under this method, deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined by multiplying the differences between the financial reporting and tax reporting bases for assets and liabilities by the enacted tax rates expected to be in effect when such differences are recovered or settled. These deferred tax assets and liabilities are separated into current and long-term amounts based on the classification of the related assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes. Valuation allowances on deferred tax assets are estimated based on our assessment of the realizability of such amounts.

Derivative Financial Instruments

        From time to time, we use derivative financial instruments to manage the risk of interest rate fluctuations on debt and account for derivative financial instruments in accordance with SFAS No. 133, Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities (SFAS 133), as amended, which requires that all derivative instruments be reported on the balance sheet at fair value and establishes criteria for designation and effectiveness of hedging relationships. Changes in the fair value of derivatives are recorded each period in current operations or in shareholders' equity as other comprehensive income (loss) depending upon whether the derivative is designated as part of a hedge transaction and, if it is, the type of hedge transaction.

        We, from time to time, enter into interest rate swap agreements to hedge against variability in cash flows resulting from fluctuations in the benchmark interest rate, which is LIBOR, on our debt. These agreements involve the exchange of variable interest rates for fixed interest rates over the life of the swap agreement without an exchange of the notional amount upon which the payments are based. On a quarterly basis, the differential to be received or paid as interest rates change is accrued and recognized as an adjustment to interest expense in the accompanying consolidated statement of operations. In addition, on a quarterly basis the mark to market valuation is recorded as an adjustment to other comprehensive income/loss as a change to shareholder's equity. The related amount receivable from or payable to counterparties is included as an asset or liability in our consolidated balance sheet.

Legal Contingencies

        From time to time, we are involved in litigation in the operation of our business. We reserve for costs related to contingencies when a loss is probable and the amount is reasonably estimable. While we believe our provision for legal contingencies is adequate, the outcome of our legal proceedings is difficult to predict and we may settle legal claims or be subject to judgments for amounts that differ from our estimates. In addition, legal contingencies could have a material adverse impact on our results of operations in any given future reporting period. See "Risk Factors."

55



INDUSTRY OVERVIEW

        The human services industry provides services to people with a range of disabilities and special needs, including (i) individuals with mental retardation and developmental disabilities, (ii) at-risk youth and (iii) individuals with acquired brain injury. The market for these services remains highly fragmented, with the majority of service providers consisting of not-for-profit organizations, small or medium-size proprietary entities and publicly-owned entities. The services in these segments are funded primarily through Medicaid, a joint federal and state health insurance program under which eligible state expenditures are matched with federal funding. In addition, funds are also provided by other federal, state and local governmental programs and, to a lesser extent, private payors.

Mental Retardation and Developmental Disabilities

        Approximately 1.6% of the U.S. population, or 4.6 million people, are considered to have MR/DD, or a severe, chronic developmental disability attributable to a mental or physical impairment. These individuals live in supervised residential settings, including institutions; with family caregivers or on their own. Public spending on MR/DD services grew from an estimated $30.0 billion in 1998 to an estimated $38.6 billion in 2004, a rate of 4.3% per year. In 2004, approximately 492,000 individuals with MR/DD received care within a supervised residential setting, which represents only 11% of the MR/DD population. Approximately 60% of the MR/DD population, or approximately 2.8 million individuals, remain in the care of their family and approximately 28%, or 1.3 million individuals, live independently.

        Over the past two decades, the delivery of services to the MR/DD population in supervised residential settings has grown significantly and, at the same time, there has been a major shift from institutional settings to home and community-based settings, both in part due to the Americans with Disabilities Act ("ADA") and the U.S. Supreme Court Olmstead decision in 1999. The U.S. Supreme Court held in its Olmstead decision that under the Americans with Disabilities Act, states are required to place persons with mental disabilities in community settings rather than in institutions when such placement is deemed appropriate by medical professionals, the transfer from institutional care to a less restricted setting is not opposed by the affected individual, and the placement can be accommodated taking into account the resources available to the state and the needs of other individuals with mental disabilities. We believe that community settings provide a higher quality and, in some cases, lower cost alternative to care provided in state institutions.

        Home and Community-Based Services ("HCBS") Waiver programs, Medicaid programs where the federal government has waived the requirement that services be delivered in institutional settings, are the primary funding vehicle for home and community-based services. The HCBS program was instituted as an alternative to the intermediate care facilities/mentally retarded program, or ICF-MR program described below, authorizing federal reimbursement for a wide variety of community supports and services, including life-skills training, respite care, other family support, case management, supported employment and supported living. In these programs, the provider responds to the client's identified needs and typically is paid on a fee-for-service basis.

        Federal funding for HCBS Waiver programs for individuals with MR/DD increased from $4.4 billion in 1998 to $9.2 billion in 2004, representing an annual increase of approximately 13.1%. Approximately 68% of these individuals with MR/DD that receive care in supervised residential settings live in small group homes paid for under the HCBS Waiver programs. In 2004, federal, state and local HCBS waiver spending totaled $15.7 billion for 416,546 individuals, with all 50 states and the District of Columbia participating.

        The ICF-MR Program was established in 1971 when legislation was enacted to provide for Federal Financial Participation ("FFP") for ICF-MR as an optional Medicaid service. This congressional authorization allows states to receive federal matching funds for institutional services that are funded

56



with state or local government dollars. To qualify for Medicaid reimbursement, ICFs-MR must be certified and comply with federal standards in eight areas, including: management, client protections, facility staffing, active treatment services, client behavior and facility practices, health care services, physical environment and dietetic services.

        The ICF-MR program is used by states to support MR/DD housing program, in both smaller (up to 16 residents) and larger (16 residents or more) institutional settings. Individuals who live in ICFs-MR receive active treatment. In 2004, the ICF-MR program provided approximately $1.9 billion in federal funding to approximately 43,774 individuals living in public and private ICF-MR settings of up to 16 residents.

        We believe that the following factors will continue to benefit the sector, and in particular home and community-based programs:

    Increasing life expectancy of MR/DD population—The life expectancy of individuals with MR/DD increased from 59 years in the 1970s to 66 years in the 1990s and we expect this trend to continue in the future. In addition, approximately 2.8 million individuals with MR/DD are presently cared for by a family member, and 25% of their caregivers are age 60 or older. As individuals with MR/DD grow older and an increasing number outlive their family member's ability to provide continuous care, we expect the demand for MR/DD services to expand.

    Active Litigation and Advocacy—Individuals with MR/DD are supported by active and well-organized advocacy groups. Using legislation prompted by the Olmstead decision, as well as lawsuits filed on behalf of those on waiting lists for services, policy makers, civil rights lawyers, social workers and advocacy groups are forcing states to provide individuals with MR/DD the choice to live and receive services in home and community-based settings. Currently, more than 80,000 individuals are on formal state waitlists to receive services funded through HCBS Waiver programs and there are more than 45 active lawsuits advocating for community integration and the reduction of HCBS waiting lists.

    Continued Closure of State Institutions—Although most of the shift from institutions to home and community-based settings has occurred, the closure of additional state institutions is expected. There were approximately 200,000 individuals in state institutions in 1968 compared to approximately 41,000 individuals in 2004. State governments are still actively working to close many state institutions that remain open, with nine institutions in eight states identified for closure by the end of 2007. Most of these institutions are in the markets that we serve.

At-Risk Youth

        The ARY service market includes children with severe emotional, developmental, medical, and behavioral challenges, as well as youth under the auspices of the juvenile justice system and their families. We believe that the market for ARY services is rapidly growing as a result of the increase in child welfare referrals and number of youth arrests as well as the expanding 10 to 19 year-old population. The market for ARY services grew from $25 billion in 1998 to $39 billion in 2004, which represents an increase of approximately 8% annually. ARY services are funded from a variety of sources, including state and local government appropriations, Medicaid, and Title IV-E of the Social Security Act, or "The Adoption Assistance and Child Welfare Act of 1980."

        Similar to MR/DD programs, there has been an increased emphasis on home and community-based alternatives for the ARY population. More states are shifting funds to private providers of these services in an attempt to purchase cost-effective, evidence-based care.

57



Acquired Brain Injury

        Continued progress in medical technology is resulting in an increased number of individuals surviving a traumatic ABI. Currently, 5.3 million people in the U.S. are living with a permanent disability as a result of an ABI. In addition, more than 1.4 million new ABI cases, 85,000 of which result in permanent disabilities, are expected each year. The market for ABI services grew from $7.6 billion in 1998 to $9.5 billion in 2004, representing an annual increase of approximately 3.8%.

        Both the public and private sectors finance post-acute services for individuals with an ABI. Federal and state governments pay for a large portion of post-acute services, as private insurance plans limit post-acute services and typically do not pay for long-term care or community-based support. The Traumatic Brain Injury Act of 1996 allocated Medicaid dollars to improve the access, delivery and quality of ABI services. In recent years, the increase in state ABI Waiver programs that provide easier access to Medicaid funds has expanded the number of individuals who can afford ABI services. Currently 24 states have developed community based waiver programs to support long term care services for survivors of ABI. In addition, we believe that there has been a push by payors to move from high cost institution-based settings to lower cost outpatient and day treatment programs as soon as possible. This shift should benefit providers such as MENTOR, that offer a continuum of care from physical and neurological rehabilitation to more basic long-term care services in non-institutional settings.

58



BUSINESS

Company Overview

        We are a leading provider of home and community-based human services to individuals with mental retardation and other developmental disabilities, at-risk youth and their families, and persons with acquired brain injury. Since our founding in 1980, we have grown to provide services to approximately 21,700 clients in 34 states. We design customized service plans to meet the unique needs of our clients in home and community-based settings. Most of our services involve residential support, typically in small group home or host home settings, designed to improve our clients' quality of life and to promote client independence and participation in community life. Services that we provide include day programs, vocational services, case management, early intervention, post-acute treatment and neurorehabilitation services, among others. Our customized services offer our clients, as well as the payors for these services, an attractive, cost-effective alternative to human services provided in large, institutional settings.

        We believe that our broad range of services, high-quality reputation and relationships with government agencies have made us one of the largest providers in the United States of home and community-based services. In the past three years, our management team has grown the Company organically through investment in new programs and geographies, census growth in existing programs and cross-selling programs within existing markets. In addition, since fiscal 2003, we have completed and successfully integrated more than 20 acquisitions.

        As of September 30, 2006, we provided our services through approximately 15,700 full-time equivalent employees, as well as approximately 3,900 independently contracted host home caregivers, or Mentors. We derive over 93% of our revenues from a diverse group of state and county governmental payors. We generated net revenues of approximately $789.2 million for fiscal 2006.

        Our services are offered through a variety of models, including (i) small group homes, most of which house six people or fewer, (ii) host homes, or the "Mentor" model, in which a client lives in the home of a trained Mentor, (iii) in-home settings, in which we support clients' independence with 24-hour services in their own homes, (iv) non-residential settings, consisting primarily of day programs and periodic services in various settings and (v) educational settings, in which we offer in-school, after-school and alternative educational services. We provide services in these settings to the following population groups:

        Our service lines do not represent operating segments per SFAS 131 as management does not internally evaluate the operating performance or review the results of the service lines to assess performance or make decisions about allocating resources. Also, discrete financial information is not available by service line at the level necessary for management to assess the performance or make

59



resource allocation decisions. Accordingly, we operate our business as one human services reporting segment organized into three divisions, an Eastern Division, a Central Division and a Western Division.

Competitive Strengths

        We believe that the following competitive strengths have allowed us to achieve and maintain our position as a leading provider of home and community-based services to our target population groups:

        National Platform with Diverse Payor and Program Mix.     We serve clients in 34 states, which are home to approximately 80% of the United States population, although we do not operate in all regions of those states. We believe that we deliver a level of quality and responsiveness that smaller local service providers are not always able to offer and which has helped us forge strong relationships with state and county agencies. Our extensive history of serving children and adults with a range of challenges and needs has led to the development of operational expertise in quality assurance, customer satisfaction survey implementation and analysis, outcomes measurement and risk management. Our national platform has also enabled us to implement best practices across our organization and leverage economies of scale in various direct and indirect costs. For instance, we have been able to develop the expertise and systems to facilitate compliance with the increasingly complex and diverse billing requirements of our payors. In addition, our national platform, reputation and knowledge enable us to respond quickly and efficiently to new opportunities. As a result, we have successfully expanded our markets and entered a number of new service areas, including ABI, early childhood autism programs and non-residential therapeutic schools. Finally, the more than 30 different types of programs that we offer, coupled with our diverse base of state and county payors, stabilize our revenue base and mitigate the impact of changes in public policy, rates or reimbursement policies in any particular state, county or program.

        Client-Oriented Care Model.     We have the expertise to design customized service plans to meet the unique needs of our clients in community-based settings. We specialize in adapting our service offerings to a wide range of intensities of care and other client requirements, as well as in providing cost-effective services that are accountable to clients, their families and payors. For example, our program for foster children with complex medical conditions includes individual plans of care that address each child's medical condition, as well as his or her physical and emotional needs. These children are cared for in a Mentor host home with the support of medical professionals, which we believe is better for the development of children and often a less expensive alternative for payors than hospital settings.

        Stable Revenue and Strong Cash Flow.     The extended length of care inherent in our MR/DD service line, which is the largest part of our business, provides us with a stable, recurring base of revenue. Clients with MR/DD live in our homes for an average of approximately eight years and the increased life expectancy of the MR/DD population, as described above, is extending the average length of stay in our homes. Life expectancy and the services available for individuals with ABI have also increased as a result of improved medical resources and technology providing additional stability to our revenue base. Furthermore, our business model requires capital expenditures of approximately 2% of net revenues per year and has modest working capital needs.

        Flexible Fixed Cost Structure.     We believe that our fixed costs are lower than those of large institutional care providers, enabling us to respond quickly to market developments and regulatory changes. A substantial portion of our caregivers are hourly employees or independently contracted clinicians and Mentors, which allows us to quickly respond to changes in our staffing needs. Our group homes consist of a mix of owned residential real estate and leased real estate, including many leases with terms of two years or less. We believe that the structure of our real estate portfolio allows us to respond quickly to changes in our service levels.

60



        Experienced and Committed Management Team and Equity Sponsor.     Our management team, having served previously as policy makers, fiscal managers and service providers, has extensive public and private sector experience in human services. Our senior management team has been with us for an average of 11 years and averages approximately 21 years in the human services industry. Over the past ten years, members of our management team have helped to grow the Company from $88.3 million in revenues in 1997 to $789.2 million in net revenues for fiscal 2006 through organic growth and the integration of 37 acquisitions. In connection with the Merger, the management investors made a significant equity contribution of approximately $11.6 million. In addition, our equity sponsor, Vestar Capital Partners, has considerable experience making investments in a wide variety of industries, including healthcare.

Our Strategy

        We believe home and community-based human services that increase client independence and participation in community life while reducing payor costs will continue to grow in market share. We intend to continue to capitalize on these trends, both in existing markets and in new markets where we believe significant opportunities exist. The primary aspects of our strategy include the following:

        Grow Our Census and Expand Our Services in Existing Markets.     We intend to continue to expand our census in existing markets where we leverage our reputation for high-quality, innovative services and our relationships with referral sources to serve new individuals and families. We also intend to continue to cross-sell new services, which involve starting new service lines or offering new programs in markets where we already have a well-established base of operations and relationships with existing referral sources. For example, our acquisition of an ABI operation in Illinois in 1998 has provided us with the clinical and operational expertise to export a range of ABI programs to 12 states where we offered other services. Similarly, we have leveraged our experience in early intervention services in both California and Arizona to obtain a new contract for early intervention services in Nevada which will expand our services in that state. Finally, in South Carolina we plan to begin operating host home services for adults with MR/DD in a market where we have historically offered only group home services to this population.

        Expand Our Services in New Markets.     We also intend to continue to seek new opportunities to grow in each of our service lines by leveraging our current infrastructure to expand into new territories through new program starts, or new starts. We often seek new starts through the signing of an anchor contract in a new state or region with the intention of leveraging the initial contract to expand by service line or by model. For example, we increased our census in Illinois from 437 in fiscal 2002 to 651 in fiscal 2006 after establishing ARY programs in four new cities through the new start process. A new start typically requires a modest initial investment to fund operating losses but generally achieves profitability within 18-24 months. Since the inception of our new start program in fiscal 2002, as of September 30, 2006, we have successfully launched 91 new starts, including 23 which launched in fiscal 2006.

        Continue to Strengthen Our Third-Party Payor Relationships.     Much of our organic growth in recent years has resulted from the strength of our relationships with state and local government agencies. Our relationships with these payors have enabled us to gain contract referrals and to cross-sell new services into existing markets. We continue to strengthen these relationships by providing innovative quality assurance, reporting and billing programs designed to serve the needs of third-party payors. We seek to position ourselves as the provider of choice to state and county governments and other third-party payors by finding solutions to their most challenging human service delivery problems.

        Selectively Pursue Acquisitions.     Members of our management team have a proven track record of identifying, pursuing and successfully integrating acquisitions, having completed 37 acquisitions since 1997. We have selectively supplemented our organic growth through acquisitions which have allowed us

61



to penetrate new geographies, enter new service lines, leverage our systems, operating costs and best practices, and pursue cross-selling opportunities. We monitor the market nationally for human service businesses that we can purchase at an attractive price and efficiently "tuck-in" to our existing operations. We believe we are often seen as a preferred acquirer in these situations due to our experience, relationships, infrastructure and reputation for quality. We intend to continue to pursue acquisitions that are philosophically compatible and can be readily integrated into our existing operations.

        Expand into Related Services and Programs.     We intend to continue to evaluate opportunities to provide services to additional population groups in the human services industry. We believe that our broad range of services, relationships with third-party payors, reputation for quality care and infrastructure give us the ability to expand the number of clients we serve in a cost-effective manner. We have successfully entered new service lines, including ABI, and program areas, including early childhood autism programs, non-residential therapeutic schools and home health care. As we continue to strengthen existing services, we will use our clinical skills, personnel and experience to provide new, related services.

Service Lines and Operating Models

Mental Retardation/Developmental Disability

        As of September 30, 2006, we provided MR/DD services to approximately 15,700 clients in 28 states. For fiscal 2006, our MR/DD services generated revenues of $549.9 million, representing approximately 70% of our net revenues. We receive substantially all our revenues for MR/DD services from state and county governmental payors. Our MR/DD programs include 24-hour supervision and live-in settings such as our small group homes, ICFs-MR, or host homes. Once placed in a host home, ICF-MR, or small group home setting, clients rarely change service settings, and many of them live the remainder of their lives in our program.

        Most of our MR/DD services are home and community-based, focusing on improving our clients' access to community resources and participation in community life, increasing their personal choice and improving their adaptive living skills. Our programs, which provide a range of individually tailored behavioral and life skills training and medical support, in addition to intensive case management and service monitoring, help our clients live in the community. We help clients increase their participation in everyday activities, providing opportunities for them to learn and generalize skills and behaviors that facilitate greater community participation. Through regular involvement in community activities, our clients establish a social and support network that consists of both persons with and without disabilities. For some of our clients, our home and community-based residential programs serve as their first living arrangement after institutionalization. We believe that we have a reputation for being responsive to individual clients' needs, as well as for expertise in assessing, supporting and serving people with disabilities.

        The majority of our residential services to MR/DD clients are provided in small group home or ICF-MR settings. Most of our small group homes house six or fewer individuals while the majority of our ICFs-MR house eight or fewer individuals. These homes and ICFs-MR are typically subject to standards set by the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services, or "CMS," a federal agency within the U.S. Department of Health and Human Services, as well as review and oversight by state agencies. Our homes and ICFs-MR are staffed 24 hours a day, typically with two staff members on the premises at peak service hours, often with awake overnight coverage. Typically, residents work outside the home during the day in supported employment settings or participate in structured day programs. Our day and supported employment programs provide meaningful structure to each person's day and serve as the venue for additional skill development for participants. Some of our MR/DD clients live in host home settings, in which we place a client in the home of one of our Mentors, and the client lives with

62



the Mentor and the Mentor's family. This model is an inherently flexible one, allowing services to be individually designed to respond to the client's specific needs and preferences. As in our small group home and ICF-MR programs, individuals living in our host home programs receive behavioral and life skills training, medical support and intensive case management and service monitoring, and participate in day or supported employment programs.

        Our group home and ICF-MR staff and our host home providers have access to a team of professionals who are available 24 hours per day, 365 days per year for telephone triage, and, when warranted, crisis intervention.

        In-home arrangements place our MR/DD clients in independent, non-staffed housing with services provided as needed, subject to personalized support plans designed by social workers or other professionals. Supported living is a preferred model for many persons with MR/DD and for most activists and experts in the field because it increases the person's freedom and independence.

        In 2003, we acquired REM, Inc., one of the largest providers of MR/DD services in the United States. The REM acquisition significantly increased the scope of our MR/DD services, provided us access to nine new markets and doubled our revenues.

At-risk Youth

        As of September 30, 2006, we provided ARY services to approximately 5,700 children, adolescents and their families in 23 states. For fiscal 2006, our ARY services generated net revenues of $146.2 million, representing approximately 18% of our net revenues. We receive substantially all our revenues for ARY services from state and county governmental payors. Our ARY programs include therapeutic foster care (host home), independent living, family reunification, family preservation, alternative schools and adoption services. At September 30, 2006, approximately 80% of our ARY services to children were delivered in a host home setting, in which the client lives in the home of one of our Mentors, usually for a transitional period lasting anywhere from one to two years, as the child prepares for adulthood or permanent placement with his family or adoptive parents. Our individualized approach allows us to work with an ever-changing client population that is diverse in terms of age and gender as well as in type and severity of problem. Children we serve include those with serious emotional disorders or behavioral issues, court-involved youth and children with complex medical needs.

        Our ARY clients typically come from troubled families, and may previously have lived in large institutions and other residential treatment settings that may have been unable to provide the structure, supervision or clinical interventions to meet their needs. In a host home, each child is given a stable environment and therapeutic services to the extent needed to address emotional disorders, often stemming from abuse and neglect. Our residential ARY services emphasize behavior control, increased self-esteem and self-control, and the development of critical thinking, problem-solving, and independent living skills. Our ultimate goal is to reunite participating children with their biological families or prepare them, when appropriate, for permanent placement, through adoption or independent living. Unlike many of our MR/DD services, most of our ARY services are designed to be short-term and transitional in nature.

        In recent years, we have begun to provide family-based services which support both the child and the biological family in their efforts to remain preserved or reunify following an out-of-home placement. These services are non-residential and are, in most cases, billed on an hourly basis. Families receive both clinical and practical support from professional and paraprofessional staff in their own homes. State departments of social services are increasingly seeking providers who can offer this service as a wrap service to treatment foster care programs.

63


        We also provide alternative school services to youth who are unable to succeed in traditional educational settings. These schools offer courses in an environment which supports a range of challenges to learning, including severe behavioral problems and learning disabilities. Some of our schools provide vocational training and after school services.

Acquired brain injury

        As of September 30, 2006, we provided ABI services in 12 states and served approximately 360 clients nationally. For fiscal 2006, our ABI services generated net revenues of $56.9 million, representing approximately 7% of our net revenues. For fiscal 2006, we received approximately 48% of our ABI revenues from state and county governmental payors and approximately 52% from private payors.

        The high costs associated with inpatient hospitalization typically limit the amount of time spent by our ABI clients in acute care settings. This leads to a demand on the part of both clients and payors for post-acute programs with the ability to safely and efficiently serve challenging post-acute cases. In addition, providers that offer a continuum of care, from post-acute care to long-term, as-needed services, are more attractive to payors looking to step-down individuals' level of care rapidly and seamlessly.

        We offer our ABI services in a variety of settings, small group homes, host homes, in-home and nonresidential (day treatment) and intensive residential settings. We also operate a small hospital-based program which provides in-patient treatment designed to meet the needs of persons recovering from ABI shortly after the injury is sustained.

        These settings provide the venue for implementing an individually tailored plan of care which will focus on neurorehabilitation or neurobehavioral rehabilitation and enable the participant to live as independently and productively as possible. Neurorehabilitation programs use active rehabilitation to maximize neurological recoveries. Individualized functional goals are designed to help persons with ABI return home, to their communities, and to work or school. Neurobehavioral rehabilitation focuses on teaching behavioral alternatives to various unwanted or dangerous behaviors. This approach is intended to enhance participation in daily routines and certain aspects of the community.

        As part of their participation in our programs, clients receive, as individually appropriate, a number of therapies, which include, but are not limited to, physical, speech and language, cognitive, behavioral, and life skills, as well as counseling, case management, and vocational services. Our continuum of services includes programs designed for particular population groups, such as adolescents and substance abusers.

Other

        We derive revenues from other sources, including through the provision of home health services to individuals with physical disabilities and the elderly. Our services to these clients include skilled nursing, physical therapy, occupational therapy, personal care, and homemaking services, among others. For fiscal 2006, these other sources of revenues generated net revenues of $36.2 million, representing approximately 5% of our net revenues. Our revenues for these services come from a diverse mix of governmental and private payors.

Training and Supporting our Direct Care Workers

        We provide pre-service and in-service education to all of our direct care workers, including employees and independent contractors, clinical and administrative staff, and we encourage staff and contractors to avail themselves of outside training opportunities whenever possible. Employees and independent contractors participate in orientation programs designed to increase understanding of our

64



mission, philosophy of care, and our Code of Conduct and compliance program. In addition, education and skill development in competencies required for specific duties are provided in accordance with licensing and regulatory requirements and our internal operating standards. These include, but are not limited to, human rights, individual service plan development, universal precautions, first aid, mandated reporting of abuse and neglect, confidentiality, emergency procedures, medication management, risk management and incident reporting procedures. We maintain an extensive resource library of training materials and an intranet site that facilitates the identification and exchange of expertise across all of our operations. Pre-service and in-service education sessions are required as a condition of continued employment or a continued contractual relationship with us. This training helps our staff to understand their responsibilities to the program and its participants, and results in both personal and professional development of staff and contractors. We work to increase individual job satisfaction and retention of motivated, qualified employees and contractors.

        In addition to pre-service and in-service orientation, our Mentors receive training which is specific to the individual or child placed in their home. A home study is conducted and interviews and criminal background checks are performed on all adult members of the Mentor household. Often, pre-placement visits occur before the placement is finalized to observe first hand whether the placement will be successful. Mentors are regularly monitored by our case manager or coordinator according to a prescribed schedule. Depending on the needs of the child or adult, these visits may be weekly, every other week or monthly, or in some cases, more than once a week. Mentors have access to our on-call person for emergency telephone triage and on-site crisis intervention, when necessary. Many Mentors attend support groups offered at the program office. Mentors often have planned respite days built into their service agreements and, to accommodate these days, for one or two days a month the client may spend the night in the home of another Mentor.

Sales/Business Development and Marketing

        We receive substantially all of our MR/DD and ARY clients through third-party referrals, most frequently through recommendations to family members from state or local agencies. Since our operations depend heavily on these referrals, we seek to ensure that we provide high-quality services in all states in which we operate, allowing us to enhance our name recognition and maintain a positive reputation with the state and local agencies.

        Relationships with referral sources are cultivated and maintained at the local level by key operations managers. Local programs may, however, avail themselves of corporate resources to help grow and diversify their businesses. Staff across the country have the following business development and marketing services available to promote both new and existing product lines.

        Our business development group works with operations to drive the growth of programs and services across the country and to divest non-performing business units. The business development group has implemented an RFP response program designed to expand core growth and promote new program starts and cross sell opportunities. It also conducts research on entry into new markets and the competitive landscape. Our business development group is led by our Executive Vice President and Chief Development Officer, with four Division Managers across the country. The business development group works closely with two mergers and acquisitions professionals, who are based in Atlanta, Georgia, and with several consultants to identify, prioritize, and implement the best growth opportunities. All of its activities are grouped in three pipelines: new program starts (programs in new markets or new programs in existing markets in each case requiring an investment to fund operating losses); proposals (responses to requests-for-proposal); and acquisitions.

        Our ABI sales force is independently organized. ABI sales efforts are led by a Director of Sales and Marketing who oversees an 11-member, geographically assigned sales staff. This staff conducts clinical evaluations to determine eligibility for our ABI programs.

65



Customers and Contracts

        Our customers, which pay us to provide services to our clients, are generally governmental agencies and not-for-profit organizations and, to a limited extent, private payors. Our MR/DD and ARY services are delivered pursuant to contracts with various governmental agencies, such as departments of mental retardation, juvenile justice and child welfare, for the provision of services. Such contracts may be issued at the county or state level, depending upon the structure of the service system of the state in question. Contracts may cover a range of individuals such as all children referred for host home services in a county or a particular set of individuals who will share group living arrangements. Contracts are sometimes issued for specific individuals, where rates are individually determined based on need. Although our contracts generally have a stated term of one year and generally may be terminated without cause on 60-day's notice, the contracts are typically renewed annually if we have complied with licensing, certification, program standards and other regulatory requirements. As provider of record, we contractually obligate ourselves to adhere to the applicable federal and state regulations regarding the provision of services, the maintenance of records and submission of claims for reimbursement under Medicaid. For fiscal 2006, revenue from our contracts with state and local governmental agencies in the states of Minnesota, California, Florida, Indiana and West Virginia, our five largest revenue-generating states, comprised 45% of our net revenues. For fiscal 2005, revenue from our contracts with state and local governmental agencies in the states of Minnesota, California, Indiana, West Virginia and Wisconsin, our five largest revenue-generating states, comprised 47% of our net revenues. Revenue from our contracts with state and local governmental agencies in the state of Minnesota, our largest state, accounted for 17% and 19% of our net revenues for fiscal 2006 and for fiscal 2005, respectively.

        We have entered into service agreements with Alliance Human Services, Inc., an independent, not-for-profit organization, to provide ARY services for states and local governments that prefer or choose not to enter into contracts with for-profit corporations to provide those services. In these cases, Alliance has licenses or contracts with state or local agencies, and we have entered into service agreements with Alliance in South Carolina, Pennsylvania, North Carolina, Massachusetts, Ohio, Indiana, Illinois, Texas, and California to provide certain treatment services in local programs for ARY. Approximately 5% of our revenues for both fiscal 2006 and for fiscal 2005 were derived from contracts with Alliance.

Competition

MR/DD

        The MR/DD market is highly fragmented, with providers ranging from small, local agencies to large, national organizations. While state and local governments continue to supply a small percentage of services, the majority of services are provided by the private sector. Not-for-profit organizations are also active in all states and range from small agencies serving a limited area with specific programs to multi-state organizations. Many of the not-for-profit companies are affiliated with advocacy and sponsoring groups such as community mental health and mental retardation centers as well as religious organizations.

ARY

        Competition in the at-risk youth and troubled youth market is extremely fragmented, with several thousand providers in the United States. Our primary competition consists of local not-for-profits serving one particular geographic area. We do not actively compete with national ARY providers, most of which do not focus on youth populations outside of institutional and detention facilities. We believe that our extensive service offering and ability to work with youths experiencing a variety of mental, emotional, behavioral and physical difficulties further differentiate us from other providers.

66



ABI

        We compete with several large chains of inpatient and outpatient rehabilitation services in the provision of ABI services. We also compete with hospitals and other local rehabilitation facilities.

Regulatory Framework

        We must comply with comprehensive government regulation of our business, including federal, state and local statutes, regulations and policies governing the licensing of facilities, the quality of service, the revenues received for services, and reimbursement for the cost of services. State and federal regulatory agencies have broad discretionary powers over the administration and enforcement of laws and regulations that govern our operations.

        The following regulatory considerations are paramount to our operations:

        Funding.     Federal and state funding for our services is subject to statutory and regulatory changes, contracting and managed care initiatives, level of care assessments, court orders, rate setting and state budgetary considerations, all of which may materially increase or decrease reimbursement for our services. We actively participate in local and national legislative initiatives that seek to impact funding and regulation of our services. We derive revenues for our MR/DD and ARY services, a majority of our revenues for our home health services and a significant portion of our ABI services from Medicaid programs.

        Licensure and qualification to deliver service.     We are required to comply with extensive licensing and regulatory requirements applicable to the services we deliver. These include requirements for participation in the Medicaid and Medicare programs, state and local contractual obligations, and requirements relating to individual rights, the credentialing of all of our employees and contract Mentors (including background and Office of Inspector General checks), the quality of care delivered, the physical plant and facilitation of community participation. Compliance with state licensing requirements is a prerequisite for participation in government-sponsored health care assistance programs, such as Medicaid or Medicare. To qualify for reimbursement under Medicaid or Medicare, facilities and programs are subject to various requirements imposed by federal and state authorities. We maintain a licensing database that tracks activity on licenses governing the provision of services.

        In addition to Medicaid participation requirements, our facilities and services are subject to annual or semi-annual licensing and other regulatory requirements of state and local authorities. These requirements relate to the condition of the facilities, the quality and adequacy of personnel and the quality of services provided. State licensing and other regulatory requirements vary by jurisdiction and are subject to change and local interpretation.

        From time to time we receive notices from regulatory inspectors that, in their opinion, there are deficiencies resulting from a failure to comply with various regulatory requirements. We review such notices and take corrective action as appropriate. In most cases we and the reviewing agency agree upon the steps to be taken to address the deficiency and, from time to time, we or one or more of our subsidiaries may enter into agreements with regulatory agencies requiring us to take certain corrective action in order to maintain our licenses. Serious deficiencies, or failure to comply with any regulatory agreements, may result in the assessment of fines or penalties and/or decertification or delicensure actions by the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services ("CMS") or state regulatory agencies.

        We deliver services and support under a number of different funding and program provisions. Our most significant source of funding for our disability service line are Home and Community Based Services ("HCBS") Waiver programs, Medicaid programs for which eligibility is based on a set of criteria (typically disability or age) established by the state and approved by the federal government. There is no uniformity between states and/or regulations governing our delivery of waivered services to individuals. Each state where we deliver services operates under a plan submitted by the state to CMS to use Medicaid funds in non-institutional settings. Typically the state writes its own regulations

67



governing providers and services provided under the state waiver program. Consequently, there is no uniform method of describing or predicting the outcomes of regulations across states where we deliver HCBS Waiver services. In addition, our ICFs/MR are governed by federal regulations, and may also be subject to individual state rules that vary widely in application and content. Federal regulations require that in order to maintain Medicaid certification as an ICF/MR, the facility is subject to annual on site survey (a federal rule and process implemented by state agencies). Failure to successfully pass this inspection and remedy all defects or conditions cited may result in a finding of immediate jeopardy or other serious sanction and, ultimately, may cause a loss of both certification and funding for that particular facility.

        Similarly, child foster care and other children's services are largely governed by individual state regulations which vary both in terms and regulatory content. Failure to comply with any state's regulations requires remedial action on our part and a failure to adequately remedy the problem may result in provider or contract termination.

        All states in which we operate have adopted laws or regulations which generally require that a state agency approve us as a provider, and many require a determination that a need exists prior to the addition of covered individuals or services. Provider licenses are not transferable. Consequently, should we intend to acquire, develop, expand or divest services in any state or to enter a new state, we may be required to undergo a rigorous licensing, transfer and approval process prior to conducting business or completing any transaction.

        Similarly, some states have a formal Certificate of Need ("CON") process, whereby the state health care authority must first determine that a service proposed is needed under the state health plan, prior to any service being licensed or applied for. The CON process varies by state and may be formal in design, encompassing any transfer, organizational change, capital improvements, divestitures or acquisitions. Formal processes may include public notice, opportunity for affected parties to request a hearing prior to the health care authority approving the project, as well as an opportunity for the state authority to deny the project. Other states have a less formal process for CON application and approval and may be limited to new or institutional projects. Very few states require CON approval for waivered services. Failure to comply with a state CON process may result in a prohibition on Medicaid billing and may subject the provider to fines, penalties, other civil sanctions or criminal penalties for the operators or owners of an unapproved health service.

        Other regulatory matters.     The Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996, or "HIPAA," set national standards for the protection of health information created, maintained or transmitted by health providers. Under the law and regulations known collectively as the privacy and security rules, covered entities must implement standards to protect and guard against the misuse of individually identifiable health information.

        Federal regulations issued pursuant to HIPAA contain, among other measures, provisions that require organizations to implement significant and expensive new computer systems, employee training programs and business procedures. Rules have been established to protect the integrity, security and distribution of electronic health and related financial information. We believe we are in compliance with the electronic transactions standards and have privacy and security policies and procedures in place. We have trained employees in these policies and procedures. Failure to timely implement or comply with HIPAA regulations may, under certain circumstances, trigger the imposition of civil or criminal penalties.

        The federal Civil False Claims Act imposes civil liability on individuals and entities that submit or cause to be submitted false or fraudulent claims for payment to the government. Violations of the Civil False Claims Act may include treble damages and penalties of up to $11,000 per false or fraudulent claim.

68



        In addition to actions being brought by government officials under the Civil False Claims Act, the Civil False Claims Act also allows a private individual with direct knowledge of fraud to bring a "whistleblower," or qui tam suit on behalf of the government for violations of the Civil False Claims Act. The whistleblower receives a statutory amount of up to 30% of the recovered amount from the government's litigation proceeds if the litigation is successful or if the case is successfully settled. Recently, the number of whistleblower suits brought against healthcare providers has increased dramatically, and has included suits based (among other things) upon alleged violations of the Federal Anti-Kickback Law.

        The Anti-Kickback Law prohibits kickbacks, rebates and any other form of remuneration in return for referrals. Any remuneration, direct or indirect, offered, paid, solicited, or received, in return for referrals of patients or business for which payment may be made in whole or in part under Medicare or Medicaid could be considered a violation of law. The language of the Anti-Kickback law also prohibits payments made to anyone to induce them to recommend purchasing, leasing, or ordering any goods, facility, service, or item for which payment may be made in whole or in part by Medicare or Medicaid. Criminal penalties under the Anti-Kickback Law include fines up to $25,000, imprisonment for up to 5 years, or both. In addition, acts constituting a violation of the Anti-Kickback Law may also lead to civil penalties, such as fines, assessments and exclusion from participation in the Medicare and Medicaid programs.

        Additionally we must comply with local zoning and licensing ordinances and requirements. The Federal Fair Housing Amendments Act of 1988 protects the interests of the individuals we serve, prohibits local discriminatory ordinance practices and provides additional opportunities and accommodations for people with disabilities to live in their community of choice.

        Federal regulations promulgated by the Occupational Safety and Health Administration ("OSHA") require us to have safety plans for blood borne pathogens and other work place risks. At any point in time OSHA investigators may receive a complaint which requires on-site inspection and/or audit, the outcome of which may adversely affect our operations.

        Periodically, new statutes and regulations are written and adopted that directly affect our business. It is often difficult to predict the impact a new regulation will have on our operations until we have taken steps to implement its requirements. For example, Medicare Part D concerning payment for prescription medications, and the Deficit Reduction Act of 2005 which added increased emphasis on recipient responsibility for directing services provided, remain fairly new federal initiatives. Thus, the ultimate impact remains unclear and only the passage of time and our experience with compliance will permit our assessment of the exact impact each new statute or regulation has on our business.

        A material violation of a law or regulation could subject us to fines and penalties and in some circumstances could disqualify some or all of the facilities and programs under our control from future participation in Medicaid, Medicare or other government programs.

        Conviction of abusive or fraudulent behavior with respect to one facility or program may subject other facilities and programs under common control or ownership to disqualification from participation in the Medicaid and/or Medicare program. Executive Order 12549 prohibits any corporation or facility from participating in federal contracts if it or its principals (included but not limited to officers, directors, owners and key employees) have been debarred, suspended, or declared ineligible or have been voluntarily excluded from participating in federal contracts. In addition, some state regulators provide that all facilities licensed with a state under common ownership or control are subject to delicensure if any one or more of such facilities are delicensed.

        We must also comply with the standards set forth by the Office of Inspector General governing internal compliance and external reporting requirements. OIG advisory opinions, though limited in their application to Medicaid programs, are reviewed and monitored regularly. Significant media and public attention has recently focused on health care. Because the law in this area is complex and continuously evolving, ongoing or future governmental investigations or litigation may result in

69



interpretations that are inconsistent with current practices. It is possible that outside entities could initiate investigations or future litigation impacting our services and that such matters could result in penalties and adverse publicity. It is also possible that our executive and other management personnel could be included in these investigations and litigation or be named defendants.

        Our general counsel and a dedicated Compliance Officer (JD level position) oversee our compliance program. The program activities are reported regularly to the management compliance committee which includes the CEO as well as medical, operations, HR and quality expertise. In addition, the program activities are periodically reported at the board level.

Risk Management and Insurance

        Our risk management function is responsible for identifying, evaluating and reducing the risks that employees and clients are exposed to within our network. The risk function is managed by two in-house attorneys who are responsible, among other things, for identifying cases that are appropriate for mediation or settlement discussions, identifying incident trends and developing appropriate training resources. We have incurred professional and general liability claims and insurance expense for professional and general liability of $6.5 million and $3.2 million, for fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. In fiscal 2006, in connection with the Merger, we purchased additional insurance for $2.6 million for certain claims relating to the pre-Merger periods. We also have insurance coverage against any losses that may result from the REM business prior to our purchase.

        We currently self-insure for professional and general liability for amounts of up to $1.0 million per claim and up to $2.0 million in the aggregate per year. Above these limits, we have limited additional third-party coverage.

Employees and Mentors

        As of September 30, 2006, we had approximately 15,700 full time equivalent employees, as well as approximately 3,900 independent contractors who were under contract to us as Mentors. Our employees are generally not unionized. However, as of September 30, 2006, approximately 17 of our employees were represented by a labor union and we are negotiating our first collective bargaining agreement. We have experienced no work stoppage attributable to labor disputes, and we consider our employee relations to be good.

Properties

        As of September 30, 2006, we owned 418 facilities and two offices, and leased 987 facilities and offices. We also provided services in homes owned by our Mentors. We owned 330 facilities which serve six individuals or fewer, and 88 facilities which serve more than six individuals. We leased 661 residential facilities, 69 day program sites and 257 offices. More than half of our leased small group homes have terms of two years or less. We believe that our properties are adequate and suitable for our business as presently conducted.

Legal Proceedings

        We are in the human services business and therefore we have been and continue to be subject to claims alleging that we, our Mentors or our employees failed to provide proper care for a client, as well as claims by our clients, our Mentors, our employees or community members against us for negligence or intentional misconduct. Included in our recent claims are claims alleging personal injury, assault, battery, abuse, wrongful death and other charges. Regulatory agencies may initiate administrative proceedings alleging that our programs, employees or agents violate statutes and regulations and seek to impose monetary penalties on us. We could be required to incur significant costs to respond to regulatory investigations or defend against civil lawsuits and, if we do not prevail, we could be required

70



to pay substantial amounts of money in damages, settlement amounts or penalties arising from these legal proceedings.

        We reserve for costs related to contingencies when a loss is probable and the amount is reasonably estimable. While we believe our provision for legal contingencies is adequate, the outcome of the legal proceedings is difficult to predict and we may settle legal claims or be subject to judgments for amounts that differ from our estimates.

        See "Risk factors" and "Management's discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operation" for additional information.

71



MANAGEMENT

Directors and Executive Officers

        The following table sets forth information with respect to the members of the board of directors and the executive officers of the Issuer (as of December 15, 2006):

Name

  Age
  Position
Gregory Torres   57   Chairman

Edward M. Murphy

 

59

 

President, Chief Executive Officer and Director

Juliette E. Fay

 

54

 

Executive Vice President and Chief Development Officer

Denis M. Holler

 

52

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer

John J. Green

 

47

 

Senior Vice President of Field Finance

Hugh R. Jones III

 

42

 

Senior Vice President and Chief Administrative Officer

Linda DeRenzo

 

47

 

Senior Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary

Bruce F. Nardella

 

49

 

Senior Vice President and President—Eastern Division

David M. Petersen

 

58

 

Senior Vice President and President—Central Division

Robert A. Longo

 

44

 

Senior Vice President and President—Western Division

James L. Elrod Jr.

 

52

 

Director

Daniel S. O'Connell

 

52

 

Director

Brian K. Ratzan

 

36

 

Director

Jeffry A. Timmons

 

65

 

Director

         Gregory Torres has served as our Chairman since September 2004. Mr. Torres served as our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer from September 2004 to January 2005, as well as our President and Chief Executive Officer from January 1996 until September 2004. On January 1, 2005, Mr. Torres stepped down as Chief Executive Officer and remained Chairman of the board of directors. Mr. Torres joined MENTOR in 1980 as a member of our first board of directors. In 1992 Mr. Torres became senior vice president for business development, strategic planning and public affairs. Prior to joining us, Mr. Torres held prominent positions within the public sector including: chief of staff of the Massachusetts Senate Committee on Ways and Means and assistant secretary of human services. Mr. Torres began his career as a direct care worker in the juvenile justice field. Mr. Torres is a graduate of St. Vincent's College and holds an M.P.A. from Harvard University.

         Edward M. Murphy has served as our President since September 2004 and our Chief Executive Officer since January 2005. Mr. Murphy has extensive experience working in the areas of criminal justice, mental health and human services, health care and finance. For six years starting in 1979 Mr. Murphy served the Commonwealth of Massachusetts as Commissioner of the Department of Youth Services. Mr. Murphy subsequently served four years as Commissioner of the Department of Mental Health. For six years, Mr. Murphy led the Massachusetts Health and Educational Facilities Authority, an independent public authority established to assist nonprofit organizations in borrowing funds through the issuance of tax-exempt bonds. Mr. Murphy later worked as Senior Vice President specializing in debt financing and advisory services for healthcare clients at Tucker Anthony, an investment banking and brokerage firm, and served as President and COO of Olympus Healthcare Group. Most recently, in 1999 Mr. Murphy founded Alliance Health and Human Services and served as the organization's President and CEO until September 2004. He is a trustee of the Massachusetts

72



Health and Education Tax Exempt Trust, a closed end investment company traded on the American Stock Exchange. Mr. Murphy is a graduate of Boston College and holds M.A. and Ph.D. degrees from the University of Massachusetts at Amherst.

         Juliette E. Fay has served as our Executive Vice President and Chief Development Officer since January 2006, managing national business development and the Mergers and Acquisition group. Prior to this appointment, Ms. Fay served as the Senior Vice President of National Business Development and Marketing, beginning in January of 2002. From 1998 to 2002, Ms. Fay served as our Vice President of Business Development. Before joining us, Ms. Fay was the president and CEO of Charles River Health Management, a provider-based managed care company, from 1995 to 1998; the director of marketing and business development at the Massachusetts Health and Educational Facilities Authority from 1989 to 1995; chief of staff for the Massachusetts Department of Mental Health from 1986 to 1989; and the assistant commissioner for facility operations at the Department of Youth Services from 1979 to 1985. Ms. Fay holds a B.A. from Boston College and an M.P.A. from Harvard University.

         Denis M. Holler has served as our Senior Vice President of Finance since January 2002. Mr. Holler joined us in October 2000 as Vice President of Financial Operations and led the Company's finance functions through the 2001 purchase by Madison Dearborn Partners. In his current role he oversees corporate finance functions, including managing external relationships with our equity sponsor, banking partners and high-yield investors. Mr. Holler was Chief Financial Officer of the Fortress Corporation from September 1991 to November 1999 and designed and implemented accounting systems for the Chancellor Corporation from 1989 to 1991. He was also a C.P.A. with Deloitte & Touche from 1984 to 1989, specializing in auditing and SEC reporting. Mr. Holler holds a B.A. from Fordham University, as well as an M.S. in Accounting and an M.B.A. from Northeastern University.

         John J. Green has served as our Senior Vice President of Field Finance since May 2003 when we acquired REM. In this role, Mr. Green oversees field finance operations across our three divisions, and manages the reimbursement group, payroll services, real estate and leasing management services, and field financial reporting and analysis. Mr. Green joined REM in April 1986 as Assistant Controller and became Controller of REM in July 1990. He is a Certified Public Accountant with 25 years of experience both in public accounting and healthcare industries, including audit experience with Deloitte & Touche and accounting management in a hospital setting. Mr. Green's expertise encompasses finance, accounting, reimbursement, human resources and information systems. Mr. Green holds a B.S. in accounting and finance from Minnesota State University-Mankato.

         Hugh R. (Tripp) Jones, III has served as our Senior Vice President and Chief Administrative Officer since May 2004, and served as our Senior Vice President of Public Strategy from February 2003 to May 2004. In his current role, Mr. Jones coordinates corporate and divisional functions with responsibility for human resources, information technology, legal and public strategy. Before joining us, he co-founded in 1995 and led MassINC, a nonpartisan think tank committed to the growth and vitality of the middle class. Mr. Jones has spent much of his professional life working on public education policy, including serving as staff director of the Massachusetts Legislature's Education Committee where he helped spearhead the passage of the state's landmark 1993 Education Reform Act, as well as chairing Governor Mitt Romney's education transition team in 2002. In 1994 he managed the campaign of the Democratic nominee for governor of Massachusetts. He began his career working for Governor Michael S. Dukakis' administration and 1988 presidential campaign. He has a B.A. from Hamilton College.

         Linda DeRenzo has served as our Senior Vice President and General Counsel since March 2006. Ms. DeRenzo serves as our chief legal officer and oversees the risk management, regulatory compliance and quality assurance functions. An 18-year business law veteran, Ms. DeRenzo has represented high-growth companies and their financiers in a variety of industries including information technology, life sciences and health services. Specializing in public and private equity and debt offerings, mergers

73



and acquisitions and corporate governance, Ms. DeRenzo brings experience in corporate law and corporate finance, organization building, human resource-related issues and strategic partnerships. Prior to joining us, Ms. DeRenzo was a partner at Testa, Hurwitz & Thibeault, LLP in Boston, MA from 1992 to 2004. Ms. DeRenzo has an A.B. from Dartmouth College and a J.D. from Harvard Law School.

         Bruce F. Nardella has served as our President, Eastern Division since May 2003. Mr. Nardella joined us in 1996 as a state director. Prior to that, he worked for the Massachusetts Department of Youth Services, a Massachusetts human service agency responsible for serving adjudicated youths. In 1994, he became deputy commissioner of the department. Mr. Nardella began his career working for six years at a shelter facility for court-involved boys. From 1994 to 1997, he held the elected position of City Council President for the City of Beverly, Massachusetts. Mr. Nardella holds a B.A. from Colgate University, an M.P.A. from Harvard University and an M.Ed. from Boston University.

         David M. Petersen has served as our President, Central Division since May 2003. Prior to joining us, Mr. Petersen worked for REM since 1972. After managing a segment of REM's Minnesota operations as well as all REM operations in Montana, North Dakota and Wisconsin, in 1992 he became Executive Director of REM's Minnesota operations. Mr. Petersen is the past President and current Vice President of the Board of Directors for the Association of Residential Resources in Minnesota ("ARRM"). Mr. Petersen holds B.S. and M.A. degrees from St. Cloud State University.

         Robert A. Longo has served as our President, Western Division since May 2003. Mr. Longo joined us as children's services program manager in Illinois in 1993 and became our state director for Illinois in 1994. In 1995, Mr. Longo was elevated to vice president of our then midwestern region. Before joining us, he was the assistant program director at St. Joseph's Carondelet in Chicago where he oversaw budgeting, operations and agency development and planning. He also worked as the truancy alternative group leader for a family services agency in Illinois. Mr. Longo began his career counseling adolescents in a psychiatric hospital. Mr. Longo has served on the boards of numerous organizations focused on mental health and human services, including serving for three years on the board of the national Foster Family-Based Treatment Association. Mr. Longo received his B.S. in psychology and biology from Loyola University of Chicago and his M.S. in health services administration from the University of St. Francis.

         James L. Elrod Jr. joined our board of directors in connection with the consummation of the Merger. Mr. Elrod is a Managing Director of Vestar Capital Partners. Mr. Elrod joined Vestar in 1998. Previously, he was Executive Vice President, Finance and Operations for Physicians Health Service, a public managed care company. Prior to that, he was a Managing Director and Partner of Dillon, Read & Co. Inc. Mr. Elrod is currently a director of DynaVox Systems, LLC, Essent Healthcare, Inc., and Sunrise Medical, Inc. Mr. Elrod received his B.A. from Colgate University and his M.B.A. from Harvard Business School.

         Daniel S. O'Connell joined our board of directors in connection with the consummation of the Merger. Mr. O'Connell is the founder and Chief Executive Officer of Vestar Capital Partners. Prior to the founding of Vestar Capital Partners in 1988, Mr. O'Connell was a Managing Director and Co-Head of the Management Buyout Group at The First Boston Corporation. Mr. O'Connell is currently a director of Birds Eye Foods, Inc., Argo-Tech Corporation, Sunrise Medical, Inc., Nybron Flooring International and St. John Knits International, Inc. In addition, he is a trustee of Brown University and is on the Advisory Board of the Yale University School of Management. Mr. O'Connell received his B.A. from Brown University and his M.B.A. from Yale University School of Management.

         Brian K. Ratzan joined our board of directors in connection with the consummation of the Merger. Mr. Ratzan is a Managing Director of Vestar Capital Partners. Mr. Ratzan joined Vestar in 1998. Previously, he was a Vice President at Trace International Holdings, Inc., a private investment firm. Prior to that, he was a member of the Corporate Finance Group at Donaldson, Lufkin & Jenrette.

74



Mr. Ratzan is currently a director of Birds Eye Foods, Inc.. Mr. Ratzan received his B.A. from the University of Michigan and his M.B.A. from Harvard Business School.

         Jeffry A. Timmons has served on our Board of Directors since December 1, 2006. Dr. Timmons has been Babson College's Franklin W. Olin Distinguished Professor of Entrepreneurship since 1995. Prior to 1995, Dr. Timmons held simultaneous professorships at Babson College and Harvard Business School, where his teaching and research specialties were entrepreneurship, new ventures, entrepreneurial finance and venture capital. For over forty years, Dr. Timmons has been involved in the world of entrepreneurship as an investor, director or advisor in private companies and investment funds, including Cellular One, the Boston Communication Group and others. Dr. Timmons is a graduate of Colgate University and holds M.B.A. and D.B.A. degrees from Harvard University.

Composition of the Board of Directors After This Offering

        We expect to add one additional independent director to our board of directors.

Committees of the Board of Directors

        We have an audit committee, compliance committee, a capital allocation committee and a compensation committee of the board of directors. Presently, Mr. Ratzan is the sole member of the audit committee, Messrs. Elrod and Torres are the members of the compliance committee, Messrs. Ratzan and Murphy are the members of the capital allocation committee and Messrs. Elrod and Timmons are the members of the compensation committee.

Executive Compensation

        The following summarizes the principal components of compensation for our chief executive officer and the other highest compensated executive officers (collectively, the "named executive officers") for fiscal years 2004, 2005 and 2006.

Name and Principal Position

  Fiscal
Year

  Salary
  Bonus (1)
  Other Annual
Compensation

  Long-term
Compensation
Awards/Securities
Underlying
Options (2)(3)(4)

  All Other
Compensation (4)

  Total
Compensation

Edward M. Murphy
President, Chief Executive Officer and Director
  2006
2005
2004
  $
$
$
305,000
290,000
9,738
  $
$
$
314,147
77,745
2,846
(5)

$
$
$
56,250
75,000
(6)
(6)


200,000
  $
$
$
5,699,589
31,270
8,986
(7)
(8)
(8)
$
$
$
6,374,986
474,015
21,570

John W. Gillespie(9)
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

 

2006
2005
2004

 

$
$
$

280,000
280,000
280,000

 

$
$
$

321,317
105,064
43,008

(5)


$
$
$


837
7,845


(11)
(11)



10,000

 

$
$
$

313,800
30,800
29,958

(10)
(8)
(8)

$
$
$

915,117
416,701
360,811

Juliette E. Fay(12)
Executive Vice President and Chief Development Officer

 

2006
2005
2004

 

$
$
$

249,327
220,000
220,000

 

$
$
$

70,044
44,234
25,344

 

$
$
$


1,318
12,348


(11)
(11)

17,500
7,500
7,000

 

$
$
$

1,080,762
19,800
18,150

(13)
(8)
(8)

$
$
$

1,400,133
285,352
275,842

David M. Petersen(14)
President, Central Division

 

2006
2005
2004

 

$
$
$

231,213
225,000
225,000

 

$
$
$

59,392
58,798
16,480

 

$
$
$


948
8,878


(11)
(11)

20,000
10,000
15,000

 

$
$
$

944,276
20,250
18,563

(15)
(8)
(8)

$
$
$

1,234,881
304,996
268,921

Hugh R. Jones III(16)
Senior Vice President and Chief Administrative Officer

 

2006
2005
2004

 

$
$
$

218,250
208,000
208,000

 

$
$
$

145,503
41,821
23,962

(17)


$
$
$


115
1,075

 

17,500
10,000
10,000

 

$
$
$

988,699
18,720
17,160

(18)
(8)
(8)

$
$
$

1,352,452
268,656
250,197

Elizabeth V. Hopper(19)
Former Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer

 

2006
2005
2004

 

$
$
$

280,000
280,000
280,000

 

$
$
$


75,064
43,008

 

$
$
$


6,872
64,380


(11)
(11)



10,000

 

$
$
$


243,493
30,183


(20)
(8)

$
$
$

280,000
605,429
417,571

(1)
Bonuses are determined based on consolidated growth compared to pre-established targets and individual performance reviews.

75


(2)
Represents options granted in fiscal 2004, fiscal 2005 and fiscal 2006 under the National MENTOR Holdings Inc. Stock Option Plan.

(3)
Pursuant to the Merger, all outstanding shares of equity awards subject to vesting held by the named executive officers were converted into the right to receive cash. Consequently, as of September 30, 2006, the end of our most recent fiscal year, there were no shares of equity awards subject to vesting outstanding.

(4)
For the payments made related to stock options outstanding at the time of the Merger, all unvested stock options became vested in accordance with the change in control provision of the original stock option agreements and all stock options outstanding at the time of the Merger were cancelled.

(5)
Includes bonuses related to the Transactions in addition to bonuses for fiscal 2006.

(6)
Represents embedded compensation resulting from the grant of stock options in September 2004 with a purchase price below the then fair market value.

(7)
Amount includes a $5,660,000 payment equal to the excess of the fair market value over the exercise price for stock options outstanding at the time of the Merger. Amount also includes $39,589 in contributions made by the Company to the National MENTOR Inc. Executive Deferred Compensation Plan.

(8)
Amount represents contributions made by the Company to the National MENTOR Inc. Executive Deferred Compensation Plan.

(9)
John W. Gillespie resigned on September 30, 2006. In connection with the 2004 refinancing, Mr. Gillespie received payments of $108,473 relating to certain deferred compensation obligations.

(10)
Amount includes a $283,000 payment equal to the excess of the fair market value over the exercise price for stock options outstanding at the time of the Merger. Amount also includes $30,800 in contributions made by the Company to the National MENTOR Inc. Executive Deferred Compensation Plan.

(11)
Represents above market interest earned through fiscal 2004 and through November 4, 2004, respectively, on amounts held in the National MENTOR, Inc. Equity Deferred Compensation Plan and the National Mentor Services, LLC 2003 Deferred Compensation Plan, which accrued interest at a rate of 14% compounding quarterly. In conjunction with the offering of the old notes on November 4, 2004, these deferred compensation obligations were paid and these plans were subsequently terminated.

(12)
In connection with the 2004 refinancing, Ms. Fay received aggregate payments of $170,749 relating to certain deferred compensation obligations.

(13)
Amount includes a $1,054,550 payment equal to the excess of the fair market value over the exercise price for stock options outstanding at the time of the Merger. Amount also includes $26,212 in contributions made by the Company to the National MENTOR Inc. Executive Deferred Compensation Plan.

(14)
In connection with the 2004 refinancing, Mr. Peterson received aggregate payments of $122,758 relating to certain deferred compensation obligations.

(15)
Amount includes a $923,500 payment equal to the excess of the fair market value over the exercise price for stock options outstanding at the time of the Merger. Amount also includes $20,776 in contributions made by the Company to the National MENTOR Inc. Executive Deferred Compensation Plan.

(16)
In connection with the 2004 refinancing, Mr. Jones received aggregate payments of $14,862 relating to certain deferred compensation obligations.

(17)
Includes a bonus paid to Mr. Jones to facilitate his repayment of an outstanding note to the Company in addition to a bonus for fiscal 2006.

(18)
Amount includes a $969,100 payment equal to the excess of the fair market value over the exercise price for stock options outstanding at the time of the Merger. Amount also includes $19,599 in contributions made by the Company to the National MENTOR Inc. Executive Deferred Compensation Plan.

(19)
Elizabeth V. Hopper retired on October 1, 2005 and options granted to Ms. Hopper in fiscal 2003 were cancelled in connection with her retirement. In addition, in connection with the 2004 refinancing, Ms. Hopper received aggregate payments of $890,223 relating to certain deferred payment obligations.

(20)
Represents a bonus paid at the time of Ms. Hopper's departure of $211,944 as well as $31,549 in contributions made by the Company to the National MENTOR Inc. Executive Deferred Compensation Plan. Also, at the time of her retirement Ms. Hopper was paid $141,887 relating to the National MENTOR Inc. Executive Deferred Compensation Plan.

76


Option Grants During Fiscal 2006

        The following table sets forth the number of options granted to the named executive officers under the National MENTOR Holdings, Inc. Stock Option Plan during fiscal 2006.

 
   
   
   
   
  Potential Realizable
Value at Assumed
Annual Rates of Stock
Price Appreciation for
Option Term(2)

 
   
  Percentage
of Total
Options
Granted to
Employees in
Fiscal Year

   
   
 
  Number of
Securities
Underlying
Options
Granted

   
   
Name

  Exercise
Price

  Expiration
Date(1)

  5%
  10%
Edward M. Murphy.   $     $      
John W. Gillespie(3)                
Juliette E. Fay     7,500
10,000
  2.5
3.4
%
%
  22.50
22.50
  12/8/15
12/30/15
  106,126
141,501
  268,944
358,592
David M. Petersen     10,000
10,000
  3.4
3.4
%
%
  22.50
22.50
  12/8/15
12/30/15
  141,501
141,501
  358,592
358,592
Hugh R. Jones III     7,500
10,000
  2.5
3.4
%
%
  22.50
22.50
  12/8/15
12/30/15
  106,126
141,501
  268,944
358,592
Elizabeth V. Hopper(4)                

(1)
There were no options outstanding at September 30, 2006, as all unvested stock options became vested in accordance with the change in control provision of the original stock option agreements, and all stock options outstanding at the time of the Merger were cancelled.

(2)
Potential realizable value represents the difference between the market value of our common stock for which the option may be exercised, assuming that the market value of our common stock on the date of the grant appreciates in value to the end of the ten year option term at annualized rates of 5% and 10%, respectively, and the exercise price of the option. The rates of appreciation used in this table are prescribed by regulation of the SEC and are not intended to forecast future appreciation of the market value of the common stock.

(3)
John W. Gillespie resigned on September 30, 2006.

(4)
Elizabeth V. Hopper retired on October 1, 2005.

Aggregated Option Exercises During Fiscal 2006

        There were no options outstanding at September 30, 2006, as all unvested stock options became vested in accordance with the change in control provision of the original stock option agreements, and all stock options outstanding at the time of the Merger were cancelled.

Employment Agreements

Gregory Torres

        On June 29, 2006, Gregory Torres entered into an amended and restated employment agreement with us. Pursuant to the employment agreement, Mr. Torres has agreed to serve as a non-executive employee, providing services as requested by the Board of Directors and Chief Executive Officer including assistance in fostering industry relations for our benefit and developing our strategy and internal management. The term of the agreement is three years from the date of the employment agreement, unless terminated earlier in accordance with the agreement. The employment agreement provides for a base salary of $100,000 per year, with Mr. Torres to receive, upon termination of the agreement by mutual consent, an end of term bonus of $100,000, payable bi-weekly in arrears for twelve months. The employment agreement contains provisions pursuant to which Mr. Torres has agreed not to disclose our confidential information. Mr. Torres has also agreed not to solicit our employees or contractors or compete with us for a period of one year after his employment with us has been terminated.

77



Edward M. Murphy

        On June 29, 2006, Edward M. Murphy entered into an amended and restated employment agreement with us. Pursuant to the employment agreement, Mr. Murphy has agreed to serve as President and Chief Executive Officer. The initial term is three years from the date of the employment agreement, and after the initial term has expired, the employment agreement will renew automatically each year for a one year term, unless terminated earlier by the parties. The employment agreement provides for a base salary of $350,000 per year, subject to review and adjustment from time to time with an annual bonus equal to no less than Mr. Murphy's base salary if the Company reaches certain yearly-determined performance objectives. In addition to base salary, Mr. Murphy is entitled to participate in all benefit plans to the extent they are made available to other senior executives at his level. Under the terms of the agreement, if Mr. Murphy is terminated by us without cause, we are obligated to continue to pay him his base salary and targeted annual bonus for two years following the date of such termination, as well as a pro rata bonus amount for the year in which such termination occurs. The employment agreement contains provisions pursuant to which Mr. Murphy has agreed not to disclose our confidential information. Mr. Murphy has also agreed not to solicit our employees or contractors, or compete with us for a period of two years after his employment with us has been terminated.

John W. Gillespie

        On August 20, 2001, John W. Gillespie entered into an employment agreement with us. Pursuant to the employment agreement, Mr. Gillespie served as Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer. The initial term was two years from the date of the employment agreement, and the employment agreement renewed automatically each year for a one year term, unless terminated earlier by the parties. The employment agreement provided for a base salary of $230,000 per year, subject to review and adjustment from time to time. The employment agreement contained provisions pursuant to which Mr. Gillespie has agreed not to disclose our confidential information or solicit our employees or contractors for a period of 18 months after his employment with us has been terminated, or compete with us for a period of one year after his employment with us has been terminated. Mr. Gillespie gave notice to us that he would not renew the term of his employment agreement when it expired on August 20, 2006 and agreed to extend the term of his agreement with us through the end of our fiscal 2006. Consistent with that agreement, Mr. Gillespie resigned on September 30, 2006.

Separation Agreements

Donald R. Monack

        Donald R. Monack served as our Executive Vice President and Chief Development Officer until he resigned on March 31, 2005. Pursuant to the terms of our separation agreement with Mr. Monack, he would receive compensation equal to $280,000 per annum plus certain health benefits for two years from the date of his resignation. In addition, the separation agreement provides for Mr. Monack's receipt of one bonus payment equal to $111,200. The separation agreement contains provisions pursuant to which Mr. Monack has agreed not to disclose our confidential information or solicit our employees or contractors for a period of 18 months after his employment with us has terminated.

Elizabeth V. Hopper

        Elizabeth V. Hopper served as our Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer until she retired on October 1, 2005. Pursuant to the terms of our separation agreement with Ms. Hopper, she would receive compensation equal to $280,000 per annum plus certain health benefits for two years from the date of her resignation. In addition, the separation agreement provides for Ms. Hopper's receipt of one bonus payment equal to $56,944. The separation agreement contains provisions pursuant

78



to which Ms. Hopper has agreed not to disclose our confidential information or solicit our employees or contractors for a period of 18 months after her employment with us has terminated, or compete with us for a period of one year after her employment with us has terminated.

Severance Agreements

        In connection with the Merger, Juliette E. Fay, Hugh R. Jones III and David M. Petersen entered into severance agreements with us on June 29, 2006. Pursuant to these agreements, in the event that the employment of any such employees is terminated under certain conditions, they will be entitled to (i) the payment of an aggregate amount equal to their base salary, (ii) the payment of an amount equal to their annual cash bonuses earned in the year prior to their severance and (iii) continued coverage under our health, medical and welfare benefit plans for a period of one year from the date of termination. The severance agreements also contain provisions pursuant to which any of such employees agree not to disclose our confidential information, solicit our employees or contractors or compete with us.

Stock Option Plan

        In November 2001, our Board of Directors approved a stock option plan, which provides for the grant to our directors, officers and key employees of options to purchase shares of our common stock. As of June 1, 2006, options to purchase an aggregate of 1,097,250 shares were outstanding under the plan, all of which will vest in connection with the Merger. Pursuant to the Merger Agreement, all outstanding vested options issued under the 2001 stock option plan which are outstanding as of the effective time of the Merger were cancelled in exchange for a cash payment equal to the excess of the $35.30 per share over the exercise price per share of the option. It is not currently anticipated that any additional options will be granted under the 2001 Plan after the Merger. See "The Transactions—The merger" for a description of the treatment of options in connection with the Merger.

        In connection with the Merger, members of management participated in the equity of the Company through the purchases or grants of units in NMH Investment. In addition, Dr. Timmons will have the right to purchase Preferred Units, Class A Common Units and Class E Common Units of NMH Investment as described below under "Certain relationships and related party transactions—Post-Transactions arrangements."

Mentor Network 401(k) Plan

        The National Mentor Network, Inc.'s 401(k) plan continues after the Merger. Currently, substantially all of the salaried employees, including our named executive officers, participate in the Mentor Network 401(k) Plan savings plan (the "401(k) Plan"). Employees are permitted to defer a portion of their income under the 401(k) Plan and, at the discretion of our board of directors, we may make matching contributions and profit sharing contributions as determined annually. We contributed approximately $450,000 as a match on employees' 401(k) Plan contributions for calendar year 2005, including the named executive officers. In addition, an approximately $2.6 million discretionary employer profit sharing contribution was made to the 401(k) Plan for calendar year 2005.

        In addition, we expect that the named executive officers and all other currently eligible employees will participate in non-qualified deferred compensation plans described below or as may be established after the Merger.

National MENTOR Inc. Executive Deferred Compensation Plan

        The National MENTOR, Inc. Executive Deferred Compensation Plan became effective March 9, 2001. The plan is an unfunded, nonqualified deferred compensation arrangement to provide deferred compensation to Senior Vice Presidents and above. Under this plan executives receive an allocation to

79



their account based on a percentage of base compensation. This allocation is made at the end of the year for service rendered during the year. All balances accrue interest at a rate approved by the board, currently six percent. In addition, our board of directors may decide to make discretionary contributions to any participant's plan. The plan allows us to establish a grantor trust to accumulate assets to provide for the obligations under the plan. Any assets of the grantor trust would be subject to the claims of our general creditors. A participant's account balance is 100% vested and non-forfeitable and will be distributed to a participant following his or her retirement or termination from the Company, at the board's direction under certain circumstances or at a time specified by the participant when he or she enrolls in the plan.

National MENTOR, Inc. Executive Deferral Plan

        The National MENTOR, Inc. Executive Deferral Plan became effective on October 1, 2003. The plan is available to highly compensated employees (as defined by Section 414(q) of the Internal Revenue Code). Participants are selected by the board of directors and must sign and submit a valid salary reduction agreement. Participants may contribute up to 100% of salary, bonus and/or commission earned during the plan year. This plan is coordinated with our 401(k) plan, so that we match contributions in such a way as to maximize the value to participants. Participant contributions and matching contributions vest 100% when deposited with the plan. Distributions are made upon a participant's termination of employment, disability, death or retirement at age 65. Participants can elect to have distributions made in a lump sum, over a five or ten-year period.

The MENTOR Network Executive Leadership Incentive Plan

        The National MENTOR Holdings, Inc. Executive Leadership Incentive Plan became effective on November 11, 2003. Our Chief Executive Officer, Executive Vice President, Senior Vice Presidents and Division Presidents are eligible to receive incentive-based compensation under this plan. The purpose of the plan is to provide for compensation tied to individual performance and the achievement of organizational goals. The plan is administered by our compensation committee, which determines, among other things, the funding for the plan, which is based on a combination of revenue and EBITDA growth or other criteria. Employees who terminate their employment voluntarily, other than for retirement, or who are terminated for cause will not receive any incentive payment for the year in which their employment terminates.

NMH Investment 2006 Unit Plan

        In connection with the Merger, NMH Investment approved the NMH Investment 2006 Unit Plan. The plan became effective on June 1, 2006 and was amended on December 14, 2006. The purpose of this plan is to allow certain officers, employees, non-employee directors and consultants of the Company to participate in the long-term growth and financial success of the Company through acquisition of equity interests in NMH Investment, including Preferred Units and Class A, Class B, Class C, Class D and Class E Common Units of NMH Investment. The plan is administered by the management committee of NMH Investment which determines, among other things, specific participants in the plan as well as the amount and value of any Units awarded.

Compensation of Directors

        We reimburse directors for any out-of-pocket expenses incurred by them in connection with services provided in such capacity. We compensate our outside directors, for services they provide in their capacities as director. Pursuant to this policy, our independent director, Dr. Jeffry A. Timmons, receives a fee of $5,000 for each meeting of the Board of Directors that he attends in person a fee of and $1,000 for each meeting that he attends by phone and each committee meeting he attends. Dr. Timmons is also reimbursed for his out-of-pocket expenses in connection with committee meetings.

80



SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS AND MANAGEMENT

        NMH Investment indirectly owns 100% of the Issuer. The following table sets forth information with respect to the expected beneficial ownership of voting equity interests of NMH Investment by (i) each person or entity known to us to beneficially hold five percent or more of equity interests of NMH Investment, (ii) each of our directors, (iii) each of our named executive officers and (iv) all of our executive officers and expected directors as a group.

        Under SEC rules, a person is deemed to be a "beneficial owner" of a security if that person has or shares voting power or investment power, which includes the power to dispose of or to direct the disposition of such security. A person is also deemed to be a beneficial owner of any securities of which that person has a right to acquire beneficial ownership within 60 days. Securities that can be so acquired are deemed to be outstanding for purposes of computing such person's ownership percentage, but not for purposes of computing any other person's percentage. Under these rules, more than one person may be deemed to be a beneficial owner of the same securities and a person may be deemed to be a beneficial owner of securities as to which such person has no economic interest.

        Except as otherwise indicated in the footnotes below, each of the beneficial owners has, to our knowledge, sole voting and investment power with respect to the indicated Class A Units which is expected to be the only class of voting equity interests in NMH Investment. Unless otherwise noted, the address of each beneficial owner is 313 Congress Street, 6th Floor, Boston, MA 02210.

        Beneficial ownership has been determined in accordance with the applicable rules and regulations promulgated under the Exchange Act.

Name and address of Beneficial Owner

  Number of
Class A Units(1)(2)

  Percent of
Class A Units

 
Vestar Capital Partners V, L.P.(3)(4)   6,918,627   92.2 %
Gregory Torres(4)   25,000   *  
Edward M. Murphy(4)   130,000   1.7 %
Juliette E. Fay(4)   41,750   *  
David M. Petersen(4)   31,200   *  
Hugh R. Jones III(4)   40,000   *  
John W. Gillespie(6)      
Elizabeth V. Hopper(6)      
James L. Elrod Jr.(4)(5)      
Daniel S. O'Connell(4)(5)      
Brian K. Ratzan(4)(5)      
Jeffry A. Timmons      
All directors and executive officers (14 persons)   415,637   5.5 %

*
Less than 1.0%.

(1)
In addition, certain members of the management own non-voting Preferred Units, Class B Units, Class C Units and Class D Units, and Dr. Timmons is expected to acquire non-voting Class E Units, which are non voting and are not reflected in the table above. See "Certain relationships and related party transactions—Management unit subscription agreements" for additional information.

(2)
The Preferred Units and 30% of Class A Units held by the management investors were fully vested with respect to appreciation immediately upon issuance. The remaining 70% of Class A Units will vest over time. See "Certain relationships and related party transactions—Management unit subscription agreements" for additional information.

(3)
In addition, Vestar Capital Partners V, L.P. (the "Fund") owns 1,728,137 Preferred Units, representing approximately 96.7% of the Preferred Units, of NMH Investment. Vestar Associates V, L.P. is the general partner of the Fund having voting and investment power over membership interest held or controlled by the Fund. Vestar Managers V, Ltd. ("VMV") is the general partner of Vestar Associates V, L.P. Each of Vestar Associates V, L.P. and VMV disclaims beneficial ownership of any membership interests in NMH Investment beneficially owned by the Fund.

(4)
The address of each of Messrs. Torres, Murphy, Petersen, Jones and Timmons, as well as Ms. Fay, is c/o National Mentor Holdings, Inc., 313 Congress Street, Sixth Floor, Boston, MA 02210. The address of each of Vestar Capital Partners V, L.P. and Messrs. Elrod, O'Connell and Ratzan is c/o Vestar Capital Partners, 245 Park Avenue, 41st Floor, New York, NY 10167.

(5)
Mr. O'Connell is the Chief Executive Officer of Vestar Capital Partners and Messrs. Elrod and Ratzan are Managing Directors of Vestar Capital Partners. Each of Messrs. O'Connell, Elrod and Ratzan disclaims beneficial ownership of any membership interests in NMH Investment beneficially owned by the Fund except to the extent of his indirect pecuniary interest therein.

(6)
Mr. Gillespie resigned and Ms. Hopper retired on September 30, 2006 and October 1, 2005, respectively.

81



CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

Limited Liability Company Agreement

        Under the amended and restated limited liability company agreement of our ultimate parent company, NMH Investment, by and among NMH Investment, Vestar, an affiliate of Vestar, and certain key employees of NMH Investment or one or more of its subsidiaries (collectively, the "members"), the initial management committee consists of seven members elected by a plurality vote of all of the holders of NMH Investment's Class A Units. Any member of the management committee may be removed at any time by the holders of a majority of the total voting power of the outstanding Class A Units. The management committee consists of the same individuals as the board of directors of the Issuer.

        The management committee manages and controls the business and affairs of NMH Investment and has the power to, among other things, amend the limited liability company agreement, approve any significant corporate transactions, and appoint officers. It can also delegate such authority by agreement or authorization.

        The limited liability company agreement also contains agreements among the parties with respect to the allocation of net income and net loss and the distribution of assets.

Management Unit Subscription Agreements

        In connection with the completion of the Transactions, NMH Investment entered into several agreements with management investors whereby such management investors subscribed for and purchased, and NMH Investment agreed to issue and sell to such management investors on the date of the consummation of the Merger (the "Closing Date"), Preferred Units and Class A Units (which is the only class of voting equity interests in NMH Investment). In addition, NMH Investment has entered into agreements with management investors whereby such management investors purchased non-voting Class B Units, Class C Units and Class D Units. The Preferred Units and 30% of the Class A Units were fully vested with respect to appreciation upon issuance on the Closing Date. The remaining units' right to share in an increase in value of NMH Investment will vest according to schedules that include various time and performance targets and certain other events. The management investors have agreed to purchase an aggregate number of units that are expected to constitute approximately 3.3% of the preferred equity interest and approximately 7.8% of the voting power in NMH Investment outstanding on the Closing Date. In the aggregate, Class B, Class C and Class D units represent the right to receive up to approximately an additional 7.5% of the increase in value of the common equity interests in NMH Investment. NMH Investment may be required to purchase all of a management investor's units in the event of the management investor's disability, death or retirement. In addition, NMH Investment has the right to purchase all or a portion of a management investor's units upon the termination of such management investor's active employment with us or our affiliates. The price at which the units will be purchased will vary depending on a number of factors, including (i) the circumstances of such termination of employment and on whether the management investor engages in certain proscribed competitive activities following employment, (ii) the length of time such units were held and (iii) the financial performance of NMH Investment over a certain specified time period. However, NMH Investment shall not be obligated to purchase any units at any time to the extent that the purchase of such units, or a payment to NMH Investment by one of its subsidiaries in order to fund such purchase, would result in a violation of law, a financing default or adverse accounting consequences, or if a financing default exists which prohibits such purchase or payment. Notwithstanding any other provision of the management unit subscription agreements, NMH Investment will have no obligation to issue, sell or deliver any of its units to any management investor (i) who is not a full-time employee of, or consultant to, NMH Investment or any of its subsidiaries on

82



the Closing Date, (ii) whose representations and warranties contained therein are not true as of the Closing Date in all material respects or (iii) who has breached his obligations thereunder.

Director Unit Subscription Agreement

        In connection with his election to our Board of Directors, Jeffry A. Timmons is expected to enter into a Director Unit Subscription Agreement (the "DUSA"), among NMH Investment, himself, and Fiddlewood Farms Investments, LLC ("Fiddlewood"), a limited liability company controlled by Dr. Timmons and his spouse. Under the DUSA, Dr. Timmons will subscribe for and assign to Fiddlewood, the right to acquire specified amounts of Preferred Units, Class A Common Units and Class E Common Units of NMH Investment. Under the DUSA, Dr. Timmons has the right to invest up to $125,000.00 in our units. NMH Investment may be required to purchase all of Dr. Timmons' units in the event of his disability, death or retirement. In addition, NMH Investment has the right to purchase all or a portion of Dr. Timmons' units upon the termination of his service as a director with us or our affiliates at a price determined by a variety of factors disclosed in detail in the DUSA. However, NMH Investment shall not be obligated to purchase any units at any time to the extent that purchase of such units, or a payment to NMH Investment by one of its subsidiaries in order to fund such purchase, would result in a violation of law, a financing default or adverse accounting consequences, or if a financing default exists which prohibits such purchase or payment.

Securityholders Agreement

        Pursuant to the Securityholders Agreement among NMH Investment, Vestar, an affiliate of Vestar, the management investors and any future parties to such agreement that became effective at the closing of the Transactions (collectively, the "Securityholders"), the units of NMH Investment beneficially owned by the Securityholders are subject to certain restrictions on transfer, as well as the other provisions described below.

        The Securityholders Agreement provides that the Securityholders will vote all of their units to elect and continue in office a management committee or board of directors of NMH Investment and each of its subsidiaries consisting of up to seven members or directors composed of:

        In addition, each Securityholder has agreed, subject to certain limited exceptions, that he will vote all of his units as directed by Vestar in connection with amendments to NMH Investment's organizational documents, mergers or other business combinations, the disposition of all or substantially all of NMH Investment's property and assets, reorganizations, recapitalizations or the liquidation, dissolution or winding up of NMH Investment.

        Prior to the earlier of (i) a sale of a majority of the equity or voting interests of NMH Investment, Parent or certain of their holding company subsidiaries, or in a sale of all or substantially all of the assets of NMH Investment and its subsidiaries, except for any transactions with a wholly-owned subsidiary of Vestar or of NMH Investment and (ii) the fifth anniversary of the date of purchase, the management investors will be prohibited from transferring units to a third party, subject to certain exceptions.

        The Securityholders Agreement provides (i) the management investors with "tag-along" rights with respect to transfers of securities beneficially owned by Vestar, its partners or their transferees, and (ii) Vestar with "take-along" rights with respect to securities owned by the management investors in a

83



sale of a majority of the equity or voting interests of NMH Investment, Parent or certain of their holding company subsidiaries, or in a sale of all or substantially all of the assets of NMH Investment and its subsidiaries. In addition, Vestar has certain rights to require NMH Investment (or its successors) to register securities held by it under the Securities Act up to eight times, and Vestar and the other Securityholders have certain rights to participate in publicly registered offerings of NMH Investment's common equity initiated by NMH Investment or other third parties.

Management Agreement

        In connection with the consummation of the Transactions, the Sponsor entered into a management agreement with us relating to certain advisory and consulting services that the Sponsor will render to us. In consideration of those services, we agreed to pay to the Sponsor an aggregate per annum management fee equal to the greater of (i) $850,000 and (ii) an amount per annum equal to 1.00% of our consolidated earnings before depreciation, interest, taxes and amortization for each fiscal year before deduction of the Sponsor's fee, determined as set forth in our new senior secured credit facilities, commencing upon the completion of the Transactions. We also agreed to pay the Sponsor a transaction fee equal to $7.5 million plus all out-of-pocket expenses incurred by the Sponsor prior to the completion of the Transactions for services rendered by the Sponsor in connection with the consummation of the Transactions. This transaction fee is recorded in goodwill and deferred financing in the September 30, 2006 balance sheet. We also agreed to indemnify the Sponsor and its affiliates from and against all losses, claims, damages and liabilities arising out of the performance by the Sponsor of its services pursuant to the management agreement. The management agreement will terminate upon the earlier to occur of (i) the termination of the Merger Agreement or (ii) such time after the completion of the Transactions as the Sponsor and its partners and their respective affiliates hold, directly or indirectly in the aggregate, less than 20% of the voting power of our outstanding voting stock.

Historical Arrangements

Loan to Hugh R. Jones III

        In December 2002, we entered into a management stock purchase agreement with Hugh R. Jones III, our Senior Vice President and Chief Administrative Officer. Under the terms of the agreement, Mr. Jones purchased 12,210.496 shares of common stock of the Issuer for a purchase price of $4.00 per share and 51.158 shares of preferred stock of the Issuer for a purchase price of $1,000.00 per share. Mr. Jones borrowed the full $100,000.00 purchase price from us pursuant to a promissory note in principal amount of $100,000.00. The note bears an annual interest rate of 8%. The note matures five years from the date of execution, and Mr. Jones may extend the scheduled maturity date until December 31, 2010 upon 60 days written notice to us. Mr. Jones is required to prepay a portion of the note equal to the amount of all cash proceeds he receives in connection with his ownership, disposition, transfer or sale of the stock. On November 4, 2004, in connection with the 2004 refinancing, Mr. Jones repaid $56,427.04 of principal and accrued interest. On October 14, 2005, Mr. Jones repaid the remaining principal balance and accrued interest of $63,751.04 using a bonus he received from us on that date.

Transactions with Madison Dearborn

        Management Services Agreement.     In March 2001, we entered into a management services agreement with Madison Dearborn under which Madison Dearborn performed certain management, financing and strategic functions as directed by our board of directors for an annual fee of $250,000 plus out-of-pocket expenses. During the period from October 1, 2005 to June 29, 2006 and years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004, we incurred $198,304, $270,191 and $256,741, respectively, of

84


management fees and expenses under that agreement. The management services agreement terminated upon consummation of the Transactions.

Alliance Health and Human Services, Inc.

        Prior to joining Mentor in September 2004, Edward Murphy, our President and Chief Executive Officer, was a member of the board of directors of Alliance Health and Human Services, Inc. and its President. Mr. Murphy had served in these capacities at Alliance since 1999 and was instrumental in establishing and developing Alliance's service contracts with Mentor to provide ARY services in states that prefer or choose not to enter into contracts with for-profit corporations. Upon joining Mentor, Mr. Murphy resigned from all of his positions with Alliance and no longer has any financial interest in Alliance. Approximately 5% of our net revenues for both fiscal 2006 and fiscal 2005 are derived from contracts with Alliance.

85



THE EXCHANGE OFFER

General

        The Issuer hereby offers to exchange a like principal amount of exchange notes for any or all outstanding notes on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this prospectus and accompanying letter of transmittal. We refer to the offer as the "exchange offer." You may tender some or all of your outstanding notes pursuant to the exchange offer.

        As of the date of this prospectus, $180,000,000 aggregate principal amount of the outstanding notes is outstanding. This prospectus, together with the letter of transmittal, is first being sent to all holders of outstanding notes known to us on or about    , 2007. The Issuer's obligation to accept outstanding notes for exchange pursuant to the exchange offer is subject to certain conditions set forth under "Conditions to the exchange offer" below. The Issuer currently expects that each of the conditions will be satisfied and that no waivers will be necessary.

Purpose and Effect of the Exchange Offer

        We entered into a registration rights agreement with the initial purchasers of the outstanding notes in which we agreed, under certain circumstances, to file a registration statement relating to an offer to exchange the outstanding notes for exchange notes. We also agreed to use our reasonable best efforts to cause this registration statement to be declared effective and to cause the exchange offer to be consummated within 360 days after the issue date of the outstanding notes. The exchange notes will have terms substantially identical to the terms of the outstanding notes, except that the exchange notes will not contain terms with respect to transfer restrictions or additional interest upon a failure to fulfill certain of our obligations under the registration rights agreement. The outstanding notes were issued on June 29, 2006.

        Under the circumstances set forth below, we will use our reasonable best efforts to cause the SEC to declare effective a shelf registration statement with respect to the resale of the outstanding notes within the time periods specified in the registration rights agreement and to keep the shelf registration statement effective for two years or such shorter period ending when all outstanding notes or exchange notes covered by the statement have been sold in the manner set forth and as contemplated in the statement or to the extent that the applicable provisions of Rule 144(k) under the Securities Act are amended or revised. These circumstances include:

        If we fail to comply with certain obligations under the registration rights agreement, we will be required to pay additional interest to holders of the outstanding notes and the exchange notes required

86



to be registered on a shelf registration statement. Please read the section "Description of notes—registration rights" for more details regarding the registration rights agreement.

        Each holder of outstanding notes that wishes to exchange their outstanding notes for exchange notes in the exchange offer will be required to make the following written representations:

        Each broker-dealer that receives exchange notes for its own account in exchange for outstanding notes, where the broker-dealer acquired the outstanding notes as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities, must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection with any resale of such exchange notes. Please see "Plan of Distribution."

Resale of exchange notes

        Based on interpretations by the staff of the SEC as set forth in no-action letters issued to third parties referred to below, we believe that you may resell or otherwise transfer exchange notes issued in the exchange offer without complying with the registration and prospectus delivery provisions of the Securities Act, if:

        If you are an affiliate of the Issuer, or are engaging in, or intend to engage in, or have any arrangement or understanding with any person to participate in, a distribution of the exchange notes, or are not acquiring the exchange notes in the ordinary course of your business, then:

        This prospectus may be used for an offer to resell, for the resale or for other retransfer of exchange notes only as specifically set forth in this prospectus. With regard to broker-dealers, only broker-dealers that acquired the outstanding notes as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities may participate in the exchange offer. Each broker-dealer that receives exchange notes for its own account in exchange for outstanding notes where such outstanding notes were acquired by

87



such broker-dealer as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection with any resale of the exchange notes. Please read "Plan of Distribution" for more details regarding the transfer of exchange notes.

Terms of the Exchange Offer

        On the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this prospectus and in the accompanying letter of transmittal, we will accept for exchange in the exchange offer outstanding notes that are validly tendered and not validly withdrawn prior to the expiration date. Outstanding notes may only be tendered in denominations of $2,000 and integral multiples of $2,000. We will issue $2,000 principal amount or an integral multiple of $2,000 of exchange notes in exchange for a corresponding principal amount of outstanding notes surrendered in the exchange offer.

        The form and terms of the exchange notes will be substantially identical to the form and terms of the outstanding notes, except that the exchange notes will not contain terms with respect to transfer restrictions or additional interest upon a failure to fulfill certain of our obligations under the registration rights agreement. The exchange notes will evidence the same debt as the outstanding notes. The exchange notes will be issued under and entitled to the benefits of the same indenture under which the outstanding notes were issued, and the exchange notes and the outstanding notes will constitute a single class and series of notes for all purposes under the indenture. For a description of the indenture, please see "Description of the notes".

        The exchange offer is not conditioned upon any minimum aggregate principal amount of outstanding notes being tendered for exchange.

        As of the date of this prospectus, $180,000,000 aggregate principal amount of the outstanding notes is outstanding. This prospectus and a letter of transmittal are being sent to all registered holders of outstanding notes. There will be no fixed record date for determining registered holders of outstanding notes entitled to participate in the exchange offer.

        We intend to conduct the exchange offer in accordance with the provisions of the registration rights agreement, the applicable requirements of the Securities Act and the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"), and the rules and regulations of the SEC. Outstanding notes that are not tendered for exchange in the exchange offer will remain outstanding and continue to accrue interest and will be entitled to the rights and benefits that such holders have under the indenture relating to such holders' outstanding notes, except for any rights under the registration rights agreement that by their terms terminate upon the consummation of the exchange offer.

        We will be deemed to have accepted for exchange properly tendered outstanding notes when we have given oral or written notice of the acceptance to the exchange agent. The exchange agent will act as agent for the tendering holders for the purposes of receiving the exchange notes from us and delivering exchange notes to holders. Subject to the terms of the registration rights agreement, we expressly reserve the right to amend or terminate the exchange offer and to refuse to accept the occurrence of any of the conditions specified below under "—Conditions to the exchange offer".

        Holders who tender outstanding notes in the exchange offer will not be required to pay brokerage commissions or fees or, subject to the instructions in the letter of transmittal, transfer taxes with respect to the exchange of outstanding notes. We will pay all charges and expenses, other than certain applicable taxes described below, in connection with the exchange offer. It is important that you read "—Fees and expenses" below for more details regarding fees and expenses incurred in the exchange offer.

88



Expiration Date; Extensions, Amendments

        As used in this prospectus, the term "expiration date" means 5:00 p.m. midnight, New York City time, on    , 2007 which is the 21 st business day after the date of this prospectus. However, if we, in our sole discretion, extend the period of time for which the exchange offer is open, the term "expiration date" will mean the latest time and date to which we shall have extended the expiration of the exchange offer.

        To extend the period of time during which the exchange offer is open, we will notify the exchange agent of any extension by oral or written notice, followed by notification to the registered holders of the outstanding notes no later than 9:00 a.m., New York City time, on the business day after the previously scheduled expiration date.

        We reserve the right, in our sole discretion:

        Any delay in acceptance, extension, termination or amendment will be followed as promptly as practicable by oral or written notice to the registered holders of the outstanding notes. If we amend the exchange offer in a manner that we determine to constitute a material change, including the waiver of a material condition, we will promptly disclose the amendment by press release or other public announcement as required by Rule 14e-1(d) of the Exchange Act and will extend the offer period if necessary so that at least five business days remain in the offer following notice of the material change.

Conditions to the Exchange Offer

        Despite any other term of the exchange offer, we will not be required to accept for exchange, or to issue exchange notes in exchange for, any outstanding notes, and we may terminate or amend the exchange offer as provided in this prospectus before accepting any outstanding notes for exchange, if:

        In addition, we will not be obligated to accept for exchange the outstanding notes of any holder that has not made to us:

89


        We expressly reserve the right at any time or at various times to extend the period of time during which the exchange offer is open. Consequently, we may delay acceptance of any outstanding notes by notice by press release or other public announcement as required by Rule 14e-1(d) of the Act of such extension to their holders. During any such extensions, all outstanding notes previously tendered will remain subject to the exchange offer, and we may accept them for exchange. We will return any outstanding notes that we do not accept for exchange for any reason without expense to their tendering holder as promptly after the expiration or termination of the exchange offer.

        We expressly reserve the right to amend or terminate the exchange offer and to reject for exchange any outstanding notes not previously accepted for exchange upon the occurrence of any of the conditions of the exchange offer specified above. We will give notice by press release or other public announcement as required by Rule 14e-1(d) of the Act of any extension, amendment, non-acceptance or termination to the holders of the outstanding notes as promptly. In the case of any extension, such notice will be issued no later than 9:00 a.m., New York City time, on the business day after the previously scheduled expiration date.

        These conditions are for our sole benefit, and we may assert them regardless of the circumstances that may give rise to them so long as such circumstances do not arise due to our action or inaction or waive them in whole or in part at any or at various times in our sole discretion. If we fail at any time to exercise any of the foregoing rights, this failure will not constitute a waiver of such right. Each such right will be deemed an ongoing right that we may assert at any time or at various times.

Procedures for Tendering Outstanding Notes

        Only a holder of outstanding notes may tender their outstanding notes in the exchange offer. To tender in the exchange offer, a holder must comply with either of the following:

        In addition, either:

        To be tendered effectively, the exchange agent must receive any physical delivery of the letter of transmittal and other required documents at the address set forth below under "—Exchange agent" prior to the expiration date.

        A tender to us that is not withdrawn prior to the expiration date constitutes an agreement between us and the tendering holder upon the terms and subject to the conditions described in this prospectus and in the letter of transmittal.

90



        The method of delivery of outstanding notes, letter of transmittal and all other required documents to the exchange agent is at the holder's election and risk. Rather than mail these items, we recommend that holders use an overnight or hand delivery service. In all cases, holders should allow sufficient time to assure timely delivery to the exchange agent before the expiration date. Holders should not send letters of transmittal or certificates representing outstanding notes to us. Holders may request that their respective brokers, dealers, commercial banks, trust companies or other nominees effect the above transactions for them.

        If you are a beneficial owner whose outstanding notes are held in the name of a broker, dealer, commercial bank, trust company, or other nominee who wishes to participate in the exchange offer, you should promptly contact such party and instruct such person to tender outstanding notes on your behalf.

        You must make these arrangements or follow these procedures before completing and executing the letter of transmittal and delivering the outstanding notes.

        Signatures on the letter of transmittal or a notice of withdrawal, as the case may be, must be guaranteed by a member firm of a registered national securities exchange or of the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc., a commercial bank or trust company having an office or correspondent in the U.S. or another "eligible guarantor institution" within the meaning of Rule 17A(d)-15 under the Exchange Act unless the outstanding notes surrendered for exchange are tendered:

        If the letter of transmittal is signed by a person other than the registered holder of any outstanding notes listed on the outstanding notes, such outstanding notes must be endorsed or accompanied by a properly completed bond power. The bond power must be signed by the registered holder as the registered holder's name appears on the outstanding notes and an eligible guarantor institution must guarantee the signature on the bond power.

        If the letter of transmittal or any certificates representing outstanding notes or bond powers are signed by trustees, executors, administrators, guardians, attorneys-in-fact, officers of corporations, or others acting in a fiduciary or representative capacity, those persons should also indicate when signing and, unless waived by us, they should also submit evidence satisfactory to us of their authority to so act.

        The exchange agent and DTC have confirmed that any financial institution that is a participant in DTC's system may use DTC's Automated Tender Offer Program to tender. Participants in the program may, instead of physically completing and signing the letter of transmittal and delivering it to the exchange, electronically transmit their acceptance of the exchange by causing DTC to transfer the outstanding notes to the exchange agent in accordance with DTC's Automated Tender Offer Program procedures for transfer. DTC will then send an agent's message to the exchange agent. The term "agent's message" means a message transmitted by DTC, received by the exchange agent and forming part of the book-entry confirmation, that states that:

91


Book-Entry Delivery Procedures

        Promptly after the date of this prospectus, the exchange agent will establish an account with respect to the outstanding notes at DTC as the book-entry transfer facility, for purposes of the exchange offer. Any financial institution that is a participant in the book-entry transfer facility's system may make book-entry delivery of the outstanding notes by causing the book-entry transfer facility to transfer those outstanding notes into the exchange agent's account at the facility in accordance with the facility's procedures for such transfer. To be timely, book-entry delivery of outstanding notes requires receipt of a confirmation of a book-entry transfer, a "book-entry confirmation," prior to the expiration date. In addition, although delivery of outstanding notes may be effected through book-entry transfer into the exchange agent's account at the applicable book-entry transfer facility, the applicable letter of transmittal or a manually signed facsimile thereof, together with any required signature guarantees and any other required documents, or an "agent's message," as defined below, in connection with a book-entry transfer, must, in any case, be delivered or transmitted to and received by the exchange agent at its address set forth on the cover page of the applicable letter of transmittal prior to the expiration date to receive exchange notes for tendered outstanding notes, or the guaranteed delivery procedure described below must be complied with. Tender will not be deemed made until such documents are received by the exchange agent. Delivery of documents to the applicable book-entry transfer facility does not constitute delivery to the exchange agent.

Guaranteed Delivery Procedures

        If you wish to tender your outstanding notes but your outstanding notes are not immediately available or you cannot deliver your outstanding notes, the letter of transmittal or any other required documents to the exchange agent or comply with the applicable procedures under DTC's Automatic Tender Offer Program prior to the expiration date, you may still tender if:

        Upon request, the exchange agent will send to you a notice of guaranteed delivery if you wish to tender your notes according to the guaranteed delivery procedures.

92



DESCRIPTION OF NOTES

General

        Certain terms used in this description are defined under the subheading "Certain definitions." In this description, (i) the term "Issuer" refers only to National MENTOR Holdings, Inc. and not to any of its Subsidiaries and (ii) the terms "we," "our" and "us" each refer to the Issuer and its consolidated Subsidiaries.

        The Issuer issued $180,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 11 1 / 4 % Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014 and will issue the exchange notes (collectively, the "Notes") under an indenture dated June 29, 2006 (the "Indenture") among the Issuer, the Guarantors and U.S. Bank National Association, as trustee (the "Trustee").

        The following description is only a summary of the material provisions of the Indenture, does not purport to be complete and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the provisions of those agreements, including the definitions therein of certain terms used below. We urge you to read the Indenture because it, not this description, defines your rights as Holders of the Notes. You may request copies of the Indenture at our address set forth under the heading "Prospectus summary."

Brief Description of the Notes

        The Notes:

Guarantees

        The Guarantors, as primary obligors and not merely as sureties, have jointly and severally irrevocably and unconditionally guaranteed, on an unsecured senior subordinated basis, the performance and full and punctual payment when due, whether at maturity, by acceleration or otherwise, of all obligations of the Issuer under the Indenture and the Notes, whether for payment of principal of or interest on or Additional Interest in respect of the Notes, expenses, indemnification or otherwise, on the terms set forth in the Indenture by executing the Indenture.

        The Restricted Subsidiaries (other than as detailed below) have initially guaranteed the Notes. Each of the Guarantees of the Notes is a general unsecured obligation of each Guarantor, will be subordinated in right of payment to all existing and future Senior Indebtedness of each such entity and are effectively subordinated to all secured Indebtedness of each such entity. The Notes are structurally subordinated to Indebtedness of Subsidiaries of the Issuer that do not Guarantee the Notes.

        Certain of our Subsidiaries will not Guarantee the Notes. For example, no Insurance Subsidiary, Non-Profit Subsidiary, Foreign Subsidiary, non-Wholly Owned Subsidiary (subject to certain limited exceptions) or Receivables Subsidiary will guarantee the Notes. In the event of a bankruptcy, liquidation or reorganization of any of these non-guarantor Subsidiaries, the non-guarantor Subsidiaries

93



will pay the holders of their debt and their trade creditors before they will be able to distribute any of their assets to the Issuer. As of the Issue Date, all of the Issuer's Subsidiaries (other than the Insurance Subsidiary and the Non-Profit Subsidiary) were Guarantors.

        The obligations of each Guarantor under its Guarantees are limited as necessary to prevent the Guarantees from constituting a fraudulent conveyance under applicable law.

        Any entity that makes a payment under its Guarantee will be entitled upon payment in full of all guaranteed obligations under the Indenture to a contribution from each other Guarantor in an amount equal to such other Guarantor's pro rata portion of such payment based on the respective net assets of all the Guarantors at the time of such payment determined in accordance with GAAP.

        If a Guarantee was rendered voidable, it could be subordinated by a court to all other indebtedness (including guarantees and other contingent liabilities) of the Guarantor, and, depending on the amount of such indebtedness, a Guarantor's liability on its Guarantee could be reduced to zero. See "Risk factors—Risks related to this offering—Federal and state statutes allow courts, under specific circumstances, to void the notes and the guarantees, subordinate claims in respect of the notes and the guarantees and require note holders to return payments received from the Issuer or the guarantors."

        A Guarantee by a Guarantor shall provide by its terms that it shall be automatically and unconditionally released and discharged upon:

Ranking

Senior Indebtedness Versus the Notes

        The payment of the principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the Notes and the payment of any Guarantee are subordinate in right of payment to the prior payment in cash in full of all Senior Indebtedness of the Issuer or the relevant Guarantor, as the case may be, including the obligations of the Issuer and such Guarantor under the Senior Credit Facilities.

        The Notes are subordinated in right of payment to all of the Issuer's and the Guarantors' existing and future Senior Indebtedness and effectively subordinated to all of the Issuer's and the Guarantors' existing and future Secured Indebtedness to the extent of the value of the assets securing such Indebtedness. As of September 30, 2006, we had approximately $339.7 million of senior secured indebtedness (consisting of $334.2 million and $5.5 million of secured Indebtedness under the Senior Credit Facilities and the Mortgage Facility, respectively).

94


        Although the Indenture will contain limitations on the amount of additional Indebtedness that the Issuer and its Restricted Subsidiaries may incur, under certain circumstances the amount of such Indebtedness could be substantial and, in any case, such Indebtedness may be Senior Indebtedness. See "Certain covenants—Limitation on incurrence of indebtedness and issuance of disqualified stock and preferred stock."

Paying Agent and Registrar for the Notes

        The Issuer will maintain one or more paying agents for the Notes. The initial paying agent for the Notes is the Trustee.

        The Issuer will also maintain a registrar for the Notes. The initial registrar is the Trustee. The registrar will maintain a register reflecting ownership of the Notes outstanding from time to time and will make payments on and facilitate transfer of Notes on behalf of the Issuer.

        The Issuer may change the paying agents or the registrars without prior notice to the Holders. The Issuer or any of its Subsidiaries may act as a paying agent or registrar.

Subordination of the Notes

        Only Indebtedness of the Issuer or a Guarantor that is Senior Indebtedness will rank senior to the Notes and the Guarantees in accordance with the provisions of the Indenture. The Notes and Guarantees will in all respects rank pari passu with all other Senior Subordinated Indebtedness of the Issuer and the relevant Guarantor, respectively.

        We have agreed in the Indenture that the Issuer and the Guarantors will not incur any Indebtedness that is subordinate or junior in right of payment to the Senior Indebtedness of such Person, unless such Indebtedness is Senior Subordinated Indebtedness of the applicable Person or is expressly subordinated in right of payment to Senior Subordinated Indebtedness of such Person. The Indenture will not treat (i) unsecured Indebtedness as subordinated or junior to Secured Indebtedness merely because it is unsecured or (ii) Senior Indebtedness as subordinated or junior to any other Senior Indebtedness merely because it has a junior priority with respect to the same collateral.

        Neither the Issuer nor any Guarantor is permitted to pay principal of, premium, if any, or interest on the Notes (or pay any other obligations relating to the Notes, including Additional Interest, fees, costs, expenses, indemnities and rescission or damage claims) or make any deposit pursuant to the provisions described under "Legal defeasance and covenant defeasance" or "Satisfaction and Discharge" below and may not purchase, redeem or otherwise retire any Notes (collectively, "pay the notes") (except in the form of Permitted Junior Securities) if either of the following occurs (a "Payment Default"):

unless, in either case, the Payment Default has been cured or waived and any such acceleration has been rescinded or such Designated Senior Indebtedness has been paid in full in cash. Regardless of the foregoing, the Issuer is permitted to pay the Notes if the Issuer and the Trustee receive written notice approving such payment from the Representatives of all Designated Senior Indebtedness with respect to which the Payment Default has occurred and is continuing.

        During the continuance of any default (other than a Payment Default) (a "Non-Payment Default") with respect to any Designated Senior Indebtedness pursuant to which the maturity thereof may be accelerated without further notice (except such notice as may be required to effect such acceleration)

95



or the expiration of any applicable grace periods, the Issuer is not permitted to pay the Notes (except in the form of Permitted Junior Securities) for a period (a "Payment Blockage Period") commencing upon the receipt by the Trustee (with a copy to the Issuer) of written notice (a "Blockage Notice") of such Non-Payment Default from the Representative of such Designated Senior Indebtedness specifying an election to effect a Payment Blockage Period and ending 179 days thereafter. The Payment Blockage Period will end earlier if such Payment Blockage Period is terminated:

        Notwithstanding the provisions described above, unless the holders of such Designated Senior Indebtedness or the Representative of such Designated Senior Indebtedness have accelerated the maturity of such Designated Senior Indebtedness, the Issuer and related Guarantors are permitted to resume paying the Notes after the end of such Payment Blockage Period. The Notes shall not be subject to more than one Payment Blockage Period in any consecutive 360-day period irrespective of the number of defaults with respect to Designated Senior Indebtedness during such period; provided that if any Blockage Notice is delivered to the Trustee by or on behalf of the holders of Designated Senior Indebtedness of the Issuer (other than the holders of Indebtedness under the Senior Credit Facilities), a Representative of holders of Indebtedness under the Senior Credit Facilities may give another Blockage Notice within such period. However, in no event may the total number of days during which any Payment Blockage Period or Periods on the Notes is in effect exceed 179 days in the aggregate during any consecutive 360-day period, and there must be at least 181 days during any consecutive 360-day period during which no Payment Blockage Period is in effect. Notwithstanding the foregoing, however, no default that existed or was continuing on the date of delivery of any Blockage Notice to the Trustee will be, or be made, the basis for a subsequent Blockage Notice unless such default has been cured or waived for a period of not less than 90 days (it being acknowledged that any subsequent action, or any breach of any financial covenants during the period after the date of delivery of a Blockage Notice, that, in either case, would give rise to a Non-Payment Default pursuant to any provisions under which a Non-Payment Default previously existed or was continuing shall constitute a new Non-Payment Default for this purpose).

        In connection with the Notes, in the event of any payment or distribution of the assets of the Issuer upon a total or partial liquidation or dissolution or reorganization of or similar proceeding relating to the Issuer or its property:

96


        The subordination and payment blockage provisions described above will not prevent a Default from occurring under the Indenture upon the failure of the Issuer to pay interest or principal with respect to the Notes when due by their terms. If payment of the Notes is accelerated because of an Event of Default, the Issuer must promptly notify the holders of Designated Senior Indebtedness or the Representative of such Designated Senior Indebtedness of the acceleration. So long as there shall remain outstanding any Senior Indebtedness under the Senior Credit Facilities, a Blockage Notice may be given only by the administrative agent thereunder unless otherwise agreed to in writing by the requisite lenders named therein. If any Designated Senior Indebtedness of the Issuer is outstanding, neither the Issuer nor any Guarantor may pay the Notes until five Business Days after the Representatives of all the issuers of such Designated Senior Indebtedness receive notice of such acceleration and, thereafter, may pay the Notes only if the Indenture otherwise permits payment at that time.

        Each Guarantor's obligations under its Guarantee are senior subordinated obligations of that Guarantor. As such, the rights of Holders to receive payment pursuant to such Guarantee will be subordinated in right of payment to the rights of holders of Senior Indebtedness of such Guarantor. The terms of the subordination and payment blockage provisions described above with respect to the Issuer's obligations under the Notes apply equally to the obligations of such Guarantor under its Guarantee.

        A Holder by its acceptance of Notes agrees to be bound by such provisions and authorizes and expressly directs the Trustee, on its behalf, to take such action as may be necessary or appropriate to effectuate the subordination provided for in the Indenture and appoints the Trustee its attorney-in-fact for such purpose.

        By reason of the subordination provisions contained in the Indenture, in the event of a liquidation or insolvency proceeding, creditors of the Issuer or a Guarantor who are holders of Senior Indebtedness of the Issuer or such Guarantor, as the case may be, may recover more, ratably, than the Holders of the Notes, and creditors who are not holders of Senior Indebtedness may recover less, ratably, than holders of Senior Indebtedness and may recover more, ratably, than the Holders of the Notes.

        The terms of the subordination provisions described above will not apply to payments from money or the proceeds of Government Securities held in trust by the Trustee for the payment of principal of and interest on the Notes pursuant to the provisions described under "Legal defeasance and covenant defeasance" or "Satisfaction and discharge," if the foregoing subordination provisions were not violated at the time the applicable amounts were deposited in trust pursuant to such provisions.

Transfer and Exchange

        A Holder may transfer or exchange Notes in accordance with the Indenture. The registrar and the Trustee may require a Holder to furnish appropriate endorsements and transfer documents in connection with a transfer of Notes. Holders will be required to pay all taxes due on transfer. The Issuer is not required to transfer or exchange any Note selected for redemption. Also, the Issuer is not required to transfer or exchange any Note for a period of 15 days before a selection of Notes to be redeemed.

Principal, Maturity and Interest

        On the Issue Date, the Issuer issued $180,000,000 of outstanding notes in a private offering. The Notes will mature on July 1, 2014. Subject to compliance with the covenant described below under the caption "Certain covenants—Limitation on incurrence of indebtedness and issuance of disqualified stock and preferred stock," the Issuer may issue additional Notes from time to time after this offering under the Indenture ("Additional Notes"). The Notes offered by the Issuer and any Additional Notes

97



subsequently issued under the Indenture will be treated as a single class for all purposes under the Indenture, including waivers, amendments, redemptions and offers to purchase. Unless the context requires otherwise, references to "Notes" for all purposes of the Indenture and this "Description of notes" include any Additional Notes that are actually issued.

        Interest on the Notes accrues at the rate of 11 1 / 4 % per annum and will be payable semi-annually in arrears on January 1 and July 1, commencing on January 1, 2007 to the Holders of Notes of record on the immediately preceding December 15 and June 15. Interest on the Notes accrues from the most recent date to which interest has been paid or, if no interest has been paid, from and including the Issue Date. Interest on the Notes is computed on the basis of a 360 day year comprised of twelve 30 day months.

        Principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the Notes will be payable at the office or agency of the Issuer maintained for such purpose within the City and State of New York or, at the option of the Issuer, payment of interest may be made by check mailed to the Holders of the Notes at their respective addresses set forth in the register of Holders; provided that all payments of principal, premium, if any, and interest with respect to the Notes represented by one or more global notes registered in the name of or held by DTC or its nominee will be made by wire transfer of immediately available funds to the accounts specified by the Holder or Holders thereof.

Additional Interest

        Additional Interest may accrue on the outstanding notes in certain circumstances pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement. All references in the Indenture, in any context, to any interest or other amount payable on or with respect to the Notes shall be deemed to include any Additional Interest pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement.

Mandatory Redemption; Offers to Purchase; Open Market Purchases

        The Issuer is not required to make any mandatory redemption or sinking fund payments with respect to the Notes. However, under certain circumstances, the Issuer may be required to offer to purchase Notes as described under the caption "Repurchase at the option of holders." We may at any time and from time to time purchase Notes in the open market or otherwise.

Optional Redemption

        Except as set forth below, the Issuer is not entitled to redeem the Notes at its option prior to July 1, 2010.

        At any time prior to July 1, 2010 the Issuer may redeem all or a part of the Notes, upon not less than 30 nor more than 60 days' prior notice mailed by first-class mail to the registered address of each Holder, at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of Notes redeemed plus the Applicable Premium as of, and accrued and unpaid interest and Additional Interest, if any, to the date of redemption (the "Redemption Date"), subject to the rights of Holders on the relevant record date to receive interest due on the relevant interest payment date.

        On and after July 1, 2010, the Issuer may redeem the Notes, in whole or in part, upon notice as described under the heading "Repurchase at the option of holders—Selection and notice" at the redemption prices (expressed as percentages of principal amount of the Notes to be redeemed) set forth below, plus accrued and unpaid interest thereon and Additional Interest, if any, to the applicable Redemption Date, subject to the right of Holders of record on the relevant record date to receive

98



interest due on the relevant interest payment date, if redeemed during the twelve month period beginning on July 1 of each of the years indicated below:

Year

  Percentage
 
2010   105.625 %
2011   102.813 %
2012 and thereafter   100.000 %

        In addition, until July 1, 2009, the Issuer may, at its option, redeem up to 35% of the aggregate principal amount of Notes issued by it at a redemption price equal to 111.25% of the aggregate principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest thereon and Additional Interest, if any, to the applicable Redemption Date, subject to the right of Holders of Notes of record on the relevant record date to receive interest due on the relevant interest payment date, with the net cash proceeds of one or more Equity Offerings; provided that at least 65% of the sum of the aggregate principal amount of Notes originally issued under the Indenture and any Additional Notes that are Notes issued under the Indenture after the Issue Date remains outstanding immediately after the occurrence of each such redemption; provided further that each such redemption occurs within 90 days of the date of closing of each such Equity Offering.

        Notice of any redemption upon any Equity Offering may be given prior to the completion thereof, and any such redemption or notice may, at the Issuer's discretion, be subject to one or more conditions precedent, including, but not limited to, completion of the related Equity Offering.

        The Trustee shall select the Notes to be purchased in the manner described under "Repurchase at the option of holders—Selection and notice."

Repurchase at the Option of Holders

Change of Control

        The Notes provide that if a Change of Control occurs, unless the Issuer has previously or concurrently mailed irrevocable redemption notices with respect to all the outstanding Notes as described under "Optional redemption," the Issuer will make an offer to purchase all of the Notes pursuant to the offer described below (the "Change of Control Offer") at a price in cash (the "Change of Control Payment") equal to 101% of the aggregate principal amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest and Additional Interest, if any, to the date of purchase, subject to the right of Holders of the Notes of record on the relevant record date to receive interest due on the relevant interest payment date. Within 30 days following any Change of Control, the Issuer will send notice of such Change of Control Offer by first-class mail, with a copy to the Trustee, to each Holder of Notes to the address of such Holder appearing in the security register with a copy to the Trustee, with the following information:

99


        The Issuer will comply with the requirements of Rule 14e-1 under the Exchange Act and any other securities laws and regulations thereunder to the extent such laws or regulations are applicable in connection with the repurchase of Notes pursuant to a Change of Control Offer. To the extent that the provisions of any securities laws or regulations conflict with the provisions of the Indenture, the Issuer will comply with the applicable securities laws and regulations and shall not be deemed to have breached their obligations described in the Indenture by virtue thereof.

        On the Change of Control Payment Date, the Issuer will, to the extent permitted by law,

        The Senior Credit Facilities limit, and future credit agreements or other agreements relating to Senior Indebtedness to which the Issuer becomes a party may prohibit or limit, the Issuer from purchasing any Notes as a result of a Change of Control. In the event a Change of Control occurs at a time when the Issuer is prohibited from purchasing the Notes, the Issuer could seek the consent of its lenders to permit the purchase of the Notes or could attempt to refinance the borrowings that contain such prohibition. If the Issuer does not obtain such consent or repay such borrowings, the Issuer will remain prohibited from purchasing the Notes. In such case, the Issuer's failure to purchase tendered Notes would constitute an Event of Default under the Indenture. If, as a result thereof, a default occurs with respect to any Senior Indebtedness, the subordination provisions in the Indenture would restrict payments to the Holders of Notes under certain circumstances. The Senior Credit Facilities provide that certain change of control events with respect to the Issuer would constitute a default thereunder (including a Change of Control under the Indenture). If we experience a change of control that triggers a default under our Senior Credit Facilities, we could seek a waiver of such default or seek to refinance our Senior Credit Facilities. In the event we do not obtain such a waiver or refinance the

100


Senior Credit Facilities, such default could result in amounts outstanding under our Senior Credit Facilities being declared due and payable and cause a Receivables Facility to be wound down.

        Our ability to pay cash to the Holders of Notes following the occurrence of a Change of Control may be limited by our then-existing financial resources. Therefore, sufficient funds may not be available when necessary to make any required repurchases.

        The Change of Control purchase feature of the Notes may in certain circumstances make more difficult or discourage a sale or takeover of us and, thus, the removal of incumbent management. The Change of Control purchase feature is a result of negotiations between the Initial Purchasers and us. We have no present intention to engage in a transaction involving a Change of Control, although it is possible that we could decide to do so in the future. Subject to the limitations discussed below, we could, in the future, enter into certain transactions, including acquisitions, refinancings or other recapitalizations, that would not constitute a Change of Control under the Indenture, but that could increase the amount of Indebtedness outstanding at such time or otherwise affect our capital structure or credit ratings. Restrictions on our ability to incur additional Indebtedness are contained in the covenants described under "Certain covenants—Limitation on incurrence of indebtedness and issuance of disqualified stock and preferred stock" and "Certain covenants—Liens." Such restrictions in the Indenture can be waived only with the consent of the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the Notes then outstanding. Except for the limitations contained in such covenants, however, the Indenture does not contain any covenants or provisions that may afford Holders of the Notes protection in the event of a highly leveraged transaction.

        We will not be required to make a Change of Control Offer following a Change of Control if a third party makes the Change of Control Offer in the manner, at the times and otherwise in compliance with the requirements set forth in the Indenture applicable to a Change of Control Offer made by us and purchases all Notes validly tendered and not withdrawn under such Change of Control Offer. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary herein, a Change of Control Offer may be made in advance of a Change of Control, conditional upon such Change of Control, if a definitive agreement is in place for the Change of Control at the time of making of the Change of Control Offer.

        The definition of "Change of Control" includes a disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the Issuer to any Person. Although there is a limited body of case law interpreting the phrase "substantially all," there is no precise established definition of the phrase under applicable law. Accordingly, in certain circumstances there may be a degree of uncertainty as to whether a particular transaction would involve a disposition of "all or substantially all" of the assets of the Issuer. As a result, it may be unclear as to whether a Change of Control has occurred and whether a Holder of Notes may require the Issuer to make an offer to repurchase the Notes as described above.

        The provisions under the Indenture relative to the Issuer's obligation to make an offer to repurchase the Notes as a result of a Change of Control may be waived or modified with the written consent of the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the Notes.

Asset Sales

        The Indenture provides that the Issuer will not, and will not permit any of its Restricted Subsidiaries to, cause, make or suffer to exist an Asset Sale, unless:

101


shall be deemed to be cash for purposes of this provision and for no other purpose.

        Within 365 days (or 450 days in the case of Net Cash Proceeds of any Sale and Lease-Back Transaction) after the receipt of any Net Proceeds of any Asset Sale, the Issuer or such Restricted Subsidiary, at its option, may apply the Net Proceeds from such Asset Sale,

102


provided that, in the case of clauses (2) and (3) above, a binding commitment shall be treated as a permitted application of the Net Proceeds from the date of such commitment so long as the Issuer, or such other Restricted Subsidiary enters into such commitment with the good faith expectation that such Net Proceeds will be applied to satisfy such commitment within 180 days of such commitment (an "Acceptable Commitment") and, in the event any Acceptable Commitment is later cancelled or terminated for any reason before the Net Proceeds are applied in connection therewith, the Issuer or such Restricted Subsidiary enters into another Acceptable Commitment (a "Second Commitment") within 180 days of such cancellation or termination; provided further that if any Second Commitment is later cancelled or terminated for any reason before such Net Proceeds are applied, then such Net Proceeds shall constitute Excess Proceeds.

        Any Net Proceeds from the Asset Sale that are not invested or applied as provided and within the time period set forth in the first sentence of the preceding paragraph will be deemed to constitute "Excess Proceeds." When the aggregate amount of Excess Proceeds exceeds $15.0 million, the Issuer shall make an offer to all Holders of the Notes and, if required by the terms of any Indebtedness that is pari passu with the Notes ("Pari Passu Indebtedness"), to the holders of such Pari Passu Indebtedness (an "Asset Sale Offer"), to purchase the maximum aggregate principal amount of the Notes and such Pari Passu Indebtedness that is an integral multiple of $2,000 that may be purchased out of the Excess Proceeds at an offer price in cash in an amount equal to 100% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest and Additional Interest, if any, to the date fixed for the closing of such offer, in accordance with the procedures set forth in the Indenture. The Issuer will commence an Asset Sale Offer with respect to Excess Proceeds within ten Business Days after the date that Excess Proceeds exceed $15.0 million by mailing the notice required pursuant to the terms of the Indenture, with a copy to the Trustee.

        To the extent that the aggregate amount of Notes and such Pari Passu Indebtedness tendered pursuant to an Asset Sale Offer is less than the Excess Proceeds, the Issuer may use any remaining Excess Proceeds for general corporate purposes, subject to other covenants contained in the Indenture. If the aggregate principal amount of Notes or the Pari Passu Indebtedness surrendered by such holders thereof exceeds the amount of Excess Proceeds, the Trustee shall select the Notes and such Pari Passu Indebtedness to be purchased on a pro rata basis based on the accreted value or principal amount of the Notes or such Pari Passu Indebtedness tendered. Upon completion of any such Asset Sale Offer, the amount of Excess Proceeds shall be reset at zero.

        Pending the final application of any Net Proceeds pursuant to this covenant, the holder of such Net Proceeds may apply such Net Proceeds temporarily to reduce Indebtedness outstanding under a revolving credit facility or otherwise invest such Net Proceeds in any manner not prohibited by the Indenture.

        The Issuer will comply with the requirements of Rule 14e-1 under the Exchange Act and any other securities laws and regulations thereunder to the extent such laws or regulations are applicable in connection with the repurchase of the Notes pursuant to an Asset Sale Offer. To the extent that the provisions of any securities laws or regulations conflict with the provisions of the Indenture, the Issuer will comply with the applicable securities laws and regulations and shall not be deemed to have breached its obligations described in the Indenture by virtue thereof.

        The Senior Credit Facilities limit, and future credit agreements or other agreements relating to Senior Indebtedness to which the Issuer becomes a party may prohibit or limit, the Issuer from purchasing any Notes pursuant to this Asset Sales covenant. In the event the Issuer is prohibited from purchasing the Notes, the Issuer could seek the consent of its lenders to the purchase of the Notes or could attempt to refinance the borrowings that contain such prohibition. If the Issuer does not obtain

103



such consent or repay such borrowings, they will remain prohibited from purchasing the Notes. In such case, the Issuer's failure to purchase tendered Notes would constitute an Event of Default under the Indenture. If, as a result thereof, a default occurs with respect to any Senior Indebtedness, the subordination provisions in the Indenture would restrict payments to the Holders of the Notes under certain circumstances.

Selection and Notice

        If the Issuer is redeeming less than all of the Notes issued by them at any time, the Trustee will select the Notes to be redeemed (a) if the Notes are listed on any national securities exchange, in compliance with the requirements of the principal national securities exchange on which the Notes are listed or (b) on a pro rata basis to the extent practicable.

        Notices of purchase or redemption shall be mailed by first-class mail, postage prepaid, at least 30 but not more than 60 days before the purchase or redemption date to each Holder of Notes at such Holder's registered address, except that redemption notices may be mailed more than 60 days prior to a redemption date if the notice is issued in connection with a defeasance of the Notes or a satisfaction and discharge of the Indenture. If any Note is to be purchased or redeemed in part only, any notice of purchase or redemption that relates to such Note shall state the portion of the principal amount thereof that has been or is to be purchased or redeemed.

        The Issuer will issue a new Note in a principal amount equal to the unredeemed portion of the original Note in the name of the Holder upon cancellation of the original Note. Notes called for redemption become due on the date fixed for redemption. On and after the redemption date, interest ceases to accrue on Notes or portions of them called for redemption.

Certain Covenants

Limitation on Restricted Payments

        The Issuer will not, and will not permit any of its Restricted Subsidiaries to, directly or indirectly:

104


        (all such payments and other actions set forth in clauses (I) through (IV) above being collectively referred to as "Restricted Payments"), unless, at the time of such Restricted Payment:

105


        The foregoing provisions will not prohibit:

106


107


108


109


provided, however , that at the time of, and after giving effect to, any Restricted Payment permitted under clauses (11) and (16), no Default shall have occurred and be continuing or would occur as a consequence thereof.

        As of the Issue Date, all of the Issuer's Subsidiaries were Restricted Subsidiaries. The Issuer will not permit any Unrestricted Subsidiary to become a Restricted Subsidiary except pursuant to the last sentence of the definition of "Unrestricted Subsidiary." For purposes of designating any Restricted Subsidiary as an Unrestricted Subsidiary, all outstanding Investments by the Issuer and its Restricted Subsidiaries (except to the extent repaid) in the Subsidiary so designated will be deemed to be Restricted Payments in an amount determined as set forth in the last sentence of the definition of "Investment." Such designation will be permitted only if a Restricted Payment in such amount would be permitted at such time, whether pursuant to the first paragraph of this covenant or under clause (7), (10) or (11) of the second paragraph of this covenant, or pursuant to the definition of "Permitted Investments," and if such Subsidiary otherwise meets the definition of an Unrestricted Subsidiary. Unrestricted Subsidiaries will not be subject to any of the restrictive covenants set forth in the Indenture.

Limitation on Incurrence of Indebtedness and Issuance of Disqualified Stock and Preferred Stock

        The Issuer will not, and will not permit any of its Restricted Subsidiaries to, directly or indirectly, create, incur, issue, assume, guarantee or otherwise become directly or indirectly liable, contingently or otherwise (collectively, "incur" and collectively, an "incurrence") with respect to any Indebtedness (including Acquired Indebtedness) and the Issuer will not issue any shares of Disqualified Stock and will not permit any Restricted Subsidiary to issue any shares of Disqualified Stock or Preferred Stock; provided, however , that the Issuer may incur Indebtedness (including Acquired Indebtedness) or issue shares of Disqualified Stock, and any of its Restricted Subsidiaries may incur Indebtedness (including Acquired Indebtedness), issue shares of Disqualified Stock and issue shares of Preferred Stock, if the Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio on a consolidated basis for the Issuer and its Restricted Subsidiaries' most recently ended four fiscal quarters for which internal financial statements are available immediately preceding the date on which such additional Indebtedness is incurred or such Disqualified Stock or Preferred Stock is issued would have been at least 2.00 to 1.00 determined on a pro forma basis (including a pro forma application of the net proceeds therefrom), as if the additional Indebtedness had been incurred, or the Disqualified Stock or Preferred Stock had been issued, as the case may be, and the application of proceeds therefrom had occurred at the beginning of such four-quarter period.

        The foregoing limitations will not apply to:

110


111


112


113


        Accrual of interest, the accretion of accreted value and the payment of interest in the form of additional Indebtedness, Disqualified Stock or Preferred Stock of the same class will not be deemed to be an incurrence of Indebtedness, Disqualified Stock or Preferred Stock for purposes of this covenant.

        For purposes of determining compliance with any U.S. dollar-denominated restriction on the incurrence of Indebtedness, the U.S. dollar-equivalent principal amount of Indebtedness denominated in a foreign currency shall be calculated based on the relevant currency exchange rate in effect on the date such Indebtedness was incurred, in the case of term debt, or first committed, in the case of revolving credit debt; provided that if such Indebtedness is incurred to refinance other Indebtedness denominated in a foreign currency, and such refinancing would cause the applicable U.S. dollar denominated restriction to be exceeded if calculated at the relevant currency exchange rate in effect on the date of such refinancing, such U.S. dollar-denominated restriction shall be deemed not to have been exceeded so long as the principal amount of such refinancing Indebtedness does not exceed the principal amount of such Indebtedness being refinanced.

        The principal amount of any Indebtedness incurred to refinance other Indebtedness, if incurred in a different currency from the Indebtedness being refinanced, shall be calculated based on the currency exchange rate applicable to the currencies in which such respective Indebtedness is denominated that is in effect on the date of such refinancing.

Liens

        The Issuer will not, and will not permit any Guarantor to, directly or indirectly, create, incur, assume or suffer to exist any Lien (except Permitted Liens) that secures obligations under any Indebtedness ranking pari passu with or subordinated to the Notes or any related Guarantee, on any asset or property of the Issuer or any Guarantor, or any income or profits therefrom, or assign or convey any right to receive income therefrom, unless:

114


Merger, Consolidation or Sale of All or Substantially All Assets

        The Issuer may not consolidate or merge with or into or wind up into (whether or not the Issuer is the surviving corporation), or sell, assign, transfer, lease, convey or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of its properties or assets, in one or more related transactions, to any Person unless:

        The Successor Company will succeed to, and be substituted for the Issuer under the Indenture, the Guarantees and the Notes, as applicable. Notwithstanding the foregoing clause (4),

115


        Subject to certain limitations described in the Indenture governing release of a Guarantee upon the sale, disposition or transfer of a guarantor, no Guarantor will, and the Issuer will not permit any Guarantor to, consolidate or merge with or into or wind up into (whether or not the Issuer or Guarantor is the surviving corporation), or sell, assign, transfer, lease, convey or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of its properties or assets, in one or more related transactions, to any Person unless:

        Subject to certain limitations described in the Indenture, the Successor Person will succeed to, and be substituted for, such Guarantor under the Indenture and such Guarantor's Guarantee. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any Guarantor may merge into or transfer all or part of its properties and assets to another Guarantor or the Issuer or merge with an Affiliate of the Issuer solely for the purpose of reincorporating the Guarantor in a State of the United States as long as the amount of Indebtedness of such Guarantor is not increased thereby.

Transactions With Affiliates

        The Issuer will not, and will not permit any of its Restricted Subsidiaries to, make any payment to, or sell, lease, transfer or otherwise dispose of any of its properties or assets to, or purchase any property or assets from, or enter into or make or amend any transaction, contract, agreement, understanding, loan, advance or guarantee with, or for the benefit of, any Affiliate of the Issuer (each of the foregoing, an "Affiliate Transaction") involving aggregate payments or consideration in excess of $5.0 million, unless:

116


        The foregoing provisions will not apply to the following:

117


Dividend and Other Payment Restrictions Affecting Restricted Subsidiaries

        The Issuer will not, and will not permit any of its Restricted Subsidiaries to, directly or indirectly, create or otherwise cause or suffer to exist or become effective any consensual encumbrance or consensual restriction on the ability of any Restricted Subsidiary that is not a Guarantor to:

except (in each case) for such encumbrances or restrictions existing under or by reason of:

118


Limitation on Guarantees of Indebtedness by Restricted Subsidiaries

        The Issuer will not permit any of its Wholly-Owned Subsidiaries that are Restricted Subsidiaries (and non-Wholly-Owned Subsidiaries that are Restricted Subsidiaries if such non-Wholly-Owned Subsidiaries guarantee other capital markets debt securities or Credit Facilities), other than a Guarantor or an Insurance Subsidiary, Non-Profit Subsidiary or Foreign Subsidiary, to guarantee the payment of any Indebtedness of the Issuer or any other Guarantor unless:

119


Limitation on Layering

        The Indenture provides that the Issuer will not, and will not permit any Guarantor to, directly or indirectly, incur any Indebtedness (including Acquired Indebtedness) that is subordinate in right of payment to any Senior Indebtedness of the Issuer or such Guarantor, as the case may be, unless such Indebtedness is either:

        The Indenture does not treat (1) unsecured Indebtedness as subordinated or junior to Secured Indebtedness merely because it is unsecured or (2) Senior Indebtedness as subordinated or junior to any other Senior Indebtedness merely because it has a junior priority with respect to the same collateral.

Reports and Other Information

        Notwithstanding that the Issuer may not be subject to the reporting requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act or otherwise report on an annual and quarterly basis on forms provided for such annual and quarterly reporting pursuant to rules and regulations promulgated by the SEC, the Indenture will require the Issuer to file with the SEC (and make available to the Trustee and Holders of the Notes (without exhibits), without cost to any Holder, within 15 days after it files them with the SEC) from and after the Issue Date,

in each case, in a manner that complies in all material respects with the requirements specified in such form; provided that the Issuer shall not be so obligated to file such reports with the SEC if the SEC does not permit such filing, in which event the Issuer will make available such information to prospective purchasers of Notes, in addition to providing such information to the Trustee and the

120


Holders of the Notes, in each case within 15 days after the time the Issuer would be required to file such information with the SEC, if it were subject to Sections 13 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act, which obligation to provide such information may be satisfied by posting such information on its website within the time period specified above. In addition, to the extent not satisfied by the foregoing, the Issuer will agree that, for so long as any Notes are outstanding, it will furnish to Holders and to securities analysts and prospective investors, upon their request, the information required to be delivered pursuant to Rule 144A(d)(4) under the Securities Act.

        In the event that any direct or indirect parent company of the Issuer becomes a guarantor of the Notes, the Indenture will permit the Issuer to satisfy its obligations in this covenant with respect to financial information relating to the Issuer by furnishing financial information relating to such parent; provided that the same is accompanied by consolidating information that explains in reasonable detail the differences between the information relating to such parent, on the one hand, and the information relating to the Issuer and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a standalone basis, on the other hand.

        Notwithstanding the foregoing, such requirements shall be deemed satisfied prior to the commencement of the exchange offer or the effectiveness of the shelf registration statement by the filing with the SEC of the exchange offer registration statement or shelf registration statement, and any amendments thereto, with such financial information that satisfies Regulation S-X of the Securities Act.

Events of Default and Remedies

        The Indenture provides that each of the following is an Event of Default:

121


        If any Event of Default (other than of a type specified in clause (6) above) occurs and is continuing under the Indenture, the Trustee or the Holders of at least 25% in principal amount of the then total outstanding Notes may declare the principal, premium, if any, interest and any other monetary obligations on all the then outstanding Notes to be due and payable immediately; provided, however , that so long as any Indebtedness permitted to be incurred under the Indenture as part of the Senior Credit Facilities shall be outstanding, no such acceleration shall be effective until the earlier of:

        Upon the effectiveness of such declaration, such principal and interest will be due and payable immediately. Notwithstanding the foregoing, in the case of an Event of Default arising under clause (6) of the first paragraph of this section, all outstanding Notes will become due and payable without further action or notice. The Indenture provides that the Trustee may withhold from the Holders notice of any continuing Default, except a Default relating to the payment of principal, premium, if any, or interest, if it determines that withholding notice is in their interest. In addition, the Trustee shall have no obligation to accelerate the Notes if in the best judgment of the Trustee acceleration is not in the best interest of the Holders of the Notes.

        The Indenture provides that the Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the then outstanding Notes by notice to the Trustee may on behalf of the Holders of all of the Notes waive any existing Default and its consequences under the Indenture except a continuing Default in the payment of interest on, premium, if any, or the principal of any Note held by a non-consenting Holder. In the event of any Event of Default specified in clause (4) above, such Event of Default and all consequences thereof (excluding any resulting payment default, other than as a result of acceleration of the Notes) shall be annulled, waived and rescinded, automatically and without any action by the Trustee or the Holders, if within 20 days after such Event of Default arose:

        Subject to the provisions of the Indenture relating to the duties of the Trustee thereunder, in case an Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the Trustee will be under no obligation to exercise any of the rights or powers under the Indenture at the request or direction of any of the Holders of the Notes

122


unless the Holders have offered to the Trustee reasonable indemnity or security against any loss, liability or expense. Except to enforce the right to receive payment of principal, premium (if any) or interest when due, no Holder of a Note may pursue any remedy with respect to the Indenture or the Notes unless:

        Subject to certain restrictions, under the Indenture the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the total outstanding Notes are given the right to direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee or of exercising any trust or power conferred on the Trustee. The Trustee, however, may refuse to follow any direction that conflicts with law or the Indenture or that the Trustee determines is unduly prejudicial to the rights of any other Holder of a Note or that would involve the Trustee in personal liability.

        The Indenture provides that the Issuer is required to deliver to the Trustee annually a statement regarding compliance with the Indenture, and the Issuer is required, within five Business Days, upon becoming aware of any Default, to deliver to the Trustee a statement specifying such Default.

No Personal Liability of Directors, Officers, Employees and Stockholders

        No director, officer, employee, incorporator or stockholder of the Issuer or any Guarantor or any of their parent companies shall have any liability for any obligations of the Issuer or the Guarantors under the Notes, the Guarantees or the Indenture or for any claim based on, in respect of, or by reason of such obligations or their creation. Each Holder by accepting Notes waives and releases all such liability. The waiver and release are part of the consideration for issuance of the Notes. Such waiver may not be effective to waive liabilities under the federal securities laws and it is the view of the SEC that such a waiver is against public policy.

Legal Defeasance and Covenant Defeasance

        The obligations of the Issuer and the Guarantors under the Indenture will terminate (other than certain obligations) and will be released upon payment in full of all of the Notes. The Issuer may, at its option and at any time, elect to have all of its obligations discharged with respect to the Notes and have the Issuer and each Guarantor's obligation discharged with respect to its Guarantee ("Legal Defeasance") and cure all then existing Events of Default except for:

123


        In addition, the Issuer may, at its option and at any time, elect to have its obligations and those of each Guarantor released with respect to certain covenants that are described in the Indenture ("Covenant Defeasance") and thereafter any omission to comply with such obligations shall not constitute a Default with respect to the Notes. In the event Covenant Defeasance occurs, certain events (not including bankruptcy, receivership, rehabilitation and insolvency events pertaining to the Issuer) described under "Events of default and remedies" will no longer constitute an Event of Default with respect to the Notes.

        In order to exercise either Legal Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance with respect to the Notes:

124


Satisfaction and discharge

        The Indenture will be discharged and will cease to be of further effect as to all Notes, when either:

        In addition, the Issuer must deliver an Officer's Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel to the Trustee stating that all conditions precedent to satisfaction and discharge have been satisfied.

125


Amendment, Supplement and Waiver

        Except as provided in the next two succeeding paragraphs, the Indenture, any Guarantee and the Notes may be amended or supplemented with the consent of the Holders of at least a majority in principal amount of the Notes then outstanding, including consents obtained in connection with a purchase of, or tender offer or exchange offer for, Notes, and any existing Default or compliance with any provision of the Indenture or the Notes issued thereunder may be waived with the consent of the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the then outstanding Notes, other than Notes beneficially owned by the Issuer or its Affiliates (including consents obtained in connection with a purchase of or tender offer or exchange offer for the Notes).

        The Indenture provides that, without the consent of each affected Holder of Notes, an amendment or waiver may not, with respect to any Notes held by a non-consenting Holder:

        Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Issuer, any Guarantor (with respect to a Guarantee or the Indenture to which it is a party) and the Trustee may amend or supplement the Indenture and any Guarantee or Notes without the consent of any Holder;

126


        The consent of the Holders is not necessary under the Indenture to approve the particular form of any proposed amendment. It is sufficient if such consent approves the substance of the proposed amendment.

Notices

        Notices given by publication will be deemed given on the first date on which publication is made and notices given by first-class mail, postage prepaid, will be deemed given five calendar days after mailing.

Concerning the Trustee

        The Indenture contains certain limitations on the rights of the Trustee thereunder, should it become a creditor of the Issuer, to obtain payment of claims in certain cases, or to realize on certain property received in respect of any such claim as security or otherwise. The Trustee is permitted to engage in other transactions; however, if it acquires any conflicting interest it must eliminate such conflict within 90 days, apply to the SEC for permission to continue or resign.

        The Indenture provides that the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding Notes will have the right to direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for exercising any remedy available to the Trustee, subject to certain exceptions. The Indenture provides that in case an Event of Default shall occur (which shall not be cured), the Trustee will be required, in the exercise of its power, to use the degree of care of a prudent person in the conduct of his own affairs. Subject to such provisions, the Trustee is under no obligation to exercise any of its rights or powers under the Indenture at the request of any Holder of the Notes, unless such Holder shall have offered to the Trustee security and indemnity satisfactory to it against any loss, liability or expense.

127



Governing Law

        The Indenture, the Notes and any Guarantee are governed by and construed in accordance with the laws of the State of New York.

Certain Definitions

        Set forth below are certain defined terms used in the Indenture. For purposes of the Indenture, unless otherwise specifically indicated, the term "consolidated" with respect to any Person refers to such Person consolidated with its Restricted Subsidiaries, and excludes from such consolidation any Unrestricted Subsidiary.

         "Acquired Indebtedness" means, with respect to any specified Person,

         "Acquisition" means the transactions contemplated by the Transaction Agreement.

         "Additional Interest" means all additional interest then owing pursuant to the Registration Rights Agreement.

         "Affiliate" of any specified Person means any other Person directly or indirectly controlling or controlled by or under direct or indirect common control with such specified Person. For purposes of this definition, "control" (including, with correlative meanings, the terms "controlling," "controlled by" and "under common control with"), as used with respect to any Person, shall mean the possession, directly or indirectly, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management or policies of such Person, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by agreement or otherwise.

         "Applicable Premium" means, with respect to any Note on any Redemption Date, the greater of:

         "Asset Sale" means:

128


         "Business Day" means each day which is not a Legal Holiday.

         "Capital Stock" means:

         "Capitalized Lease Obligation" means, at the time any determination thereof is to be made, the amount of the liability in respect of a capital lease that would at such time be required to be capitalized and reflected as a liability on a balance sheet (excluding the footnotes thereto) in accordance with GAAP.

129


         "Cash Equivalents" means:

        Notwithstanding the foregoing, Cash Equivalents shall include amounts denominated in currencies other than those set forth in clauses (1) and (2) above, provided that such amounts are converted into

130


any currency listed in clauses (1) and (2) as promptly as practicable and in any event within ten Business Days following the receipt of such amounts.

         "Change of Control" means the occurrence of any of the following:

         "Code" means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

         "Consolidated Depreciation and Amortization Expense" means with respect to any Person for any period, the total amount of depreciation and amortization expense, including the amortization of deferred financing fees of such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries for such period on a consolidated basis and otherwise determined in accordance with GAAP.

         "Consolidated Interest Expense" means, with respect to any Person for any period, without duplication, the sum of:

131


        For purposes of this definition, interest on a Capitalized Lease Obligation shall be deemed to accrue at an interest rate reasonably determined by such Person to be the rate of interest implicit in such Capitalized Lease Obligation in accordance with GAAP.

        "Consolidated Net Income" means, with respect to any Person for any period, the aggregate of the Net Income, of such Person and its Restricted Subsidiaries for such period, on a consolidated basis, and otherwise determined in accordance with GAAP; provided, however, that, without duplication,

132


        Notwithstanding the foregoing, for the purpose of the covenant described under "Certain covenants—Limitation on restricted payments" only (other than clause (3)(d) thereof), there shall be excluded from Consolidated Net Income any income arising from any sale or other disposition of Restricted Investments made by the Issuer and its Restricted Subsidiaries, any repurchases and redemptions of Restricted Investments from the Issuer and its Restricted Subsidiaries, any repayments of loans and advances which constitute Restricted Investments by the Issuer or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries, any sale of the stock of an Unrestricted Subsidiary or any distribution or dividend from an Unrestricted Subsidiary, in each case only to the extent such amounts increase the amount of Restricted Payments permitted under such covenant pursuant to clause (3)(d) thereof.

        "Consolidated Senior Debt Ratio" means, as of any date of determination, the ratio of (1) the aggregate amount of Senior Indebtedness of the Issuer and its Restricted Subsidiaries as of such date of determination, to (2) EBITDA for the period of the most recent four consecutive fiscal quarters for which internal financial statements are available, with such pro forma and other adjustments to each of Senior Indebtedness and EBITDA as are appropriate and consistent with the pro forma and other adjustment provisions set forth in the definition of Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio.

         "Contingent Obligations" means, with respect to any Person, any obligation of such Person guaranteeing any leases, dividends or other obligations that do not constitute Indebtedness ("primary obligations") of any other Person (the "primary obligor") in any manner, whether directly or indirectly, including, without limitation, any obligation of such Person, whether or not contingent,

         "Credit Facilities" means, with respect to the Issuer or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries, one or more debt facilities, including the Senior Credit Facilities, or other financing arrangements (including, without limitation, commercial paper facilities or indentures) providing for revolving credit loans, term loans, letters of credit or other long-term indebtedness, including any notes, mortgages, guarantees, collateral documents, instruments and agreements executed in connection therewith, and any amendments, supplements, modifications, extensions, renewals, restatements or refundings thereof and any indentures or credit facilities or commercial paper facilities that replace, refund or refinance any part of the loans, notes, other credit facilities or commitments thereunder, including any such replacement, refunding or refinancing facility or indenture that increases the amount permitted to be

133


borrowed thereunder or alters the maturity thereof ( provided that such increase in borrowings is permitted under "Certain covenants—Limitation on incurrence of indebtedness and issuance of disqualified stock and preferred stock") or adds Restricted Subsidiaries as additional borrowers or guarantors thereunder and whether by the same or any other agent, lender or group of lenders.

         "Default" means any event that is, or with the passage of time or the giving of notice or both would be, an Event of Default.

         "Designated Non-cash Consideration" means the fair market value of non-cash consideration received by the Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary in connection with an Asset Sale that is so designated as Designated Non-cash Consideration pursuant to an Officer's Certificate, setting forth the basis of such valuation, executed by the principal financial officer of the Issuer, less the amount of cash or Cash Equivalents received in connection with a subsequent sale of or collection on such Designated Non-cash Consideration.

         "Designated Preferred Stock" means Preferred Stock of the Issuer or any parent corporation thereof (in each case other than Disqualified Stock) that is issued for cash (other than to a Restricted Subsidiary or an employee stock ownership plan or trust established by the Issuer or any of its Subsidiaries) and is so designated as Designated Preferred Stock, pursuant to an Officer's Certificate executed by the principal financial officer of the Issuer or the applicable parent corporation thereof, as the case may be, on the issuance date thereof, the cash proceeds of which are excluded from the calculation set forth in clause (3) of the first paragraph of the "Certain covenants—Limitation on restricted payments" covenant.

         "Designated Senior Indebtedness" means:

         "Disqualified Stock" means, with respect to any Person, any Capital Stock of such Person which, by its terms, or by the terms of any security into which it is convertible or for which it is putable or exchangeable, or upon the happening of any event, matures or is mandatorily redeemable (other than solely as a result of a change of control or asset sale) pursuant to a sinking fund obligation or otherwise, or is redeemable at the option of the holder thereof (other than solely as a result of a change of control or asset sale), in whole or in part, in each case prior to the date 91 days after the earlier of the maturity date of the Notes or the date the Notes are no longer outstanding; provided, however , that if such Capital Stock is issued to any plan for the benefit of employees of the Issuer or its Subsidiaries or by any such plan to such employees, such Capital Stock shall not constitute Disqualified Stock solely because it may be required to be repurchased by the Issuer or its Subsidiaries in order to satisfy applicable statutory or regulatory obligations.

         "EBITDA" means, with respect to any Person for any period, the Consolidated Net Income of such Person for such period

134


         "EMU" means economic and monetary union as contemplated in the Treaty on European Union.

         "Equity Interests" means Capital Stock and all warrants, options or other rights to acquire Capital Stock, but excluding any debt security that is convertible into, or exchangeable for, Capital Stock.

         "Equity Offering" means any public or private sale of common stock or Preferred Stock of the Issuer or any of its direct or indirect parent companies (excluding Disqualified Stock), other than:

135


         "euro" means the single currency of participating member states of the EMU.

        " Exchange Act " means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and the rules and regulations of the SEC promulgated thereunder.

         "Excluded Contribution" means net cash proceeds, marketable securities or Qualified Proceeds received by the Issuer from

in each case designated as Excluded Contributions pursuant to an officer's certificate executed by the principal financial officer of the Issuer on the date such capital contributions are made or the date such Equity Interests are sold, as the case may be which are excluded from the calculation set forth in clause (3) of the first paragraph under "Certain covenants—Limitation on restricted payments."

         "Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio" means, with respect to any Person for any period, the ratio of EBITDA of such Person for such period to the Fixed Charges of such Person for such period. In the event that the Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary incurs, assumes, guarantees, redeems, retires or extinguishes any Indebtedness (other than Indebtedness incurred under any revolving credit facility unless such Indebtedness has been permanently repaid and has not been replaced) or issues or redeems Disqualified Stock or Preferred Stock subsequent to the commencement of the period for which the Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio is being calculated but prior to or simultaneously with the event for which the calculation of the Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio is made (the "Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio Calculation Date"), then the Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio shall be calculated giving pro forma effect to such incurrence, assumption, guarantee, redemption, retirement or extinguishment of Indebtedness, or such issuance or redemption of Disqualified Stock or Preferred Stock, as if the same had occurred at the beginning of the applicable four-quarter period.

        For purposes of making the computation referred to above, (i) Investments, acquisitions, dispositions, mergers, consolidations and disposed operations (as determined in accordance with GAAP) that have been made by the Issuer or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries during the four-quarter reference period or subsequent to such reference period and on or prior to or simultaneously with the Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio Calculation Date shall be calculated on a pro forma basis assuming that all such Investments, acquisitions, dispositions, mergers, consolidations and disposed operations (and the change in any associated fixed charge obligations and the change in EBITDA resulting therefrom) had occurred on the first day of the four-quarter reference period and (ii) dividends with respect to any Preferred Stock (including any Designated Preferred Stock) of any Person that may be paid in cash shall be treated as having been paid in cash during the four-quarter reference period. If since the beginning of such period any Person that subsequently became a Restricted Subsidiary or was merged with or into the Issuer or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries since the beginning of such period shall have made any Investment, acquisition, disposition, merger, consolidation or disposed operation that would have required adjustment pursuant to this definition, then the Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio shall be calculated giving pro forma effect thereto for such period as if such Investment, acquisition, disposition, merger, consolidation or disposed operation had occurred at the beginning of the applicable four-quarter period.

        For purposes of this definition, whenever pro forma effect is to be given to a transaction, the pro forma calculations shall be made in good faith by a responsible financial or accounting officer of the Issuer. If any Indebtedness bears a floating rate of interest and is being given pro forma effect, the interest on such Indebtedness shall be calculated as if the rate in effect on the Fixed Charge Coverage

136



Ratio Calculation Date had been the applicable rate for the entire period (taking into account any Hedging Obligations applicable to such Indebtedness). Interest on a Capitalized Lease Obligation shall be deemed to accrue at an interest rate reasonably determined by a responsible financial or accounting officer of the Issuer to be the rate of interest implicit in such Capitalized Lease Obligation in accordance with GAAP. For purposes of making the computation referred to above, interest on any Indebtedness under a revolving credit facility computed on a pro forma basis shall be computed based upon the average daily balance of such Indebtedness during the applicable period except as set forth in the first paragraph of this definition. Interest on Indebtedness that may optionally be determined at an interest rate based upon a factor of a prime or similar rate, a eurocurrency interbank offered rate, or other rate, shall be deemed to have been based upon the rate actually chosen, or, if none, then based upon such optional rate chosen as the Issuer may designate.

         "Fixed Charges" means, with respect to any Person for any period, the sum of:

         "Foreign Subsidiary" means, with respect to any Person, any Restricted Subsidiary of such Person that is not organized or existing under the laws of the United States, any state thereof or the District of Columbia and any Restricted Subsidiary of such Foreign Subsidiary.

         "GAAP" means generally accepted accounting principles in the United States which are in effect on the Issue Date.

         "Government Securities" means securities that are:

which, in either case, are not callable or redeemable at the option of the issuer thereof, and shall also include a depository receipt issued by a bank (as defined in Section 3(a)(2) of the Securities Act), as custodian with respect to any such Government Securities or a specific payment of principal of or interest on any such Government Securities held by such custodian for the account of the holder of such depository receipt; provided that (except as required by law) such custodian is not authorized to make any deduction from the amount payable to the holder of such depository receipt from any amount received by the custodian in respect of the Government Securities or the specific payment of principal of or interest on the Government Securities evidenced by such depository receipt.

         "guarantee" means a guarantee (other than by endorsement of negotiable instruments for collection in the ordinary course of business), direct or indirect, in any manner (including letters of credit and reimbursement agreements in respect thereof), of all or any part of any Indebtedness or other obligations.

         "Guarantee" means the guarantee by any Guarantor of the Issuer's Obligations under the Indenture.

         "Guarantor" means, each Restricted Subsidiary that Guarantees the Notes in accordance with the terms of the Indenture.

137


         "Hedging Obligations" means, with respect to any Person, the obligations of such Person under any interest rate swap agreement, interest rate cap agreement, interest rate collar agreement, commodity swap agreement, commodity cap agreement, commodity collar agreement, foreign exchange contract, currency swap agreement or similar agreement providing for the transfer or mitigation of interest rate or currency risks either generally or under specific contingencies.

         "Holder" means the Person in whose name a Note is registered on the registrar's books.

         "Indebtedness" means, with respect to any Person, without duplication:

if and to the extent that any of the foregoing Indebtedness (other than letters of credit and Hedging Obligations) would appear as a liability upon a balance sheet (excluding the footnotes thereto) of such Person prepared in accordance with GAAP;

provided, however , that notwithstanding the foregoing, Indebtedness shall be deemed not to include (a) Contingent Obligations incurred in the ordinary course of business or (b) obligations under or in respect of Receivables Facilities.

         "Independent Financial Advisor" means an accounting, appraisal, investment banking firm or consultant to Persons engaged in Similar Businesses of nationally recognized standing that is, in the good faith judgment of the Issuer, qualified to perform the task for which it has been engaged.

         "Initial Purchasers" means J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., UBS Securities LLC and Banc of America Securities LLC.

         "Insurance Subsidiary" means each of Community Care Indemnity Company, a Vermont corporation, and any future Subsidiary of the Issuer engaged solely in one or more of the general liability, professional liability, health and benefits and workers compensation and any other insurance businesses, providing insurance coverage for the Issuer, its Subsidiaries and any of its direct or indirect parents and the respective employees, officers or directors thereof.

138



         "Investment Grade Rating" means a rating equal to or higher than Baa3 (or the equivalent) by Moody's and BBB- (or the equivalent) by S&P, or an equivalent rating by any other Rating Agency.

         "Investment Grade Securities" means:

         "Investments" means, with respect to any Person, all investments by such Person in other Persons (including Affiliates) in the form of loans (including guarantees), advances or capital contributions (excluding accounts receivable, trade credit, advances to customers, commission, travel and similar advances to officers and employees, in each case made in the ordinary course of business), purchases or other acquisitions for consideration of Indebtedness, Equity Interests or other securities issued by any other Person and investments that are required by GAAP to be classified on the balance sheet (excluding the footnotes) of the Issuer in the same manner as the other investments included in this definition to the extent such transactions involve the transfer of cash or other property. For purposes of the definition of "Unrestricted Subsidiary" and the covenant described under "Certain covenants—Limitation on restricted payments":

         "Investors" means Vestar Capital Partners and each of its Affiliates but not including, however, any portfolio companies of any of the foregoing.

         "Issue Date" means June 29, 2006.

         "Issuer" has the meaning set forth in the first paragraph under "General"; provided that when used in the context of determining the fair market value of an asset or liability under the Indenture, "Issuer" shall be deemed to mean the board of directors of the Issuer when the fair market value is equal to or in excess of $5.0 million (unless otherwise expressly stated).

         "Legal Holiday" means a Saturday, a Sunday or a day on which commercial banking institutions are not required to be open in the State of New York.

139



         "Lien" means, with respect to any asset, any mortgage, lien (statutory or otherwise), pledge, hypothecation, charge, security interest, preference, priority or encumbrance of any kind in respect of such asset, whether or not filed, recorded or otherwise perfected under applicable law, including any conditional sale or other title retention agreement, any lease in the nature thereof, any option or other agreement to sell or give a security interest in and any filing of or agreement to give any financing statement under the Uniform Commercial Code (or equivalent statutes) of any jurisdiction; provided that in no event shall an operating lease be deemed to constitute a Lien.

         "Management Agreement" means the management agreement between certain of the management companies associated with the Investors and the Issuer.

         "Moody's" means Moody's Investors Service, Inc. and any successor to its rating agency business.

         "Mortgage Facility" means any credit facilities secured by real property of the Issuer or its Restricted Subsidiaries, including any guarantees, collateral documents, instruments and agreements executed in connection therewith, and any amendments, supplements, modifications, extensions, renewals, restatements, refundings or refinancings thereof.

         "Net Income" means, with respect to any Person, the net income (loss) of such Person, determined in accordance with GAAP and before any reduction in respect of Preferred Stock dividends.

         "Net Proceeds" means the aggregate cash proceeds and Cash Equivalents received by the Issuer or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries in respect of any Asset Sale, including any cash and Cash Equivalents received in a Permitted Asset Swap or upon the sale or other disposition or collection of any Designated Non-cash Consideration or securities received in any Asset Sale, net of the direct costs relating to such Asset Sale and the sale or disposition of such Designated Non-cash Consideration, including legal, accounting and investment banking fees, and brokerage and sales commissions, any relocation expenses incurred as a result thereof, taxes paid or payable as a result thereof (after taking into account any available tax credits or deductions and any tax sharing arrangements), amounts required to be applied to the repayment of principal, premium, if any, and interest on Senior Indebtedness required (other than required by clause (1) of the second paragraph of "Repurchase at the option of holders—Asset sales") to be paid as a result of such transaction and any deduction of appropriate amounts to be provided by the Issuer or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries as a reserve in accordance with GAAP against any liabilities associated with the asset disposed of in such transaction and retained by the Issuer or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries after such sale or other disposition thereof, including pension and other post-employment benefit liabilities and liabilities related to environmental matters or against any indemnification obligations associated with such transaction.

         "Non-Profit Subsidiary" means each of REM New Jersey Properties, Inc., a New Jersey not-for-profit corporation, MENTOR Network Charitable Foundation, Inc., a Massachusetts not-for-profit corporation, and any other entity duly acquired or formed and organized by the Issuer or any subsidiary thereof as a not-for-profit entity under applicable state law in furtherance of the business needs of the Issuer and its subsidiaries.

         "Obligations" means any principal, interest (including any interest accruing subsequent to the filing of a petition in bankruptcy, reorganization or similar proceeding at the rate provided for in the documentation with respect thereto, whether or not such interest is an allowed claim under applicable state, federal or foreign law), penalties, fees, indemnifications, reimbursements (including reimbursement obligations with respect to letters of credit and banker's acceptances), damages and other liabilities, and guarantees of payment of such principal, interest, penalties, fees, indemnifications, reimbursements, damages and other liabilities, payable under the documentation governing any Indebtedness.

         "Offering Memorandum" means the offering memorandum, dated June 23, 2006, relating to the sale of the Notes.

140



         "Officer" means the Chairman of the Board, the Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, the President, any Executive Vice President, Senior Vice President or Vice President, the Treasurer or the Secretary of the Issuer. "Officer" of any Guarantor has a correlative meaning.

         "Officer's Certificate" means a certificate signed by an Officer that meets the requirements set forth in the Indenture.

         "Opinion of Counsel" means a written opinion from legal counsel who is acceptable to the Trustee. The counsel may be an employee of or counsel to the Issuer or the Trustee.

         "Permitted Asset Swap" means the concurrent purchase and sale or exchange of Related Business Assets or a combination of Related Business Assets and cash or Cash Equivalents between the Issuer or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries and another Person; provided , that any cash or Cash Equivalents received must be applied in accordance with the "Repurchase at the option of holders—Asset sales" covenant.

         "Permitted Holders" means each of the Investors and members of management of the Issuer (or its direct parent) who are holders of Equity Interests of the Issuer (or any of its direct or indirect parent companies) on the Issue Date and any group (within the meaning of Section 13(d)(3) or Section 14(d)(2) of the Exchange Act or any successor provision) of which any of the foregoing are members; provided , that, in the case of such group and without giving effect to the existence of such group or any other group, such Investors and members of management, collectively, have beneficial ownership of more than 50% of the total voting power of the Voting Stock of the Issuer.

         "Permitted Investments" means:

141


         "Permitted Junior Securities" means:

142


provided that the term "Permitted Junior Securities" shall not include any securities distributed pursuant to a plan of reorganization if the Indebtedness under the Senior Credit Facilities is treated as part of the same class as the Notes for purposes of such plan of reorganization; provided further that to the extent that any Senior Indebtedness of the Issuer or the Guarantors outstanding on the date of consummation of any such plan of reorganization is not paid in full in cash on such date, the holders of any such Senior Indebtedness not so paid in full in cash have consented to the terms of such plan of reorganization.

         "Permitted Liens" means, with respect to any Person:

143


144


        For purposes of this definition, the term "Indebtedness" shall be deemed to include interest on such Indebtedness.

         "Person" means any individual, corporation, limited liability company, partnership, joint venture, association, joint stock company, trust, unincorporated organization, government or any agency or political subdivision thereof or any other entity.

         "Preferred Stock" means any Equity Interest with preferential rights of payment of dividends or upon liquidation, dissolution, or winding up.

         "Qualified Proceeds" means assets that are used or useful in, or Capital Stock of any Person engaged in, a Similar Business; provided that the fair market value of any such assets or Capital Stock shall be determined by the Issuer in good faith.

         "Rating Agencies" means Moody's and S&P or if Moody's or S&P or both shall not make a rating on the Notes publicly available, a nationally recognized statistical rating agency or agencies, as the case may be, selected by the Issuer which shall be substituted for Moody's or S&P or both, as the case may be.

         "Receivables Facility" means any of one or more receivables financing facilities as amended, supplemented, modified, extended, renewed, restated or refunded from time to time, the Obligations of which are non-recourse (except for customary representations, warranties, covenants and indemnities made in connection with such facilities) to the Issuer or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries (other than a Receivables Subsidiary) pursuant to which the Issuer or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries sells its

145


accounts receivable to either (a) a Person that is not a Restricted Subsidiary or (b) a Receivables Subsidiary that in turn sells its accounts receivable to a Person that is not a Restricted Subsidiary.

         "Receivables Fees" means distributions or payments made directly or by means of discounts with respect to any accounts receivable or participation interest therein issued or sold in connection with, and other fees paid to a Person that is not a Restricted Subsidiary in connection with, any Receivables Facility.

         "Receivables Subsidiary" means any Subsidiary formed for the purpose of, and that solely engages only in one or more Receivables Facilities and other activities reasonably related thereto.

         "Registration Rights Agreement" means the Registration Rights Agreement with respect to the Notes dated as of the Issue Date, among the Issuer, the Guarantors and the Initial Purchasers.

         "Related Business Assets" means assets (other than cash or Cash Equivalents) used or useful in a Similar Business, provided that any assets received by the Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary in exchange for assets transferred by the Issuer or a Restricted Subsidiary shall not be deemed to be Related Business Assets if they consist of securities of a Person, unless upon receipt of the securities of such Person, such Person would become a Restricted Subsidiary.

         "Representative" means any trustee, agent or representative (if any) for an issue of Senior Indebtedness of the Issuer.

         "Restricted Investment" means an Investment other than a Permitted Investment.

         "Restricted Subsidiary" means any direct or indirect Subsidiary of the Issuer (including any Foreign Subsidiary) that is not then an Unrestricted Subsidiary; provided, however , that upon the occurrence of an Unrestricted Subsidiary ceasing to be an Unrestricted Subsidiary, such Subsidiary shall be included in the definition of "Restricted Subsidiary."

         "S&P" means Standard & Poor's, a division of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., and any successor to its rating agency business.

         "Sale and Lease-Back Transaction" means any arrangement providing for the leasing by the Issuer or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries of any real or tangible personal property, which property has been or is to be sold or transferred by the Issuer or such Restricted Subsidiary to a third Person in contemplation of such leasing.

         "SEC" means the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission.

         "Secured Indebtedness" means any Indebtedness of the Issuer or any of its Restricted Subsidiaries secured by a Lien.

        " Securities Act " means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the rules and regulations of the SEC promulgated thereunder.

        " Senior Credit Facilities " means the Credit Facilities under the Credit Agreement to be entered into as of the Issue Date by and among the Issuer, National Mentor, Inc., the lenders party thereto in their capacities as lenders thereunder and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Administrative Agent, including any guarantees, collateral documents, instruments and agreements executed in connection therewith, and any amendments, supplements, modifications, extensions, renewals, restatements, refundings or refinancings thereof and any indentures or credit facilities or commercial paper facilities with banks or other institutional lenders or investors that replace, refund or refinance any part of the loans, notes, other credit facilities or commitments thereunder, including any such replacement, refunding or refinancing facility or indenture that increases the amount borrowable thereunder or alters the maturity thereof ( provided that such increase in borrowings is permitted under "Certain covenants—Limitation on incurrence of indebtedness and issuance of disqualified stock and preferred stock" above).

146


        " Senior Indebtedness " means:

         provided, however , that Senior Indebtedness shall not include:

        " Senior Subordinated Indebtedness " means:

        " Significant Subsidiary " means any Restricted Subsidiary that would be a "significant subsidiary" as defined in Article 1, Rule 1-02 of Regulation S-X, promulgated pursuant to the Securities Act, as such regulation is in effect on the Issue Date.

147


        " Similar Business " means any business conducted or proposed to be conducted by the Issuer and its Restricted Subsidiaries on the Issue Date or any business that is similar, reasonably related, incidental or ancillary thereto.

        " Subordinated Indebtedness " means, with respect to the Notes,

        " Subsidiary " means, with respect to any Person:

        " Total Assets " means the total assets of the Issuer and its Restricted Subsidiaries on a consolidated basis, as shown on the most recent balance sheet of the Issuer or such other Person as may be expressly stated.

        " Transaction " means the transactions contemplated by the Transaction Agreement, including the merger of NMH MergerSub, Inc. with and into the Issuer, the offering of the Notes, the borrowings under the Senior Credit Facilities as in effect on the Issue Date, the equity investment and participation by Investors and by certain members of the Issuer's management team described in the Offering Memorandum, the repayment of all outstanding indebtedness under the existing senior secured credit facility of National MENTOR, Inc. and the repurchase of the outstanding 9 5 / 8 % Senior Subordinated Notes due 2012 of National MENTOR, Inc. pursuant to the tender offer and consent solicitation.

        " Transaction Agreement " means the Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of March 22, 2006 by and among the Issuer, NMH Holdings, LLC and MergerSub, as the same may be amended prior to the Issue Date.

        " Treasury Rate " means, as of any Redemption Date, the yield to maturity as of such Redemption Date of United States Treasury securities with a constant maturity (as compiled and published in the most recent Federal Reserve Statistical Release H.15 (519) that has become publicly available at least two Business Days prior to the Redemption Date (or, if such Statistical Release is no longer published, any publicly available source of similar market data)) most nearly equal to the period from the Redemption Date to July 1, 2010; provided, however , that if the period from the Redemption Date to

148



July 1, 2010 is less than one year, the weekly average yield on actually traded United States Treasury securities adjusted to a constant maturity of one year will be used.

        " Trust Indenture Act " means the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as amended (15 U.S.C §§ 77aaa-777bbbb).

        " Unrestricted Subsidiary " means:

        The Issuer may designate any Subsidiary of the Issuer (including any existing Subsidiary and any newly acquired or newly formed Subsidiary) to be an Unrestricted Subsidiary unless such Subsidiary or any of its Subsidiaries owns any Equity Interests or Indebtedness of, or owns or holds any Lien on, any property of, the Issuer or any Subsidiary of the Issuer (other than solely any Subsidiary of the Subsidiary to be so designated); provided that

has not at the time of designation, and does not thereafter, create, incur, issue, assume, guarantee or otherwise become directly or indirectly liable with respect to any Indebtedness pursuant to which the lender has recourse to any of the assets of the Issuer or any Restricted Subsidiary.

        The Issuer may designate any Unrestricted Subsidiary to be a Restricted Subsidiary; provided that, immediately after giving effect to such designation, no Default shall have occurred and be continuing and either:

in each case on a pro forma basis taking into account such designation.

        Any such designation by the Issuer shall be notified by the Issuer to the Trustee by promptly filing with the Trustee a copy of the resolution of the board of directors of the Issuer or any committee thereof giving effect to such designation and an Officer's Certificate certifying that such designation complied with the foregoing provisions.

        " Voting Stock " of any Person as of any date means the Capital Stock of such Person that is at the time entitled to vote in the election of the board of directors of such Person.

149



        " Weighted Average Life to Maturity " means, when applied to any Indebtedness, Disqualified Stock or Preferred Stock, as the case may be, at any date, the quotient obtained by dividing:

        " Wholly-Owned Subsidiary " of any Person means a Subsidiary of such Person, 100% of the outstanding Equity Interests of which (other than directors' qualifying shares) shall at the time be owned by such Person or by one or more Wholly-Owned Subsidiaries of such Person.

Registration Rights

        The Issuer and the Guarantors entered into a Registration Rights Agreement with the Initial Purchasers on the Issue Date. In that agreement, the Issuer and the Guarantors agreed for the benefit of the Holders that they would use their reasonable best efforts to file with the SEC and cause to become effective a registration statement relating to an offer to exchange the Notes for an issue of SEC-registered notes (the "Exchange Notes") with terms identical to the outstanding notes (except that the Exchange Notes will not be subject to restrictions on transfer or to any increase in annual interest rate as described below).

        When the SEC declares the exchange offer registration statement effective, the Exchange Notes will be offered in return for the outstanding notes. The exchange offer will remain open for at least 20 business days after the date notice of such exchange offer is mailed to the Holders. For each outstanding note surrendered under the exchange offer, the Holders will receive an Exchange Note of equal principal amount. Interest on each Exchange Note will accrue from the last interest payment date on which interest was paid on the outstanding notes or, if no interest has been paid on the outstanding notes, from the Issue Date.

        If applicable law or interpretations of the staff of the SEC do not permit the Issuer and the Guarantors to effect the exchange offer, the exchange offer is for any other reason not completed on or before the date that is 270 days after the Issue Date or the Initial Purchasers shall so request, the Issuer and the Guarantors will use their reasonable best efforts to cause to become effective a shelf registration statement relating to resales of the outstanding notes and to keep that shelf registration statement effective until the expiration of the time period referred to in Rule 144(k) under the Securities Act, or such shorter period that will terminate when all Notes covered by the shelf registration statement have been sold. The Issuer and the Guarantors will, in the event of such a shelf registration, provide to each Holder a copy of a prospectus, notify each Holder when the shelf registration statement has become effective and take certain other actions to permit resales of the outstanding notes. A Holder that sells outstanding notes under the shelf registration statement generally will be required to be named as a selling security holder in the related prospectus and to deliver a prospectus to purchasers, will be subject to certain of the civil liability provisions under the Securities Act in connection with those sales and will be bound by the provisions of the Registration Rights Agreement that are applicable to such a Holder (including certain indemnification obligations).

        If the exchange offer is not completed on or before the date that is 270 days after the Issue Date (or, if required, the shelf registration statement is not declared effective on or before the date that is 270 days after the Issue Date), the annual interest rate borne by the outstanding notes will be increased by 0.25% per annum for the first 90-day period immediately following such date and such rate will increase by an additional 0.25% per annum with respect to each subsequent 90-day period up to a

150



maximum additional interest rate of 1.00% per annum thereafter until the exchange offer is completed or the shelf registration statement is declared effective.

        If the exchange offer is effected, the Issuer will be entitled to close the exchange offer 20 business days after its commencement, provided that it has accepted all outstanding notes validly surrendered in accordance with the terms of the exchange offer. Outstanding notes not tendered in the exchange offer will be subject to all the terms and conditions specified in the Indenture, including transfer restrictions.

        This summary of the provisions of the Registration Rights Agreement does not purport to be complete and is subject to, and is qualified in its entirety by reference to, all the provisions of the Registration Rights Agreement, a copy of which is available from the Issuer upon request.

151



DESCRIPTION OF OTHER INDEBTEDNESS

Senior Secured Credit Facilities

Overview

        In connection with the Transactions, we entered into a new senior secured credit agreement with J.P. Morgan Securities Inc. and UBS Securities LLC, as joint lead arrangers, J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., UBS Securities LLC and Banc of America Securities LLC, as joint bookrunners, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent, UBS Securities LLC, as syndication agent, and Bank of America, N.A. and General Electric Capital Corporation, as co-documentation agents. The following description is only a summary of certain material provisions of the new senior secured credit facilities, does not purport to be complete and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the provisions of that agreement.

        The new senior secured credit facilities provide senior secured financing of $480.0 million, consisting of:

        The new senior secured revolving credit facility includes borrowing capacity available for letters of credit and for borrowings on same-day notice referred to as the swingline loans.

        To the extent letters of credit are issued under the synthetic letter of credit facility, the lenders thereunder will pre-fund their participations in such letters of credit to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as administrative agent, to be held by the administrative agent in a credit-linked deposit account. The administrative agent will pay to such lenders a rate per annum equal to one-month LIBOR on the amount on deposit in the credit-linked account, minus 0.15% per annum in administrative costs. To the extent we do not reimburse the relevant issuing bank for draws under letters of credit issued under the synthetic letter of credit facility, the deposit-account agent will apply funds on deposit in the credit-linked deposit account to reimburse such issuing bank.

        Subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions and to the participation of lenders, we are permitted to add additional term loan facilities or synthetic letter of credit facilities or to increase the commitments under the senior secured revolving credit facility in an aggregate amount not exceeding $100.0 million. Any such additional facilities will be secured and guaranteed with the other senior secured facilities on a pari passu basis.

Interest Rates and Fees

        Borrowings under the new senior secured credit facilities bear interest at a rate equal to an applicable margin plus, at our option, either (a) a base rate determined by reference to the higher of (1) the prime rate of JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and (2) the federal funds rate plus 1 / 2 of 1% or (b) a LIBOR rate determined by reference to the costs of funds for deposits in dollars for the interest period relevant to such borrowing adjusted for certain additional costs. The initial interest rate for borrowings is currently LIBOR plus a margin of 2.50%. The applicable margin for borrowings under the new senior secured credit facilities may be adjusted subject to our attaining certain leverage ratios.

        In addition to paying interest on outstanding principal under the new senior secured credit facilities, we pay a commitment fee to the lenders under the new senior secured revolving credit facility in respect of the average daily unutilized commitments thereunder. The initial commitment fee rate applicable to the senior secured revolving facility is 0.50% per annum. We also pay to the lenders under the synthetic letter of credit facility a facility fee equal to the margin with respect to LIBOR loans under the term loan facility plus 0.15% per annum. We also pay customary letter of credit fees.

152



Prepayments

        The new senior secured credit agreement requires us to prepay outstanding term loans, subject to certain exceptions, with:

        We may voluntarily repay outstanding loans under the new senior secured credit facilities at any time without premium or penalty, subject to certain exceptions, other than customary "breakage" costs with respect to LIBOR loans.

Amortization

        We are required to repay installments on the loans under the new senior secured term loan facility in quarterly principal amounts of 0.25% of the funded total principal amount for the first six years and nine months, with the remaining amount payable on the date that is seven years from the date of the closing of the new senior secured credit facilities.

        Principal amounts outstanding under the new senior secured revolving credit facility are due and payable in full at maturity, six years from the date of the closing of the new senior secured credit facilities.

        The administrative agent will be required to repay amounts on deposit in the credit-linked account to the lenders under the synthetic letter of credit facility on the date that is seven years from the date of the closing of the new senior secured credit facilities.

Guarantees and Security

        All obligations under the new senior secured credit facilities are unconditionally guaranteed by the Parent and, subject to certain exceptions, certain of our existing and future domestic subsidiaries, referred to in this section, collectively as "Guarantors."

        All obligations under the new senior secured credit facilities, and the guarantees of those obligations, are secured by the following assets, subject to certain exceptions:


Certain Covenants and Events of Default

        The new senior secured credit agreement contains a number of covenants that, among other things, restrict, subject to certain exceptions, our ability to:

153


        In addition, the new senior secured credit agreement requires us to maintain the following financial covenants:

        The new senior secured credit agreement also contains certain customary affirmative covenants and events of default.

Mortgage Facility

        In May 2005, our subsidiaries REM Arrowhead, Inc., REM Connecticut Community Services, Inc., REM Indiana, Inc., REM North Dakota, Inc., REM Wisconsin, Inc., REM Wisconsin II, Inc and REM Wisconsin III, Inc. entered as borrowers into a five year $8,000,000 term loan agreement, which we refer to herein as the mortgage facility, with Bank of America, N.A., which we refer to herein as the lender. We may add additional subsidiaries as borrowers from time to time by notice to the lender. Additionally, we and National MENTOR, Inc. signed the mortgage facility as guarantors. We have an option to request that the mortgage facility be increased by an amount not exceeding $4,000,000, although any such increase is subject to the consent of the lender.

        Borrowings under the mortgage facility may be used to acquire or refinance real property to be utilized in the business of the borrowers, in amounts of not more than $250,000 per acquisition. At any time, borrowings under the mortgage facility are generally available only to the extent of the value of the borrowers' "borrowing base" at such time, which consists of 75% of the aggregate appraised value of all acquired real property that secures the mortgage facility. Subject to such availability, loans may be borrowed until February 20, 2010. On September 30, 2006, loans in an amount equal to $5.5 million were outstanding under the mortgage facility.

        The borrowers are required to repay installments on the loans under the mortgage facility in equal monthly principal amounts based on different amortization schedules for each borrower ranging from five years to 20 years. Any loans outstanding on May 20, 2010, the maturity date, shall be repaid on such date.

Interest Rates and Fees

        Borrowings under the mortgage facility bear interest monthly in arrears at a rate equal to an applicable margin plus, at our option, either (a) a base rate determined by reference to the higher of (1) the prime rate of the lender and (2) the federal funds rate plus 1 / 2 of 1% or (b) a floating

154



one-month LIBOR rate determined by reference to the costs of funds for deposits in dollars for a one-month interest period as of the first business day of each month, adjusted for certain additional costs. The current applicable margins are 1.50% for base rate loans and 3.75% for LIBOR rate loans, each of which may be adjusted subject to our attaining certain leverage ratios.

Prepayments

        Voluntary prepayments and optional reductions of the unutilized portion of the mortgage facility commitment are permitted in whole or in part at any time, subject to minimum prepayment requirements. The borrowers are required to prepay loans attributable to a mortgaged property with the net proceeds of any sale of such mortgaged property and with certain insurance proceeds received in connection with such mortgaged property, subject to certain exceptions. Additionally, at any time that amounts outstanding under the mortgage facility exceed the borrowing base, the borrowers are required to prepay amounts outstanding under the mortgage facility in an amount equal to such excess.

Guarantees

        The obligations of each borrower under the mortgage facility are unconditionally guaranteed by us, National MENTOR, Inc. and each other borrower. All obligations under the mortgage facility, and the guarantees of those obligations, are secured by mortgages on each property acquired or refinanced with the proceeds of the loans.

Certain Covenants and Events of Default

        The mortgage facility contains a number of covenants that, among other things, restrict, subject to certain exceptions, our ability to:

        In addition, the mortgage facility requires us to maintain the following financial covenants:

        The mortgage facility also contains certain customary affirmative covenants and events of default.

155



BOOK-ENTRY SETTLEMENT AND CLEARANCE

The Global Notes

        The exchange notes issued in exchange for outstanding notes will be represented by global notes in definitive, fully registered form, without interest coupons (collectively, the "global notes").

        Upon issuance, the global notes will be deposited with the Trustee as custodian for The Depository Trust Company ("DTC") and registered in the name of Cede & Co., as nominee of DTC.

        Ownership of beneficial interests in each global note will be limited to persons who have accounts with DTC ("DTC participants") or persons who hold interests through DTC participants. We expect that under procedures established by DTC:

        Beneficial interests in the global notes may not be exchanged for notes in physical, certificated form except in the limited circumstances described below.

Book-entry Procedures for the Global Notes

        All interests in the global notes will be subject to the operations and procedures of DTC, Euroclear and Clearstream. We provide the following summaries of those operations and procedures solely for the convenience of investors. The operations and procedures of each settlement system are controlled by that settlement system and may be changed at any time. Neither we nor the initial purchasers are responsible for those operations or procedures.

        DTC has advised us that it is:

        DTC was created to hold securities for its participants and to facilitate the clearance and settlement of securities transactions between its participants through electronic book-entry changes to the accounts of its participants. DTC's participants include securities brokers and dealers, including the initial purchasers; banks and trust companies; clearing corporations and other organizations. Indirect access to DTC's system is also available to others such as banks, brokers, dealers and trust companies; these indirect participants clear through or maintain a custodial relationship with a DTC participant, either directly or indirectly. Investors who are not DTC participants may beneficially own securities held by or on behalf of DTC only through DTC participants or indirect participants in DTC.

156



        So long as DTC's nominee is the registered owner of a global note, that nominee will be considered the sole owner or holder of the notes represented by that global note for all purposes under the indenture. Except as provided below, owners of beneficial interests in a global note:

        As a result, each investor who owns a beneficial interest in a global note must rely on the procedures of DTC to exercise any rights of a holder of notes under the indenture (and, if the investor is not a participant or an indirect participant in DTC, on the procedures of the DTC participant through which the investor owns its interest).

        Payments of principal, premium (if any) and interest with respect to the notes represented by a global note will be made by the Trustee to DTC's nominee as the registered holder of the global note. Neither we nor the Trustee will have any responsibility or liability for the payment of amounts to owners of beneficial interests in a global note, for any aspect of the records relating to or payments made on account of those interests by DTC, or for maintaining, supervising or reviewing any records of DTC relating to those interests.

        Payments by participants and indirect participants in DTC to the owners of beneficial interests in a global note will be governed by standing instructions and customary industry practice and will be the responsibility of those participants or indirect participants and DTC.

        Transfers between participants in DTC will be effected under DTC's procedures and will be settled in same-day funds. Transfers between participants in Euroclear or Clearstream will be effected in the ordinary way under the rules and operating procedures of those systems.

        Cross-market transfers between DTC participants, on the one hand, and Euroclear or Clearstream participants, on the other hand, will be effected within DTC through the DTC participants that are acting as depositaries for Euroclear and Clearstream. To deliver or receive an interest in a global note held in a Euroclear or Clearstream account, an investor must send transfer instructions to Euroclear or Clearstream, as the case may be, under the rules and procedures of that system and within the established deadlines of that system. If the transaction meets its settlement requirements, Euroclear or Clearstream, as the case may be, will send instructions to its DTC depositary to take action to effect final settlement by delivering or receiving interests in the relevant global notes in DTC, and making or receiving payment under normal procedures for same-day funds settlement applicable to DTC. Euroclear and Clearstream participants may not deliver instructions directly to DTC depositaries that are acting for Euroclear or Clearstream.

        Because of time zone differences, the securities account of a Euroclear or Clearstream participant that purchases an interest in a global note from a DTC participant will be credited on the business day for Euroclear or Clearstream immediately following the DTC settlement date. Cash received in Euroclear or Clearstream from the sale of an interest in a global note to a DTC participant will be received with value on the DTC settlement date but will be available in the relevant Euroclear or Clearstream cash account as of the business day for Euroclear or Clearstream following the DTC settlement date.

        DTC, Euroclear and Clearstream have agreed to the above procedures to facilitate transfers of interests in the global notes among participants in those settlement systems. However, the settlement systems are not obligated to perform these procedures and may discontinue or change these procedures at any time. Neither we nor the Trustee will have any responsibility for the performance by DTC,

157



Euroclear or Clearstream or their participants or indirect participants of their obligations under the rules and procedures governing their operations.

Certificated Notes

        Notes in physical, certificated form will be issued and delivered to each person that DTC identifies as a beneficial owner of the related notes only if:

158



CERTAIN UNITED STATES FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES

Exchange of Notes

        The exchange of exchange notes for outstanding notes in the exchange offer will not constitute a taxable event to holders. Consequently, no gain or loss will be recognized by a holder upon receipt of an exchange note, the holding period of the exchange note will include the holding period of the outstanding note and the basis of the exchange note will be the same as the basis of the outstanding note immediately before the exchange.

         In any event, persons considering the exchange of exchange notes for outstanding notes should consult their own tax advisors concerning the United States federal income tax consequences in light of their particular situations as well as any consequences arising under the laws of any other taxing jurisdiction.

159



CERTAIN ERISA CONSIDERATIONS

        The following is a summary of certain considerations associated with the purchase of the notes (and exchange notes) by employee benefit plans that are subject to Title I of ERISA, plans, individual retirement accounts and other arrangements that are subject to Section 4975 of the Code or provisions under any federal, state, local, non-U.S. or other laws, rules or regulations that are similar to such provisions of ERISA or the Code (collectively, "Similar Laws"), and entities whose underlying assets are considered to include "plan assets" of any such plan, account or arrangement (each, a "Plan").

General Fiduciary Matters

        ERISA and the Code impose certain duties on persons who are fiduciaries of a Plan subject to Title I of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code (an "ERISA Plan") and prohibit certain transactions involving the assets of an ERISA Plan and its fiduciaries or other interested parties. Under ERISA and the Code, any person who exercises any discretionary authority or control over the administration of such an ERISA Plan or the management or disposition of the assets of such an ERISA Plan, or who renders investment advice for a fee or other compensation to such an ERISA Plan, is generally considered to be a fiduciary of the ERISA Plan.

        In considering an investment in the notes (or the exchange notes) of a portion of the assets of any Plan, a fiduciary should determine whether the investment is in accordance with the documents and instruments governing the Plan and the applicable provisions of ERISA, the Code or any Similar Law relating to a fiduciary's duties to the Plan including, without limitation, the prudence, diversification, delegation of control and prohibited transaction provisions of ERISA, the Code and any other applicable Similar Laws.

Prohibited Transaction Issues

        Section 406 of ERISA and Section 4975 of the Code prohibit ERISA Plans from engaging in specified transactions involving plan assets with persons or entities who are "parties in interest," within the meaning of ERISA, or "disqualified persons," within the meaning of Section 4975 of the Code, unless an exemption is available. A party in interest or disqualified person who engages in a nonexempt prohibited transaction may be subject to excise taxes and other penalties and liabilities under ERISA and the Code. In addition, the fiduciary of the ERISA Plan that engages in such a non-exempt prohibited transaction may be subject to penalties and liabilities under ERISA and/or the Code. The acquisition and/or holding of notes (or exchange notes) by an ERISA Plan with respect to which the issuer, initial purchasers or the guarantors are considered a party in interest or disqualified person may constitute or result in a direct or indirect prohibited transaction under Section 406 of ERISA and/or Section 4975 of the Code, unless the investment is acquired and is held in accordance with an applicable statutory, class or individual prohibited transaction exemption. In this regard, the United States Department of Labor has issued prohibited transaction class exemptions ("PTCEs") that may apply to the acquisition and holding of the notes (and the exchange notes). These class exemptions include, without limitation, PTCE 84-14 respecting transactions determined by independent qualified professional asset managers, PTCE 90-1, respecting insurance company pooled separate accounts, PTCE 91-38, respecting bank collective investment funds, PTCE 95-60, respecting life insurance company general accounts and PTCE 96-23, respecting transactions determined by in-house asset managers, although there can be no assurance that all of the conditions of any such exemptions will be satisfied. Because of the foregoing, the notes (and the exchange notes) should not be purchased or held by any person investing "plan assets" of any ERISA Plan, unless such purchase and holding (and the exchange of notes for exchange notes) will not constitute a non-exempt prohibited transaction under ERISA and the Code or a violation of any applicable Similar Laws.

160



Representation

        Accordingly, by acceptance of a note (or an exchange note), each purchaser and subsequent transferee will be deemed to have represented and warranted that either (i) no portion of the assets used by such purchaser or transferee to acquire or hold the notes (or the exchange notes) constitutes assets of any Plan or (ii) the purchase and holding of the notes (or the exchange notes) and the exchange of notes for exchange notes by such purchaser or transferee will not constitute a non-exempt prohibited transaction under Section 406 of ERISA or Section 4975 of the Code or a violation under any applicable Similar Laws.

        The foregoing discussion is general in nature and is not intended to be all-inclusive. Due to the complexity of these rules and the penalties that may be imposed upon persons involved in non-exempt prohibited transactions, it is particularly important that fiduciaries or other persons considering purchasing the notes (or the exchange notes) on behalf of, or with the assets of, any Plan, consult with their counsel regarding the potential applicability of ERISA, Section 4975 of the Code and any Similar Laws and the exchange notes to such transactions and whether an exemption would be applicable to the purchase and holding of the notes and the exchange notes.

161



PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION

        Each broker-dealer that receives exchange notes for its own account pursuant to the exchange offer must acknowledge that it will deliver a prospectus in connection with any resale of the exchange notes. This prospectus, as it may be amended or supplemented from time to time, may be used by a broker-dealer in connection with resales of exchange notes received in exchange for outstanding notes where the outstanding notes were acquired as a result of market-making activities or other trading activities. To the extent any such broker-dealer participates in the exchange offer, we have agreed that for a period of up to 90 days, we will use our reasonable best efforts to make this prospectus, as amended or supplemented, available to such broker-dealer for use in connection with any such resale, and will deliver as many additional copies of this prospectus and each amendment or supplement to this prospectus and any documents incorporated by reference in this prospectus as such broker-dealer may reasonably request.

        We will not receive any proceeds from any sale of exchange notes by broker-dealers. Exchange notes received by broker-dealers for their own accounts pursuant to the exchange offer may be sold from time to time in one or more transactions in the over-the-counter market, in negotiated transactions, through the writing of options on the exchange notes or a combination of these methods of resale, at market prices prevailing at the time of resale, at prices related to the prevailing market prices or negotiated prices. Any resale may be made directly to purchasers or to or through brokers or dealers who may receive compensation in the form of commissions or concessions from any broker-dealer or the purchasers of any exchange notes. Any broker-dealer that resells exchange notes that were received by it for its own account pursuant to the exchange offer and any broker or dealer that participates in a distribution of the exchange notes may be deemed to be an "underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act and any profit on any resale of exchange notes and any commissions or concessions received by these persons may be deemed to be underwriting compensation under the Securities Act. The letter of transmittal states that by acknowledging that it will deliver and by delivering a prospectus, a broker-dealer will not be deemed to admit that it is an "underwriter" within the meaning of the Securities Act.

        We have agreed to pay all expenses incident to the exchange offer and will indemnify the holders of outstanding notes, including any broker-dealers, against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the Securities Act.

162



LEGAL MATTERS

        The validity of the exchange notes and certain exchange guarantees will be passed upon by Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP. Certain matters under Arizona law will be passed upon by Jennings, Strouss & Salmon P.L.C. Certain matters under California, Colorado, Connecticut, Iowa and Utah will be passed upon by Foley & Lardner LLP. Certain matters under Illinois law will be passed upon by Kirkland & Ellis LLP. Certain matters under Indiana law will be passed upon by Barnes & Thornburg LLP. Certain matters under Maryland law will be passed upon by Whiteford, Taylor & Preston L.L.P. Certain matters under Massachusetts law will be passed upon by Choate Hall & Stewart LLP. Certain matters under Minnesota law will be passed upon by Hinshaw & Culbertson LLP. Certain matters under Nevada law will be passed upon by Woodburn and Wedge. Certain matters under New Jersey law will be passed upon by Giordano, Halleran & Ciesla A Professional Corporation. Certain matters under North Dakota law will be passed upon by the Vogel Law Firm. Certain matters under Ohio law will be passed upon by Frost Brown Todd LLC. Certain matters under Pennsylvania law will be passed upon by Reed Smith LLP. Certain matters under South Carolina law will be passed upon by Parker Poe Adams & Bernstein LLP. Certain matters under West Virginia law will be passed upon by Robinson & McElwee PLLC. Certain matters under Wisconsin law will be passed upon by Michael Best & Friedrich LLP.


EXPERTS

        The consolidated financial statements of National MENTOR Holdings, Inc. at September 30, 2006 and 2005, and for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006, the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and for the years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004, appearing in this prospectus have been audited by Ernst & Young LLP, independent registered public accounting firm, as set forth in their report appearing elsewhere herein and are included in reliance upon such report given on the authority of such firm as experts in accounting and auditing.


AVAILABLE INFORMATION

        We have filed with the SEC a registration statement on Form S-4 under the Securities Act with respect to the exchange notes. This prospectus, which forms a part of the registration statement, does not contain all of the information set forth in the registration statement. For further information with respect to us and the exchange notes, reference is made to the registration statement. Statements contained in this prospectus as to the contents of any contract or other document are not necessarily complete, and, where such contract or other document is an exhibit to the registration statement, each such statement is qualified by the provisions in such exhibit to which reference is hereby made. National Mentor Holdings, Inc. has historically filed annual, quarterly and current reports, proxy statements and other information with the SEC. We are not currently subject to the informational requirements of the Exchange Act. As a result of the offering of the exchange notes, we will become subject to the informational requirements of the Exchange Act and, in accordance therewith, will file reports and other information with the SEC. The registration statement, historical information about National Mentor Holdings, Inc. and other information can be inspected and copied at the Public Reference Room of the SEC located at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington D.C. 20549. Copies of such materials, including copies of all or any portion of the registration statement, can be obtained from the Public Reference Room of the SEC at prescribed rates. You can call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 to obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room. Such materials may also be accessed electronically by means of the SEC's home page on the Internet (http://www.sec.gov).

163


INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Audited Consolidated Financial Statements for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006, the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and the years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004    

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

F-2

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of September 30, 2006 (Successor) and September 30, 2005 (Predecessor)

 

F-3

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 (Successor), the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 (Predecessor) and for the Years Ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 (Predecessor)

 

F-4

Consolidated Statements of Redeemable Preferred Stock and Shareholders' Equity for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 (Successor), the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 (Predecessor) and for the Years Ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 (Predecessor)

 

F-5

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 (Successor), the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 (Predecessor) and for the Years Ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 (Predecessor)

 

F-6

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

F-7

F-1



Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To The Board of Directors and Audit Committee of National Mentor Holdings, Inc.

        We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of National Mentor Holdings, Inc. as of September 30, 2006 (successor) and 2005 (predecessor), and the related consolidated statements of operations, redeemable preferred stock and shareholders' equity, and cash flows for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 (successor), the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 (predecessor) and the years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 (predecessor). These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

        We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. We were not engaged to perform an audit of the Company's internal control over financial reporting. Our audits included consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

        In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of National Mentor Holdings, Inc. at September 30, 2006 (successor) and 2005 (predecessor), and the consolidated results of its operations and its cash flows for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 (successor), the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 (predecessor) and the years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 (predecessor), in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

        As discussed in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements, effective October 1, 2005, the Company adopted Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 123(R), Share-Based Payments, using the prospective transition method.

                        /s/ Ernst & Young LLP

Boston, Massachusetts
December 22, 2006

F-2



National Mentor Holdings, Inc.

Consolidated Balance Sheets

 
  Successor
September 30
2006

  Predecessor
September 30
2005

 
 
  (Amounts in thousands, except share amounts)

 
Assets              
Current assets:              
  Cash and cash equivalents   $ 29,015   $ 29,307  
  Accounts receivable, net of allowances of $1,208 and $2,800 at September 30, 2006 and 2005, respectively     98,791     83,528  
Deferred tax assets, net     5,843     3,829  
Prepaid expenses and other current assets     22,313     12,574  
   
 
 
Total current assets     155,962     129,238  
  Property and equipment, net     134,008     114,166  
  Intangible assets, net     505,060     104,571  
  Goodwill     184,375     91,263  
  Other assets     21,260     10,200  
   
 
 
Total assets   $ 1,000,665   $ 449,438  
   
 
 

Liabilities and shareholders' equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Current liabilities:              
  Accounts payable   $ 21,169   $ 14,812  
  Accrued payroll and related costs     48,432     33,678  
  Other accrued liabilities     26,798     19,957  
  Obligations under capital lease, current     393      
  Current portion of long-term debt     3,747     11,601  
   
 
 
Total current liabilities     100,539     80,048  
  Other long-term liabilities     3,548     3,048  
  Deferred tax liabilities, net     130,709     10,602  
  Obligations under capital lease, less-current portion     383      
  Long-term debt, less current portion     516,618     319,430  
Commitments and contingencies ( Note 15 and 16 )              

Shareholders' equity:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
  Common stock, $.01 par value; 1,000 and 20,000,000 shares authorized at September 30, 2006 (Successor) and 2005 (Predecessor), respectively, 100 and 10,203,109 shares issued and outstanding at September 30, 2006 (Successor) and 2005 (Predecessor), respectively         102  
  Additional paid-in capital     253,627     42,023  
  Other comprehensive loss, net of tax     (1,095 )    
  Note receivable from officer         (49 )
  Accumulated deficit     (3,664 )   (5,766 )
   
 
 
Total shareholders' equity     248,868     36,310  
   
 
 
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity   $ 1,000,665   $ 449,438  
   
 
 

See accompanying notes.

F-3



National Mentor Holdings, Inc.

Consolidated Statements of Operations

 
  (Amounts in thousands)

 
 
  Successor
   
   
   
 
 
  Period from
June 30
through

  Predecessor
 
 
  Period from
October 1
through

  Years ended
September 30

 
 
  September 30, 2006
 
 
  June 29, 2006
  2005
  2004
 
Net revenues   $ 208,881   $ 580,356   $ 693,826   $ 648,493  
Cost of revenues     160,164     439,878     524,618     491,884  
   
 
 
 
 
Gross profit     48,717     140,478     169,208     156,609  
Operating expenses:                          
  General and administrative     29,738     78,608     93,491     86,856  
  Stock option settlement         26,880          
  Transaction costs         9,136          
  Depreciation and amortization     11,714     17,539     21,743     21,484  
   
 
 
 
 
Total operating expenses     41,452     132,163     115,234     108,340  
   
 
 
 
 
Income from operations     7,265     8,315     53,974     48,269  
Other income (expense):                          
Management fee of related party     (227 )   (198 )   (270 )   (257 )
Other expense, net     (60 )   (177 )   (192 )   (2,581 )
Interest income     256     646     661     68  
Interest expense     (13,120 )   (51,719 )   (29,905 )   (26,893 )
   
 
 
 
 
(Loss) income before (benefit) provision for income taxes     (5,886 )   (43,133 )   24,268     18,606  
(Benefit) provision for income taxes     (2,222 )   (11,347 )   10,270     8,423  
   
 
 
 
 
Net (loss) income   $ (3,664 ) $ (31,786 ) $ 13,998   $ 10,183  
   
 
 
 
 

See accompanying notes.

F-4


National Mentor Holdings, Inc.
Consolidated Statements of Redeemable Preferred Stock
and Shareholders' Equity
(Amounts in thousands, except share amounts)

 
  Redeemable
Class A
Preferred Stock

   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
   
 
 
  Common Stock
   
   
   
  Note
Receivable
From
Officer

  (Accumulated
Deficit)
Retained
Earnings

   
   
 
 
  Additional
Paid-in
Capital

  Deferred
Compensation

  Other
Comprehensive
Loss

  Total
Shareholders'
Equity

  Comprehensive
Income

 
 
  Shares
  Amount
  Shares
  Amount
 
Balance at September 30, 2003 (Predecessor)   86,544     101,283   10,328,498     103     41,755     (57 )       (49 )   (11,120 )   30,632        
Issuance of Redeemable Class A preferred stock and common stock   30     30   24,370         170                     170      
Deferred compensation related to stock options                 332     (300 )               32      
Deferred compensation amortization related to stock options                     26                 26      
Forfeiture of stock options                 (5 )   2                 (3 )    
Accrued dividends on Redeemable Class A preferred stock       15,068                           (15,068 )   (15,068 )    
Other comprehensive loss related to interest rate swap                         (203 )           (203 )   (203 )
Net income                                 10,183     10,183     10,183  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Comprehensive income                                       $ 9,980  
                                                           
 
Balance at September 30, 2004 (Predecessor)   86,574     116,381   10,352,868     103     42,252     (329 )   (203 )   (49 )   (16,005 )   25,769        
Accrued dividends on Redeemable Class A preferred stock       1,533                           (1,533 )   (1,533 )    
Redemption of Redeemable Class A preferred stock and common stock   (86,574 )   (118,453 )                                  
Repurchase and retirement of common stock         (149,759 )   (1 )                   (2,226 )   (2,227 )    
Deferred compensation amortization related to Stock Options                     100                 100      
Repayment of note receivable from officer       539                                    
Settlement of interest rate swap                         203             203     203  
Net income                                 13,998     13,998     13,998  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Comprehensive income                                       $ 14,201  
                                                           
 
Balance at September 30, 2005 (Predecessor)     $   10,203,109   $ 102   $ 42,252   $ (229 ) $   $ (49 ) $ (5,766 ) $ 36,310        
Repurchase and retirement of common stock         (66,124 )   (1 )                   (1,487 )   (1,488 )    
Deferred compensation amortization related to Stock Options                     59                 59      
Stock based compensation                 525                     525      
Repayment of note receivable from officer                             49         49      
Net loss                                 (31,786 )   (31,786 )   (31,786 )
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Comprehensive loss                                       $ (31,786 )
                                                           
 
Balance at June 29, 2006 (Predecessor)     $   10,136,985   $ 101   $ 42,777   $ (170 ) $   $   $ (39,039 ) $ 3,669        
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       
Equity contributions from NMH Investment, LLC             100       $ 253,627                   $ 253,627        
Other comprehensive loss related to interest rate swap, net of tax                             (1,095 )           (1,095 )   (1,095 )
Net loss                                     (3,664 )   (3,664 )   (3,664 )
             
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Comprehensive loss                                           $ (4,759 )
                                                           
 
Balance at September 30, 2006 (Successor)             100   $   $ 253,627   $   $ (1,095 ) $   $ (3,664 ) $ 248,868        
             
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
       

See accompanying notes.

F-5



National Mentor Holdings, Inc.

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

 
  (Amounts in thousands)

 
 
  Successor
   
   
   
 
 
  Period from
June 30
through

  Predecessor
 
 
  Period from
October 1
through

  Years ended
September 30

 
 
  September 30, 2006
 
 
  June 29, 2006
  2005
  2004
 
Operating activities                          
Net (loss) income   $ (3,664 ) $ (31,786 ) $ 13,998   $ 10,183  
Adjustments to reconcile net (loss) income to net cash (used in) provided by operating activities:                          
  Accounts receivable allowances     1,412     3,641     9,341     6,114  
  Depreciation and amortization of property and equipment     4,112     10,276     13,023     12,262  
  Amortization of intangible assets     7,602     7,263     8,720     9,222  
  Amortization of deferred debt financing costs     743     8,634     2,419     5,855  
  Amortization of excess tax goodwill         305     182     141  
  Stock based compensation         583     100     58  
  (Gain) loss on disposal of business units             (80 )   2,406  
  Loss on disposal of property and equipment     69     192     292     351  
  Changes in operating assets and liabilities:                          
    Accounts receivable     (1,350 )   (15,174 )   (1,810 )   (20,503 )
    Other assets     2,071     (10,548 )   1,306     (5,914 )
    Accounts payable     (6,199 )   11,755     2,197     (59 )
    Accrued payroll and related costs     (21,052 )   34,688     (5,824 )   6,123  
    Other accrued liabilities     (18,136 )   23,107     (8,637 )   15,483  
    Deferred taxes     (2,426 )   (5,102 )   4,255     1,801  
    Other long-term liabilities     506     (124 )   (3,090 )   (5,852 )
   
 
 
 
 
Net cash (used in) provided by operating activities     (36,312 )   37,710     36,392     37,671  

Investing activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Cash paid for acquisitions, net of cash received     (5,378 )   (30,400 )   (7,286 )   (4,715 )
Cash paid for acquisition of predecessor company     (371,162 )            
Proceeds from sale of business units, net of cash and transaction costs                 341  
Purchases of property and equipment     (5,821 )   (9,976 )   (14,626 )   (15,601 )
Cash proceeds from sale of property and equipment     208     528     2,225      
   
 
 
 
 
Net cash used in investing activities     (382,153 )   (39,848 )   (19,687 )   (19,975 )

Financing activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Repayments of long-term debt     (315,058 )   (10,608 )   (226,381 )   (14,282 )
Redemption of preferred stock             (118,453 )    
Payments on obligations under capital lease     (141 )   (325 )        
Proceeds from officer notes         49     539      
Proceeds from issuance of long-term debt     515,000         344,222     4,998  
Parent capital contribution     253,627              
Purchase and retirement of preferred and common stock         (1,488 )   (2,273 )    
Payments of deferred financing costs     (20,095 )   (650 )   (9,468 )    
Proceeds from issuance of preferred and common stock                 200  
   
 
 
 
 
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities     433,333     (13,022 )   (11,814 )   (9,084 )
   
 
 
 
 
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents     14,868     (15,160 )   4,891     8,612  
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period     14,147     29,307     24,416     15,804  
   
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period   $ 29,015   $ 14,147   $ 29,307   $ 24,416  
   
 
 
 
 

Supplemental disclosure of noncash activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Accrued dividends on Redeemable Class A preferred stock   $   $   $ 1,533   $ 15,068  
Cash paid for interest   $ 6,309   $ 49,530   $ 35,468   $ 13,357  
Cash (received) paid for income taxes   $ (1,892 ) $ 3,335   $ 3,420   $ 9,464  

See accompanying notes.

F-6



National Mentor Holdings, Inc.

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

(Amounts in thousands, except share and per share amounts)

September 30, 2006

1.    Basis of Presentation

        National Mentor Holdings, Inc., through its wholly owned subsidiaries (collectively, the "Company"), is a national provider of home and community-based services to (i) individuals with mental retardation and/or developmental disabilities ("MR/DD"); (ii) at-risk children and youth with emotional, behavioral or medically complex needs and their families ("ARY"); and (iii) persons with acquired brain injury ("ABI"). Since the Company's founding in 1980, the Company has grown to provide services to approximately 21,700 clients in 34 states. The Company designs customized service plans to meet the unique needs of its clients in home and community based settings. Most of the Company's services involve residential support, typically in small group home or host home settings, designed to improve the Company's clients' quality of life and to promote client independence and participation in community life. Services that the Company provides include day programs, vocational services, case management, early intervention, post-acute treatment and neurorehabilitation services, among others. The Company's customized services offer the Company's clients, as well as the payors for these services, an attractive, cost-effective alternative to human services provided in large, institutional settings.

        The term "successor" refers to the Company following the merger and related financing transactions and the term "predecessor" refers to the Company prior to the merger and related financing transactions. The operating and cash flows results for the predecessor period October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 reflect the operating results of the Company through June 30, 2006, as one day of operations is not deemed material to present separately.

Acquisition

        On June 29, 2006, pursuant to the terms of a merger agreement (the "Merger Agreement"), dated as of March 22, 2006, among the Company, NMH Holdings, LLC ("Parent") and NMH MergerSub, Inc. ("MergerSub"), MergerSub merged with and into the Company, with the Company being the surviving corporation (the "Merger"). As a result of the Merger, Vestar Capital Partners V, L.P. ("Vestar"), an affiliate of Vestar and the management investors, through Parent and NMH Investment, LLC ("NMH Investment"), the parent company of Parent, own the Company. The equity structure of NMH Investment has not been pushed-down into the financial statements of the Company. The Merger and related financing transacations are referred to together as the "Transactions." The term "successor" refers to the Company following the Transactions, and the term "predecessor" refers to the Company prior to the Transactions.

        The Merger was accounted for under the purchase method of accounting in accordance with Financial Accounting Standard No. 141, Business Combinations (SFAS 141). Under purchase accounting, fixed assets and identifiable intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed are recorded at their respective fair values. The Company is in the process of completing valuations of certain real estate assets; thus, the allocation of the purchase price to the Company's assets is subject to adjustment.

F-7



The Transactions

        Pursuant to the Merger Agreement, MergerSub merged with and into the Company on June 29, 2006, with the Company being the surviving corporation. Pursuant to the Merger, each outstanding share of common stock of the Company was converted into the right to receive cash, and each outstanding share of common stock of MergerSub was converted into one share of common stock of the Company. Vested options to purchase common stock of the Company outstanding at the time of the Merger were converted into the right to receive cash less the exercise price of such option.

        Certain members of the Company's management team and employees agreed to exchange certain of their equity interests in the Company into Class A common units and preferred units of NMH Investment. In addition, certain management investors are participating in the equity of NMH Investment through purchases of additional Class A common units and preferred units of NMH Investment. Vestar, an affiliate of Vestar and the management investors, invested approximately $253.6 million in units of NMH Investment.

        Immediately after the consummation of the Transactions, Parent owns all of the issued and outstanding common stock of the Company. Vestar and its affiliate, owns approximately 92% of the voting units in NMH Investment, which in turn, owns Parent. The remaining voting units in NMH Investment are owned by the management investors.

        If the management investor's employment with the Company terminates under certain circumstances, the investor has the right to sell to NMH Investment and NMH Investment shall be required to repurchase the units from the investor. As such, NMH Investment may request that the Company issue a dividend to satisfy this obligation.

        The following financing transactions occurred in connection with the closing of the Merger:

    a cash investment made by Vestar and its affiliate totaling $242.0 million in preferred and Class A common units of NMH Investment;

    an investment in preferred and Class A common units of NMH Investment by the management investors of approximately $11.6 million, primarily in the form of a rollover of their existing equity interests in the Company;

    borrowings by the Company under its new senior secured credit facilities, consisting of a $335.0 million seven-year senior secured term loan facility, a $125.0 million six-year senior secured revolving credit facility, and a $20.0 million seven-year senior secured synthetic letter of credit facility. At the closing of the Merger, the Company borrowed $335.0 million under the senior secured term loan facility and utilized the entire $20.0 million synthetic letter of credit facility. The Company did not borrow under the senior secured revolving credit facility at the completion of the Transactions;

    the issuance of $180.0 million in 11 1 / 4 % Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014.

F-8


        The aggregate purchase price paid in connection with the closing of the Merger has been initially allocated as follows:

Cash   $ 14,147  
Accounts receivable     99,356  
Other assets, current and long-term     24,245  
Property and equipment     132,550  
Identifiable intangible assets     512,662  
Goodwill     178,957  
Accounts payable and accrued expenses     (81,302 )
Debt     (6,310 )
Deferred tax liabilities, net     (128,035 )
Long-term liabilities     (3,490 )
   
 
    $ 742,780  
   
 

        In connection with the closing of the Transactions, National Mentor, Inc. completed a tender offer and consent solicitation to purchase any and all of its outstanding 9 5 / 8 % senior subordinated notes due 2012 (the "old notes") and to amend the related indenture and the old notes to eliminate substantially all of the restrictive covenants and certain events of default and to modify certain other provisions of the indenture and the old notes. The Company recorded as interest expense for the period October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006, $22.5 million related to the premium and related expenses to be paid in connection with the tender offer for the old notes.

        At the closing date of the Merger, the Company terminated all commitments under the senior secured revolving credit facility, repaid all outstanding borrowings, totaling $164.9 million as of June 29, 2006, under the previous senior secured credit facility and paid any accrued and unpaid interest thereon.

        Upon entering into the Merger Agreement in March 2006, remaining unamortized deferred financing costs of approximately $8.0 million related to the Company's previous senior secured credit facility and old notes were expensed over a shortened amortization period through June 29, 2006. In addition, all unvested stock options became vested in accordance with the change in control provisions of the original stock option agreements. All stock options outstanding at the time of the Merger were cancelled, and holders of the options received an amount equal to the excess of the fair market value over the exercise price per share. The Company expensed $26.9 million in the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006, which is the difference between the fair value of the underlying stock and the related stock option exercise price. In addition, Merger related costs incurred by the predecessor company of $9.1 million were expensed in the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006, primarily consisting of professional fees.

        In connection with the Transaction, NMH Investment adopted a new equity-based plan, which authorizes equity awards to be granted for Class B, Class C, Class D and Class E common units. No awards were granted under the plan at September 30, 2006.

F-9



Pro Forma results

        The unaudited pro forma results of operations provided below for the years ended September 30, 2006 and 2005 are presented as though the Transactions had occurred at the beginning of the earliest period presented, after giving effect to purchase accounting adjustments relating to depreciation and amortization of the revalued assets, interest expense associated with the changes in consolidated debt and other acquisition related adjustments in connection with the Transactions.

 
  Year Ended
September 30, 2006

  Year Ended
September 30, 2005

 
Net Revenues   $ 789,237   $ 693,826  
Loss before benefit for income taxes     (16,873 )   (21,698 )
Net loss     (13,582 )   (12,525 )

        The pro forma information presented above does not intend to indicate what the Company's results of operations would have been if the acquisitions had in fact occurred at the beginning of the earliest period presented and is not intended to be a projection of the impact on future results or trends.

2.    Significant Accounting Policies

Principles of Consolidation

        The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company and its subsidiaries. All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

Use of Estimates

        The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America require the Company to make estimates and assumptions about future events and their impact on amounts reported in the financial statements and related notes. Since future events and the impact of those events cannot be determined with certainty, the actual results will inevitably differ from the Company's estimates. These differences could be material to the financial statements.

        These accounting policies and estimates are periodically reevaluated, and adjustments are made when facts and circumstances dictate a change. Historically, actual results have not differed materially from estimated amounts.

Cash Equivalents

        The Company considers short-term investments with maturity dates of 90 days or less at the date of purchase to be cash equivalents. Cash equivalents primarily consist of money market funds and overnight repurchase investments. The carrying value of cash equivalents approximates fair value due to their short-term maturity.

F-10



Financial Instruments

        Financial instruments consist of cash and cash equivalents, receivables, accounts payable, certain accrued liabilities and debt. These instruments are carried at cost, which approximates their respective fair values.

Concentrations of Credit and Other Risks

        Financial instruments that potentially subject the Company to credit risk primarily consist of cash and cash equivalents and accounts receivable. Cash and cash equivalents are deposited with federally insured commercial banks in the United States.

        The Company derives most of its revenues from states, counties and regional governmental agencies. These entities fund a significant portion of their payments to the Company through federal matching funds, which pass through various state and local government agencies. Management believes that due to the diversity of the state and local government agency payor base, it is doubtful that a given set of economic conditions or legislative actions would impact the payor base in a similar manner.

Revenue Recognition

        Revenues are reported net of state provider taxes or gross receipts taxes levied on services the Company provides. Revenues also are reported net of allowances for unauthorized sales and estimated sales adjustments by business unit. Sales adjustments are estimated based on an analysis of historical sales adjustments and recent developments in the payment trends in each business unit. The Company follows Staff Accounting Bulletin 104 (SAB 104), Revenue Recognition , which requires that revenue can only be recognized when evidence of an arrangement exists, the service has been provided, the price is fixed or determinable and collectibility is probable. The Company recognizes revenues for services performed pursuant to contracts with various state and local government agencies and private health care agencies as follows: cost-reimbursement contract revenues are recognized at the time the service and costs are incurred and units-of-service contract revenues are recognized at the time the service is provided. For the Company's cost-reimbursement contracts, the rate provided by the payor is based on a certain level of service and types of costs incurred in delivering the service. From time to time, the Company receives payments under cost-reimbursement contracts in excess of the allowable costs required to support those payments. In such instances, the Company estimates and records a liability for such excess payments. At the end of the contract period, any balance of excess payments is maintained as a liability until it is reimbursed to the payor. Revenues in the future may be affected by changes in rate-setting structures, methodologies or interpretations that may be enacted in states where the Company operates or by the federal government.

Cost of Revenues

        The Company classifies expenses directly related to providing services as cost of revenues, except for depreciation and amortization related to cost of revenues, which are shown separately in the consolidated income statement. Direct costs and expenses principally include salaries and benefits for service provider employees and contracted caregivers, transportation costs for clients requiring services, certain client expenses such as food, drugs and medicine, residential occupancy expenses, which primarily comprise rent and utilities, and other miscellaneous direct service-related expenses.

F-11


Property and Equipment

        Property and equipment are stated at cost, less accumulated depreciation and amortization. The Company provides for depreciation using straight-line methods over the estimated useful lives of the related assets. Estimated useful lives for buildings are 30 years. The useful lives of computer hardware and software are three years, the useful lives for furniture and equipment range from three to ten years, and the useful lives for vehicles are five years. Leasehold improvements are amortized on a straight-line basis over the lesser of the lease term or the useful life of the property and the leasehold amortization is included in depreciation expense. Capital lease assets related to vehicles are amortized over the lesser of the lease term or the useful life of the vehicles. Expenditures for maintenance and repairs are charged to operating expenses as incurred.

Capitalized Software Developed for Internal Use

        The Company accounts for software developed for internal use under Statement of Position 98-1, Accounting for the Costs of Computer Software Developed or Obtained for Internal Use (SOP 98-1), and Emerging Task Force Issue 00-2, Accounting for Website Development Costs (EITF 00-2). Costs incurred by the Company to enhance, manage, monitor and operate the Company's website are expensed as incurred, except for costs that provide additional functionality, which are capitalized in accordance with SOP 98-1 and EITF 00-2.

        As of September 30, 2005, the Company had previously capitalized $3,325 of internally developed software costs and had $3,288 of accumulated amortization. As of September 30, 2006, the net book value of internally developed software is nominal.

Accounts Receivables

        Accounts receivable primarily consist of amounts due from government agencies, not-for-profit providers, and commercial insurance companies. An estimated allowance for doubtful accounts is recorded to the extent it is probable that a portion or all of a particular account will not be collected. In evaluating the collectibility of accounts receivable, the Company considers a number of factors, including payment trends in individual states, age of the accounts, and the status of ongoing disputes with third-party payors. Complex rules and regulations regarding billing and timely filing requirements in various states are also a factor in the Company's assessment of the collectibility of accounts receivable. Actual collections of accounts receivable in subsequent periods may require changes in the estimated allowance for doubtful accounts. Changes in these estimates are charged or credited to revenue in the statement of operations in the period of the change in estimate.

Accruals for Self-Insurance

        The Company self-insures a substantial portion of its health, workers compensation, automobile and professional and general liability ("PL/GL") programs. The Company records expenses related to claims on an incurred basis, which includes estimates of fully developed losses for both reported and unreported claims. The accruals for the health and workers compensation, automobile and PL/GL programs are based on analyses performed internally by management or actuarially determined

F-12



estimates by independent third parties. Accruals relating to prior periods are periodically reevaluated and increased or decreased based on new information. As such, these changes in estimates are recorded as charges or credits to the statement of operations in a period subsequent to the change in estimate.

Goodwill and Intangible Assets

        Pursuant to SFAS No. 142, Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets (SFAS 142), the Company reviews costs of purchased businesses in excess of net assets acquired (goodwill), and indefinite-life intangible assets for impairment at least annually, unless significant changes in circumstances indicate a potential impairment may have occurred sooner. The Company is required to test goodwill on a reporting unit basis. The Company uses a fair value approach to test goodwill for impairment and recognizes an impairment charge for the amount, if any, by which the carrying amount of goodwill exceeds fair value. The impairment test for indefinite-life intangible assets requires the determination of the fair value of the intangible asset. If the fair value of the intangible asset were less than its carrying value, an impairment loss would be recognized in an amount equal to the difference. Fair values are established using discounted cash flow and comparative market multiple methods. The Company conducts its annual impairment test on July 1 of each year, and as of the date of the last test, there was no impairment and there have been no indicators of impairment since the date of the test.

        Discounted cash flows are based on management's estimates of the Company's future performance. As such, actual results may differ from these estimates and lead to a revaluation of the Company's goodwill and intangible assets. If updated calculations indicate that the fair value of goodwill or any indefinite-life intangibles is less than the carrying value of the asset, an impairment charge would be recorded in the statement of operations in the period of the change in estimate.

Impairment of Long-Lived Assets

        Pursuant to SFAS No. 144, Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets (SFAS 144), the Company reviews long-lived assets for impairment when circumstances indicate the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable based on the undiscounted future cash flows of the asset. If the carrying amount of the asset is determined not to be recoverable, a write-down to fair value is recorded based upon various techniques to estimate fair value.

Income Taxes

        The Company accounts for income taxes in accordance with SFAS No. 109, Accounting for Income Taxes (SFAS 109). Under SFAS 109, the asset and liability method is used in accounting for income taxes. Under this method, deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined by multiplying the differences between the financial reporting and tax reporting bases for assets and liabilities by the enacted tax rates expected to be in effect when such differences are recovered or settled. These deferred tax assets and liabilities are separated into current and long-term amounts based on the classification of the related assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes. Valuation allowances on deferred tax assets are estimated based on our assessment of the realizability of such amounts.

F-13



Derivative Financial Instruments

        From time to time, the Company uses derivative financial instruments to manage the risk of interest rate fluctuations on debt and accounts for derivative financial instruments in accordance with SFAS No. 133, Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities (SFAS 133), as amended, which requires that all derivative instruments be reported on the balance sheet at fair value and establishes criteria for designation and effectiveness of hedging relationships. Changes in the fair value of derivatives are recorded each period in current operations or in shareholders' equity as other comprehensive income (loss) depending upon whether the derivative is designated as part of a hedge transaction and, if it is, the type of hedge transaction.

        The Company, from time to time, enters into interest rate swap agreements to hedge against variability in cash flows resulting from fluctuations in the benchmark interest rate, which is LIBOR, on its debt. These agreements involve the exchange of variable interest rates for fixed interest rates over the life of the swap agreement without an exchange of the notional amount upon which the payments are based. On a quarterly basis, the differential to be received or paid as interest rates change is accrued and recognized as an adjustment to interest expense in the accompanying consolidated statement of operations. In addition, on a quarterly basis the mark to market valuation is recorded as an adjustment to other comprehensive income/loss as a change to shareholder's equity. The related amount receivable from or payable to counterparties is included as an asset or liability in the Company's consolidated balance sheet (see Note 9).

Stock-Based Compensation

        On December 16, 2004, the FASB issued SFAS No. 123 (revised 2004) (SFAS 123 (R)), Share-Based Payment, which is a revision of SFAS No. 123, Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation. SFAS 123(R) supersedes Accounting Principles Board Opinion No. 25, Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees (APB 25), and amends SFAS No. 95, Statement of Cash Flows. Generally, the approach in SFAS 123(R) is similar to the approach described in SFAS 123. However, SFAS 123(R) requires all share-based payments to employees, including grants of employee stock options, to be recognized in the statement of operations based on their fair values. Pro forma disclosure is no longer an alternative to financial statement recognition.

        Under SFAS 123(R), entities that used the minimum-value method, as the Company had, to measure compensation cost for stock options under SFAS 123 for financial statement recognition or pro forma disclosure purposes are required to use the prospective method. Under the prospective method, entities continue to account for nonvested awards outstanding at the date of adoption of SFAS 123(R) in the same manner as they had been accounted for prior to adoption for financial statement recognition purposes. All awards granted, modified or settled after the date of adoption are accounted for using the measurement, recognition and attribution provisions of SFAS 123(R).

        Effective October 1, 2005, the Company adopted the fair value recognition provisions of SFAS 123(R) using the prospective method. Therefore, the Company accounted for nonvested awards outstanding at the date of adoption in the same manner it accounted for them prior to adoption under the provisions of APB 25. The Company used the Black-Scholes option valuation model to determine

F-14


the fair value of share-based payments granted after October 1, 2005. In November 2001, the Board of Directors approved a stock option plan, which provided for the grant to our directors, officers and key employees of options to purchase shares of common stock. Options awarded under the stock option plan were exercisable into shares of common stock. The total number of shares of common stock as to which options could be granted could not exceed 1,292,952 shares of common stock.

        At the time of the Merger, all unvested stock options became vested in accordance with the change in control provision of the original stock option agreements. According to the Merger Agreement, all stock options outstanding at the time of the Merger were cancelled, and holders of vested options received cash payment in the amount equal to the excess of the fair market value over the exercise price per share. Therefore, the Company accrued stock-based compensation expense of $26.9 million to reflect this anticipated payment to option holders. During the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006, the Company recorded $525 of stock-based compensation expense, included in general and administrative expense in the statement of operations, as a result of adopting SFAS 123(R). In addition, stock-based compensation expense of approximately $59, $100 and $26 is reflected in pre-tax income for the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and the years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004, respectively. This compensation cost is related to options granted in 2002 and 2004 under the plan that had exercise prices less than the fair value of the underlying common stock on the date of grant. The Company did not incur stock-based compensation expense for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 because no such awards had been granted or earned.

Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)

        Other comprehensive income (loss) is defined as the change in equity of a company during a period from transactions and other events and circumstances, excluding transactions resulting from investments by owners and distributions to owners. Other comprehensive income (loss) consists of gains and losses on interest rate swaps, net of tax.

Reclassifications

        Certain 2005 amounts have been reclassified to conform to the 2006 presentation.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements

        In June 2006, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (the "FASB") issued Interpretation No. 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes—An Interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109 (FIN 48). FIN 48 clarifies the accounting for uncertainty in tax positions recognized in a company's financial statements in accordance with SFAS 109. FIN 48 prescribes a recognition threshold and measurement attributes for the financial statement recognition and measurement of a tax position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return, and provides guidance on derecognition, classification, interest and penalties, accounting in interim periods, disclosure and transition. The provisions of FIN 48 are effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2006, with the cumulative effect of the change in accounting principle recorded as an adjustment to opening retained earnings. The Company is currently

F-15



assessing the impact of FIN 48 on its consolidated financial position, results of operations and cash flows.

        In May 2005, the FASB issued SFAS 154, Accounting Changes and Error Corrections (SFAS 154). SFAS 154 replaces APB Opinion No. 20, Accounting Changes (APB 20), and FASB No. 3, Reporting Accounting Changes in Interim Financial Statements, and changes the requirements for the accounting for and reporting of a change in accounting principle. SFAS 154 applies to all voluntary changes in accounting principle. APB 20 previously required that most voluntary changes in accounting principle be recognized by including in net income of the period of the change the cumulative effect of changing to the new accounting principle. SFAS 154 requires retrospective application to prior periods' financial statements of changes in accounting principle, unless it is impracticable to determine either the period-specific effects or the cumulative effect of the change. When it is impracticable to determine the period-specific effects of an accounting change on one or more individual prior periods presented, SFAS 154 requires that the new accounting principle be applied to the balances of assets and liabilities as of the beginning of the earliest period for which retrospective application is practicable and that a corresponding adjustment be made to the opening balance of retained earnings (or other appropriate components of equity or net assets in the statement of financial position) for that period rather than being reported in an income statement. When it is impracticable to determine the cumulative effect of applying a change in accounting principle to all prior periods, SFAS 154 requires that the new accounting principle be applied as if it were adopted prospectively from the earliest date practicable. SFAS 154 is effective for accounting changes and corrections of errors made in fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2005. The adoption of SFAS 154 is not expected to have a material effect on the Company's financial statements.

3.    Acquisitions

Predecessor

2004

        In fiscal 2004, the Company acquired three companies engaged in behavioral health and human services. On January 5, 2004, the Company acquired certain assets of CRF First Choice Inc., located in Ft. Wayne, Indiana ("CRF"). CRF provides residential group home services to mentally retarded or developmentally disabled individuals. Total consideration was approximately $86 in cash. On April 30, 2004, the Company acquired the assets of Foster America Inc., headquartered in Tampa, Florida ("Foster America"). Foster America provides therapeutic foster care services to at risk youth. Total consideration was approximately $3,885 in cash. On June 30, 2004, the Company acquired the assets of CC Lifestyles Inc., located in Madison, MN ("CC Lifestyles"). CC Lifestyles provides residential group home services to mentally retarded or developmentally disabled individuals. Total consideration was approximately $111 in cash. The operating results of the acquired entities are included in the consolidated statements of operations since the dates of acquisition. The Company accounted for the acquisitions under the purchase method of accounting in accordance with SFAS 141. Accordingly, the purchase price was allocated to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed based upon their respective fair values. The excess of the purchase price over the estimated fair market value of net tangible assets

F-16



was allocated to specifically identified intangible assets, with the residual being allocated to goodwill (see Note 5).

        The aggregate purchase price for the acquisitions was allocated as follows:

Cash   $ (78 )
Accounts receivable     357  
Other assets, current and long-term     28  
Property and equipment     124  
Identifiable intangible assets     1,980  
Goodwill     2,059  
Accounts payable and accrued expenses     (388 )
   
 
    $ 4,082  
   
 

        During fiscal 2005, the Company finalized certain components of its purchase price allocation related to the acquisitions in 2004 (see Note 5).

2005

        In fiscal 2005, the Company acquired ten companies engaged in behavioral health and human services. The Company acquired the assets of Diane Marie's Place, Inc., Bayview Neuro, Inc., MSN, Inc., Spectrum Community Services, LTD (both Spectrum Tampa and Spectrum Orlando), Adam's House, Inc., The Brown Schools of Florida, Inc., McGarvey ICF/DD-H Home and Neurorestorative Associates, Inc. The Company also acquired all of the issued and outstanding shares of capital stock of Cornerstone Living Skills, Inc. Aggregate consideration for these acquisitions was approximately $8,302. The operating results of the acquired entities are included in the consolidated statements of income for the dates of acquisition. The Company accounted for the acquisitions under the purchase method of accounting in accordance with SFAS 141. Accordingly, the purchase price was allocated to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed based upon their respective fair values. The excess of the purchase price over the estimated fair market value of net tangible assets was allocated to specifically identified intangible assets, with the residual being allocated to goodwill (see Note 5).

        The aggregate purchase price for the acquisitions was allocated as follows:

Cash   $ 9  
Accounts receivable     198  
Other assets, current and long-term     27  
Property and equipment     1,066  
Identifiable intangible assets     3,192  
Goodwill     4,184  
Accounts payable and accrued expenses     (149 )
Long-term liabilities     (225 )
   
 
    $ 8,302  
   
 

F-17


2006

        In fiscal 2006, prior to the completion of the Transaction, the Company acquired six companies engaged in behavioral health and human services. On January 31, 2006, the Company acquired certain assets in Florida of American Habilitation Services ("AHS Florida") for approximately $8.5 million. AHS Florida provides residential group home, day program and ICF-MR services to individuals with developmental disabilities. On May 31, 2006, the Company acquired substantially all the assets of CareMeridian for approximately $21.4 million, subject to increase based on earnout provisions. CareMeridian is a provider of after-hospital services for catastrophically ill or injured patients in non-institutional, residential settings. In addition, the Company acquired the assets of Florida Residential Solutions, LLC, Sierra Gates, Ltd., Resources For Human Development, Inc. and Homework Center, Inc. Aggregate consideration for the six acquisitions in fiscal 2006 was approximately $30,467. The operating results of the acquired entities are included in the consolidated statements of income for the dates of acquisition. The Company accounted for the acquisitions under the purchase method of accounting in accordance with SFAS 141. Accordingly, the purchase price was allocated to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed based upon their respective fair values. The excess of the purchase price over the estimated fair market value of net tangible assets was allocated to specifically identified intangible assets, with the residual being allocated to goodwill (see Note 5).

        The aggregate purchase price for the acquisitions was allocated as follows:

Cash   $ 67  
Accounts receivable     3,792  
Other assets, current and long-term     247  
Property and equipment     1,512  
Identifiable intangible assets     17,413  
Goodwill     9,278  
Accounts payable and accrued expenses     (1,842 )
   
 
    $ 30,467  
   
 

Successor

        The Company paid for the assets of two companies engaged in behavioral health and human services at the end of the fiscal year and took ownership of those acquisitions on October 1, 2006. The purchase price for the two acquisitions was approximately $5.4 million. The cash paid for the two acquisitions was recorded in goodwill as of September 30, 2006 and a full allocation of the purchase price will be completed in fiscal 2007 including the valuation of tangible and intangible assets.

F-18


4.    Significant Contractual Arrangements

        The Company has several management agreements with subsidiaries of Alliance Health, Inc. (Alliance), an unrelated party. Alliance is a not-for-profit organization that contracts directly with state government agencies. The Company provides clinical and management services in accordance with the terms of its agreements with Alliance. The Company has no ownership interest in, and no legal control over, nor does it exert control over Alliance. Total revenue derived by the Company from contracts with Alliance was approximately $11,218, $31,514, $35,336 and $31,713 for the periods June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 and October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and for the years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004, respectively. The net amount due from Alliance in connection with the services provided by the Company under the contracts at September 30, 2006 and 2005 was approximately $9,766 and $8,380, respectively, and is included in accounts receivable in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets.

5.    Goodwill

        The Company accounts for goodwill in accordance with SFAS No. 142 which requires goodwill to be tested for impairment on an annual basis (and more frequently in certain circumstances) and written down when impaired. The Company performed its annual test of impairment of goodwill as of July 1, 2006 (after the Transaction), and based on the results of the first step of the goodwill impairment test, the Company determined that no impairment had taken place. The fair value of each reporting unit, East, Central and West Divisions, exceeded their respective carrying value, and therefore, the second step of the goodwill impairment test was not necessary.

Predecessor

        The changes in the carrying amount of goodwill for fiscal 2005 is as follows:

 
  Year ended
September 30
2005

 
Balance at beginning of period   $ 88,544  
Goodwill acquired during the year     4,184  
Adjustments to goodwill, net     (1,465 )
   
 
Balance at end of period   $ 91,263  
   
 

        The adjustments to goodwill in 2005 include a working capital settlement related to the acquisition of REM Inc. (REM Transaction) of $546, an adjustment of $(500) related to the finalization of the purchase price of the 2004 acquisitions, and $(1,511) related to tax adjustments.

Successor

        The goodwill balance as of September 30, 2006 includes goodwill related to the June 29, 2006 Transaction, which is subject to adjustment as discussed in Note 1, as well as goodwill related to businesses acquired between June 30, 2006 and September 30, 2006.

F-19



6.    Intangible Assets

Predecessor

        Identifiable intangible assets resulting from the Company's acquisition of certain businesses (Note 3) accounted for under the purchase method, include agency contracts, trade names, noncompete/nonsolicit clauses, an intellectual property model, licenses and permits and relationships with contracted caregivers. Identifiable intangible assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. Certain trade names are classified as indefinite-lived intangible assets due to the length of time the trade names have been in existence and the planned use of the trade names for the foreseeable future.

        Intangible assets consist of the following as of September 30, 2005:

Description

  Estimated Useful
Life

  Gross
Carrying Value

  Accumulated
Amortization

  Intangible
Assets, Net

Agency contracts   5-13 years   $ 96,021   $ 18,047   $ 77,974
Non-compete/non-solicit   4-5 years     350     221     129
Relationship with contracted caregivers   3 years     6,184     5,973     211
Trade names   10 years     526     136     390
Trade names   Indefinite life     19,192         19,192
Licenses and permits   10 years     8,230     1,952     6,278
Intellectual property models   10 years     550     153     397
       
 
 
        $ 131,053   $ 26,482   $ 104,571
       
 
 

        Amortization expense for the period October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 was $7,263 and for the years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 was $8,720 and $9,222, respectively.

Successor

        Intangible assets consist of the following as of September 30, 2006:

Description

  Estimated Useful
Life

  Gross
Carrying Value

  Accumulated
Amortization

  Intangible
Assets, Net

Agency contracts   7-18 years   $ 413,200   $ 6,297   $ 406,903
Non-compete/non-solicit   4-5 years     262     10     252
Relationship with contracted caregivers   10 years     10,300     258     10,042
Trade names   9-11 years     3,100     77     3,023
Trade names   Indefinite life     47,700         47,700
Licenses and permits   10 years     37,500     938     36,562
Intellectual property models   7 years     600     22     578
       
 
 
        $ 512,662   $ 7,602   $ 505,060
       
 
 

        Amortization expense during the period June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 was $7,602.

F-20



        The estimated remaining amortization expense related to intangible assets with finite lives for each of the five succeeding years and thereafter is as follows:

Year ending September 30,

   
2007   $ 30,418
2008     30,418
2009     30,418
2010     30,416
2011     30,402
Thereafter     305,288
   
    $ 457,360
   

7.    Property and Equipment

        Property and equipment consists of the following at September 30:

 
  Successor
2006

  Predecessor
2005

 
Buildings and land*   $ 98,207   $ 91,411  
Vehicles     15,684     15,031  
Computer hardware and software     6,996     14,669  
Furniture and fixtures     9,839     13,307  
Leasehold improvements     3,665     6,754  
Office and telecommunication equipment     3,729     6,219  
Software developed for internal use         3,325  
   
 
 
      138,120     150,716  
Less accumulated depreciation and amortization     (4,112 )   (36,550 )
   
 
 
Property and equipment, net   $ 134,008   $ 114,166  
   
 
 

*
Buildings and land are subject to adjustment as discussed in Note 1.

        Depreciation and amortization expense during the periods June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 and October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and for the years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 was $4,112, $10,276, $13,023 and $12,262, respectively.

F-21


8.    Prepaid Expenses and Other Current Assets

        Prepaid expenses and other current assets consisted of the following at September 30:

 
  Successor
2006

  Predecessor
2005

Income tax receivable   $ 10,040   $ 2,115
Prepaid insurance     6,399     4,702
Deferred financing costs, current     3,208     1,325
Prepaid business expenses     1,825     1,696
Other     841     2,736
   
 
Prepaid expenses and other current assets   $ 22,313   $ 12,574
   
 

9.    Other Accrued Liabilities

        Other accrued liabilities consisted of the following at September 30:

 
  Successor
2006

  Predecessor
2005

Accrued interest   $ 6,067   $ 6,484
Payer overpayments     3,703     2,293
Self-insurance accruals     3,605     2,243
Accrued professional services     2,548     1,496
Cost reimbursement accruals     4,142     3,129
Deferred revenue     1,848     1,598
Accrued swap valuation liability     1,838    
Accrued real estate tax     1,529     1,387
Other     1,518     1,327
   
 
Other accrued liabilities   $ 26,798   $ 19,957
   
 

10.    Financing Arrangements

        In connection with the Transactions, the Company terminated all commitments under the senior secured revolving credit facility and repaid all outstanding borrowings under the previous senior credit facility and paid any accrued and unpaid interest. The new senior credit facility consists of a $335.0 million seven-year senior secured term loan facility, a $125.0 million six-year senior secured revolving credit facility and a $20.0 million seven-year senior secured synthetic letter of credit facility. At the closing of the Transactions, the Company borrowed $335.0 million under the senior secured term loan facility, utilized the entire $20.0 million synthetic letter of credit facility, and issued $180.0 in senior subordinated notes. As of September 30, 2006, the Company did not borrow under the senior secured revolving credit facility.

F-22


        Also in connection with the closing of the Transactions, National Mentor, Inc. completed a tender offer and consent solicitation to purchase the old senior subordinated notes due 2012 and to amend the related indenture and the old notes to eliminate substantially all of the restrictive covenants and certain events of default and to modify certain other provisions of the indenture and the old notes. As of September 30, 2006, there is $750 of the old notes outstanding. The Predecessor Company recorded interest expense and an accrued liability as of June 29, 2006 of $22.5 million related to the premium and expenses to be paid in connection with the tender offer for the old notes.

        The Company's long-term debt consists of the following:

 
  Successor
September 30
2006

  Predecessor
September 30
2005

Senior term B loan, principal and interest due in quarterly installments through June 29, 2013; variable interest rate (7.87% at September 30, 2006)   $ 334,163   $
Senior revolver, due June 29, 2012; quarterly cash interest payments at a variable interest rate        
Senior term B loan, principal due in quarterly installments through September 30, 2011; variable interest rate (6.25% at September 30, 2005)         171,945
Senior revolver, due November 4, 2010; quarterly cash interest payments at a variable interest rate        
Senior subordinated notes, due July 1, 2014; semi-annual cash interest payments beginning January 1, 2007 (interest rate of 11 1 / 4 %)     180,000    
Senior subordinated notes, due November 4, 2012; semi-annual cash interest payments beginning June 1, 2005 (interest rate of 9 5 / 8 %)     750     150,000
Term loan mortgage, principal and interest due in monthly installments through May 20, 2010; variable interest rate (9.75% and 8.25% at September 30, 2006 and September 30, 2005, respectively)     5,452     6,086
Note Payable to Seller (Magellan Health Services, Inc., "Magellan"), due March 8, 2007; semiannual cash interest payments at 12% beginning September 2001         3,000
   
 
    $ 520,365   $ 331,031
Less current portion     3,747     11,601
   
 
Long-term debt   $ 516,618   $ 319,430
   
 

        Any amounts outstanding under the new senior revolver are due June 29, 2012. The $335.0 million new term B loan has a term of seven years and amortizes one percent per year, paid quarterly, for the first six years, with the remaining balance due in the seventh year. The new senior credit agreement also includes a provision for the prepayment of a portion of the outstanding term loan amounts at any year-end, beginning with the year ended September 30, 2007, equal to an amount ranging from 0-50% of a calculated amount, depending on the Company's leverage ratio, if the Company generates certain levels of cash flow. For the year ended September 30, 2005, under the then-existing senior credit agreement, one-half of the calculated amount equaled $5.8 million. This amount is reflected in the

F-23



current portion of long-term debt in the September 30, 2005 consolidated balance sheet and was paid in December 2005.

        The interest rate on the term B loan is equal to LIBOR plus 2.50% or Prime plus 1.50%. The interest rate on the term B loan outstanding at September 30, 2006 is based on LIBOR plus 2.50%. The interest rates for any senior revolving credit facility borrowings are equal to either LIBOR plus 2.50% or Prime plus 1.50%. Cash paid for interest amounted to approximately $6.3 million, $49.5 million and $35.5 million for the periods from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 and October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively. Cash paid for interest for the period October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 includes $22.5 premium and related expenses paid in connection with the tender offer for the old notes.

        The Company has, from time to time, used interest rate swap agreements to convert a portion of its variable rate debt to fixed rate debt. The Company has entered into interest rate swap agreements whereby the Company is fixing the interest rate on approximately $221.2 million of its $335.0 million term B loan to reduce the interest rate exposure, effective as of August 31, 2006. The rate and term of the interest rate swaps is 5.32% and four years, respectively. The amount of the term B loan subject to the interest rate swap agreements will reduce to $85.7 million at the end of the four year term. The swap is a derivative under SFAS 133 and it is accounted for pursuant thereto. The fair value of the swap agreements, representing the estimated amount that the Company would pay to a third party assuming the Company's obligations under the interest rate swap agreements ceased at September 30, 2006, was $1.1 million, net of $0.7 million of tax. The fair value of these agreements was determined with the assistance of independent commercial bankers and represents the fair value based on pricing models and independent formulas using current assumptions.

        Since the Company has the ability to elect different interest rates on the debt at each reset date, the hedging relationship does not qualify for the use of the shortcut method. Therefore, the effectiveness of the hedge relationships is being assessed on a quarterly basis during the life of the hedge by comparing whether the critical terms of the hedge continue to match the terms of the debt. Under this approach, the Company exactly matches the terms of the interest rate swap to the terms of the underlying debt and, therefore, assumes 100% hedge effectiveness with no formal quarterly assessment of effectiveness or measurement of ineffectiveness. The entire change in fair market value is recorded in the shareholders' equity net of tax as other comprehensive loss of $1.1 million at September 30, 2006.

        The senior credit facility agreement and the bond indenture contain both affirmative and negative financial and non-financial covenants, including limitations on the Company's ability to incur additional debt, sell material assets, retire, redeem or otherwise reacquire capital stock, acquire the capital stock or assets of another business, pay dividends, and require the Company to meet or exceed certain financial ratios. At September 30, 2006, the Company is in compliance with all covenants.

        The priority with regard to the right of payment on the Company's debt is such that the senior credit facilities and the term loan mortgage have priority over all of the Company's long-term debt. The senior credit facilities are secured by substantially all of the assets of the Company.

F-24



        The Company incurred deferred financing costs of approximately $20.4 million as of September 30, 2006, related to the refinancing in June 2006. The balance sheet included $3.2 million in other current assets and $16.5 million as an other long-term asset primarily related to the refinancing described in Note 1, as well as the mortgage facility. As of September 30, 2005, the balance sheet included deferred financing costs of $1.3 million in other current assets and $7.1 million as an other long-term asset. The Company charged approximately $0.7 million, $8.6 million and $2.4 million to interest expense during the periods from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 and October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and fiscal 2005, respectively, related to the amortization of deferred financing costs. Included in this charge for the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 is approximately $8.0 million due to the shortened amortization period due to the refinancing described in Note 1.

        On June 14, 2006, the outstanding principal balance of the subordinated promissory note to Magellan of $3.0 million was settled by the Company.

        Annual maturities of the Company's long-term debt for the years ending September 30 are as follows.

        Amounts due at any year end may increase as a result of the provision in the new senior credit agreement that requires a prepayment of a portion of the outstanding term loan amounts if the Company generates certain levels of cash flow.

2007   $ 3,747
2008     3,747
2009     3,747
2010     7,611
2011     3,350
Thereafter     498,163
   
Total   $ 520,365
   

11.    Capital Leases

        The Company leases vehicles under capital lease agreements with terms ranging from 24 to 84 months with average monthly payments of less than one thousand dollars per vehicle. These vehicles are primarily used for client transportation. Assets acquired under capital leases with an original cost of $1.2 million and related accumulated amortization of $445 are included in property and equipment for the year ended September 30, 2006. Amortization expense for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 and the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 was $128 and $317, respectively.

F-25


        The following is a schedule of the future minimum lease payments under the capital leases together with the present value of net minimum lease payments at September 30, 2006:

2007   $ 424
2008     240
2009     99
2010     38
2011     6
Thereafter    
   
Total minimum lease payments   $ 807
   

        Interest expense on capital leases during the periods June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 and October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 was $29 and $10, respectively.

12. Redeemable Class A Preferred Stock and Shareholders' Equity

Predecessor

Redeemable Class A Preferred Stock

        On November 4, 2004, the predecessor Company redeemed all of its then outstanding Redeemable Class A Preferred Stock as part of the refinancing of its debt. There is no Redeemable Preferred Stock of the successor company.

Common Stock

        Prior to the Transactions, there were 20,000,000 shares of $0.01 par value common stock authorized. The total number of issued and outstanding shares at September 30, 2005 was 10,203,109.

Successor

Common Stock

        As of September 30, 2006, the Company has 1,000 shares of $0.01 par value common stock authorized and 100 shares issued and outstanding. All of the outstanding shares are held by NMH Holdings, LLC ("Parent").

Dividends

        The holders of common stock are entitled to receive dividends when and if declared by the Company's Board of Directors.

Voting

        The holders of common stock are entitled to one vote per share.

F-26



13.    Employee Savings and Retirement Plans

        On January 1, 2004, various 401(k) plans and a qualified profit sharing plan were merged into a single multi-company plan (the Plan) covering all of the wholly owned subsidiaries of the Company. Under the Plan, employees may contribute a portion of their earnings, which are invested in mutual funds of their choice. After January 1, the Company makes a matching contribution for the previous calendar year on behalf of all participants employed on the last day of the year. This matching contribution vests immediately. In addition, there is a profit sharing feature of the Plan, whereby, at the discretion of management, an allocation may be made to all of the eligible employees in one or more of its subsidiaries. Profit sharing contributions vest ratably over three years with forfeitures available to cover plan costs and employer matches in future years. The Company made contributions of approximately $373, $4,064, $3,029 and $2,497 to this and predecessor plans for the periods June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 and October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and for the years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004, respectively.

        The Company also maintains various nonqualified plans for highly compensated employees (the Plans). Two of these Plans held preferred stock of the Company and phantom preferred stock that was provided to management as a result of acquisitions. These plans were terminated in connection with the November 4, 2004 refinancing with all participants receiving the accreted value.

        The Company has two remaining deferred compensation plans: (1) the National MENTOR Inc. Executive Deferred Compensation Plan is an unfunded, nonqualified deferred compensation arrangement for certain highly compensated employees in which the Company allocates to the executive's account a percentage of the executive's base compensation. This allocation is made at the end of the year for service rendered during the year. The Company allocated $78, $180, $317 and $264 for the the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006, the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and for the years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004, respectively; the unfunded accrued liability is $884 and $771 as of September 30, 2006 and 2005, respectively. (2) the National MENTOR Inc. Executive Deferral Plan, available to highly compensated employees, is a plan in which participants contribute a percentage of salary and/or bonus earned during the year. Employees contributed $427, $516, $485 and $149 to this plan for the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006, the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and for the years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004, respectively. The accrued liability related to this plan is $1.4 million and $611 as of September 30, 2006 and 2005, respectively. In connection with the National Mentor Inc. Executive Deferral Plan, the Company purchases Company owned life insurance (COLI) Policies on certain plan participants. The cash surrender value of the COLI Policies is designed to provide a source for funding the accrued liability. As of September 30, 2006 and 2005, the cash surrender value of the COLI Policies is $1.4 million and $608, respectively.

14.    Related Party Transactions

Management Agreements

Predecessor

        In March 2001, the Company entered into a management services agreement with Madison Dearborn Partners (MDP), the majority stockholder of the predecessor Company, under which MDP

F-27



performs certain management, financing and strategic functions as directed by the Company's Board of Directors for an annual fee of $250 plus out-of-pocket expenses. During the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and the fiscal years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004, the Company incurred $198, $270 and $257, respectively, of management fees and expenses under such agreement.

Successor

        On June 29, 2006, the Company entered into a management agreement with Vestar relating to certain advisory and consulting services for an annual fee equal to the greater of (i) $850 or (ii) an amount equal to 1.0% of the Company's consolidated earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation, amortization and management fees for each fiscal year determined as set forth in the new senior credit facilities. As part of the management agreement, the Company paid Vestar a transaction fee of approximately $7.5 million for services rendered in connection with the consummation of the Transactions. This transaction fee was allocated between goodwill and deferred financing costs in the September 30, 2006 balance sheet. As part of the management agreement, the Company agreed to indemnify Vestar and its affiliates from and against all losses, claims, damages and liabilities arising out of the performance by Vestar of its services pursuant to the management agreement. The management agreement will terminate upon such time that Vestar and its partners and their respective affiliates hold, directly or indirectly in the aggregate, less than 20% of the voting power of the outstanding voting stock of the Company.

Office lease agreements

        The Company leases several offices and homes from its employees, or from relatives of employees, primarily in the states of Minnesota, California and Nevada, which have various expiration dates extending out as far as May 2016. The Company incurred approximately $549 and $390 in rent expense during the the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 and October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006, respectively, related to these leases. The leases in California and Nevada are as a result of the CareMeridian acquisition on May 31, 2006. The Company incurred approximately $231 and $178 in rent expense during the year ended September 30, 2005 and 2004, respectively, related to the Minnesota leases.

15.    Operating Leases

        The Company leases office and client residential facilities, vehicles and certain office equipment in several locations under operating lease arrangements, which expire at various dates through 2015. In addition to base rents presented below, the majority of the leases require payments for additional expenses such as taxes, maintenance and utilities. Certain of the leases contain renewal options at the Company's option and some have escalation clauses which are recognized as deferred rent. Total rent expense during the periods June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 and October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and for the years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 was $8,525, $22,766, $25,813 and $22,987, respectively.

F-28



        Future minimum lease payments for noncancelable operating leases for the years ending September 30 are as follows:

2007   $ 28,063
2008     22,163
2009     17,091
2010     13,015
2011     9,959
Thereafter     13,672
   
    $ 103,963
   

16.    Accruals for Self-Insurance and Other Commitments and Contingencies

        The Company maintains professional and general liability, workers' compensation, automobile liability and health insurance with policies that include self-insured retentions. The Company intends to maintain such coverage in the future and is of the opinion that its insurance coverage is adequate to cover potential losses on asserted claims. General and professional liability has a self-insured retention of $1.0 million per claim and $2.0 million in the aggregate. In connection with the Merger, subject to the same retentions, the Company purchased additional insurance for certain claims relating to pre-Merger periods. For workers' compensation, the Company has a $350 per claim retention with statutory limits. Automobile liability has a $100 per claim retention, with additional insurance coverage above the retention. The Company purchases both aggregate and specific stop loss insurance as protection against extraordinary claims liability for health insurance claims. Stop loss insurance covers any claims in the aggregate that exceed 120% of expected claims liability as well as any individual claims that exceed $250. Expected claims liability is determined based an actuarial methods. The basis of the analysis is the Company's historical loss experience, which is then developed using generally accepted actuarial methods, including, but not limited to, the incurred loss and paid loss development methods. The appropriate liability is selected based on the results of the analysis.

        Beginning November 1, 2005, the first $1.0 million per claim and $2.0 million in the aggregate of professional and general liability claims was transferred to and funded into the Company's wholly-owned subsidiary captive insurance company. The accounts of the captive insurance company are fully consolidated with those of the other operations of the Company in the accompanying financial statements.

        The Company issued approximately $21.8 million in standby letters of credit as of September 30, 2006 related to the Company's workers' compensation insurance coverage. These letters of credit are secured by the $20.0 million Synthetic letter of credit facility and $1.8 million of the senior secured revolving credit facility.

        The Company is in the human services business and therefore has been and will continue to be subject to claims alleging that the Company, its independently contracted host home caregivers, or "Mentors," or its employees failed to provide proper care for a client, as well as claims by the

F-29



Company's clients, Mentors, employees or community members against the Company for negligence or intentional misconduct. Included in the Company's recent claims are claims alleging personal injury, assault, battery, abuse, wrongful death and other charges. Regulatory agencies may initiate administrative proceedings alleging that the Company's programs, employees or agents violate statutes and regulations and seek to impose monetary penalties on the Company. The Company could be required to incur significant costs to respond to regulatory investigations or defend against civil lawsuits and, if the Company does not prevail, the Company could be required to pay substantial amounts of money in damages, settlement amounts or penalties arising from these legal proceedings.

        The Company accrues for costs related to contingencies when a loss is probable and the amount is reasonably estimable. While the Company believes the provision for contingencies is adequate, the outcome of the legal and other such proceedings is difficult to predict and the Company may settle claims or be subject to judgments for amounts that differ from the Company's estimates.

17.    Income Taxes

        The (benefit) provision for income taxes consists of the following:

 
   
  Predecessor
 
  Successor
 
  Period from
October
through
June 29,

   
   
 
  Period from June 30
through
September 30,

  Years ended
September 30,

 
  2006
  2006
  2005
  2004
Current:                        
  Federal   $ (7 ) $ (7,086 ) $ 3,481   $ 4,015
  State     211     840     1,934     2,470
   
 
 
 
Total current taxes payable (benefit)     204     (6,246 )   5,415     6,485
Net deferred tax (benefit) expense     (2,426 )   (5,101 )   4,855     1,938
   
 
 
 
Income tax (benefit) provision   $ (2,222 ) $ (11,347 ) $ 10,270   $ 8,423
   
 
 
 

        The Company (was refunded) paid income taxes during the periods of June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 and October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and for the years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004 of $(1,892), $3,335, $3,420 and $9,464, respectively. The Company has received approximately $10,428, $1,545 by September 30, 2006 and $8,883 subsequent to September 30, 2006, from the federal government due to a carryback of the net operating loss for the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006.

        Deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects of temporary differences between the carrying amount of the assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and the amounts used for income

F-30



tax purposes. Significant components of the Company's deferred tax assets and liabilities at September 30 are as follows:

 
  Successor
September 30
2006

  Predecessor
September 30
2005

 
Gross deferred tax assets:              
  Deferred compensation   $ 919   $ 1,107  
  Interest rate swap agreements     743      
  Accrued workers' compensation     4,708     3,951  
  Net operating loss carryforwards     8,439     2,604  
  Allowance for bad debts     1,038     976  
  Capital loss carryforward     96     97  
  Other         114  
  Alternative minimum tax credit     456      
   
 
 
      16,399     8,849  
  Valuation reserve     (3,181 )   (2,856 )
   
 
 

Deferred tax assets

 

 

13,218

 

 

5,993

 
Deferred tax liabilities:              
  Depreciation and amortization     (12,576 )   (7,370 )
  Amortization of goodwill and intangible assets     (124,862 )   (4,297 )
  Other accrued liabilities     (646 )   (768 )
  Accrued payroll and related costs         (331 )
   
 
 
Net deferred tax liabilities   $ (124,866 ) $ (6,773 )
   
 
 

        SFAS 109 requires a valuation allowance to reduce the deferred tax assets recorded if, based on the weight of the evidence, it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. After consideration of all the evidence, both positive and negative, management has determined that a $3,181 and $2,856 valuation allowance at September 30, 2006 and 2005, respectively, is necessary to reduce the deferred tax assets to the amount that will more likely than not be realized. The valuation allowance primarily relates to certain state net operating loss carryforwards. At September 30, 2006 and 2005, the Company has net operating loss carryforwards of approximately $22,197 for federal purposes, which expire from 2026 through 2027, and $62,915 and $49,425, respectively, for state income tax purposes, which expire from 2006 through 2027.

F-31



        The following is a reconciliation between the statutory and effective income tax rates:

 
  Successor
  Predecessor
 
 
  Period from
June 30
through

  Period from
October 1
through

   
   
 
 
  Years ended
September 30

 
 
  September 30, 2006
  June 29, 2006
 
 
  2005
  2004
 
Federal income tax at statutory rate   35.0 % 35.0 % 35.0 % 35.0 %
State income taxes, net of federal tax benefit   2.7   (0.1 ) 7.9   10.0  
Other nondeductible expenses   (1.0 ) (8.3 ) 0.5   1.0  
Credits       (0.3 ) (0.3 )
Other   1.1   (0.3 ) (0.8 ) (0.5 )
   
 
 
 
 
Effective tax rate   37.8 % 26.3 % 42.3 % 45.2 %
   
 
 
 
 

18.    Segment Information

        The Company provides home and community-based human services for individuals with mental retardation and other developmental disabilities, at-risk youth and their families and persons with acquired brain injury. The Company operates its business in three operating divisions: an Eastern Division, a Central Division and a Western Division. For the reasons discussed below, the Company's operating divisions are aggregated to represent one reportable segment, human services, under SFAS No. 131, Disclosures about Segments of an Enterprise and Related Information (SFAS 131). Accordingly, the accompanying consolidated financial statements reflect the operating results of the Company's one reportable segment. The aggregate of the Company's Eastern, Central and Western operating divisions meets the definition of a segment in SFAS 131 as each of the three divisions engages in business activities that earn similar type revenues and incur expenses, its operating results are regularly reviewed by management (comprising the Company's chief operating decision-maker) to assess its performance and make decisions about resources to be allocated to the respective divisions; discrete financial information is available in the form of detailed statements of operations for each division. The Company's three service lines, which comprise mental retardation and other developmental disabilities, at-risk youth and persons with acquired brain injury do not represent operating segments per SFAS 131 as management does not internally evaluate the operating performance or review the results of the service lines to assess performance or make decisions about allocating resources. Discrete financial information is not available by service line at the level necessary for management to assess performance or make resource allocation decisions.

        The Company's Eastern, Central and Western operating divisions are combined into one reportable segment in accordance with the criteria outlined in SFAS 131. The aggregation of the three operating divisions is consistent with the objective and basic principles of SFAS 131 in that it provides the users of the financial statements with the same information that management uses to internally evaluate and manage the business. Each of the Company's operating divisions provides the same types of services discussed above to similar customer groups, principally individuals. All of the operating divisions have similar economic characteristics, such as similar long-term gross margins. All of the

F-32



operating divisions follow the same operating procedures and methods in managing their operations, as services are provided in a similar manner. In addition, each operating division operates in a similar regulatory environment, as each operating division has common objectives and regulatory and supervisory responsibilities (e.g., licensing, certification, program standards, regulatory requirements).

        The following table sets forth information about revenue by service line as of the dates specified:

Service Line Revenues

 
  Successor
  Predecessor
 
  Period from
June 30
through

   
   
   
 
  Period from
October 1
through

  Years ended
September 30

 
  September 30, 2006
 
  June 29, 2006
  2005
  2004
Mental Retardation/Developmental Disability   $ 142,265   $ 407,618   $ 501,037   $ 481,700
Children and Families at Risk     38,712     107,512     117,891     100,609
Acquired Brain Injury     19,605     37,249     37,741     35,075
Other     8,299     27,977     37,157     31,109
   
 
 
 
  Consolidated Total   $ 208,881   $ 580,356   $ 693,826   $ 648,493
   
 
 
 

19.    Stock Option Plan

        Prior to the Transaction, the Predecessor Company had a stock option plan that provided for the grant to directors, officers and key employees of options to purchase shares of common stock. Options typically have a vesting term of four years and expire ten years from date of grant. The total number of shares of common stock as to which options were granted could not exceed 1,292,952 shares of common stock. During the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006, fiscal 2005 and fiscal 2004, 294,500, 192,000 and 547,000 options, respectively, were granted.

        At the time of the Merger, all unvested stock options became vested in accordance with the change in control provisions of the original stock option agreements. According to the Merger Agreement, all stock options outstanding at the time of the Merger were cancelled, and holders of vested options received cash payment in the amount equal to the excess of the fair market value over the exercise price per share. The Successor Company has not established any share-based payment compensation arrangements.

F-33



        The fair value of options granted during the period from October 1 through June 29, 2006, fiscal 2005 and 2004 were calculated using the following assumptions:

 
  Period from
October 1
through

   
   
 
  Years ended September 30
 
  June 29
2006

 
  2005
  2004
Weighted-average exercise price   $ 22.50   $ $11.00   $ 7.00
Risk-free interest rate     4.40%     4.40%     4.26%
Expected dividend yield            
Expected life     6.25 years     10 years     10 years
Expected volatility     64.9%        
Weighted-average fair value of options granted   $ 14.38   $ 3.00   $ 2.71

        For the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006, the expected life was determined based on the shortcut method and expected volatility was determined based on historical data of equity instruments of comparable companies. For fiscal 2005 and 2004, the expected life was estimated based on historical exercise patterns.

        The following table illustrates the effect on net income if the fair value based method had been applied to fiscal 2005 and 2004.

 
  Years ended September 30
 
 
  2005
  2004
 
Net income, as reported   $ 13,998   $ 10,183  
Add: Stock-based employee compensation expense included in reported net income, net of related tax effects     58     14  
Deduct: Total stock-based employee compensation expense determined under fair value-based method for all awards, net of related tax effects     (347 )   (142 )
   
 
 
Net income, pro forma   $ 13,709   $ 10,055  
   
 
 

F-34


        A summary of the activity under the Company's stock option plan is presented below:

 
  Period from
October 1, 2005
through

  Years ended September 30
 
  June 29, 2006
  2005
  2004
 
  Options
  Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price

  Options
  Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price

  Options
  Weighted-
Average
Exercise
Price

Outstanding at beginning of period   847,000   $ 7.08   697,125   $ 5.93   189,000   $ 2.79
Granted   294,500     22.50   192,000     11.00   547,000     7.00
Cancelled or forfeited*   (1,141,500 )   11.06   (42,125 )   5.85   (38,875 )   5.74
   
       
       
     
Outstanding at end of period         847,000   $ 7.08   697,125   $ 5.93
   
       
       
     
Exercisable at end of period         221,625   $ 5.01   62,156   $ 2.27
   
       
       
     

*
Options of 1,081,750 were settled for cash on June 29, 2006 in connection with the Merger.

20.    Valuation and Qualifying Accounts

        The following table summarizes information about the allowances for doubtful accounts and sales allowances during the periods June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 and October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006 and for the years ended September 30, 2005 and 2004:

 
  Balance at
Beginning
of Period

  Provision
  Write-offs
  Balance
at End
of Period

Successor                    
Period from June 30 through September 30, 2006   $   1,412   (204 ) $ 1,208
   
 
 
 

Predecessor

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
Period from October 1 through June 29, 2006   $ 2,800   3,641   (3,808 ) $ 2,633
Year ended September 30, 2005   $ 2,796   9,341   (9,337 ) $ 2,800
Year ended September 30, 2004   $ 1,922   6,114   (5,240 ) $ 2,796

21.    Subsequent Events

        On December 1, 2006 the Company acquired the assets of Therapeutic Programs, Inc. (TPI) for approximately $9 million, subject to increase based on earnout provisions. TPI is a proprietary therapeutic foster care company headquartered in Montgomery, Alabama. TPI operates a small family-based services program in Jefferson County. TPI provides services to approximately 380 children and adolescents statewide, employs 130 staff and generates approximately $13 million in annual gross revenue in the eleven locations acquired by Mentor.

F-35



        On December 1, 2006, the Company acquired the stock of Rockland Child Development Services, Inc. (RCDS) for approximately $13 million, subject to increase based on earnout provisions. RCDS is an early intervention company located in Suffern, New York, that provides multilingual home-based developmental evaluation and clinical services to infants and toddlers with or at-risk for developmental delays, and children in the Committee on Preschool Education program. Established in 1999, RCDS provides services in Rockland and Orange Counties and the City of New York and generates approximately $11 million in annual gross revenues.

F-36


GRAPHIC



PART II
INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

Item 20: Indemnification of Directors and Officers.

Delaware General Corporation Law

        Section 145(a) of the Delaware General Corporation Law provides that a corporation may indemnify any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative (other than an action by or in the right of the corporation) by reason of the fact that such person is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise, against expenses (including attorneys' fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred by such person in connection with such action, suit or proceeding if such person acted in good faith and in a manner such person reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation, and, with respect to any criminal action or proceeding, had no reasonable cause to believe such person's conduct was unlawful.

        Section 145(b) of the Delaware General Corporation Law provides that a corporation may indemnify any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any threatened, pending or completed action or suit by or in the right of the corporation to procure a judgment in its favor by reason of the fact that such person is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise against expenses (including attorneys' fees) actually and reasonably incurred by such person in connection with the defense or settlement of such action or suit if such person acted in good faith and in a manner such person reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation and except that no indemnification shall be made in respect of any claim, issue or matter as to which such person shall have been adjudged to be liable to the corporation unless and only to the extent that the Delaware Court of Chancery or the court in which such action or suit was brought shall determine upon application that, despite the adjudication of liability but in view of all the circumstances of the case, such person is fairly and reasonably entitled to indemnity for such expenses which the Delaware Court of Chancery or such other court shall deem proper.

        Section 145(c) of the Delaware General Corporation Law provides that to the extent that a director, officer, employee or agent of a corporation has been successful on the merits or otherwise in defense of any action, suit or proceeding referred to in Section 145(a) and (b), or in defense of any claim, issue or matter therein, such person shall be indemnified against expenses (including attorneys' fees) actually and reasonably incurred by such person in connection therewith.

        Section 145(d) of the Delaware General Corporation Law provides that any indemnification under Section 145(a) and (b) (unless ordered by a court) shall be made by the corporation only as authorized in the specific case upon a determination that indemnification of the director, officer, employee or agent is proper in the circumstances because such person has met the applicable standard of conduct set forth in Section 145(a) and (b). Such determination shall be made (1) by a majority vote of the directors who were not parties to such action, suit or proceeding, even though less than a quorum, or (2) if there are no such directors, or if such directors so direct, by independent legal counsel in a written opinion, or (3) by the stockholders.

        Section 145(e) of the Delaware General Corporation Law provides that expenses (including attorneys' fees) incurred by an officer or director in defending any civil, criminal, administrative or investigative action, suit or proceeding may be paid by the corporation in advance of the final disposition of such action, suit or proceeding upon receipt of an undertaking by or on behalf of such

II-1



director or officer to repay such amount if it shall ultimately be determined that such person is not entitled to be indemnified by the corporation as authorized in Section 145. Such expenses (including attorneys' fees) incurred by other employees and agents may be so paid upon such terms and conditions, if any, as the board of directors deems appropriate.

        Section 145(f) of the Delaware General Corporation Law provides that the indemnification and advancement of expenses provided by, or granted pursuant to, Section 145 shall not be deemed exclusive of any other rights to which those seeking indemnification or advancement of expenses may be entitled under any bylaw, agreement, vote of stockholders or disinterested directors or otherwise.

        Section 145(g) of the Delaware General Corporation Law provides that a corporation shall have the power to purchase and maintain insurance on behalf of any person who is or was a director, officer, employee or agent of the corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise against any liability asserted against such person and incurred by such person in any such capacity, or arising out of such person's capacity as such, whether or not the corporation would have the power to indemnify such person against such liability under Section 145.

        Section 174 of the DGCL provides, among other things, that a director, who willfully or negligently approves of an unlawful payment of dividends or an unlawful stock purchase or redemption, may be held liable for such actions. A director who was either absent when the unlawful actions were approved or dissented at the time, may avoid liability by causing his or her dissent to such actions to be entered in the books containing the minutes of the meetings of the board of directors at the time such action occurred or immediately after such absent director receives notice of the unlawful acts.

National MENTOR Holdings, Inc. Certificate of Incorporation and By-laws

        The Issuer's certificate of incorporation provides that to the fullest extent permitted by the Delaware General Corporation Law, as may be amended, none of Holdings' directors shall be liable to it or its stockholders for monetary damages for a breach of fiduciary duty as a director. Holdings' by-laws provide that each person who was or is made a party or is threatened to be made a party to or is involved in any action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative (hereinafter a "proceeding"), by reason of the fact that he or she, or a person of whom he or she is the legal representative, is or was a director or officer, of Holdings or is or was serving at the request of Holdings as a director, officer, employee, fiduciary, or agent of another corporation or of a partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise, shall be indemnified and held harmless by Holdings to the fullest extent which it is empowered to do so by the Delaware General Corporation Law, against all expense, liability and loss) including attorneys' fees actually and reasonably incurred by such person in connection with such proceeding) and such indemnification shall inure to the benefit of his or her heirs, executors and administrators; provided, however, that, subject to certain exceptions, Holdings shall indemnify any such person seeking indemnification in connection with a proceeding initiated by such person only if such proceeding was authorized by the board of directors of Holdings. The right to indemnification conferred in the By-laws is a contract right and, subject to certain exceptions, shall include the right to be paid by Holdings the expenses incurred in defending any such proceeding in advance of its final disposition.

Other Registrants

        The other registrants are organized in Arizona, California, Colorado, Connecticut, Delaware, Illinois, Indiana, Iowa, Maryland, Massachusetts, Minnesota, Nevada, New Jersey, New York, North Dakota, Ohio, Pennsylvania, South Carolina, Utah, West Virginia and Wisconsin. Indemnification of such registrants' directors and officers provided by applicable law, by the registrants' organizational

II-2



documents, by contract or otherwise are substantially similar to that afforded by the directors and officers of National MENTOR Holdings, Inc.

Item 21. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules.

    (a)
    Exhibits

Exhibit No.
  Description
2.1*   Merger Agreement between National MENTOR Holdings, Inc., NMH Holdings, LLC, and NMH MergerSub Inc., dated as of March 22, 2006.
3.1*   Certificate of Formation of National MENTOR Holdings, LLC
3.2*   Limited Liability Company Agreement of National MENTOR Holdings, LLC
3.3*   Certificate of Incorporation of National MENTOR Holdings, Inc.
3.4*   By-Laws of National MENTOR Holdings, Inc.
3.5*   Certificate of Formation of National Mentor, LLC.
3.6*   Limited Liability Company Agreement of National Mentor, LLC.
3.7*   Certificate of Formation of National Mentor Services, LLC.
3.8*   Limited Liability Company Agreement of National Mentor Services, LLC.
3.9*   Certificate of Formation of Family Advocacy Services, LLC.
3.10*   Limited Liability Company Agreement of Family Advocacy Services, LLC.
3.11*   Certificate of Incorporation of National Mentor Services, Inc.
3.12*   By-Laws of National Mentor Services, Inc.
3.13*   Certificate of Incorporation of Mentor Management, Inc.
3.14*   By-Laws of Mentor Management, Inc.
3.15*   Certificate of Formation of National Mentor Healthcare, LLC
3.16*   Limited Liability Company Agreement of National Mentor Healthcare, LLC
3.17*   Articles of Incorporation of Center for Comprehensive Services, Inc.
3.18*   By-Laws of Center for Comprehensive Services, Inc.
3.19*   Articles of Incorporation of Illinois Mentor, Inc.
3.20*   By-Laws of Illinois Mentor, Inc.
3.21*   Articles of Incorporation of Massachusetts Mentor, Inc.
3.22*   By-Laws of Massachusetts Mentor, Inc.
3.23*   Articles of Incorporation of Loyd's Liberty Homes, Inc.
3.24*   By-Laws of Loyd's Liberty Homes, Inc.
3.25*   Articles of Incorporation of Unlimited Quest, Inc.
3.26*   By-Laws of Unlimited Quest, Inc.
3.27*   Articles of Incorporation of First Step Independent Living Program, Inc.
3.28*   By-Laws of First Step Independent Living Program, Inc.
3.29*   Articles of Incorporation of Homework Center, Inc.
     

II-3


3.30*   By-Laws of Homework Center, Inc.
3.31*   Articles of Incorporation of Horrigan Cole Enterprises, Inc.
3.32*   By-Laws of Horrigan Cole Enterprises, Inc.
3.33*   Articles of Incorporation of Ohio Mentor, Inc.
3.34*   By-Laws of Ohio Mentor, Inc.
3.35*   Articles of Incorporation of South Carolina Mentor, Inc.
3.36*   By-Laws of South Carolina Mentor, Inc.
3.37*   Articles of Incorporation of Mentor Maryland, Inc.
3.38*   By-Laws of Mentor Maryland, Inc.
3.39*   Articles of Incorporation of Cornerstone Living Skills, Inc.
3.40*   By-Laws of Cornerstone Living Skills, Inc.
3.41*   Articles of Incorporation of REM, Inc.
3.42*   By-Laws of REM, Inc.
3.43*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Arizona Rehabilitation, Inc.
3.44*   By-Laws of REM Arizona Rehabilitation, Inc.
3.45*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Arrowhead, Inc.
3.46*   By-Laws of REM Arrowhead, Inc.
3.47*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Central Lakes, Inc.
3.48*   By-Laws of REM Central Lakes, Inc.
3.49*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Colorado, Inc.
3.50*   By-Laws of REM Colorado, Inc.
3.51*   Articles of Organization of REM Community Payroll Services, LLC.
3.52*   Member Control Agreement of REM Community Payroll Services, LLC.
3.53*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Community Options, Inc.
3.54*   By-Laws of REM Community Options, Inc.
3.55*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Connecticut Community Services, Inc.
3.56*   By-Laws of REM Connecticut Community Services, Inc.
3.57*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Consulting & Services, Inc.
3.58*   By-Laws of REM Consulting & Services, Inc.
3.59*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Consulting of Ohio, Inc.
3.60*   By-Laws of REM Consulting of Ohio, Inc.
3.61*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Developmental Services, Inc.
3.62*   By-Laws of REM Developmental Services, Inc.
3.63*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Health, Inc.
3.64*   By-Laws of REM Health, Inc.
     

II-4


3.65*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Health of Iowa, Inc.
3.66*   By-Laws of REM Health of Iowa, Inc.
3.67*   Certificate of Formation of REM Health of Nebraska, LLC.
3.68*   Limited Liability Company Agreement of REM Health of Nebraska, LLC.
3.69*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Health of Wisconsin, Inc.
3.70*   By-Laws of REM Health of Wisconsin, Inc.
3.71*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Health of Wisconsin II, Inc.
3.72*   By-Laws of REM Health of Wisconsin II, Inc.
3.73*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Heartland, Inc.
3.74*   By-Laws of REM Heartland, Inc.
3.75*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Hennepin, Inc.
3.76*   By-Laws of Rem Hennepin, Inc.
3.77*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Home Health, Inc.
3.78*   By-Laws of REM Home Health, Inc.
3.79*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Indiana, Inc.
3.80*   By-Laws of REM Indiana, Inc.
3.81*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Indiana Community Services, Inc.
3.82*   By-Laws of REM Indiana Community Services, Inc.
3.83*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Indiana Community Services II, Inc.
3.84*   By-Laws of REM Indiana Community Services II, Inc.
3.85*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Iowa Community Services, Inc.
3.86*   By-Laws of REM Iowa Community Services, Inc.
3.87*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Iowa, Inc.
3.88*   By-Laws of REM Iowa, Inc.
3.89*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Management, Inc.
3.90*   By-Laws of REM Management, Inc.
3.91*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Maryland, Inc.
3.92*   By-Laws of REM Maryland, Inc.
3.93*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Minnesota Community Services, Inc.
3.94*   By-Laws of REM Minnesota Community Services, Inc.
3.95*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Minnesota, Inc.
3.96*   By-Laws of REM Minnesota, Inc.
3.97*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Nevada, Inc.
3.98*   By-Laws of REM Nevada, Inc.
3.99*   Articles of Incorporation of REM New Jersey, Inc.
     

II-5


3.100*   By-Laws of REM New Jersey, Inc.
3.101*   Articles of Incorporation of REM North Dakota, Inc.
3.102*   By-Laws of REM North Dakota, Inc.
3.103*   Articles of Incorporation of REM North Star, Inc.
3.104*   By-Laws of REM North Star, Inc.
3.105*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Ohio, Inc.
3.106*   By-Laws of REM Ohio, Inc.
3.107*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Ohio Waivered Services, Inc.
3.108*   By-Laws of REM Ohio Waivered Services, Inc.
3.109*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Pennsylvania Community Services, Inc.
3.110*   By-Laws of REM Pennsylvania Community Services, Inc.
3.111*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Ramsey, Inc.
3.112*   By-Laws of REM Ramsey, Inc.
3.113*   Articles of Incorporation of REM River Bluffs, Inc.
3.114*   By-Laws of REM River Bluffs, Inc.
3.115*   Articles of Incorporation of REM South Central Services, Inc.
3.116*   By-Laws of REM South Central Services, Inc.
3.117*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Southwest Services, Inc.
3.118*   By-Laws of REM Southwest Services, Inc.
3.119*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Utah, Inc.
3.120*   By-Laws of REM Utah, Inc.
3.121*   Articles of Incorporation of REM West Virginia, Inc.
3.122*   By-Laws of REM West Virginia, Inc.
3.123*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Wisconsin, Inc.
3.124*   By-Laws of REM Wisconsin, Inc.
3.125*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Wisconsin II, Inc.
3.126*   By-Laws of REM Wisconsin II, Inc.
3.127*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Wisconsin III, Inc.
3.128*   By-Laws of REM Wisconsin III, Inc.
3.129*   Articles of Incorporation of REM Woodvale, Inc.
3.130*   By-Laws of REM Woodvale, Inc.
3.131   Certificate of Incorporation of Rockland Child Development Services, Inc.
3.132   By-Laws of Rockland Child Development Services, Inc.
4.1*   Indenture, dated as of June 29, 2006, by and among National Mentor Holdings, Inc., the guarantors named therein, and U.S. Bank National Association, as trustee.
     

II-6


4.2   Supplemental Indenture, dated as of January 11, 2007, by and among National Mentor Holdings, Inc., Rockland Child Development Services, Inc. and U.S. Bank National Association, as trustee.
4.3*   Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of June 29, 2006, by and among National MENTOR Holdings, Inc., the guarantors named therein and J.P. Morgan Securities Inc., UBS Investment Bank and Banc of America Securities LLC with respect to 11 1 / 4 % Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014.
4.4*   Form of Senior Subordinated Note (attached as exhibit to Exhibit 4.1).
5.1   Opinion of Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP.
5.2*   Opinion of Jennings, Strouss & Salmon P.L.C.
5.3*   Opinion of Foley & Lardner LLP.
5.4*   Opinion of Kirkland & Ellis LLP.
5.5*   Opinion of Barnes & Thornburg LLP.
5.6*   Opinion of Whiteford, Taylor & Preston L.L.P.
5.7*   Opinion of Choate, Hall & Stewart LLP.
5.8*   Opinion of Hinshaw & Culbertson LLP.
5.9*   Opinion of Woodburn and Wedge.
5.10*   Opinion of Giordano, Halleran & Ciesla A Professional Corporation.
5.11*   Opinion of Vogel Law Firm.
5.12*   Opinion of Frost Brown Todd LLC.
5.13*   Opinion of Reed Smith LLP.
5.14*   Opinion of Parker Poe Adams & Bernstein LLP.
5.15*   Opinion of Robinson & McElwee PLLC.
5.16*   Opinion of Michael Best & Friedrich LLP.
10.1*   Credit Agreement, dated June 29, 2006, among NMH Holdings, LLC, National MENTOR Holdings, Inc., the several lenders parties thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Administrative Agent.
10.2*   Term Loan Agreement, dated May 20, 2005, among National MENTOR Holdings, Inc., National MENTOR, Inc., REM Arrowhead, Inc., REM Connecticut Community Services, Inc., REM Indiana, Inc., REM North Dakota, Inc., REM Wisconsin I, Inc., REM Wisconsin II, Inc., REM Wisconsin III, Inc., and certain other Borrowers, and BANK OF AMERICA, N.A.
10.3*   Amendment No. 1 to Term Loan Agreement and Joinder Agreement, dated June 29, 2006, among NMH Holdings, LLC, National Mentor Holdings, Inc., National Mentor, Inc., REM Arrowhead, Inc., REM Connecticut Community Services, Inc., REM Indiana, Inc., REM North Dakota, Inc., REM Wisconsin, Inc., REM Wisconsin II, Inc., REM Wisconsin III, Inc. and Bank of America, N.A.
10.4*   Amended and Restated Employment Agreement, dated June 29, 2006, between National MENTOR Holdings, Inc. and Edward Murphy.
     

II-7


10.5*   Amended and Restated Employment Agreement, dated June 29, 2006, between National MENTOR Holdings, Inc. and Gregory Torres.
10.6*   First Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated March 9, 2001, between National MENTOR, Inc. and Elizabeth V. Hopper.
10.7*   First Amendment to Employment Agreement, dated March 9, 2001, between National MENTOR, Inc. and Donald Monack.
10.8*   Separation Agreement and Release, dated March 31, 2005, among National MENTOR Holdings, Inc., National MENTOR, Inc. and Donald Monack.
10.9*   Separation Agreement, dated as of September 30, 2005, among National MENTOR Holdings, Inc., National MENTOR, Inc. and Elizabeth V. Hopper.
10.10*   Form of Severance and Noncompetition Agreement
10.11*   Management Services Agreement, dated as of June 29, 2006, between National Mentor Holdings, Inc., National Mentor, Inc., NMH Investment, LLC, NMH Holdings, LLC and Vestar Capital Partners.
10.12*   National MENTOR, Inc. Executive Deferred Compensation Plan, dated March 9, 2001.
10.13*   National MENTOR, Inc. Executive Deferral Plan, dated November 1, 2003.
10.14*   The MENTOR Executive Leadership Incentive Plan.
10.15   Form of Management Unit Subscription Agreement.
10.16   Form of Director Unit Subscription Agreement (Timmons).
10.17   NMH Investment, LLC Amended and Restated 2006 Unit Plan.
12.1   Statement Regarding Computation of Earnings to Fixed Charges.
21.1*   Subsidiaries of National MENTOR Holdings, Inc.
23.1   Consent of Ernst & Young LLP.
23.2   Consent of Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP (included in Exhibit 5.1).
23.3*   Consent of Jennings, Strouss & Salmon P.L.C. (included in Exhibit 5.2).
23.4*   Consent of Foley & Lardner LLP (included in Exhibit 5.3).
23.7*   Consent of Kirkland & Ellis LLP (included in Exhibit 5.4).
23.8*   Consent of Barnes & Thornburg LLP (included in Exhibit 5.5).
23.10*   Consent of Whiteford, Taylor & Preston L.L.P. (included in Exhibit 5.6).
23.11*   Consent of Choate, Hall & Stewart LLP (included in Exhibit 5.7).
23.12*   Consent of Hinshaw & Culbertson LLP (included in Exhibit 5.8).
23.13*   Consent of Woodburn and Wedge (included in Exhibit 5.9).
23.14*   Consent of Giordano, Halleran & Ciesla A Professional Corporation (included in Exhibit 5.10).
23.15*   Consent of Vogel Law Firm (included in Exhibit 5.11).
23.16*   Consent of Frost Brown Todd LLC (included in Exhibit 5.12).
23.17*   Consent of Reed Smith LLP (included in Exhibit 5.13).
23.18*   Consent of Parker Poe Adams & Bernstein LLP (included in Exhibit 5.14).
     

II-8


23.20*   Consent of Robinson & McElwee PLLC (included in Exhibit 5.15).
23.21*   Consent of Michael Best & Friedrich LLP (included in Exhibit 5.16).
24.1*   Power of Attorney.
25.1*   Statement of Eligibility of Trustee on Form T-1 under the Trust Indenture Act of 1939 of U.S. Bank National Association.
99.1*   Form of Letter of Transmittal.
99.2*   Form of Letter to Brokers, Dealers.
99.3*   Form of Letter to Clients.
99.4*   Form of Notice of Guaranteed Delivery.

*
Previously filed.

Item 22. Undertakings.

        The undersigned registrants hereby undertake:

    (1)
    To file, during any period in which offers or sales are being made, a post-effective amendment to this registration statement:

    (i)
    To include any prospectus required by Section 10(a)(3) of the Securities Act of 1993;

    (ii)
    To reflect in the prospectus any facts or events arising after the effective date of the registration statement (or the most recent post-effective amendment thereof) which, individually or in the aggregate, represent a fundamental change in the information set forth in the registration statement. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any increase or decrease in volume of securities offered (if the total dollar value of securities offered would not exceed that which was registered) and any deviation from the low or high end of the estimated maximum offering range may be reflected in the form of prospectus filed with the Commission pursuant to Rule 424(b) if, in the aggregate, the changes in volume and price represent no more than a 20% change in the maximum aggregate offering price set forth in the "Calculation of Registration Fee" table in the effective registration statement; and

    (iii)
    To include any material information with respect to the plan of distribution not previously disclosed in the registration statement or any material change to such information in the registration statement.

    (2)
    That, for the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, each such post-effective amendment shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.

    (3)
    To remove from registration by means of a post-effective amendment any of the securities being registered which remain unsold at the termination of the offering.

        Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to directors, officers, or controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act and is therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrants of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of

II-9


the registrants in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the registrants will, unless in the opinion of it counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

        The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to respond to requests for information that is incorporated by reference into the prospectus pursuant to Item 4, 10(b), 11, or 13 of this form, within one business day of receipt of such request, and to send the incorporated documents by first class mail or other equally prompt means. This includes information contained in documents filed subsequent to the effective date of the registration statement through the date of responding to the request.

        The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes to supply by means of a post-effective amendment all information concerning a transaction, and the company being acquired involved therein, that was not the subject of and included in the registration statement when it became effective.

II-10


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, National MENTOR Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    NATIONAL MENTOR HOLDINGS, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer


POWER OF ATTORNEY

        KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints Edward M. Murphy, Denis M. Holler and Linda DeRenzo, and each of them, his or her true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power of substitution and resubstitution, for him or her and in his or her name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign any or all amendments (including post-effective amendments) to this registration statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and to file the same, with all exhibits thereto, and other documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto said attorneys-in- fact and agents, and each of them, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done in and about the premises, as fully to all intents and purposes as he or she might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and agents or any of them, or their, or his or her substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement and power of attorney have been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Gregory Torres

 

Chairman and Director

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Brian Ratzan

 

Director

*

Daniel S. O'Connell

 

Director

*

James L. Elrod, Jr.

 

Director

/s/  
JEFFRY A. TIMMONS       
Jeffry A. Timmons

 

Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-11


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Center for Comprehensive Services, Inc., an Illinois corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    CENTER FOR COMPREHENSIVE SERVICES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*

Nancy Weisling

 

Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-12



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Cornerstone Living Skills, Inc., a California corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    CORNERSTONE LIVING SKILLS, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-13


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Family Advocacy Services, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    FAMILY ADVOCACY SERVICES, LLC

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer)

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Bruce F. Nardella

 

Senior Vice President and Manager

*

Margie Blazier

 

Manager

*

Henry Cofiell

 

Manager

*

Lisa Coscia

 

Manager
     

II-14



*

Patricia Donovan

 

Manager

*

Roberta J. Irgens

 

Manager

*

Noreen Rysticken

 

Manager

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-15



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, First Step Independent Living Program, Inc., a California corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007

    FIRST STEP INDEPENDENT LIVING PROGRAM, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer
(principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-16



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Homework Center, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    HOMEWORK CENTER, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-17



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Horrigan Cole Enterprises, Inc., a California corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    HORRIGAN COLE ENTERPRISES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-18



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Illinois Mentor, Inc., an Illinois corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    ILLINOIS MENTOR, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer
(principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*

Robert A. Longo

 

Senior Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-19



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Loyd's Liberty Homes, Inc., a California corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    LOYD'S LIBERTY HOMES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer
(principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-20



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Massachusetts Mentor, Inc., a Massachusetts corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    MASSACHUSETTS MENTOR, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer
(principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-21


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Mentor Management, Inc., a Delaware corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    MENTOR MANAGEMENT, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-22



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Mentor Maryland, Inc., a Maryland corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    MENTOR MARYLAND, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer)

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Bruce F. Nardella

 

Director

*

Margie Blazier

 

Director

*

Henry Cofiell

 

Director

*

Lisa Coscia

 

Director

*

Patricia Donovan

 

Director

*

Roberta J. Irgens

 

Director

*

Noreen Rysticken

 

Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-23


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, National Mentor Healthcare, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    NATIONAL MENTOR HEALTHCARE, LLC

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Manager

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Manager

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-24


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, National MENTOR Holdings, LLC, a Delaware corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.



    NATIONAL MENTOR HOLDINGS, LLC

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Manager

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Manager

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-25


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, National Mentor, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    NATIONAL MENTOR, LLC

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Manager

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Manager

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-26


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, National Mentor Services, Inc., a Delaware corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    NATIONAL MENTOR SERVICES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-27


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, National Mentor Services, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    NATIONAL MENTOR SERVICES, LLC

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Manager

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Manager

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-28



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Ohio Mentor, Inc., an Ohio corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    OHIO MENTOR, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-29



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-30



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Arizona Rehabilitation, Inc., an Arizona corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM ARIZONA REHABILITATION, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-31



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Arrowhead, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM ARROWHEAD, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-32



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Central Lakes, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM CENTRAL LAKES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-33



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Colorado, Inc., a Colorado corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM COLORADO, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-34



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Community Options, Inc., a West Virginia corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM COMMUNITY OPTIONS, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-35



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Community Payroll Services, LLC, a Minnesota limited liability company, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM COMMUNITY PAYROLL SERVICES, LLC

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Governor

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Governor

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-36



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Connecticut Community Services, Inc., a Connecticut corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM CONNECTICUT COMMUNITY SERVICES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-37



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Consulting & Services, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM CONSULTING & SERVICES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-38



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Consulting of Ohio, Inc., an Ohio corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM CONSULTING OF OHIO, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-39



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Developmental Services, Inc., an Iowa corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM DEVELOPMENTAL SERVICES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-40



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Health, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM HEALTH, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-41



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Health of Iowa, Inc., an Iowa corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM HEALTH OF IOWA, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-42


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Health of Nebraska, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM HEALTH OF NEBRASKA, LLC

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Manager

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Manager

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-43


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Health of Wisconsin, Inc., a Wisconsin corporation, has duly caused this amendment to theRegistration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM HEALTH OF WISCONSIN, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-44


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Health of Wisconsin II, Inc., a Wisconsin corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM HEALTH OF WISCONSIN II, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-45


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Heartland, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM HEARTLAND, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-46


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Hennepin, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM HENNEPIN, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-47


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Home Health, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM HOME HEALTH, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-48


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Indiana, Inc., an Indiana corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM INDIANA, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-49


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Indiana Community Services, Inc., an Indiana corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM INDIANA COMMUNITY SERVICES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-50


SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Indiana Community Services II, Inc., an Indiana corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM INDIANA COMMUNITY SERVICES II, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 

*

Edward M. Murphy

 

President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-51



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Iowa Community Services, Inc., an Iowa corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM IOWA COMMUNITY SERVICES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-52



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Iowa, Inc., an Iowa corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM IOWA, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-53



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Management, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM MANAGEMENT, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-54



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Maryland, Inc., a Maryland corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM MARYLAND, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-55



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Minnesota Community Services, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM MINNESOTA COMMUNITY SERVICES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-56



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Minnesota, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM MINNESOTA, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-57



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Nevada, Inc., a Nevada corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM NEVADA, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-58



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM New Jersey, Inc., a New Jersey corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM NEW JERSEY, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-59



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM North Dakota, Inc., a North Dakota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM NORTH DAKOTA, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-60



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM North Star, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM NORTH STAR, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-61



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Ohio, Inc., an Ohio corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM OHIO, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-62



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Ohio Waivered Services, Inc., an Ohio corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM OHIO WAIVERED SERVICES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-63



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Pennsylvania Community Services, Inc., a Pennsylvania corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM PENNSYLVANIA COMMUNITY SERVICES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-64



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Ramsey, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM RAMSEY, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-65



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM River Bluffs, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM RIVER BLUFFS, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-66



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM South Central Services, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM SOUTH CENTRAL SERVICES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-67



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Southwest Services, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM SOUTHWEST SERVICES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-68



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Utah, Inc., a Utah corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM UTAH, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-69



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM West Virginia, Inc., a West Virginia corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM WEST VIRGINIA, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-70



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Wisconsin, Inc., a Wisconsin corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM WISCONSIN, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-71



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Wisconsin II, Inc., a Wisconsin corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM WISCONSIN II, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-72



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Wisconsin III, Inc., a Wisconsin corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM WISCONSIN III, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-73



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, REM Woodvale, Inc., a Minnesota corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    REM WOODVALE, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
     
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-74



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Rockland Child Development Services, Inc., a New York corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    ROCKLAND CHILD DEVELOPMENT SERVICES, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer


POWER OF ATTORNEY

        KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints Edward M. Murphy, Denis M. Holler and Linda DeRenzo, and each of them, his or her true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power of substitution and resubstitution, for him or her and in his or her name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign any or all amendments (including post-effective amendments) to this registration statement under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and to file the same, with all exhibits thereto, and other documents in connection therewith, with the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto said attorneys-in-fact and agents, and each of them, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done in and about the premises, as fully to all intents and purposes as he or she might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and agents or any of them, or their, or his or her substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement and power of attorney have been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2006.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
/s/   EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

/s/  
DENIS M. HOLLER       
Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

/s/  
JULIETTE E. FAY       
Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

II-75



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, South Carolina Mentor, Inc., a South Carolina corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    SOUTH CAROLINA MENTOR, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer (principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-76



SIGNATURES

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, Unlimited Quest, Inc., a California corporation, has duly caused this amendment to the Registration Statement on Form S-4 to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Boston, State of Massachusetts, on January 12, 2007.

    UNLIMITED QUEST, INC.

 

 

By:

/s/  
EDWARD M. MURPHY       
Edward M. Murphy
President and Chief Executive Officer

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated on January 12, 2007.

Signature
  Title

 

 

 
*
Edward M. Murphy
  President and Chief Executive Officer
(principal executive officer) and Director

*

Denis M. Holler

 

Senior Vice President of Finance and Treasurer (principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)

*

Juliette E. Fay

 

Executive Vice President and Director

*By:

 

/s/  
LINDA DERENZO       
Attorney-in-fact

 

 

 

 

II-77




QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document

Exhibit 3.131

CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION
OF
ROCKLAND CHILD DEVELOPMENT SERVICES, INC.
Under Section 402 of the Business Corporation Law

Charles H. Rosenberg
950 Third Avenue
New York, New York 10022


CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION
OF
ROCKLAND CHILD DEVELOPMENT SERVICES, INC.


Under Section 402 of the Business Corporation Law

        The undersigned, being a natural person of at least 18 years of age and acting as the incorporator of the corporation hereby being formed under the Business Corporation Law, certifies that:

        FIRST:    The name of the corporation is ROCKLAND CHILD DEVELOPMENT SERVICES, INC.

        SECOND:    The Corporation is formed for the following purpose or purposes:

        To apply to the State of New York State Department of Health for approval to serve as an agency to provide Evaluators, and Service Providers and Service Coordinators under the New York State Early Intervention Program, and to provide such early intervention home-based services as shall be authorized by the New York State Department of Health in connection with its early intervention programs, and to provide such other and additional services relating thereto or connected therewith as shall be authorized by the State of New York Department of Health.

        Upon receiving said approval from the State of New York Department of Health, an amended certificate of incorporation will be filed which will substitute the following as the first paragraph of Article Second.

        SECOND:    The corporation is formed for the following purpose or purposes:

        To serve as an agency to provide Evaluators, and Service Providers and Service Coordinators under the New York State Early Intervention Program, and to provide such early intervention home-based services as shall be authorized by the New York State Department of Health in connection with its early intervention programs, and to provide such other and additional services relating thereto or connected therewith as shall be authorized by the State of New York Department of Health.

        To carry on a general mercantile, industrial, investing, and trading business in all its branches; to devise, invent, manufacture, fabricate, assemble, install, service, maintain alter, buy, sell, import, export, license as licensor or licensee, lease as lessor or lessee, distribute, job, enter into, negotiate, execute, acquire, and assign contracts in respect of, acquire, receive, grant, and assign licensing arrangements, options, franchises, and other rights in respect of, and generally deal in and with, at wholesale and retail, as principal, and as sales, business, special, or general agent, representative, broker, factor, merchant, distributor, jobber, advisor, and in any other lawful capacity, goods, wares, merchandise, commodities, and unimproved, improved, finished, processed, and other real, personal, and mixed property of any and all kinds, together with the components, resultants, and by-products thereof; to acquire by purchase or otherwise own, hold, lease, mortgage, sell, or otherwise dispose of, erect, construct, make, alter, enlarge, improve, and to aid or subscribe toward the construction, acquisition, or improvement of any factories, shops, storehouses, buildings, and commercial and retail establishments of every character, including all equipment, fixtures, machinery, implements, and supplies necessary, or incidental to, or connected with, any of the purposes or business of the corporation; and generally to perform any and all acts connected therewith or arising therefrom or incidental thereto, and all acts proper or necessary for the purpose of the business.

        To engage generally in the real estate business as principal, agent, broker, and in any lawful capacity, and generally to take, lease, purchase, or otherwise acquire, and to own, use, hold, sell, convey, exchange, lease, mortgage, work, clear, improve, develop, divide, and otherwise handle, manage, operate, deal in, and dispose of real estate, real property, lands, multiple-dwelling structures, houses, buildings, and other works, and any interest or right therein; to take, lease, purchase, or otherwise acquire, and to own, use, hold, sell, convey, exchange, hire, lease, pledge, mortgage, and otherwise handle, and deal in and dispose of, as principal, agent, broker, and in any lawful capacity,



such personal property, chattels, chattels real, rights, easements, privileges, choses in action, notes, bonds, mortgages, and securities, as may lawfully be acquired, held, or disposed of; and to acquire, purchase, sell, assign, transfer, dispose of, and generally deal in and with, as principal, agent, broker, and in any lawful capacity, mortgages and other interests in real, personal, and mixed properties; to carry on a general construction, contracting, building, and realty management business as principal, agent, representative, contractor, subcontractor, and in any other lawful capacity.

        To apply for, register, obtain, purchase, lease, take licenses in respect of or otherwise acquire, and to hold, own, use, operate, develop, enjoy, turn to account, grant licenses and immunities in respect of, manufacture under, and to introduce, sell, assign, mortgage, pledge or otherwise dispose of, and in any manner deal with and contract with reference to:

        To engage in any lawful act or activity for which corporations may be organized under the Business Corporation Law, provided that the corporation is not formed to engage in any act or activity requiring the consent or approval of any state official, department, board, agency, or other body without such consent or approval first being obtained.

        To have, in furtherance of the corporate purposes, all of the powers conferred upon corporations organized under the Business Corporation Law subject to any limitations thereof contained in this certificate of incorporation or in the laws of the State of New York.

        THIRD:    The office of the corporation is to be located in the County of Rockland, State of New York.

        FOURTH:    The aggregate number of shares which the corporation shall have authority to issue is one thousand, all of which are of a par value of one dollar each, and all of which are of the same class.

        FIFTH:    The Secretary of State is designated as the agent of the corporation upon whom process against the corporation may be served. The post office address within the State of New York to which the Secretary of State shall mail a copy of any process against the corporation served upon him is: 58 Concord Drive, Monsey, New York 10952.

        SIXTH:    The duration of the corporation is to be perpetual.

        SEVENTH:    The corporation shall, to the fullest extent permitted by Article 7 of the Business Corporation Law, as the same may be amended and supplemented, indemnify any and all persons whom it shall have power to indemnify under said Article from and against any and all of the expenses, liabilities, or other matters referred to in or covered by said Article, and the indemnifications provided for herein shall not be deemed exclusive of any other rights to which any person may be entitled under any By-Law, resolution of shareholders, resolution of directors, agreement, or otherwise, as permitted by said Article, as to action in any capacity in which he served at the request of the corporation.

        EIGHTH:    The personal liability of the directors of the corporation is eliminated to the fullest extent permitted by the provisions of paragraph (b) of Section 402 of the Business Corporation Law, as the same may be amended and supplemented.

2



        NINTH:    Whenever under the provisions of the Business Corporation Law shareholders are required or permitted to take any action by vote, such action may be taken without a meeting on written consent, signed by the holders of outstanding shares having not less than the minimum number of votes that would be necessary to authorize or take such action as a meeting at which all shares entitled to vote thereon were present and voted, in accordance with the provisions of Section 615 of the Business Corporation Law.

Signed on September 29, 1999

  /s/   JOHN S. HOEMGMANN       
John S. Hoemgmann, Incorporator
Two World Trade Center
Suite 8746
New York, New York 10048-8798
 
State of New York   }    
    ss:
Department of State }    

         I hereby certify that the annexed copy has been compared with the original document in the custody of the Secretary of State and that the same is a true copy of said original.

         Witness my hand and seal of the Department of State on December 1, 2006

Special Deputy Secretary of State

3


New York State
Department of State
Division of Corporations, State Records
and Uniform Commercial Code
41 State Street
Albany, NY 12231
www.dos.state.ny.us

CERTIFICATE OF AMENDMENT
OF THE
CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION
OF
ROCKLAND CHILD DEVELOPMENT SERVICES, INC.
(
Insert Name of Domestic Corporation )
Under Section 805 of the Business Corporation Law

        FIRST:    The name of the corporation is: Rockland Child Development Services, Inc.

        If the name of the corporation has been changed, the name under which it was formed is:                       



        SECOND:    The date of filing of the certificate of incorporation with the Department of State is: October 22, 1999

        THIRD:    The amendment effected by this certificate of amendment is as follows: (Set forth each amendment in a separate paragraph providing the subject matter and full text of each amended paragraph. For example, an amendment changing the name of the corporation would read as follows: Paragraph First of the Certificate of Incorporation relating to the corporation name is hereby amended to read as follows: First: The name of the corporation is... (new name)... )

        Paragraph Second of the Certificate of Incorporation relating to the purpose of the corporation is hereby amended to read in its entirety as follows: Second: The corporation is formed for the following purpose or purposes: (i) to serve as an agency to provide evaluators, service providers and service coordinators under the New York State Early Intervention Program, and to provide such early intervention home-based services as shall be authorized by the New York State Department of Health in connection with its early intervention programs, and to provide such other and additional services relating thereto or connected therewith as shall be authorized by the State of New York Department of Health; (ii) to engage in any lawful act or activity for which corporations may be organized under the Business Corporation Law, provided that the corporation is not formed to engage in any act or activity requiring the consent or approval of any state official, department, board, agency or other body without such consent or approval first being obtained; and (iii) to have, in furtherance of the corporate purposes, all of the powers conferred upon corporations organized under the Business Corporation Law subject to any limitations thereof contained in the laws of the State of New York.

         Nothing herein shall authorize the corporation to engage in the practice of any profession, or to use a professional title of any profession, required to be licensed by title VIII of the Education Law.

        FOURTH:    The certificate of amendment was authorized by: [ Check the appropriate box ]

o   The vote of the board of directors followed by a vote of a majority of all outstanding shares entitled to vote thereon at a meeting of shareholders.

ý   The vote of the board of directors followed by the unanimous written consent of the holders of all outstanding shares.

/s/   JULIETTE FAY       
( Signature)
  Juliette Fay, Executive Vice President
(Name and Capacity of Signer)

CERTIFICATE OF AMENDMENT
OF THE
CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION
OF
ROCKLAND CHILD DEVELOPMENT SERVICES, INC.
Under Section 805 of the Business Corporation Law

Filer's Name: Rogers Warner
Address:
401 South Tryon Street
City, State and Zip Code:
Charlotte, North Carolina 28202

        NOTE:    This form was prepared by the New York State Department of State. It does not contain all optional provisions under the law. You are not required to use this form. You may draft your own form or use forms available at legal stationery stores. The Department of State recommends that all documents be prepared under the guidance of an attorney. The certificate must be submitted with a $60 filing fee, plus the required tax on shares pursuant to §180 of the Tax Law, if applicable.

2




QuickLinks

Exhibit 3.131

QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document


Exhibit 3.132

BY-LAWS
OF
ROCKLAND CHILD DEVELOPMENT SERVICES, INC.
(a New York corporation)

ARTICLE I
Provisions of Law

        These By-Laws shall be subject to such provisions of the statutory and common laws of the state in which the corporation was incorporated as may be applicable to corporations organized under the laws of such state. Subsequent references herein to provisions of law shall be deemed to be references to the aforesaid provisions of law. All references in these By-Laws to such provisions of law shall be construed to refer to such provisions as from time to time amended.

ARTICLE II
Articles of Incorporation

        These By-Laws shall be subject to the Articles of Incorporation of the corporation. All references in these By-Laws to the Articles of Incorporation shall be construed to mean the Articles of Incorporation of the corporation as from time to time amended.

ARTICLE III
Stockholders

        1.     Annual Meeting:     The annual meeting of stockholders shall be held on December 1 in each year if not a legal holiday, and if a legal holiday, the next succeeding full business day, or at such other date and time as shall be designated from time to time by the Board of Directors or the President. Each annual meeting shall be held for the purpose of electing Directors of the corporation and for such other purposes and for the transaction of such other business as may properly be brought before the meeting.

        If the election of Directors of the corporation shall not be held on the day designated in accordance with the foregoing, the Board of Directors shall cause such election to be held as soon thereafter as convenient. A special meeting of the stockholders of the corporation shall be held for such election and for such other purposes and for the transaction of such other business as might have been held or transacted at such annual meeting. Any election held, or any business transacted at such special meeting, shall have the same force and effect as if held or transacted at the annual meeting.

        2.     Special Meetings:     Unless otherwise required by law or the Articles of Incorporation, a special meeting of the stockholders may be called for any purpose or purposes by the Directors or by the President. Upon written request of one or more stockholders who own at least ten percent (10%) of the capital stock issued and outstanding and entitled to vote at the meeting, a special meeting shall be called by the Secretary, or in the case of the death, absence, incapacity or refusal to act of the Secretary, by any other officer. Such request shall state the purpose or purposes of the proposed meeting.

        3.     Place of Meeting:     All meetings of the stockholders, annual or special, shall be held at such place within or without the state of incorporation as may be designated from time to time by the Board of Directors or the officer calling the meeting or if not so designated, at the registered office of the corporation.

1



        4.     Notice of Meetings:     Except as otherwise provided by law, a written notice of every meeting of stockholders, annual or special, stating the place, date and hour thereof, and, in the case of special meetings, the purpose or purposes for which the meeting is to be held, shall be given by the person or persons calling the meeting or by any officer of the corporation acting at his or their direction not less than ten (10) nor more than sixty (60) days before the meeting to each stockholder, who by law, by the Articles of Incorporation or by these By-Laws, is entitled to vote at or notice of such meeting. Such notice shall be given either personally, by leaving it with him or at his residence or place of business, or by telephone, telecopy or electronic mail or other equivalent electronic media. If mailed, such notice shall be deemed to be given when deposited in the United States mail, with postage prepaid, directed to the stockholder at his address as it appears on the records of the corporation. No notice of any adjourned meeting shall be required if (a) the time and place thereof are announced at the meeting at which the adjournment is taken, (b) the adjournment is for less than thirty (30) days, and (c) no new record date is fixed for the adjourned meeting.

        5.     Waivers of Notice:     Whenever notice is required to be given to any stockholder by law, the Articles of Incorporation or these By-Laws, a written waiver thereof, signed by the stockholder entitled to notice, whether before or after the time stated therein, shall be deemed equivalent to notice. Attendance of a stockholder at a meeting shall constitute a waiver of notice of such meeting, except when the stockholder attends a meeting for the express purpose of objecting, at the beginning of the meeting, to the transaction of any business because the meeting is not lawfully called or convened. Neither the business to be transacted at, nor the purpose of, any regular or special meeting of the stockholders need be specified in any written waiver of notice.

        6.     Voting List:     The officer who has charge of the stock ledger of the corporation shall prepare and make, at least ten days before every meeting of stockholders, a complete list of the stockholders entitled to vote at the meeting, arranged in alphabetical order, and showing the address of each stockholder and the number of shares registered in the name of each stockholder. Such list shall be open to the examination of any stockholder, for any purpose germane to the meeting, during ordinary business hours, for a period of at least ten days prior to the meeting, either at a place within the city or town where the meeting is to be held, which place shall be specified in the notice of the meeting, or, if not so specified, at the place where the meeting is to be held. The list shall also be produced and kept at the time and place of the meeting during the whole time thereof, and may be inspected by any stockholder who is present.

        7.     Quorum:     Except as may be otherwise provided by law, by the Articles of Incorporation, or by these By-Laws, the holders of a majority of all stock issued and outstanding and entitled to vote at a meeting (or if there shall be more than one (1) class or series of stock issued and outstanding and entitled to vote separately at such meeting, and a separate vote by class or series shall be required by law, by the Articles of Incorporation or by these By-Laws, then a majority of each such class or series) present in person or represented by proxy, shall constitute a quorum. The holders of a majority in interest of all stock issued and outstanding, entitled to vote and present in person or represented by proxy at any meeting of stockholders, including any adjourned meeting, whether or not a quorum is present, may adjourn such meeting to another time and place. At any adjourned meeting, any business may be transacted which might have been transacted at the meeting as originally called, provided a quorum shall be in attendance at such adjourned meeting.

        8.     Voting and Proxies:     Unless otherwise provided by the Articles of Incorporation, each stockholder shall have one (1) vote for each share of stock and a proportionate vote for each fractional share of stock entitled to vote, held by him of record according to the records of the corporation. Stockholders may vote either in person or by written proxy dated not more than three (3) years before such vote, unless the proxy provides for a longer period. A proxy with respect to stock held in the name of two (2) or more persons shall be valid if executed by one (1) of them unless at or prior to the exercise of the proxy, the corporation receives a specific written notice to the contrary from any one

2



(1) of them. A proxy purporting to have been executed by or on behalf of a stockholder shall be deemed valid unless challenged at or prior to its exercise. All elections of Directors shall be by written ballot unless otherwise provided in the Articles of Incorporation.

        9.     Required Vote:     If a quorum is present, then, except as otherwise required by law, the Articles of Incorporation or these By-Laws, the holders of a majority of the stock present in person or represented by proxy at the meeting and entitled to vote shall decide any such election or other matter to be voted upon by the stockholders.

        10.     Action Without Meeting:     Unless otherwise required in the Articles of Incorporation, any action required to be taken at any annual or special meeting of stockholders, or any action which may be taken at any annual or special meeting of such stockholders, may be taken without a meeting, without prior notice and without a vote, if a consent in writing, setting forth the action so taken, shall be signed by the holders of outstanding stock having not less than the minimum number of votes that would be necessary to authorize or take such action at a meeting at which all shares entitled to vote thereon were present and voted. Prompt notice of the taking of the corporate action without a meeting by less than unanimous written consent shall be given to those stockholders who have not consented in writing.

        11.     Record Date:     For the purpose of determining the stockholders entitled to notice of or to vote at any meeting of stockholders or any adjournment thereof, or to express consent to corporate action in writing without a meeting, or for the purpose of determining stockholders entitled to receive payment of any dividend or other distribution or allotment of any rights, or entitled to exercise any rights in respect of any change, conversion or exchange of stock, or for the purpose of any other lawful action, the Directors may fix, in advance, a date as the record date for any such determination of stockholders. Such date shall not be more than sixty or less than ten days before the date of such meeting, nor more than sixty days prior to any other action. If no such record date is fixed:

        11.1   The record date for determining stockholders entitled to notice of or to vote at a meeting of stockholders shall be at the close of business on the day next preceding the day on which notice is given, or, if notice is waived, at the close of business on the day next preceding the day on which the meeting is held;

        11.2   The record date for determining stockholders entitled to express consent to corporate action in writing without a meeting, when no prior action by the Directors is necessary, shall be the day on which the first written consent is expressed;

        11.3   The record date for determining stockholders for any purpose other than those specified in Sections 11.1 and 11.2 shall be at the close of business on the day on which the Board adopts the resolution relating thereto.

        When a determination of stockholders entitled to notice of or to vote at any meeting of stockholders has been made as provided in this Section 11 such determination shall apply to any adjournment thereof, unless the Board fixes a new record date for the adjourned meeting.

ARTICLE IV
Directors

        1.     Powers:     The business and affairs of the corporation shall be managed by or under the direction of the Board of Directors, which may exercise all the powers of the corporation and do all such lawful acts and things as are not by law or by the Articles of Incorporation or by these By-Laws directed or required to be exercised or done by the stockholders.

3



        2.     Number; Qualification; Term of Office:     The Board of Directors shall consist of one or more members. The total number of Directors shall be fixed initially by the incorporators and may thereafter be changed from time to time by action of the stockholders or the Directors. Directors need not be stockholders. Each Director shall hold office until his successor is elected and qualified, or until his earlier death, resignation or removal.

        3.     Election of Directors:     The Board of Directors shall be elected at the annual meeting, or in lieu thereof at any special meeting, of stockholders in the manner prescribed by law, by the Articles of Incorporation and by these By-Laws.

        4.     Newly Created Directorships and Vacancies:     Unless otherwise provided in the Articles of Incorporation, vacancies and newly created directorships resulting from any increase in the authorized number of directors elected by all of the stockholders having the right to vote as a single class may be filled by vote of a majority of the directors then in office, although less than a quorum, or by a sole remaining director, or by the stockholders by a majority of the stock present or represented by proxy at a special meeting of stockholders called for that purpose. A Director elected to fill a vacancy shall be elected to hold office until his successor is elected and qualified, or until his earlier death, resignation or removal. If there are no Directors in office, then an election of Directors may be held in the manner provided by law. In the event of a vacancy in the Board of Directors, the remaining Directors, except as otherwise required by law or these By-Laws, may exercise the power of the full Board of Directors until the vacancy is filled.

        5.     Resignations and Removal of Directors:     Any Director may resign at any time by written notice to the Corporation. Such resignation shall be effective upon receipt unless it is specified to be effective at some other time or upon the happening of some other event. Any Director may be removed from office with or without cause by the stockholders upon the vote of the holders of a majority of stock then issued and outstanding and entitled to vote thereon or in such manner as may be provided in the Articles of Incorporation.

        6.     Regular Meetings:     Regular meetings of the Board of Directors may be held without notice at such times and places as the Directors may determine from time to time; provided that any Director who is absent when such a determination is made shall be given prompt notice of such determination. The first meeting of the Board of Directors following the annual meeting of the stockholders may be held without notice immediately after and at the same place as the annual meeting of the stockholders or the special meeting held in lieu thereof.

        7.     Special Meetings and Notice:     Special meetings of the Board of Directors may be called at any time by the President, Treasurer or by any Director. Notice of a special meeting shall be given by the Secretary, an Assistant Secretary or the person calling the meeting to each Director in person or by telephone, telecopy or electronic mail, or other equivalent electronic media sent to his last known business or home address, at least twenty-four (24) hours in advance of the meeting, or by written notice mailed to his business or home address, at least forty-eight (48) hours in advance of the meeting. Notice of a meeting need not be given to any Director, if a written waiver of notice, executed by him before or after the meeting, is filed with the records of the meeting, or to any Director who attends the meeting without protesting prior thereto or at its commencement the lack of notice to him. Any notice given hereunder shall state the place, date and hour of the meeting, but need not specify the purposes of the meeting except that if an amendment to these By-Laws or any matter referred to in Article VII or Paragraphs 5 and 6 of Article VIII of these By-Laws shall be a purpose of the meeting, the same shall be so stated in the notice.

        8.     Quorum; Voting and Adjournments:     Except as otherwise required by law, by the Articles of Incorporation or by these By-Laws, a majority of the total number of Directors then in office shall constitute a quorum at any meeting of the Directors, and the act of a majority of the Directors present at a meeting at which a quorum shall be present shall be the act of the Board of Directors. Any

4



meeting of Directors may be adjourned to any other time and place as a majority of those Directors present at such meeting and voting shall determine whether or not a quorum of Directors shall be present.

        9.     Action Without Meeting:     Any action required or permitted to be taken at any meeting of the Directors may be taken without a meeting, if a written consent thereto is signed by all the Directors then in office and such written consent is filed with the records of the meetings of the Directors. Such consent shall be treated as a vote for all purposes.

        10.     Telephonic Meetings:     Unless otherwise restricted by the Articles of Incorporation or these By-Laws, members of the Board of Directors or of any committee thereof may participate in a meeting of the Board of Directors or of any committee, as the case may be, by means of conference telephone or similar communications equipment by means of which all persons participating in the meeting can hear each other, and such participation in a meeting shall constitute presence in person at the meeting.

        11.     Committees:     The Board of Directors may, in its discretion, by resolution passed by a majority of the whole Board, designate one (1) or more committees, each committee to consist of one (1) or more of the Directors of the corporation and which shall have and may exercise, except as may be otherwise limited by law, such powers and authority, including those possessed by the Board of Directors itself, as shall be conferred or authorized by the resolutions appointing it. The Board of Directors shall have the power at any time to discharge, change the membership of, fill vacancies in, or designate one or more directors as alternate members of any such committee. Written minutes of all proceedings of any such committee shall be kept and made available to each Director, at his request. Except as the Board of Directors may otherwise determine, a majority of the Directors then constituting the membership of any such committee shall constitute a quorum for the transaction of business, except that when a committee shall have only one (1) Director, then one (1) Director shall constitute a quorum. When a quorum is present at any meeting of any such committee, a majority of those present and voting shall be requisite and sufficient to effect any action, or to decide any question or measure presented to the meeting, unless a larger vote shall be required by law or by other provisions of these By-Laws or by the Board of Directors.

        Notice shall be provided to each committee member in accordance with Section 7 of this Article, as if such committee meeting were a special meeting of the Directors.

        In the event of the absence or disqualification of any member of any committee designated by the Board of Directors, the member or members thereof present at any meeting and not disqualified from voting, whether or not he or they constitute a quorum, may unanimously appoint another member of the Board of Directors to act at the meeting in the place of any such absent or disqualified member.

ARTICLE V
Officers

        1.     Officers:     The officers of the corporation shall be elected by the Board of Directors and shall consist of a President, a Treasurer, a Secretary and such other officers, including without limitation a Chairman of the Board of Directors and one or more Vice Presidents, Assistant Treasurers and Assistant Secretaries, as the Directors may from time to time determine. Such other officers shall have such duties and powers as shall be designated from time to time by the Board of Directors or the chief executive officer, and they shall be responsible to and shall report to the chief executive officer or to such other officer as the chief executive officer or the Board of Directors shall designate. If authorized by resolution of the Board of Directors, the chief executive officer may be empowered to appoint from time to time Assistant Secretaries and Assistant Treasurers. Any number of offices may be held by the same person, unless the Articles of Incorporation or these By-Laws otherwise provide.

5



        2.     Tenure:     Each officer of the Corporation shall hold office until his successor is elected and qualified, unless a different term is specified in the vote electing or appointing him, or until his earlier death, resignation or removal.

        3.     Removal:     The Directors may remove any officer elected or appointed by them with or without cause upon the vote of the Directors then in office.

        4.     Resignation:     Any officer may resign at any time by delivering his written resignation to the Corporation at its principal office or to the chief executive officer or Secretary. Such resignation shall be effective upon receipt unless it is specified to be effective at some other time or upon the happening of some other event.

        5.     Vacancies:     Vacancies in any office may be filled by the Directors.

        6.     Certain Duties and Powers:     The officers designated below, subject at all times to modification by and to the direction and control of the Directors, shall have and may exercise the respective duties and powers set forth below:

        A.     The Chairman of the Board of Directors:     The Chairman of the Board of Directors, if there be one, shall, when present, preside at all meetings of the Directors.

        B.     President:     The President shall be the chief executive officer of the corporation and shall have general supervision and control of its business. Unless otherwise provided by the Directors, he shall preside, when present, at all meetings of stockholders, and, if a director, at all meetings of Directors unless there be a Chairman of the Board of Directors who is present at the meeting.

        C.     Treasurer:     The Treasurer shall be the chief financial officer of the corporation and shall have general charge of the financial affairs of the corporation and shall keep or cause to be kept accurate books of account. He shall have custody of all funds, securities and valuable documents of the corporation.

        D.     Secretary:     The Secretary shall keep a true record of the proceedings of all meetings of the stockholders and Directors of the corporation. In the absence of the Secretary from any such meeting, an Assistant Secretary, if there be one, otherwise a temporary Secretary shall be chosen by the person presiding at the meeting, and he shall so record the proceedings thereof. Unless a transfer agent is appointed, the Secretary shall also keep or cause to be kept the stock transfer books of the corporation.

        In addition, except as otherwise required by law, these By-Laws or the Articles of Incorporation, and subject to modification by and to the direction and control of the Board of Directors, each officer shall have in addition to the above duties and powers, such duties and powers as are customarily incident to his office.

ARTICLE VI
Capital Stock

        1.     Certificates of Stock:     Unless the Directors provide by resolution or resolutions that some or all of any or all classes or series of the corporation's stock shall be uncertificated shares, the shares of the corporation shall be represented by certificates. Any such resolution shall not apply to shares represented by a certificate unless such certificate is surrendered to the corporation. Notwithstanding the adoption of such a resolution by the Directors, every holder of stock represented by certificates and upon request every holder of uncertificated shares shall be entitled to one or more certificates signed by the Chairman or Vice-Chairman of the Board of Directors or by the President or a Vice President and by the Treasurer or an Assistant Treasurer or the Secretary or an Assistant Secretary representing the number of shares registered in certificate form. Any or all the signatures on the certificate may be

6



a facsimile. In case any officer, transfer agent or registrar who has signed or whose facsimile signature has been placed upon a certificate shall have ceased to be such officer, transfer agent or registrar before such certificate is issued, it may be issued by the corporation with the same effect, as if he were such officer, transfer agent or registrar at the date of issue.

        2.     Legends:     Every certificate issued for shares of stock at a time when such shares are subject to any restriction on transfer pursuant to the Articles of Incorporation, these By-Laws or any agreement among any stockholders or among any such stockholders and the corporation shall have the restriction noted conspicuously on the certificate and shall also set forth on the face or back of the certificate either (i) the full text of the restriction or (ii) a statement of the existence of such restriction and a statement that the corporation will furnish a copy thereof to the holder of such certificate upon written request and without charge.

        Every certificate issued for shares of stock at a time when the corporation is authorized to issue more than one class or series of stock shall set forth on the face or back of the certificate either (i) the full text or a summary of the powers, designations, preferences, and relative, participating, optional or other special rights of the shares of each class and series, if any, authorized to be issued, or (ii) a statement of the existence of such powers, designations, preferences and relative, participating, optional or other special rights and a statement that the corporation will furnish a copy thereof to the holder of such certificate upon written request and without charge.

        In the event the Directors have authorized uncertificated stock, within a reasonable time after the issuance or transfer of uncertificated stock, the corporation shall send to the registered owners thereof a written notice containing the information required to be set forth or stated on certificates pursuant to law and these By-Laws, or with respect to uncertificated stock issued at a time when the corporation is authorized to issue more than one class or series of stock, a statement that the corporation will furnish without charge to each stockholder who so requests the powers, designations, preferences and relative participating, optional or other special rights of each class of stock or series thereof and the qualifications, limitations or restrictions of such preferences and/or rights.

        3.     Transfers:     The Directors may appoint a transfer agent and a registrar of transfers or either and require all stock certificates to bear their signatures. Transfers of shares of capital stock of the corporation shall be made only on the books of the corporation by the registered holder thereof or by his duly authorized attorney appointed by a power of attorney duly executed and filed with the Secretary of the corporation or a transfer agent, and on surrender of the certificate or certificates for such shares properly endorsed. The Directors may make such additional rules and regulations not inconsistent with law, with the Articles of Incorporation or with these By-Laws as it deems expedient relative to the issue, transfer and registration of stock certificates.

        4.     Pledges:     Transferees of stock of the corporation transferred as collateral security shall be entitled to a new certificate therefor if the instrument of transfer substantially describes the debt or duty which is intended to be secured thereby. Whenever any transfer of shares shall be made for collateral security, and not absolutely, it shall be so expressed in the entry of transfer and on the face of any new certificate issued therefor if, when the certificates are presented to the corporation for transfer or uncertificated shares are requested to be transferred, both the transferor and the transferee request the corporation to do so.

        5.     Replacement of Certificates:     In case of the alleged loss, destruction or mutilation of a certificate of stock issued by the corporation, a duplicate certificate may be issued in place thereof, upon such terms as the Directors may prescribe.

7



ARTICLE VII
Indemnification

        1.     Indemnification of Officers and Directors:     The Corporation shall indemnify any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative, by reason of the fact that he is or was a director or an officer of the Corporation, against expenses (including attorneys' fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred by him in connection with such action, suit or proceeding to the fullest extent and in the manner set forth in and permitted by the applicable corporation law in the state of incorporation, and any other applicable law, as from time to time in effect. Such rights of indemnification shall not be deemed exclusive of any other rights to which such director or officer may be entitled apart from the foregoing provisions. The foregoing provisions of this Article VII, Paragraph 1, shall be deemed to be a contract between the Corporation and each director and officer who serves in such capacity at any time while this Article VII and the relevant provisions of the applicable corporation law in the state of incorporation and other applicable law, if any, are in effect, and any repeal or modification thereof shall not affect any rights or obligations then existing with respect to any state of facts then or theretofore existing or any action, suit or proceeding thereto or thereafter brought or threatened based in whole or in part upon any such state of facts.

        2.     Indemnification of Other Persons:     The Corporation may indemnify any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative by reason of the fact that he is or was an employee or agent of the Corporation, or is or was serving at the request of the Corporation as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise, against expenses (including attorneys' fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred by him in connection with such action, suit or proceeding to the extent and in the manner set forth in and permitted by the applicable corporation law in the state of incorporation, and any other applicable law, as from time to time in effect. Such right of indemnification shall not be deemed exclusive of any other rights to which any such person may be entitled apart from the foregoing provisions.

        3.     Miscellaneous:     Notwithstanding anything contained in and without limiting the generality of the foregoing provisions:

        A.    The extent of the rights of indemnification, as hereinabove set forth, shall include, without limitation, all liabilities, costs and expenses of defending, compromising or settling any action, suit or other proceeding, and the satisfaction of any judgment or decree entered or rendered therein, including the payment of fines or penalties imposed in criminal actions or proceedings.

        B.    The termination of any action, suit or proceeding, civil or criminal, by judgment, order, settlement (whether with or without court approval), conviction, or upon a plea of guilty or nolo contendere, or its equivalent, shall not create a presumption that the person did not meet the standard of conduct required under the applicable corporation law in the state of incorporation, or any other applicable law, in order to be entitled to indemnification as hereinabove provided.

        C.    Expenses incurred by any person who may have a right of indemnification under this By-Law in defending a civil or criminal action, suit or proceeding may be paid by the corporation in advance of the final disposition of such action, suit or proceeding to the extent permitted by the applicable corporation law in the state of incorporation, and any other applicable law, as from time to time in effect, when approved by the Board of Directors.

8



ARTICLE VIII
Miscellaneous Provisions

        1.     Fiscal Year:     The fiscal year of the Corporation shall be determined, and may be changed, by the Board of Directors.

        2.     Seal:     The seal of the corporation shall, subject to alteration by the Directors, bear its name and the year of its incorporation.

        3.     Execution of Instruments:     Except as otherwise authorized by the Board of Directors, all deeds, mortgages, leases, transfers, contracts, bonds, notes, checks, drafts and other obligations authorized to be executed by an officer of the corporation in its behalf shall be signed by the Chairman of the Board, the President, any Vice President or the Treasurer except as the Directors may generally or in particular cases otherwise determine.

        4.     Voting of Securities:     Except as the Directors may otherwise designate, the Chairman or the President may waive notice of, and act, or appoint any other person or persons to waive notice of or act, as proxy or attorney in fact for this corporation (with or without power of substitution) at any meeting of stockholders or shareholders of any other corporation or organization, the securities of which may be held by this corporation; and may as such proxy or attorney for this corporation (with or without power of substitution), consent to, and sign in writing, any action in lieu of any such meeting.

        5.     Amendments:     These By-Laws may be altered, amended or repealed by the stockholders or, if so authorized by the Articles of Incorporation, by the Directors, at any meeting of the stockholders or of the Directors; provided, however, that notice of the substance of any such alteration, amendment or repeal be contained in the notice of such meeting.

        6.     Ratification:     Any transaction may be ratified by the Board of Directors or by the stockholders; and if so ratified, shall have the same force and effect as if the questioned transaction had been originally duly authorized, and said ratification shall be binding upon the corporation and its stockholders and shall constitute a bar to any claim or execution of any judgment in respect of such questioned transaction.

        7.     Reliance on Records:     Each officer, Director or member of any committee designated by the Board of Directors in the manner hereinbefore provided shall in the performance of his duties be fully protected in relying in good faith upon the books of account or reports made to the corporation by any of its officials, or by an independent certified public accountant, or by an appraiser selected with reasonable care by the Board of Directors or by any committee, or in relying in good faith upon other records of the corporation.

9




QuickLinks


Exhibit 4.2

 

SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURE

 

Supplemental Indenture (this “ Supplemental Indenture ”), dated as of January 11, 2007, among National Mentor Holdings, Inc., a Delaware corporation (the “ Issuer ”), Rockland Child Development Services, Inc., a New York corporation (the “ Guaranteeing Subsidiary ”) and a subsidiary of the Issuer and U.S. Bank National Association, as trustee (the “ Trustee ”).

 

W I T N E S S E T H

 

WHEREAS, each of the Issuer and the Guarantors (as defined in the Indenture referred to below) has heretofore executed and delivered to the Trustee an indenture (the “ Indenture ”), dated as of June 29, 2006, providing for the issuance of an unlimited aggregate principal amount of 11¼% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014 (the “ Notes ”);

 

WHEREAS, the Indenture provides that under certain circumstances the Guaranteeing Subsidiary shall execute and deliver to the Trustee a supplemental indenture pursuant to which the Guaranteeing Subsidiary shall unconditionally guarantee all of the Issuer’s Obligations under the Notes and the Indenture on the terms and conditions set forth herein and under the Indenture (the “ Guarantee ”); and

 

WHEREAS, pursuant to Section 9.01 of the Indenture, the Trustee is authorized to execute and deliver this Supplemental Indenture.

 

NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt of which is hereby acknowledged, the parties mutually covenant and agree for the equal and ratable benefit of the Holders of the Notes as follows:

 

(1)           Capitalized Terms .  Capitalized terms used herein without definition shall have the meanings assigned to them in the Indenture.

 

(2)           Agreement to be Bound .  The Guarantor hereby becomes a party to the Indenture as a Guarantor and as such will have all of the rights and be subject to all of the obligations and agreements of a Guarantor under the Indenture.  The Guarantor agrees to be bound by all of the provisions of the Indenture applicable to a Guarantor and to perform all of the obligations and agreements of a Guarantor under the Indenture.

 

(3)           Guarantee .  The Guarantor agrees, on a joint and several basis with all the existing and future Guarantors, to fully, unconditionally and irrevocably guarantee to each Holder of the Notes and the Trustee the Guarantor obligations pursuant to Article 11 and Article 12 of the Indenture, including without limitation, the full and prompt payment of the principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the Notes, on a senior subordinated basis as provided in the Indenture.

 

(4)           Notices .  All notices and other communications to the Guarantor shall be given as provided in the Indenture.

 

(5)           Parties .  Nothing expressed or mentioned herein is intended or shall be construed to give any Person, firm or corporation, other than the Holders and the Trustee, any legal or equitable right, remedy or claim under or in respect of this Supplemental Indenture or the Indenture or any provision herein or therein contained.

 



 

(6)           Governing Law .  THIS SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURE SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.

 

(7)           Ratification of Indenture; Supplemental Indentures Part of Indenture .  Except as expressly amended hereby, the Indenture is in all respects ratified and confirmed and all the terms, conditions and provisions thereof shall remain in full force and effect.  This Supplemental Indenture shall form a part of the Indenture for all purposes, and every Holder of Notes heretofore or hereafter authenticated and delivered shall be bound hereby.  The Trustee makes no representation or warranty as to the validity or sufficiency of this Supplemental Indenture.

 

(8)           Counterparts .  The parties hereto may sign one or more copies of this Supplemental Indenture in counterparts, all of which together shall constitute one and the same agreement.

 

(9)           Headings .  The headings of in this Supplemental Indenture are for convenience of reference only and shall not be deemed to alter or affect the meaning or interpretation of any provisions hereof.

 

(10)         Trust Indenture Act Controls.   If and to the extent that any provision of this Indenture limits, qualifies or conflicts with another provision which is required to be included in this Supplemental Indenture by the TIA, the provision required by the TIA shall control.  Each Guarantor in addition to performing its obligations under its Guarantee shall perform such other obligations as may be imposed upon it with respect to this Indenture under the TIA.

 

[Signature page follows]

 

2



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Supplemental Indenture to be duly executed, all as of the date first above written.

 

 

 

NATIONAL MENTOR HOLDINGS, INC.

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ EDWARD M. MURPHY

 

 

 

Name: Edward M. Murphy

 

 

Title: President and Chief Executive Officer

 

 

 

ROCKLAND CHILD DEVELOPMENT SERVICES,
INC.

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ EDWARD M. MURPHY

 

 

 

Name: Edward M. Murphy

 

 

Title: President and Chief Executive Officer

 

 

 

U.S. BANK NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, as trustee

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ RICHARD PROKOSH

 

 

 

Name: Richard Prokosh

 

 

Title: Vice President

 

3




Exhibit 5.1

 

[Letterhead of Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP]

 

 

January 12, 2007

 

National Mentor Holdings, Inc.

313 Congress Street, 6 th Floor

Boston MA 02210

 

Ladies and Gentlemen:

 

We have acted as counsel to Rockland Child Development Services, Inc., a New York corporation (the “Company”) in connection with the Registration Statement on Form S-4 (the “Registration Statement”) filed by National Mentor Holdings, Inc. (the “Issuer”), the Company and certain other subsidiaries of the Issuer listed therein (the “Existing Guarantors”) with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “Commission”) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, relating to the issuance by the Issuer of $180,000,000 aggregate principal amount of its 11-1/4% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014 (the “Exchange Securities”) and the issuance by the Company of a guarantee (the “Guarantee”) with respect to the Exchange Securities. The Exchange Securities and the Guarantee will be issued under an indenture dated as of June 29, 2006 (the “Indenture”) among the Issuer, the Existing Guarantors and U.S. Bank National Association, as trustee (the “Trustee”), as supplemented by a Supplemental Indenture, dated as of January 11, 2007 (the “Supplemental Indenture”), among the Issuer, the Company and the Trustee. The Exchange Securities will be offered by the Issuer in exchange for $180,000,000 aggregate principal amount of its outstanding 11-1/4% Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014.

 

We have examined the Registration Statement, the Indenture and the Supplemental Indenture, which have been filed with the Commission as exhibits to the Registration Statement. W e also have examined the originals, or duplicates or certified or conformed copies, of such corporate records, agreements, documents and other instruments and have made such other investigations as we have deemed relevant and necessary in connection with the opinions hereinafter set forth. As to questions of fact material to this opinion, we have relied upon

 



 

certificates or comparable documents of public officials and of officers and representatives of the Company, the Issuer and the Existing Guarantors.

 

In rendering the opinions set forth below, we have assumed the genuineness of all signatures, the legal capacity of natural persons, the authenticity of all documents submitted to us as originals, the conformity to original documents of all documents submitted to us as duplicates or certified or conformed copies and the authenticity of the originals of such latter documents. We also have assumed that the Indenture is the valid and legally binding obligation of the Trustee.

 

Based upon the foregoing, and subject to the qualifications, assumptions and limitations stated herein, we are of the opinion that, when the Guarantee has been duly issued, the Guarantee will constitute a valid and legally binding obligation of the Company enforceable against the Company in accordance with its terms.

 

Our opinion set forth above is subject to (i) the effects of bankruptcy, insolvency, fraudulent conveyance, reorganization, moratorium and other similar laws relating to or affecting creditors’ rights generally, (ii) general equitable principles (whether considered in a proceeding in equity or at law) and (iii) an implied covenant of good faith and fair dealing.

 

We do not express any opinion herein concerning any law other than the law of the State of New York and the federal law of the United States.

 

We hereby consent to the filing of this opinion letter as Exhibit 5 to the Registration Statement and to the use of our name under the caption “Legal matters” in the Prospectus included in the Registration Statement .

 

 

Very truly yours,

 

 

 

/s/ Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP

 

 

 

 

SIMPSON THACHER & BARTLETT LLP

 




Exhibit 10.15

 

FORM OF MANAGEMENT UNIT SUBSCRIPTION AGREEMENT

 

(Class B Units, Class C Units and Class D Units)

 

THIS MANAGEMENT UNIT SUBSCRIPTION AGREEMENT (this “ Agreement ”) is made as of                              , 2006, by and between NMH Investment, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (the “ Company ”), and the individual named on the signature page hereto (the “ Executive ”).

 

WHEREAS, on the terms and subject to the conditions hereof, the Executive desires to subscribe for and acquire from the Company, and the Company desires to issue and provide or sell to the Executive, the Company’s Class B Common Units (the “ Class B Units ”), Class C Common Units (the “ Class C Units ”) and Class D Common Units (the “ Class D Units ”; collectively with the Class B Units and the Class C Units, the “ Units ”), in each case in the amounts set forth on Schedule I, as hereinafter set forth; and

 

WHEREAS, this Agreement is one of several agreements entered into or being entered into by the Company with certain persons who are or will be key employees and/or directors of the Company or one or more subsidiaries (collectively with the Executive, the “ Management Investors ”) as part of an equity purchase plan designed to comply with Rule 701 promulgated under the Securities Act (as defined below);

 

NOW, THEREFORE, in order to implement the foregoing and in consideration of the mutual representations, warranties, covenants and agreements contained herein, the parties hereto agree as follows:

 

1.                                        Definitions .

 

1.1                                  Agreement . The term “Agreement” shall have the meaning set forth in the preface.

 

1.2                                  Applicable Percentage . The term “Applicable Percentage” shall mean, with respect to an Executive’s Class B Units, the percentage set forth in the applicable table under the heading “Applicable Percentage,” as more specifically determined in accordance with the schedule set forth as Exhibit 1.2, attached hereto and incorporated herein by this reference.

 

1.3                                  Board . The “Board” shall mean the Company’s Management Committee.

 

1.4                                  Cause . The term “Cause” used in connection with the termination of employment of the Executive shall have the same meaning ascribed to such term in any employment or severance agreement then in effect between Executive and the Company or one of its subsidiaries or, if no such agreement containing a definition of “Cause” is then in effect, shall mean a termination of employment of the Executive by the Company or any subsidiary thereof due to (i) the commission by the Executive of an act of fraud or embezzlement, (ii) the indictment or conviction of the Executive for (x) a felony or (y) a crime involving moral

 

1



 

turpitude or a plea by Executive of guilty or nolo contendere involving such a crime (to the extent it gives rise to an adverse effect on the business or reputation of the Company or any of its subsidiaries), (iii) the willful misconduct by the Executive in the performance of Executive’s duties, including any willful misrepresentation or willful concealment by Executive on any report submitted to the Company (or any of its securityholders or subsidiaries) which is not of a de minimis nature, (iv) the violation by Executive of a written Company policy regarding substance abuse, sexual harassment or discrimination or any other material written policy of the Company regarding employment, (v) the willful failure of the Executive to render services to the Company or any of its subsidiaries in accordance with Executive’s employment which failure amounts to a material neglect of the Executive’s duties to the Company or any of its subsidiaries, (vi) the repeated failure of the Executive to comply with reasonable directives of the Board of Directors of National Mentor Holdings, Inc. (“ NMH ”) or the Chief Executive Officer of NMH consistent with the Executive’s duties or (vii) the material breach by Executive of any of the provisions of any agreement between Executive, on the one hand, and the Company or a securityholder or an affiliate of the Company, on the other hand. Notwithstanding the foregoing, with respect to clauses (iii), (iv), (v), (vi) and (vii) above, Executive’s termination of employment with the Company or NMH shall not be deemed to have been terminated for Cause unless and until Executive has been provided written notice of the Company’s or NMH’s intention to terminate his employment for Cause and the specific facts relied on; and ten (10) business days from the receipt of such notice to cure any such conduct or omission giving rise to a termination for Cause; and Executive does not cure any such conduct or omission within such ten business-day period.

 

1.5                                  Closing . The term “Closing” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2.2.

 

1.6                                  Closing Date . The term “Closing Date” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2.2.

 

1.7                                  Company . The term “Company” shall have the meaning set forth in the preface.

 

1.8                                  Cost . The term “Cost” shall mean the price per Unit paid by the Executive as proportionately adjusted for all subsequent distributions of Units and other recapitalizations and less the amount of any tax distributions made with respect to the Units pursuant to Section 4.4(i) of the LLC Agreement.

 

1.9                                  Disability . The term “Disability” of the Executive shall have the same meaning ascribed to such term in any employment or severance agreement then in effect between Executive and the Company or one of its subsidiaries or, if no such agreement containing a definition of “Disability” is then in effect, shall mean the inability of the Executive to perform the essential functions of Executive’s job, with or without reasonable accommodation, by reason of a physical or mental infirmity, for a continuous period of six months. The period of six months shall be deemed continuous unless Executive returns to work for at least 30 consecutive business days during such period and performs during such period at the level and competence that existed prior to the beginning of the six-month period. The date of such Disability shall be on the first day of such six-month period.

 

2



 

1.10                            Employee and Employment . The term “employee” shall mean any employee (as defined in accordance with the regulations and revenue rulings then applicable under Section 3401(c) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended) of the Company or any of its subsidiaries, and the term “employment” shall include service as a part- or full-time employee to the Company or any of its subsidiaries.

 

1.11                            Executive . The term “Executive” shall have the meaning set forth in the preface.

 

1.12                            Executive Group . The term “Executive Group” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.1(a).

 

1.13                            Fair Market Value . The term “Fair Market Value” used in connection with the value of Units shall mean the average of the closing prices of the sales of the Company’s Units on all securities exchanges on which the Units may at the time be listed, or, if there have been no sales on any such exchange on any day, the average of the highest bid and lowest asked prices on all such exchanges at the end of such day or, if on any day the Units are not so listed, the average of the representative bid and asked prices quoted in the NASDAQ System as of 4:00 P.M., New York time, or, if on any day the Units are not quoted in the NASDAQ System, the average of the highest bid and lowest asked prices on such day in the domestic over-the-counter market as reported by the National Quotation Bureau Incorporated or any similar successor organization, in each such case averaged over a period of 21 days consisting of the day as of which the Fair Market Value is being determined and the 20 consecutive business days prior to such day. If at any time the Units are not listed on any securities exchange or quoted in the NASDAQ System or the over-the-counter market, the Fair Market Value shall be the fair value of the Units determined in good faith by the Board using its reasonable business judgment (valuing the Company and its subsidiaries as a going concern; disregarding any discount for minority interest or marketability of the Units, whether due to transfer restrictions or the lack of a public market for the Units; taking into account the Preferred Priority Return (as defined in the LLC Agreement); without taking into account the effect of any contemporaneous repurchase of Units at less than Fair Market Value under Section 4) after consultation with an independent appraiser, accountant or investment banking firm (the “Valuation Expert”); provided that (i) the Board shall only be obligated to consult a Valuation Expert once annually absent special circumstances (as determined in good faith by the Board) and (ii) if the Executive disagrees in good faith with the Board’s determination and such dispute involves an amount in excess of $250,000, the Executive shall notify the Company in writing of such disagreement within ten (10) business days of receipt of the Board’s determination of the fair market value of such Units, in which event a second Valuation Expert (the “ Arbiter ”) selected by mutual agreement of the Executive and the Board shall make a determination of the fair market value thereof (valuing the Company and its subsidiaries as set forth above); and without taking into account the effect of any contemporaneous repurchase of Units at less than Fair Market Value under Section 4) solely by (i) reviewing a single written presentation timely made by each of the Company and the Executive setting forth their respective resolutions of the dispute and the bases therefor and (ii) accepting either the Executive’s or the Company’s proposed resolution of the dispute. For the avoidance of doubt, the determination of Fair Market Value of any Unit shall be based on the amounts distributable in respect of such Unit under the terms of the LLC Agreement, including any adjustments necessary to reflect the portion of any tax distributions that were previously made in respect of such Unit but not charged against other distributions in respect of such Unit.

 

3



 

Within five (5) business days after the Company’s receipt of Executive’s written notice of disagreement, the Company shall make available to Executive all data (including reports of employees and outside advisors) relied upon by the Board in making its determination. The Executive’s and the Company’s written presentations must be submitted to the Arbiter within 30 days of the Arbiter’s engagement, written notice of which shall be delivered by the Company to the Executive. The Arbiter shall notify the Executive and the Company of its decision within 40 days of its engagement. If the Executive’s proposed resolution is accepted, the Company also shall pay all of the Executive’s reasonable out-of-pocket fees and expenses (including reasonable fees and expenses of counsel and one Valuation Expert) incurred in connection with the arbitration. Each of the Company and the Executive agrees to execute, if requested by the Arbiter, a reasonable engagement letter with the Arbiter.

 

1.14                            Financing Default . The term “Financing Default” shall mean an event which would constitute (or with notice or lapse of time or both would constitute) an event of default under any of the following as they may be amended from time to time: (i) the Credit Agreement dated as of the date hereof among NMH, NMH Holdings, LLC, the lenders party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. as sole administrative agent for such lenders, and the Indenture, dated as of the date hereof, among NMH, the Guarantors (as defined in the Indenture), and U.S. Bank National Association, as trustee, and the Senior Subordinated Notes issued by NMH pursuant to the Indenture (collectively, the “ Financing Agreements ”), and any extensions, renewals, refinancings or refundings thereof in whole or in part; (ii) any other agreement under which an amount of indebtedness of the Company or any of its subsidiaries in excess of $5,000,000 is outstanding as of the time of the aforementioned event, and any extensions, renewals, refinancings or refundings thereof in whole or in part; (iii) restrictive financial covenants contained in the LLC Agreement of the Company or NMH’s organizational documents; (iv) any amendment of, supplement to or other modification of any of the instruments referred to in clauses (i) through (iii) above; and (v) any of the securities issued pursuant to or whose terms are governed by the terms of any of the agreements set forth in clauses (i) through (iv) above, and any extensions, renewals, refinancings or refundings thereof in whole or in part.

 

1.15                            Good Reason . The term “Good Reason” shall have the same meaning ascribed to such term in any employment or severance agreement then in effect between Executive and the Company or one of its subsidiaries or, if no such agreement containing a definition of “Good Reason” is then in effect, shall mean (i) a change by the Company or NMH in Executive’s duties and responsibilities which is materially inconsistent with Executive’s position in the Company or in NMH, (ii) a reduction in Executive’s annual base salary or annual bonus opportunity (excluding any reduction in Executive’s salary or bonus opportunity that is part of a plan to reduce compensation of comparably situated employees of the Company generally; provided that such reduction in Executive’s salary or bonus opportunity is not greater than ten percent (10%) of Executive’s salary or bonus opportunity as in effect on the date hereof), (iii) a material breach by the Company of the employment agreement, if any, between Executive and the Company or one of its subsidiaries, and (iv) the relocation of the Executive’s principal place of work from its current location to a location that is beyond a 50-mile radius of such current location; provided that, notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the foregoing, Executive shall only have “Good Reason” to terminate employment following the Company’s failure to remedy the act or

 

4



 

omission which is alleged to constitute “Good Reason” within fifteen (15) days following the Company’s receipt of written notice from Executive specifying such act or omission.

 

1.16                            LLC Agreement . The term “LLC Agreement” means the Second Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement, dated as of December 11, 2006, by and among the Company, Vestar and the other Members of the Company a party thereto, as amended from time to time in accordance with the provisions thereof.

 

1.17                            Management Investors . The term “Management Investors” shall have the meaning set forth in the preface.

 

1.18                            Permitted Transferee . The term “Permitted Transferee” means any transferee of Units pursuant to clauses (f) or (g) of the definition of “Exempt Employee Transfer” as defined in the Securityholders Agreement.

 

1.19                            Person . The term “Person” shall mean any individual, corporation, partnership, limited liability company, trust, joint stock company, business trust, unincorporated association, joint venture, governmental authority or other entity of any nature whatsoever.

 

1.20                            Public Offering . The term “Public Offering” shall have the meaning set forth in the Securityholders Agreement.

 

1.21                            Purchase Price . The term “Purchase Price” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2.1.

 

1.22                            Retirement . The term “Retirement” shall mean, with respect to the Executive, the Executive’s retirement as an employee of the Company or any of its subsidiaries on or after reaching age 65 or such earlier age as may be otherwise determined by the Board after at least three years employment with the Company or any of its subsidiaries after the Closing Date.

 

1.23                            Sale of the Company . The term “Sale of the Company” shall have the meaning set forth in the Securityholders Agreement, except that transactions with a Person or Persons that are a wholly owned Subsidiary (as defined in the Securityholders Agreement) of Vestar and/or Vestar/NMH Investors, LLC or NMH Investment, LLC shall be excluded.

 

1.24                            Securities Act . The term “Securities Act” shall mean the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and all rules and regulations promulgated thereunder, as the same may be amended from time to time.

 

1.25                            Securityholders Agreement . The term “Securityholders Agreement” shall mean the Securityholders Agreement dated as of the Closing Date among Vestar, the Management Investors and the Company, as it may be amended or supplemented thereafter from time to time.

 

1.26                            Termination Date . The term “Termination Date” means the date upon which Executive’s employment with the Company and its subsidiaries is terminated.

 

1.27                            Vestar . The term “Vestar” means Vestar Capital Partners V, L.P., a Cayman Islands exempted limited partnership.

 

5



 

2.                                        Subscription for and Purchase of Units.

 

2.1                                  Purchase of Units . Pursuant to the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Agreement, the Executive hereby subscribes for and agrees to purchase, and the Company hereby agrees to issue and sell to the Executive, on the Closing Date the number of Class B, Class C and Class D Units set forth in Part 1 of Schedule I attached hereto at the applicable prices per unit and for the aggregate amounts (the “ Purchase Price ”) set forth in Schedule I attached hereto.

 

2.2                                  The Closing . The closing (the “ Closing ”) of the purchase of Units hereunder shall take place on                               (the “ Closing Date ”). The Company and the Executive hereby agree that the Purchase Price shall be deducted from the Executive’s next regularly scheduled paycheck following the Closing Date, and that that such deduction shall represent payment in full for the Units, and that the Executive shall execute and deliver to the Company a writing satisfactory to the Company and evidencing the Executive’s acceptance and adoption of all of the terms and provisions of each of the LLC Agreement and the Securityholders Agreement.

 

2.3                                  Section 83(b) Election . Within 10 days after the Closing, Executive shall provide the Company with a completed election under Section 83(b) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and the regulations promulgated thereunder in the form of Exhibit A attached hereto. The Company shall timely file (via certified mail, return receipt requested) such election with the Internal Revenue Service (“ IRS ”), and shall provide Executive with proof of such timely filing.

 

2.4                                  Closing Conditions . Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary, the Company shall be under no obligation to issue and sell to the Executive any Units unless (i) Executive is an employee of, or consultant to, the Company or one of its Subsidiaries on the Closing Date; (ii) the representations of Executive contained in Section 3 hereof are true and correct in all material respects as of the Closing Date and (iii) Executive is not in breach of any agreement, obligation or covenant herein required to be performed or observed by Executive on or prior to the Closing Date.

 

3.                                        Investment Representations and Covenants of the Executive.

 

3.1                                  Units Unregistered . The Executive acknowledges and represents that Executive has been advised by the Company that:

 

(a)                                   the offer and sale of the Units have not been registered under the Securities Act;
 
(b)                                  the Units must be held indefinitely and the Executive must continue to bear the economic risk of the investment in the Units unless the offer and sale of such Units are subsequently registered under the Securities Act and all applicable state securities laws or an exemption from such registration is available;
 
(c)                                   there is no established market for the Units and it is not anticipated that there will be any public market for the Units in the foreseeable future;

 

6



 

(d)                                  a notation shall be made in the appropriate records of the Company indicating that the Units are subject to restrictions on transfer and, if the Company should at some time in the future engage the services of a securities transfer agent, appropriate stop-transfer instructions will be issued to such transfer agent with respect to the Units.
 

3.2                                  Additional Investment Representations . The Executive represents and warrants that:

 

(a)                                   the Executive’s financial situation is such that Executive can afford to bear the economic risk of holding the Units for an indefinite period of time, has adequate means for providing for Executive’s current needs and personal contingencies, and can afford to suffer a complete loss of Executive’s investment in the Units;
 
(b)                                  the Executive’s knowledge and experience in financial and business matters are such that Executive is capable of evaluating the merits and risks of the investment in the Units;
 
(c)                                   the Executive understands that the Units are a speculative investment which involves a high degree of risk of loss of Executive’s investment therein, there are substantial restrictions on the transferability of the Units and, on the Closing Date and for an indefinite period following the Closing, there will be no public market for the Units and, accordingly, it may not be possible for the Executive to liquidate Executive’s investment in case of emergency, if at all;
 
(d)                                  the terms of this Agreement provide that if the Executive ceases to be an employee of the Company or its subsidiaries, the Company and its affiliates have the right to repurchase the Units at a price which may, under certain circumstances, be less than the Fair Market Value thereof;
 
(e)                                   the Executive understands and has taken cognizance of all the risk factors related to the purchase of the Units and, other than as set forth in this Agreement, no representations or warranties have been made to the Executive or Executive’s representatives concerning the Units or the Company or their prospects or other matters;
 
(f)                                     the Executive has been given the opportunity to examine all documents and to ask questions of, and to receive answers from, the Company and its representatives concerning the Company and its subsidiaries, the Securityholders Agreement, the Company’s organizational documents and the terms and conditions of the purchase of the Units and to obtain any additional information which the Executive deems necessary;
 
(g)                                  all information which the Executive has provided to the Company and the Company’s representatives concerning the Executive and Executive’s financial position is complete and correct as of the date of this Agreement; and
 
(h)                                  the Executive is an “accredited investor” within the meaning of Rule 501(a) under the Securities Act.

 

7



 

4.                                        Certain Sales and Forfeitures Upon Termination of Employment.

 

4.1                                  Put Option .

 

(a)                                   If the Executive’s employment with the Company and its subsidiaries terminates due to the Disability, death or Retirement of the Executive prior to the earlier of (i) a Public Offering or (ii) a Sale of the Company, the Executive and the Executive’s Permitted Transferees (hereinafter sometimes collectively referred to as the “ Executive Group ”) shall have the right, subject to the provisions of Section 5 hereof, for 90 days following the date that is six (6) months after the date of such termination of employment of the Executive, to sell to the Company, and the Company shall be required to purchase (subject to the provisions of Section 5 hereof), on one occasion from each member of the Executive Group, all (but not less than all) of the number of Units then held by the Executive Group that equals the sum of (i) the product of (x) the total number of Class B Units collectively held by the Executive Group and (y) the Applicable Percentage (measured as of the Termination Date), at a price per Unit equal to the applicable purchase price determined pursuant to Section 4.1(c) and (ii) the total number of Class C and Class D Units collectively held by the Executive Group for which the performance goals set forth in LLC Agreement have been achieved prior to the termination, at a price per Unit equal to the applicable purchase price determined pursuant to Section 4.1(c). In order to exercise its rights with respect to the Units pursuant to this Section 4.1(a), the Executive Group shall also be required to simultaneously exercise any similar rights it may have with respect to any other units of the Company held by the Executive Group in accordance with the terms of the agreements pursuant to which such other units were purchased from the Company.

 

(b)                                  If the Executive Group desires to exercise its option to require the Company to repurchase Units pursuant to Section 4.1(a), the members of the Executive Group shall send one written notice to the Company setting forth such members’ intention to collectively sell all of their Units pursuant to Section 4.1(a), which notice shall include the signature of each member of the Executive Group. Subject to the provisions of Section 5.1, the closing of the purchase shall take place at the principal office of the Company on a date specified by the Company no later than the 60th day after the giving of such notice.

 

(c)                                   In the event of a purchase by the Company pursuant to Section 4.1(a), the purchase price of any Unit subject to purchase under Section 4.1(a) shall be Fair Market Value (measured as of the purchase date); provided that in any case the Board shall have the right, in its sole discretion, to increase any of the foregoing purchase prices.

 

4.2                                  Call Options .

 

(a)                                   If the Executive’s employment with the Company and its subsidiaries terminates for any of the reasons set forth in clauses (i), (ii) or (iii) below prior to a Sale of the Company, or if the Executive engages in “Competitive Activity” (as defined in Section 6.1 of this Agreement), the Company shall have the right and option to purchase for a period of 90 days following the Termination Date, and each member of the Executive Group shall be required to sell to the Company, any or all of such Units then held by such member of the Executive Group (it being understood that if Units of any class subject to repurchase hereunder may be repurchased at different prices, the Company may elect to repurchase only the portion of the

 

8



 

Units of such class subject to repurchase hereunder at the lower price), at a price per unit equal to the applicable purchase price determined pursuant to Section 4.2(c):

 

(i)                                      if the Executive’s employment with the Company and its subsidiaries is terminated due to the Disability, death or Retirement of the Executive;

 

(ii)                                   if the Executive’s employment with the Company and its subsidiaries is terminated by the Company and its subsidiaries without Cause or by the Executive for Good Reason;

 

(iii)                                if the Executive’s employment with the Company and its subsidiaries is terminated (A) by the Company or any of its subsidiaries for Cause or (B) by the Executive for any other reason not set forth in Section 4.2(a)(i) or Section 4.2(a)(ii).

 

(b)                                  If the Company desires to exercise one of its options to purchase Units pursuant to this Section 4.2, the Company shall, not later than 90 days after the Termination Date, send written notice to each member of the Executive Group of its intention to purchase Units, specifying the number of Units to be purchased (the “ Call Notice ”). Subject to the provisions of Section 5, the closing of the purchase shall take place at the principal office of the Company on a date specified by the Company no later than the 30th day after the giving of the later of the Call Notice.

 

(c)                                   In the event of a purchase by the Company pursuant to Section 4.2(a), the purchase price shall be:

 

(i)                                      with respect to a purchase of all Units, in the case of a termination of employment described in Section 4.2(a)(iii)(A) or if Executive engages in a “Competitive Activity” (as defined in Section 6.1 of this Agreement), a price per Unit equal to the lesser of (A) Fair Market Value (measured as of the Termination Date) and (B) Cost;

 

(ii)                                   with respect to a purchase of Class B Units, in the case of a termination of employment described in Section 4.2(a)(i) or Section 4.2(a)(ii), with respect to the number of Units being purchased which is the product of (x) the total number of Units being purchased and (y) the Applicable Percentage (measured as of the Termination Date), a price per Unit equal to Fair Market Value (measured as of the Termination Date), and (if the Applicable Percentage (measured as of the Termination Date) is less than 100%) the purchase price with respect to the remaining Units being sold shall be a price per Unit equal to the lesser of (A) Fair Market Value (measured as of the Termination Date) and (B) Cost;

 

(iii)                                with respect to a purchase of Class B Units, in the case of a termination of employment described in Section 4.2(a)(iii)(B), with respect to the number of Units being purchased which is the product of (x) the total number of units being purchased and (y) the Applicable Percentage (measured as of the Termination Date), a price per Unit equal to Fair Market Value (measured as of the Termination Date), and (if the Applicable Percentage (measured as of the Termination Date) is less than 100%) the purchase price with respect to the remaining Units being sold shall be a price per Unit equal to the lesser of (A) Fair Market Value (measured as of the Termination Date) and (B) Cost;

 

9



 

(iv)                               with respect to a purchase of Class C Units or Class D Units, in the case of a termination of employment prior to                               described in Section 4.2(a)(iii)(B), a price per Unit equal to the lesser of (A) Fair Market Value (measured as of the Termination Date) and (B) Cost; and

 

(v)                                  with respect to a purchase of Class C Units or Class D Units, in the case of a termination of employment described in Section 4.2(a)(i) or Section 4.2(a)(ii) or a termination of employment on or after June 29, 2009(4) described in Section 4.2(a)(iii)(B), a price per Unit equal to Fair Market Value (measured as of the Termination Date without giving effect to any performance targets set forth in the LLC Agreement of the Company which may have been achieved after the Termination Date);

 

provided that in any case the Board shall have the right, in its sole discretion, to increase any purchase price set forth above.

 

4.3                                  Obligation to Sell Several . If there is more than one member of the Executive Group, the failure of any one member thereof to perform its obligations hereunder shall not excuse or affect the obligations of any other member thereof, and the closing of the purchases from such other members by the Company shall not excuse, or constitute a waiver of its rights against, the defaulting member.

 

5.                                        Certain Limitations on the Company’s Obligations to Purchase Units.

 

5.1                                  Deferral of Purchases . (a)  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, the Company shall not be obligated to purchase any Units at any time pursuant to Section 4, regardless of whether it has delivered a notice of its election to purchase any such Units, (i) to the extent that the purchase of such Units or the payment to the Company or one of its subsidiaries of a cash dividend or distribution by a subsidiary of the Company to fund such purchase (together with any other purchases of Units pursuant to Section 4 or pursuant to similar provisions in agreements with other employees of the Company and its subsidiaries of which the Company has at such time been given or has given notice and together with cash dividends and distributions to fund such other purchases) would result (A) in a violation of any law, statute, rule, regulation, policy, order, writ, injunction, decree or judgment promulgated or entered by any federal, state, local or foreign court or governmental authority applicable to the Company or any of its subsidiaries or any of its or their property, (B) after giving effect thereto, in a Financing Default or (C) adverse accounting treatment for the Company, or (ii) if immediately prior to such purchase there exists a Financing Default which prohibits such purchase, dividend or distribution. The Company shall within fifteen days of learning of any such fact so notify the members of the Executive Group that it is not obligated to purchase units hereunder.

 

(b)                                  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in Section 4, any Units which a member of the Executive Group has elected to sell to the Company or which the Company has elected to purchase from members of the Executive Group, but which in

 

10



 

accordance with Section 5.1(a) are not purchased at the applicable time provided in Section 4, shall be purchased by the Company for the applicable purchase price, together with interest thereon at the Applicable Federal Rate as in effect on the date such purchase is so deferred on or prior to the fifteenth day after such date or dates that (after taking into account any purchases (and related dividends and distributions) to be made at such time pursuant to agreements with other employees of the Company and its subsidiaries) the purchase of such Units (and related dividends and distributions) are no longer prohibited under Section 5.1(a), and the Company shall give the members of the Executive Group five days prior notice of any such purchase.

 

5.2                                  Payment for Units . If at any time the Company elects or is required to purchase any Units pursuant to Section 4, the Company shall pay the purchase price for the Units it purchases (i) first, by the cancellation of any indebtedness, if any, owing from the Executive to the Company or any of its subsidiaries (which indebtedness shall be applied pro rata against the proceeds receivable by each member of the Executive Group receiving consideration in such repurchase) and (ii) then, by the Company’s delivery of a check or wire transfer of immediately available funds for the remainder of the purchase price, if any, against delivery of the certificates or other instruments representing the Units so purchased, duly endorsed; provided that if any of the conditions set forth in Section 5.1(a) exists which prohibits such cash payment (either directly or indirectly as a result of the prohibition of a related cash dividend or distribution), the portion of the cash payment so prohibited may be made, to the extent such payment is not prohibited, by the Company’s delivery of a junior subordinated promissory note (which shall be subordinated and subject in right of payment to the prior payment of any debt outstanding under the Financing Agreements and any modifications, renewals, extensions, replacements and refunding of all such indebtedness) of the Company (a “ Junior Subordinated Note ”) in a principal amount equal to the balance of the purchase price, payable (x) in the event of a termination of employment referenced in Section 4.2(a)(i) and (ii), as soon as the conditions set forth in Section 5.1(a) no longer exist or (x) in the event of a termination of employment referenced in Section 4.2(a)(iii), on the fifth anniversary of the issuance thereof, and bearing interest payable annually at the Applicable Federal Rate on the date of issuance; provided further that if any of the conditions set forth in Section 5.1(a) exists which prohibits such payment (or the payment described in the next proviso) by delivery of a Junior Subordinated Note, the portion of the payment so prohibited may be made, to the extent such payment is not prohibited, by the Company’s delivery of preferred units of the Company having an aggregate liquidation preference equal to the balance of the purchase price; provided further that in the case of a purchase pursuant to Section 4.2(a)(iii) the Company may elect at any time to deliver a Junior Subordinated Note in a principal amount equal to all or a portion of the cash purchase price (in lieu of paying such portion of the purchase price in cash), which Junior Subordinated Note shall mature on the fifth anniversary of its issuance and accrue interest annually at the Applicable Federal Rate on the date of issuance, which interest shall be payable at maturity. The Company shall use its reasonable efforts to repurchase Units pursuant to Section 4.1(a) or Section 4.2(a)(i) or Section 4.2(a)(ii) with cash and/or to prepay any Junior Subordinated Notes or redeem any preferred units issued in connection with a repurchase of Units pursuant to Section 4.1(a) or Section 4.2(a)(i) or Section 4.2(a)(ii). The Company shall have the right set forth in clause (i) of the first sentence of this Section 5.2 whether or not the member of the Executive Group selling such units is an obligor of the Company. Any Junior Subordinated Note (or preferred units issued in lieu thereof) shall become prepayable (or redeemable) upon a Sale of the Company from net cash proceeds, if any, payable to the Company or its unitholders; to the extent that

 

11



 

sufficient net cash proceeds are not so payable, the Junior Subordinated Note (or preferred units issued in lieu thereof) shall be cancelled in exchange for such other non-cash consideration received by unitholders in the Sale of the Company having a fair market value equal to the principal of and accrued interest on the note. Any Junior Subordinated Note (or preferred units issued in lieu thereof) also shall become prepayable upon the consummation of an initial Public Offering. The principal of and accrued interest on any such note may be prepaid (and preferred units issued in lieu thereof may be redeemed) in whole or in part at any time at the option of the Company. If interest (or cash dividends) is required to be paid on any Junior Subordinated Note (or preferred units issued in lieu thereof) prior to maturity and any of the conditions set forth in Section 5.1(a) exists or if any such cash payment would result in adverse accounting treatment for the Company which prohibits the payment of such interest (or dividends) in cash, such interest may be cumulated and accrued until and to the extent that such prohibition no longer exists.

 

6.                                        Noncompetition.

 

6.1                                  Competitive Activity . Executive shall be deemed to have engaged in “Competitive Activity” if, during the period commencing on the date hereof and ending on the later of (x) the first anniversary of the date Executive’s employment with the Company and its subsidiaries is terminated or (y) the maximum number of years of base salary Executive is entitled to receive as severance in a termination by the Company without Cause, Executive, whether on Executive’s own behalf or on behalf of or in conjunction with any other person or entity, directly or indirectly (A) solicits, or assists in soliciting, the business of any client of the Company or any of its subsidiaries (collectively, the “ Entities ”), or hires any employee of any of the Entities, or interferes with, or attempts to interfere with, the relationships between any of the Entities, on the one hand, and any of its customers, clients, suppliers, partners, members, employees or investors, on the other hand; or (B) becomes an employee, agent, representative, consultant, partner, shareholder or holder of any other financial interest with respect to any business, individual, partnership, joint venture, association, firm, corporation or other entity engaged, wholly or in part, in the provision or sale of acquired brain injury services, therapeutic foster care, other foster care or other home or community-based healthcare, therapy, counseling or other educational or human services to people with special needs, or any other business that the Company is actively conducting or is actively considering conducting at the time of Executive’s termination of employment (so long as Executive knows or reasonably should have known about such plan(s)), in each case in any geographical area within 100 mile radius of the Executive’s principal place of work as of the Termination Date with the Company or its affiliates, as applicable(the “ Competitive Business ”). Notwithstanding the foregoing, if Executive is subject to a more restrictive noncompetition covenant in any agreement with the Company or any of its affiliates, the most restrictive of such noncompetition covenants shall apply.

 

6.2                                  Activity Date . If Executive engages in Competitive Activity, the “ Activity Date ” shall be the first date on which Executive engages in such Competitive Activity.

 

6.3                                  Repayment of Proceeds . If Executive engages in Competitive Activity, then Executive shall be required to pay to the Company, within ten business days following the Activity Date, an amount equal to the excess, if any, of (A) the aggregate proceeds Executive

 

12



 

received upon the sale or other disposition of Executive’s Units, over (B) the aggregate Cost of such Units.

 

7.                                        Miscellaneous.

 

7.1                                  Transfers to Permitted Transferees . Prior to the transfer of Units to a Permitted Transferee (other than a transfer subsequent to a Sale of the Company), the Executive shall deliver to the Company a written agreement of the proposed transferee (a) evidencing such Person’s undertaking to be bound by the terms of this Agreement and (b) acknowledging that the Units transferred to such Person will continue to be Units for purposes of this Agreement in the hands of such Person. Any transfer or attempted transfer of Units in violation of any provision of this Agreement or the Securityholders Agreement shall be void, and the Company shall not record such transfer on its books or treat any purported transferee of such Units as the owner of such Units for any purpose.

 

7.2                                  Recapitalizations, Exchanges, Etc., Affecting Units . The provisions of this Agreement shall apply, to the full extent set forth herein with respect to Units, to any and all securities of the Company or any successor or assign of the Company (whether by merger, consolidation, sale of assets or otherwise) which may be issued in respect of, in exchange for, or in substitution of the Units, by reason of any dividend payable in units, issuance of units, combination, recapitalization, reclassification, merger, consolidation or otherwise.

 

7.3                                  Executive’s Employment by the Company . Nothing contained in this Agreement shall be deemed to obligate the Company or any subsidiary of the Company to employ the Executive in any capacity whatsoever or to prohibit or restrict the Company (or any such subsidiary) from terminating the employment of the Executive at any time or for any reason whatsoever, with or without Cause.

 

7.4                                  Cooperation . Executive agrees to cooperate with the Company in taking action reasonably necessary to consummate the transactions contemplated by this Agreement.

 

7.5                                  Binding Effect . The provisions of this Agreement shall be binding upon and accrue to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective heirs, legal representatives, successors and assigns; provided, however, that no Transferee shall derive any rights under this Agreement unless and until such Transferee has executed and delivered to the Company a valid undertaking and becomes bound by the terms of this Agreement; and provided further that Vestar is a third party beneficiary of this Agreement and shall have the right to enforce the provisions hereof.

 

7.6                                  Amendment; Waiver . This Agreement may be amended only by a written instrument signed by the parties hereto. No waiver by any party hereto of any of the provisions hereof shall be effective unless set forth in a writing executed by the party so waiving.

 

7.7                                  Governing Law . This Agreement shall be governed by and construed and enforced in accordance with the laws of the State of Delaware applicable to contracts made and to be performed therein.

 

13



 

7.8                                  Jurisdiction . Any suit, action or proceeding with respect to this Agreement, or any judgment entered by any court in respect of any thereof, shall be brought in any court of competent jurisdiction in the State of Delaware, and each of the Company and the members of the Executive Group hereby submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of such courts for the purpose of any such suit, action, proceeding or judgment. Each of the members of the Executive Group and the Company hereby irrevocably waives (i) any objections which it may now or hereafter have to the laying of the venue of any suit, action or proceeding arising out of or relating to this Agreement brought in any court of competent jurisdiction in the State of Delaware, (ii) any claim that any such suit, action or proceeding brought in any such court has been brought in any inconvenient forum and (iii) any right to a jury trial.

 

7.9                                  Notices . All notices and other communications hereunder shall be in writing and shall be deemed to have been duly given when personally delivered, telecopied (with confirmation of receipt), one day after deposit with a reputable overnight delivery service (charges prepaid) and three days after deposit in the U.S. Mail (postage prepaid and return receipt requested) to the address set forth below or such other address as the recipient party has previously delivered notice to the sending party.

 

(a)                                   If to the Company:

 

NMH Investment, LLC
c/o Vestar Capital Partners
245 Park Avenue, 41st Floor
New York, NY  10167
Attn: General Counsel
Telecopy: (212) 808-4922

 

with a copy to:

 

Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP
425 Lexington Avenue
New York, NY 10017-3954
Attn: Peter J. Gordon
Telecopy: (212) 455-2502

 

(b)                                  If to the Executive, to the address as shown on the unit register of the Company.

 

7.10                            Integration . This Agreement and the documents referred to herein or delivered pursuant hereto which form a part hereof contain the entire understanding of the parties with respect to the subject matter hereof and thereof. There are no restrictions, agreements, promises, representations, warranties, covenants or undertakings with respect to the subject matter hereof other than those expressly set forth herein and therein. This Agreement supersedes all prior agreements and understandings between the parties with respect to such subject matter.

 

7.11                            Counterparts . This Agreement may be executed in separate counterparts, and by different parties on separate counterparts each of which shall be deemed an original, but all of which shall constitute one and the same instrument.

 

14



 

7.12                            Injunctive Relief . The Executive and Executive’s Permitted Transferees each acknowledges and agrees that a violation of any of the terms of this Agreement will cause the Company irreparable injury for which adequate remedy at law is not available. Accordingly, it is agreed that the Company shall be entitled to an injunction, restraining order or other equitable relief to prevent breaches of the provisions of this Agreement and to enforce specifically the terms and provisions hereof in any court of competent jurisdiction in the United States or any state thereof, in addition to any other remedy to which it may be entitled at law or equity.

 

7.13                            Rights Cumulative; Waiver . The rights and remedies of the Executive and the Company under this Agreement shall be cumulative and not exclusive of any rights or remedies which either would otherwise have hereunder or at law or in equity or by statute, and no failure or delay by either party in exercising any right or remedy shall impair any such right or remedy or operate as a waiver of such right or remedy, nor shall any single or partial exercise of any power or right preclude such party’s other or further exercise or the exercise of any other power or right. The waiver by any party hereto of a breach of any provision of this Agreement shall not operate or be construed as a waiver of any preceding or succeeding breach and no failure by either party to exercise any right or privilege hereunder shall be deemed a waiver of such party’s rights or privileges hereunder or shall be deemed a waiver of such party’s rights to exercise the same at any subsequent time or times hereunder.

 

*     *     *     *     *

 

15



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Management Unit Subscription Agreement as of the date first above written.

 

 

NMH INVESTMENT, LLC,

 

a Delaware limited liability company

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

[Name of Executive]

 

16



 

CONSENT OF SPOUSE

 

I,                              , the undersigned spouse of Executive, hereby acknowledge that I have read the foregoing Management Unit Subscription Agreement (the “ Agreement ”) and that I understand its contents. I am aware that the Agreement provides for the repurchase of my spouse’s Units (as defined in the Agreement) under certain circumstances and imposes other restrictions on the transfer of such Units. I agree that my spouse’s interest in the Units is subject to the Agreement and any interest I may have in such Units shall also be irrevocably bound by the Agreement and, further, that my community property interest in such Units, if any, shall be similarly bound by the Agreement.

 

I am aware that the legal, financial and other matters contained in the Agreement are complex and I am encouraged to seek advice with respect thereto from independent legal and/or financial counsel. I have either sought such advice or determined after carefully reviewing the Agreement that I hereby waive such right.

 

 

Acknowledged and agreed this        day of

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Witness

 

 

1



 

SCHEDULE I

Purchased Units

 

Number

 

Price per Unit

 

Aggregate Amount

Class B Units:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Class C Units:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Class D Units:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2



 

EXHIBIT A

 

ELECTION TO INCLUDE UNITS IN GROSS
INCOME PURSUANT TO SECTION 83(b) OF THE
INTERNAL REVENUE CODE

 

The undersigned purchased units (the “Units”) of NMH Investment, LLC (the “ Company ”) on                              . The undersigned desires to make an election to have the Units taxed under the provision of Section 83(b) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (“ Code §83(b) ”), at the time the undersigned purchased the Units.

 

Therefore, pursuant to Code §83(b) and Treasury Regulation §1.83-2 promulgated thereunder, the undersigned hereby makes an election, with respect to the Units (described below), to report as taxable income for calendar year      the excess, if any, of the Units’ fair market value on                               over the purchase price thereof.

 

The following information is supplied in accordance with Treasury Regulation §1.83-2(e):

 



 

1.                                        The name, address and social security number of the undersigned:

 

[Name]

 

[Address]

 

SSN:                                       

 

2.                                        A description of the property with respect to which the election is being made:          Class B Common Units,         Class C Common Units and          Class D Common Units.

 

3.                                        The date on which the property was transferred:                              . The taxable year for which such election is made:  calendar year     .

 

4.                                        The restrictions to which the property is subject:  The Class B Common Units are subject to a time-based vesting schedule and the Class C and Class D Common Units are subject to certain time and performance based objectives. If the undersigned ceases to be employed by the Company or any of its subsidiaries under certain circumstances, all or a portion of the Units may be subject to repurchase by the Company at the original purchase price paid for the Units, regardless of the fair market value of the Units on the date of such repurchase. The Units are also subject to transfer restrictions.

 

5.                                        The aggregate fair market value on                               of the property with respect to which the election is being made, determined without regard to any lapse restrictions: $          .

 

6.                                        The aggregate amount paid for such property: $          .

 

A copy of this election has been furnished to the Secretary of the Company pursuant to Treasury Regulations §1.83-2(e)(7).

 

 

Dated:

 

 

 

[Name]

 



 

Exhibit 1.2 to the Management Unit Subscription Agreement

 

Class B Units

 

With respect to a purchase of Class B Units pursuant to Section 4.2 in the case of a termination of employment of an Executive described in Section 4.2(a)(i) or Section 4.2(a)(ii), the Applicable Percentage shall be determined in accordance with the following table attached to this Exhibit 1.2 as Annex A based on the Month (as defined below) during which the employment of such Executive is terminated:

 

With respect to a purchase of Class B Units pursuant to Section 4.2 in the case of a termination of employment of an Executive described in Section 4.2(a)(iii)(B), the Applicable Percentage shall be determined in accordance with the table attached to this Exhibit 1.2 as Annex B based on the Month (as defined below) during which the employment of such Executive is terminated.

 

For purposes of this Exhibit 1.2, “Month” means (i) in the case of Month 1, the period commencing on                               (the “Measurement Date”)(4) and ending on the calendar day immediately preceding the one-month anniversary of the Measurement Date, (ii) for Month 2, the period commencing on the one-month anniversary of the Measurement Date and ending on the calendar day immediately preceding the two-month anniversary of the Measurement Date and (iii) for each other Month, the period determined in the manner in which Month 2 was determined, substituting the number of the month minus one for “one” in the preceding clause (ii) and substituting the number of the month for “two” in the preceding clause (ii).

 



 

Annex A to Exhibit 1.2

 

 

 

Month During Which

 

 

 

 

 

Employment is

 

Applicable

 

 

 

Terminated

 

Percentage

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1

 

0.00

%

 

 

2

 

0.00

%

 

 

3

 

0.00

%

 

 

4

 

0.00

%

 

 

5

 

0.00

%

 

 

6

 

0.00

%

 

 

7

 

0.00

%

 

 

8

 

0.00

%

 

 

9

 

0.00

%

 

 

10

 

0.00

%

 

 

11

 

0.00

%

End of 1st year

 

12

 

0.00

%

 

 

13

 

20.00

%

 

 

14

 

21.70

%

 

 

15

 

23.40

%

 

 

16

 

25.10

%

 

 

17

 

26.80

%

 

 

18

 

28.50

%

 

 

19

 

30.20

%

 

 

20

 

31.90

%

 

 

21

 

33.60

%

 

 

22

 

35.30

%

 

 

23

 

37.00

%

End of 2nd year

 

24

 

38.70

%

 

 

25

 

40.40

%

 

 

26

 

42.10

%

 

 

27

 

43.80

%

 

 

28

 

45.50

%

 

 

29

 

47.20

%

 

 

30

 

48.90

%

 

 

31

 

50.60

%

 

 

32

 

52.30

%

 

 

33

 

54.00

%

 

 

34

 

55.70

%

 

 

35

 

57.40

%

End of 3rd year

 

36

 

59.10

%

 

 

37

 

60.80

%

 

 

38

 

62.50

%

 

 

39

 

64.20

%

 

 

40

 

65.90

%

 

 

41

 

67.60

%

 

 

42

 

69.30

%

 

 

43

 

71.00

%

 



 

 

 

44

 

72.70

%

 

 

45

 

74.40

%

 

 

46

 

76.10

%

 

 

47

 

77.80

%

End of 4th year

 

48

 

79.50

%

 

 

49

 

81.20

%

 

 

50

 

82.90

%

 

 

51

 

84.60

%

 

 

52

 

86.30

%

 

 

53

 

88.00

%

 

 

54

 

89.70

%

 

 

55

 

91.40

%

 

 

56

 

93.10

%

 

 

57

 

94.80

%

 

 

58

 

96.50

%

 

 

59

 

98.20

%

End of 5th year

 

60

 

99.90

%

 

 

61 and thereafter

 

100.00

%

 



 

Annex B to Exhibit 1.2

 

 

 

Month During Which

 

 

 

 

 

Employment is

 

Applicable

 

 

 

Terminated

 

Percentage

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1

 

0.00

%

 

 

2

 

0.00

%

 

 

3

 

0.00

%

 

 

4

 

0.00

%

 

 

5

 

0.00

%

 

 

6

 

0.00

%

 

 

7

 

0.00

%

 

 

8

 

0.00

%

 

 

9

 

0.00

%

 

 

10

 

0.00

%

 

 

11

 

0.00

%

End of 1st year

 

12

 

0.00

%

 

 

13

 

0.00

%

 

 

14

 

0.00

%

 

 

15

 

0.00

%

 

 

16

 

0.00

%

 

 

17

 

0.00

%

 

 

18

 

0.00

%

 

 

19

 

0.00

%

 

 

20

 

0.00

%

 

 

21

 

0.00

%

 

 

22

 

0.00

%

 

 

23

 

0.00

%

End of 2nd year

 

24

 

0.00

%

 

 

25

 

0.00

%

 

 

26

 

0.00

%

 

 

27

 

0.00

%

 

 

28

 

0.00

%

 

 

29

 

0.00

%

 

 

30

 

0.00

%

 

 

31

 

0.00

%

 

 

32

 

0.00

%

 

 

33

 

0.00

%

 

 

34

 

0.00

%

 

 

35

 

0.00

%

End of 3rd year

 

36

 

0.00

%

 

 

37

 

40.00

%

 

 

38

 

43.18

%

 

 

39

 

46.36

%

 

 

40

 

49.54

%

 

 

41

 

52.72

%

 

 

42

 

55.90

%

 

 

43

 

59.08

%

 



 

 

 

44

 

62.26

%

 

 

45

 

65.44

%

 

 

46

 

68.62

%

 

 

47

 

71.80

%

End of 4th year

 

48

 

74.98

%

 

 

49

 

77.06

%

 

 

50

 

79.14

%

 

 

51

 

81.22

%

 

 

52

 

83.30

%

 

 

53

 

85.38

%

 

 

54

 

87.46

%

 

 

55

 

89.54

%

 

 

56

 

91.62

%

 

 

57

 

93.70

%

 

 

58

 

95.78

%

 

 

59

 

97.86

%

End of 5th year

 

60

 

99.94

%

 

 

61 and thereafter

 

100.00

%

 




Exhibit 10.16

 

FORM OF DIRECTOR UNIT SUBSCRIPTION AGREEMENT

 

(Preferred Units, Class A Units and Class E Units)

 

THIS DIRECTOR UNIT SUBSCRIPTION AGREEMENT (this “ Agreement ”) is made as of                              , among NMH Investment, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (the “ Company ”), Jeffry A. Timmons (the “ Director ”) and Fiddlewood Farms Investments, LLC, a New Hampshire limited liability company controlled by the Director and his spouse (“ FFI ”).

 

WHEREAS, on the terms and subject to the conditions hereof, the Director desires to subscribe for, and to assign to his designee, FFI, the Director’s right to acquire from the Company, and the Company desires to issue and sell to FFI, as the assignee and designee of the Director, the Company’s Participating Preferred Units (the “ Preferred Units ”), Class A Common Units (the “ Class A Units ”) and Class E Common Units (the “ Class E Units ”, and together with the Preferred Units and the Class A Units, the “ Units ”), in each case in the amounts set forth on Schedule I , as hereinafter set forth; and

 

WHEREAS, this Agreement is one of several agreements entered into or being entered into by the Company with certain persons who are or will be key employees and/or directors of the Company or one or more of its subsidiaries as part of an equity purchase plan designed to comply with Rule 701 promulgated under the Securities Act (as defined below);

 

NOW, THEREFORE, in order to implement the foregoing and in consideration of the mutual representations, warranties, covenants and agreements contained herein, the parties hereto agree as follows:

 

1.                                        Definitions .

 

1.1                                  Agreement . The term “Agreement” shall have the meaning set forth in the preface.

 

1.2                                  Applicable Percentage . The term “Applicable Percentage” shall mean, with respect to FFI’s Class E Units, the percentage set forth in the applicable table under the heading “Applicable Percentage,” as more specifically determined in accordance with the schedule set forth as Exhibit 1.2, attached hereto and incorporated herein by this reference.

 

1.3                                  Board . The “Board” shall mean the Company’s Management Committee.

 

1.4                                  Cause . The term “Cause” shall mean a termination of the Director’s service as a member of the Board due to (i) the commission by the Director of an act of fraud or embezzlement, (ii) the indictment or conviction of the Director for (x) a felony or (y) a crime involving moral turpitude or a plea by Director of guilty or nolo contendere involving such a crime (to the extent it gives rise to an adverse effect on the business or reputation of the Company or any of its subsidiaries), (iii) the willful misconduct by the Director in the performance of Director’s duties, including any willful misrepresentation or willful concealment by Director on any report submitted to the Company (or any of its securityholders or

 



 

subsidiaries) which is not of a de minimis nature, (iv) the willful failure of the Director to render services to the Company or any of its subsidiaries in accordance with Director’s service which failure amounts to a material neglect of the Director’s duties to the Company or any of its subsidiaries or (v) the material breach by Director or FFI of any of the provisions of any agreement between Director or FFI, on the one hand, and the Company or a securityholder or an affiliate of the Company, on the other hand.

 

1.5                                  Closing . The term “Closing” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2.2.

 

1.6                                  Closing Date . The term “Closing Date” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2.2.

 

1.7                                  Company . The term “Company” shall have the meaning set forth in the preface.

 

1.8                                  Cost . The term “Cost” shall mean the price per Unit paid by FFI as proportionately adjusted for all subsequent distributions of Units and other recapitalizations and less the amount of any tax distributions made with respect to the Units pursuant to Section 4.4(j) of the LLC Agreement.

 

1.9                                  Disability . The term “Disability” of the Director shall mean the inability of the Director to perform the essential functions of Director’s job, with or without reasonable accommodation, by reason of a physical or mental infirmity, for a continuous period of six months. The period of six months shall be deemed continuous unless Director returns to work for at least 30 consecutive business days during such period and performs during such period at the level and competence that existed prior to the beginning of the six-month period. The date of such Disability shall be on the first day of such six-month period.

 

1.10                            Director . The term “Director” shall have the meaning set forth in the preface.

 

1.11                            Director Group . The term “Director Group” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 4.1(a).

 

1.12                            Fair Market Value . The term “Fair Market Value” used in connection with the value of Units shall mean the average of the closing prices of the sales of the Company’s Units on all securities exchanges on which the Units may at the time be listed, or, if there have been no sales on any such exchange on any day, the average of the highest bid and lowest asked prices on all such exchanges at the end of such day or, if on any day the Units are not so listed, the average of the representative bid and asked prices quoted in the NASDAQ System as of 4:00 P.M., New York time, or, if on any day the Units are not quoted in the NASDAQ System, the average of the highest bid and lowest asked prices on such day in the domestic over-the-counter market as reported by the National Quotation Bureau Incorporated or any similar successor organization, in each such case averaged over a period of 21 days consisting of the day as of which the Fair Market Value is being determined and the 20 consecutive business days prior to such day. If at any time the Units are not listed on any securities exchange or quoted in the NASDAQ System or the over-the-counter market, the Fair Market Value shall be the fair value of the Units determined in good faith by the Board using its reasonable business judgment (valuing the

 



 

Company and its subsidiaries as a going concern; disregarding any discount for minority interest or marketability of the Units, whether due to transfer restrictions or the lack of a public market for the Units; taking into account the Preferred Priority Return (as defined in the LLC Agreement); without taking into account the effect of any contemporaneous repurchase of Units at less than Fair Market Value under Section 4) after consultation with an independent appraiser, accountant or investment banking firm (the “ Valuation Expert ”); provided that (i) the Board shall only be obligated to consult a Valuation Expert once annually absent special circumstances (as determined in good faith by the Board) and (ii) if FFI disagrees in good faith with the Board’s determination and such dispute involves an amount in excess of $250,000, FFI shall notify the Company in writing of such disagreement within ten (10) business days of receipt of the Board’s determination of the fair market value of such Units, in which event a second Valuation Expert (the “ Arbiter ”) selected by mutual agreement of FFI and the Board shall make a determination of the fair market value thereof (valuing the Company and its subsidiaries as set forth above) solely by (i) reviewing a single written presentation timely made by each of the Company and FFI setting forth their respective resolutions of the dispute and the bases therefor and (ii) accepting either FFI’s or the Company’s proposed resolution of the dispute. For the avoidance of doubt, the determination of Fair Market Value of any Unit shall be based on the amounts distributable in respect of such Unit under the terms of the LLC Agreement, including any adjustments necessary to reflect the portion of any tax distributions that were previously made in respect of such Unit but not charged against other distributions in respect of such Unit.

 

Within five (5) business days after the Company’s receipt of FFI’s written notice of disagreement, the Company shall make available to FFI all data (including reports of employees and outside advisors) relied upon by the Board in making its determination. FFI’s and the Company’s written presentations must be submitted to the Arbiter within 30 days of the Arbiter’s engagement, written notice of which shall be delivered by the Company to FFI. The Arbiter shall notify FFI and the Company of its decision within 40 days of its engagement. If FFI’s proposed resolution is accepted, the Company also shall pay all of FFI’s reasonable out-of-pocket fees and expenses (including reasonable fees and expenses of counsel and one Valuation Expert) incurred in connection with the arbitration. Each of the Company and FFI agrees to execute, if requested by the Arbiter, a reasonable engagement letter with the Arbiter.

 

1.13                            Financing Default . The term “Financing Default” shall mean an event which would constitute (or with notice or lapse of time or both would constitute) an event of default under any of the following as they may be amended from time to time: (i) the Credit Agreement dated as of June 26, 2006 among National Mentor Holdings, Inc. (“ NMH ”), NMH Holdings, LLC, the lenders party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. as sole administrative agent for such lenders, and the Indenture, dated as of the date hereof, among NMH, the Guarantors (as defined in the Indenture), and U.S. Bank National Association, as trustee, and the Senior Subordinated Notes issued by NMH pursuant to the Indenture (collectively, the “ Financing Agreements ”), and any extensions, renewals, refinancings or refundings thereof in whole or in part; (ii) any other agreement under which an amount of indebtedness of the Company or any of its subsidiaries in excess of $5,000,000 is outstanding as of the time of the aforementioned event, and any extensions, renewals, refinancings or refundings thereof in whole or in part; (iii) restrictive financial covenants contained in the LLC Agreement of the Company or NMH’s

 



 

organizational documents; (iv) any amendment of, supplement to or other modification of any of the instruments referred to in clauses (i) through (iii) above; and (v) any of the securities issued pursuant to or whose terms are governed by the terms of any of the agreements set forth in clauses (i) through (iv) above, and any extensions, renewals, refinancings or refundings thereof in whole or in part.

 

1.14                            LLC Agreement . The term “LLC Agreement” means the Second Amended and Restated Limited Liability Company Agreement, dated as of December 11, 2006, by and among the Company, Vestar and the other Members of the Company a party thereto, as amended from time to time in accordance with the provisions thereof.

 

1.15                            Permitted Transferee . The term “Permitted Transferee” means any transferee of Units pursuant to clauses (f) or (g) of the definition of “Exempt Employee Transfer” as defined in the Securityholders Agreement. For purposes of the Securityholders Agreement, the “Family Group” of FFI shall be the Director’s “Family Group”, as defined in the Securityholders Agreement.

 

1.16                            Person . The term “Person” shall mean any individual, corporation, partnership, limited liability company, trust, joint stock company, business trust, unincorporated association, joint venture, governmental authority or other entity of any nature whatsoever.

 

1.17                            Public Offering . The term “Public Offering” shall have the meaning set forth in the Securityholders Agreement.

 

1.18                            Preferred Units . The term “Preferred Units” shall have the meaning set forth in the recitals.

 

1.19                            Purchase Price . The term “Purchase Price” shall have the meaning set forth in Section 2.1.

 

1.20                            Sale of the Company . The term “Sale of the Company” shall have the meaning set forth in the Securityholders Agreement, except that transactions with a Person or Persons that are a wholly owned Subsidiary (as defined in the Securityholders Agreement) of Vestar and/or Vestar/NMH Investors, LLC or NMH Investment, LLC shall be excluded.

 

1.21                            Securities Act . The term “Securities Act” shall mean the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and all rules and regulations promulgated thereunder, as the same may be amended from time to time.

 

1.22                            Securityholders Agreement . The term “Securityholders Agreement” shall mean the Securityholders Agreement dated as of the Closing Date among Vestar, the Management Investors and the Company, as it may be amended or supplemented thereafter from time to time. For purposes of the Securityholders Agreement, FFI is an “Employee” and the Units are “Employee Securities,” in each case as those terms are defined in the Securityholders Agreement.

 



 

1.23                            Termination Date . The term “Termination Date” means the date upon which Director’s service as a member of the Board is terminated.

 

1.24                            Vestar . The term “Vestar” means Vestar Capital Partners V, L.P., a Cayman Islands exempted limited partnership.

 

2.                                        Subscription for and Purchase of Units .

 

2.1                                  Purchase of Units . Pursuant to the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in this Agreement, FFI hereby subscribes for and agrees to purchase, and the Company hereby agrees to issue and sell to FFI, on the Closing Date the number of Preferred Units, Class A Units and Class E Units set forth in Schedule I attached hereto at the applicable prices per unit and for the aggregate amounts (the “ Purchase Price ”) set forth in Schedule I attached hereto.

 

2.2                                  The Closing . The closing (the “ Closing ”) of the purchase of Units hereunder shall take place simultaneously with the execution hereof (the “ Closing Date ”). At the Closing, FFI shall deliver to the Company (i) the Purchase Price, payable by delivery of the amount in cash set forth on Schedule I attached hereto, by delivery of a cashier’s or certified check or by wire transfer in immediately available funds and (ii) a writing satisfactory to the Company and executed by FFI that evidences its acceptance and adoption of all of the terms and provisions of each of the LLC Agreement and the Securityholders Agreement.

 

2.3                                  Section 83(b) Election . Within 10 days after the Closing, Director shall provide the Company with a completed election under Section 83(b) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, and the regulations promulgated thereunder in the form of Exhibit A attached hereto. The Company shall timely file (via certified mail, return receipt requested) such election with the Internal Revenue Service (“ IRS ”), and shall provide Director with proof of such timely filing.

 

2.4                                  Closing Conditions . Notwithstanding anything in this Agreement to the contrary, the Company shall be under no obligation to issue and sell to FFI any Units unless (i) the Director is a member of the Board on the Closing Date; (ii) the representations of the Director and FFI contained in Section 3 hereof are true and correct in all material respects as of the Closing Date and (iii) the Director and FFI are not in breach of any agreement, obligation or covenant herein required to be performed or observed by the Director or FFI on or prior to the Closing Date.

 

3.                                        Investment Representations and Covenants of the Director and FFI .

 

3.1                                  Units Unregistered . The Director and FFI acknowledge and represent that each has been advised by the Company that:

 

(a)                                   the offer and sale of the Units have not been registered under the Securities Act;
 
(b)                                  the Units must be held indefinitely and FFI must continue to bear the economic risk of the investment in the Units unless the offer and sale of such Units are

 



 

subsequently registered under the Securities Act and all applicable state securities laws or an exemption from such registration is available;
 
(c)                                   there is no established market for the Units and it is not anticipated that there will be any public market for the Units in the foreseeable future;
 
(d)                                  a notation shall be made in the appropriate records of the Company indicating that the Units are subject to restrictions on transfer and, if the Company should at some time in the future engage the services of a securities transfer agent, appropriate stop-transfer instructions will be issued to such transfer agent with respect to the Units.
 

3.2                                  Additional Investment Representations . The Director and FFI represent and warrant that:

 

(a)                                   FFI’s financial situation is such that FFI can afford to bear the economic risk of holding the Units for an indefinite period of time, has adequate means for providing for FFI’s current needs and contingencies, and can afford to suffer a complete loss of FFI’s investment in the Units;
 
(b)                                  FFI’s knowledge and experience in financial and business matters are such that FFI is capable of evaluating the merits and risks of the investment in the Units;
 
(c)                                   FFI understands that the Units are a speculative investment which involves a high degree of risk of loss of FFI’s investment therein, there are substantial restrictions on the transferability of the Units and, on the Closing Date and for an indefinite period following the Closing, there will be no public market for the Units and, accordingly, it may not be possible for FFI to liquidate FFI’s investment in case of emergency, if at all;
 
(d)                                  the terms of this Agreement provide that if the Director ceases to be a member of the Board, the Company and its affiliates have the right to repurchase the Units at a price which may, under certain circumstances, be less than the Fair Market Value thereof;
 
(e)                                   FFI understands and has taken cognizance of all the risk factors related to the purchase of the Units and, other than as set forth in this Agreement, no representations or warranties have been made to FFI or FFI’s representatives concerning the Units or the Company or their prospects or other matters;
 
(f)                                     FFI has been given the opportunity to examine all documents and to ask questions of, and to receive answers from, the Company and its representatives concerning the Company and its subsidiaries, the Securityholders Agreement, the Company’s organizational documents and the terms and conditions of the purchase of the Units and to obtain any additional information which FFI deems necessary;

 



 

(g)                                  all information which FFI has provided to the Company and the Company’s representatives concerning FFI and FFI’s financial position is complete and correct as of the date of this Agreement;
 
(h)                                  FFI is an “accredited investor” within the meaning of Rule 501(a) under the Securities Act; and
 
(i)                                      the sole members of FFI are the Director, his spouse, his two daughters and his two sons-in-law.
 

4.                                        Certain Sales and Forfeitures Upon Termination of Employment .

 

4.1                                  Put Option .

 

(a)                                   If the Director’s service as a member of the Board terminates due to the Disability or death of the Director prior to the earlier of (i) a Public Offering or (ii) a Sale of the Company, the Director, FFI and the Director’s Permitted Transferees (hereinafter sometimes collectively referred to as the “ Director Group ”) shall have the right, subject to the provisions of Section 5 hereof, for 90 days following the date that is six (6) months after the date of such termination of employment of the Director, to sell to the Company, and the Company shall be required to purchase (subject to the provisions of Section 5 hereof), on one occasion from each member of the Director Group, all (but not less than all) of the number of Units then held by the Director Group that equals the sum of (i) the total number of Class A Units collectively held by the Director Group, at a price per Unit equal to the applicable purchase price determined pursuant to Section 4.1(c),  (ii) the total number of Preferred Units collectively held by the Director Group, at a price per Unit equal to the applicable purchase price determined pursuant to Section 4.1(c) and (iii) the product of (x) the total number of Class E Units collectively held by the Director Group and (y) the Applicable Percentage (measured as of the Termination Date), at a price per Unit equal to the applicable purchase price determined pursuant to Section 4.1(c). In order to exercise its rights with respect to the Units pursuant to this Section 4.1(a), the Director Group shall also be required to simultaneously exercise any similar rights it may have with respect to any other units of the Company held by the Director Group in accordance with the terms of the agreements pursuant to which such other units were purchased from the Company.

 

(b)                                  If the Director Group desires to exercise its option to require the Company to repurchase Units pursuant to Section 4.1(a), the members of the Director Group shall send one written notice to the Company setting forth such members’ intention to collectively sell all of their Units pursuant to Section 4.1(a), which notice shall include the signature of each member of the Director Group. Subject to the provisions of Section 5.1, the closing of the purchase shall take place at the principal office of the Company on a date specified by the Company no later than the 60th day after the giving of such notice.

 

(c)                                   In the event of a purchase by the Company pursuant to Section 4.1(a), the purchase price of any Unit subject to purchase under Section 4.1(a) shall be Fair Market Value (measured as of the purchase date); provided that in any case the Board shall have the right, in its sole discretion, to increase any of the foregoing purchase prices.

 



 

4.2                                  Call Options .

 

(a)                                   If the Director’s service as a member of the Board terminates for any of the reasons set forth in clauses (i), (ii) or (iii) below prior to a Sale of the Company, the Company shall have the right and option to purchase for a period of 90 days following the Termination Date, and each member of the Director Group shall be required to sell to the Company, any or all of such Units then held by such member of the Director Group (it being understood that if Units of any class subject to repurchase hereunder may be repurchased at different prices, the Company may elect to repurchase only the portion of the Units of such class subject to repurchase hereunder at the lower price), at a price per unit equal to the applicable purchase price determined pursuant to Section 4.2(c):

 

(i)                                      if the Director’s service as a member of the Board is terminated due to the Disability or death of the Director;

 

(ii)                                   if the Director’s service as a member of the Board is terminated by the Company and its subsidiaries without Cause or by the Director for any reason when none of the circumstances set forth in clauses (i) and (iii) apply;

 

(iii)                                if the Director’s service as a member of the Board is terminated by the Company or any of its subsidiaries for Cause.

 

(b)                                  If the Company desires to exercise one of its options to purchase Units pursuant to this Section 4.2, the Company shall, not later than 90 days after the Termination Date, send written notice to each member of the Director Group of its intention to purchase Units, specifying the number of Units to be purchased (the “ Call Notice ”). Subject to the provisions of Section 5, the closing of the purchase shall take place at the principal office of the Company on a date specified by the Company no later than the 30th day after the giving of the later of the Call Notice.

 

(c)                                   In the event of a purchase by the Company pursuant to Section 4.2(a), the purchase price shall be:

 

(i)                                      with respect to a purchase of all Units, in the case of a termination of the Director’s service as a member of the Board described in Section 4.2(a)(iii), a price per Unit equal to the lesser of (A) Fair Market Value (measured as of the Termination Date) and (B) Cost;

 

(ii)                                   with respect to a purchase of Preferred Units or Class A Units, in the case of a termination of the Director’s service as a member of the Board described in Sections 4.2(a)(i) or Section 4.2(a)(ii), a price per Unit equal to Fair Market Value (measured as of the Termination Date); and

 

(iii)                                with respect to a purchase of Class E Units, in the case of a termination of the Director’s service as a member of the Board described in Section 4.2(a)(i) or Section 4.2(a)(ii), with respect to the number of Units being purchased which is the product of (x)

 



 

the total number of Units being purchased and (y) the Applicable Percentage (measured as of the Termination Date), a price per Unit equal to Fair Market Value (measured as of the Termination Date), and (if the Applicable Percentage (measured as of the Termination Date) is less than 100%) the purchase price with respect to the remaining Units being sold shall be a price per Unit equal to the lesser of (A) Fair Market Value (measured as of the Termination Date) and (B) Cost;

 

provided that in any case the Board shall have the right, in its sole discretion, to increase any purchase price set forth above.

 

4.3                                  Obligation to Sell Several . If there is more than one member of the Director Group, the failure of any one member thereof to perform its obligations hereunder shall not excuse or affect the obligations of any other member thereof, and the closing of the purchases from such other members by the Company shall not excuse, or constitute a waiver of its rights against, the defaulting member.

 

5.                                        Certain Limitations on the Company’s Obligations to Purchase Units .

 

5.1                                  Deferral of Purchases . (a)  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, the Company shall not be obligated to purchase any Units at any time pursuant to Section 4, regardless of whether it has delivered a notice of its election to purchase any such Units, (i) to the extent that the purchase of such Units or the payment to the Company or one of its subsidiaries of a cash dividend or distribution by a subsidiary of the Company to fund such purchase (together with any other purchases of Units pursuant to Section 4 or pursuant to similar provisions in agreements with other employees of the Company and its subsidiaries of which the Company has at such time been given or has given notice and together with cash dividends and distributions to fund such other purchases) would result (A) in a violation of any law, statute, rule, regulation, policy, order, writ, injunction, decree or judgment promulgated or entered by any federal, state, local or foreign court or governmental authority applicable to the Company or any of its subsidiaries or any of its or their property, (B) after giving effect thereto, in a Financing Default or (C) adverse accounting treatment for the Company, or (ii) if immediately prior to such purchase there exists a Financing Default which prohibits such purchase, dividend or distribution. The Company shall within fifteen days of learning of any such fact so notify the members of the Director Group that it is not obligated to purchase units hereunder.

 

(b)                                  Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in Section 4, any Units which a member of the Director Group has elected to sell to the Company or which the Company has elected to purchase from members of the Director Group, but which in accordance with Section 5.1(a) are not purchased at the applicable time provided in Section 4, shall be purchased by the Company for the applicable purchase price, together with interest thereon at the Applicable Federal Rate as in effect on the date such purchase is so deferred on or prior to the fifteenth day after such date or dates that (after taking into account any purchases (and related dividends and distributions) to be made at such time pursuant to agreements with other employees of the Company and its subsidiaries) the purchase of such Units (and related dividends and distributions) are no longer prohibited under Section 5.1(a), and the Company shall give the members of the Director Group five days prior notice of any such purchase.

 



 

5.2                                  Payment for Units . If at any time the Company elects or is required to purchase any Units pursuant to Section 4, the Company shall pay the purchase price for the Units it purchases (i) first, by the cancellation of any indebtedness, if any, owing from the Director to the Company or any of its subsidiaries (which indebtedness shall be applied pro rata against the proceeds receivable by each member of the Director Group receiving consideration in such repurchase) and (ii) then, by the Company’s delivery of a check or wire transfer of immediately available funds for the remainder of the purchase price, if any, against delivery of the certificates or other instruments representing the Units so purchased, duly endorsed; provided that if any of the conditions set forth in Section 5.1(a) exists which prohibits such cash payment (either directly or indirectly as a result of the prohibition of a related cash dividend or distribution), the portion of the cash payment so prohibited may be made, to the extent such payment is not prohibited, by the Company’s delivery of a junior subordinated promissory note (which shall be subordinated and subject in right of payment to the prior payment of any debt outstanding under the Financing Agreements and any modifications, renewals, extensions, replacements and refunding of all such indebtedness) of the Company (a “ Junior Subordinated Note ”) in a principal amount equal to the balance of the purchase price, payable (x) in the event of a termination of employment referenced in Section 4.2(a)(i) and (ii), as soon as the conditions set forth in Section 5.1(a) no longer exist or (x) in the event of a termination of the Director’s service as a member of the Board referenced in Section 4.2(a)(iii), on the fifth anniversary of the issuance thereof, and bearing interest payable annually at the Applicable Federal Rate on the date of issuance; provided further that if any of the conditions set forth in Section 5.1(a) exists which prohibits such payment (or the payment described in the next proviso) by delivery of a Junior Subordinated Note, the portion of the payment so prohibited may be made, to the extent such payment is not prohibited, by the Company’s delivery of preferred units of the Company having an aggregate liquidation preference equal to the balance of the purchase price; provided further that in the case of a purchase pursuant to Section 4.2(a)(iii) the Company may elect at any time to deliver a Junior Subordinated Note in a principal amount equal to all or a portion of the cash purchase price (in lieu of paying such portion of the purchase price in cash), which Junior Subordinated Note shall mature on the fifth anniversary of its issuance and accrue interest annually at the Applicable Federal Rate on the date of issuance, which interest shall be payable at maturity. The Company shall use its reasonable efforts to repurchase Units pursuant to Section 4.1(a) or Section 4.2(a)(i) or Section 4.2(a)(ii) with cash and/or to prepay any Junior Subordinated Notes or redeem any preferred units issued in connection with a repurchase of Units pursuant to Section 4.1(a) or Section 4.2(a)(i) or Section 4.2(a)(ii). The Company shall have the right set forth in clause (i) of the first sentence of this Section 5.2 whether or not the member of the Director Group selling such units is an obligor of the Company. Any Junior Subordinated Note (or preferred units issued in lieu thereof) shall become prepayable (or redeemable) upon a Sale of the Company from net cash proceeds, if any, payable to the Company or its unitholders; to the extent that sufficient net cash proceeds are not so payable, the Junior Subordinated Note (or preferred units issued in lieu thereof) shall be cancelled in exchange for such other non-cash consideration received by unitholders in the Sale of the Company having a fair market value equal to the principal of and accrued interest on the note. Any Junior Subordinated Note (or preferred units issued in lieu thereof) also shall become prepayable upon the consummation of an initial Public Offering. The principal of and accrued interest on any such note may be prepaid (and preferred units issued in lieu thereof may be

 



 

redeemed) in whole or in part at any time at the option of the Company. If interest (or cash dividends) is required to be paid on any Junior Subordinated Note (or preferred units issued in lieu thereof) prior to maturity and any of the conditions set forth in Section 5.1(a) exists or if any such cash payment would result in adverse accounting treatment for the Company which prohibits the payment of such interest (or dividends) in cash, such interest may be cumulated and accrued until and to the extent that such prohibition no longer exists.

 

6.                                        Miscellaneous .

 

6.1                                  Transfers to Permitted Transferees . Prior to the transfer of Units to a Permitted Transferee (other than a transfer subsequent to a Sale of the Company), the Director shall deliver to the Company a written agreement of the proposed transferee (a) evidencing such Person’s undertaking to be bound by the terms of this Agreement and (b) acknowledging that the Units transferred to such Person will continue to be Units for purposes of this Agreement in the hands of such Person. Any transfer or attempted transfer of Units in violation of any provision of this Agreement or the Securityholders Agreement shall be void, and the Company shall not record such transfer on its books or treat any purported transferee of such Units as the owner of such Units for any purpose.

 

6.2                                  Recapitalizations, Exchanges, Etc., Affecting Units . The provisions of this Agreement shall apply, to the full extent set forth herein with respect to Units, to any and all securities of the Company or any successor or assign of the Company (whether by merger, consolidation, sale of assets or otherwise) which may be issued in respect of, in exchange for, or in substitution of the Units, by reason of any dividend payable in units, issuance of units, combination, recapitalization, reclassification, merger, consolidation or otherwise.

 

6.3                                  Director’s Employment by the Company . Nothing contained in this Agreement shall be deemed to (i) obligate the Company or any subsidiary of the Company to employ the Director in any capacity whatsoever or to prohibit or restrict the Company (or any such subsidiary) from terminating the employment of the Director at any time or for any reason whatsoever, with or without Cause, or (ii) require Director to remain a member of the Board.

 

6.4                                  Cooperation . The Director and FFI agree to cooperate with the Company in taking action reasonably necessary to consummate the transactions contemplated by this Agreement.

 

6.5                                  Binding Effect . The provisions of this Agreement shall be binding upon and accrue to the benefit of the parties hereto and their respective heirs, legal representatives, successors and assigns; provided, however, that no Transferee shall derive any rights under this Agreement unless and until such Transferee has executed and delivered to the Company a valid undertaking and becomes bound by the terms of this Agreement; and provided further that Vestar is a third party beneficiary of this Agreement and shall have the right to enforce the provisions hereof.

 

6.6                                  Amendment; Waiver . This Agreement may be amended only by a written instrument signed by the parties hereto. No waiver by any party hereto of any of the provisions hereof shall be effective unless set forth in a writing executed by the party so waiving.

 



 

6.7                                  Governing Law . This Agreement shall be governed by and construed and enforced in accordance with the laws of the State of Delaware applicable to contracts made and to be performed therein.

 

6.8                                  Jurisdiction . Any suit, action or proceeding with respect to this Agreement, or any judgment entered by any court in respect of any thereof, shall be brought in any court of competent jurisdiction in the State of Delaware, and each of the Company and the members of the Director Group hereby submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of such courts for the purpose of any such suit, action, proceeding or judgment. Each of the members of the Director Group and the Company hereby irrevocably waives (i) any objections which it may now or hereafter have to the laying of the venue of any suit, action or proceeding arising out of or relating to this Agreement brought in any court of competent jurisdiction in the State of Delaware, (ii) any claim that any such suit, action or proceeding brought in any such court has been brought in any inconvenient forum and (iii) any right to a jury trial.

 

6.9                                  Notices . All notices and other communications hereunder shall be in writing and shall be deemed to have been duly given when personally delivered, telecopied (with confirmation of receipt), one day after deposit with a reputable overnight delivery service (charges prepaid) and three days after deposit in the U.S. Mail (postage prepaid and return receipt requested) to the address set forth below or such other address as the recipient party has previously delivered notice to the sending party.

 

(a)                                   If to the Company:

 

NMH Investment, LLC
c/o Vestar Capital Partners
245 Park Avenue, 41st Floor
New York, NY  10167
Attn: General Counsel
Telecopy: (212) 808-4922

 

with a copy to:

 

Simpson Thacher & Bartlett LLP
425 Lexington Avenue
New York, NY 10017-3954
Attn: Peter J. Gordon
Telecopy: (212) 455-2502

 

(b)                                  If to FFI, to the address as shown on the unit register of the Company.

 

6.10                            Integration . This Agreement and the documents referred to herein or delivered pursuant hereto which form a part hereof contain the entire understanding of the parties with respect to the subject matter hereof and thereof. There are no restrictions, agreements, promises, representations, warranties, covenants or undertakings with respect to the subject matter hereof

 



 

other than those expressly set forth herein and therein. This Agreement supersedes all prior agreements and understandings between the parties with respect to such subject matter.

 

6.11                            Counterparts . This Agreement may be executed in separate counterparts, and by different parties on separate counterparts each of which shall be deemed an original, but all of which shall constitute one and the same instrument.

 

6.12                            Injunctive Relief . The Director, FFI and FFI’s Permitted Transferees each acknowledges and agrees that a violation of any of the terms of this Agreement will cause the Company irreparable injury for which adequate remedy at law is not available. Accordingly, it is agreed that the Company shall be entitled to an injunction, restraining order or other equitable relief to prevent breaches of the provisions of this Agreement and to enforce specifically the terms and provisions hereof in any court of competent jurisdiction in the United States or any state thereof, in addition to any other remedy to which it may be entitled at law or equity.

 

6.13                            Rights Cumulative; Waiver . The rights and remedies of the Director, FFI and the Company under this Agreement shall be cumulative and not exclusive of any rights or remedies which each would otherwise have hereunder or at law or in equity or by statute, and no failure or delay by any party in exercising any right or remedy shall impair any such right or remedy or operate as a waiver of such right or remedy, nor shall any single or partial exercise of any power or right preclude such party’s other or further exercise or the exercise of any other power or right. The waiver by any party hereto of a breach of any provision of this Agreement shall not operate or be construed as a waiver of any preceding or succeeding breach and no failure by any party to exercise any right or privilege hereunder shall be deemed a waiver of such party’s rights or privileges hereunder or shall be deemed a waiver of such party’s rights to exercise the same at any subsequent time or times hereunder.

 

*     *     *     *     *

 



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties have executed this Management Unit Subscription Agreement as of the date first above written.

 

 

NMH INVESTMENT, LLC,

 

a Delaware limited liability company

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

 

Name:

 

 

Title:

 

 

 

FIDDLEWOOD FARMS INVESTMENTS, LLC,

 

a Delaware limited liability company

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

 

 

 

 



 

SCHEDULE I

Purchased Units

 

Number

 

Price per Unit

 

Aggregate Amount

 

Preferred Units:

 

 

 

$

 

 

$

 

 

Class A Units:

 

 

 

$

 

 

$

 

 

Class E Units:

 

 

 

$

 

 

$

 

 

Total

 

 

 

 

 

$

 

 

 



 

EXHIBIT A

 

ELECTION TO INCLUDE UNITS IN GROSS
INCOME PURSUANT TO SECTION 83(b) OF THE
INTERNAL REVENUE CODE

 

The undersigned purchased units (the “Units”) of NMH Investment, LLC (the “ Company ”) on                              . The undersigned desires to make an election to have the Units taxed under the provision of Section 83(b) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (“ Code §83(b) ”), at the time the undersigned purchased the Units.

 

Therefore, pursuant to Code §83(b) and Treasury Regulation §1.83-2 promulgated thereunder, the undersigned hereby makes an election, with respect to the Units (described below), to report as taxable income for calendar year            the excess, if any, of the Units’ fair market value on                               over the purchase price thereof.

 

The following information is supplied in accordance with Treasury Regulation §1.83-2(e):

 

1.                                        The name, address and social security number of the undersigned:

 

Jeffry A. Timmons
[address]

 

SSN: [Insert number]

 

2.                                        A description of the property with respect to which the election is being made:                              .

 

3.                                        The date on which the property was transferred:                              . The taxable year for which such election is made:  calendar year     .

 

4.                                        The restrictions to which the property is subject:  The Class A Common Units and the Class E Common Units are subject to a time-based vesting schedule. If the undersigned ceases to be employed by the Company or any of its subsidiaries under certain circumstances, all or a portion of the Units may be subject to repurchase by the Company at the original purchase price paid for the Units, regardless of the fair market value of the Units on the date of such repurchase. The Units are also subject to transfer restrictions.

 

5.                                        The aggregate fair market value on                               of the property with respect to which the election is being made, determined without regard to any lapse restrictions: $      .

 

6.                                        The aggregate amount paid for such property: $      .

 



 

A copy of this election has been furnished to the Secretary of the Company pursuant to Treasury Regulations §1.83-2(e)(7).

 

 

Dated:

 

 

 

[Director]

 



 

Exhibit 1.2 to the Director Unit Subscription Agreement

 

Class E Units

 

With respect to a purchase of Class E Units pursuant to Section 4.2 in the case of a termination of the Director’s service as a member of the Board described in Section 4.2(a)(i) or Section 4.2(a)(ii), the Applicable Percentage shall be determined in accordance with the following table attached to this Exhibit 1.2 as Annex A based on the Month (as defined below) during which the service of the Director is terminated:

 

For purposes of this Exhibit 1.2, “Month” means (i) in the case of Month 1, the period commencing on                               (the “Measurement Date”) and ending on the calendar day immediately preceding the one-month anniversary of the Measurement Date, (ii) for Month 2, the period commencing on the one-month anniversary of the Measurement Date and ending on the calendar day immediately preceding the two-month anniversary of the Measurement Date and (iii) for each other Month, the period determined in the manner in which Month 2 was determined, substituting the number of the month minus one for “one” in the preceding clause (ii) and substituting the number of the month for “two” in the preceding clause (ii).

 



 

Annex A to Exhibit 1.2

 

 

 

Month During Which

 

 

 

 

 

Service is

 

Applicable

 

 

 

Terminated

 

Percentage

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1

 

0.00

%

 

 

2

 

0.00

%

 

 

3

 

0.00

%

 

 

4

 

0.00

%

 

 

5

 

0.00

%

 

 

6

 

0.00

%

 

 

7

 

0.00

%

 

 

8

 

0.00

%

 

 

9

 

0.00

%

 

 

10

 

0.00

%

 

 

11

 

0.00

%

End of 1st year

 

12

 

0.00

%

 

 

13

 

20.00

%

 

 

14

 

21.70

%

 

 

15

 

23.40

%

 

 

16

 

25.10

%

 

 

17

 

26.80

%

 

 

18

 

28.50

%

 

 

19

 

30.20

%

 

 

20

 

31.90

%

 

 

21

 

33.60

%

 

 

22

 

35.30

%

 

 

23

 

37.00

%

End of 2nd year

 

24

 

38.70

%

 

 

25

 

40.40

%

 

 

26

 

42.10

%

 

 

27

 

43.80

%

 

 

28

 

45.50

%

 

 

29

 

47.20

%

 

 

30

 

48.90

%

 

 

31

 

50.60

%

 

 

32

 

52.30

%

 

 

33

 

54.00

%

 

 

34

 

55.70

%

 

 

35

 

57.40

%

End of 3rd year

 

36

 

59.10

%

 

 

37

 

60.80

%

 

 

38

 

62.50

%

 

 

39

 

64.20

%

 

 

40

 

65.90

%

 

 

41

 

67.60

%

 

 

42

 

69.30

%

 



 

 

 

43

 

71.00

%

 

 

44

 

72.70

%

 

 

45

 

74.40

%

 

 

46

 

76.10

%

 

 

47

 

77.80

%

End of 4th year

 

48

 

79.50

%

 

 

49

 

81.20

%

 

 

50

 

82.90

%

 

 

51

 

84.60

%

 

 

52

 

86.30

%

 

 

53

 

88.00

%

 

 

54

 

89.70

%

 

 

55

 

91.40

%

 

 

56

 

93.10

%

 

 

57

 

94.80

%

 

 

58

 

96.50

%

 

 

59

 

98.20

%

End of 5th year

 

60

 

99.90

%

 

 

61 and thereafter

 

100.00

%

 




Exhibit 10.17

 

NMH INVESTMENT, LLC

 

Amended and Restated 2006 Unit Plan

 

SECTION 1. Purpose . The purposes of this NMH Investment, LLC Amended and Restated 2006 Unit Plan (the “ Plan ”) are to promote the interests of NMH Investment, LLC (the “ Company ”) and its members by (i) attracting and retaining exceptional officers and other employees, non-employee directors and consultants of the Company and its Subsidiaries and (ii) enabling such individuals to acquire an equity interest in and participate in the long-term growth and financial success of the Company.

 

SECTION 2. Definitions . As used in the Plan, the following terms shall have the meanings set forth below:

 

Award ” shall mean the grant of the right to purchase Preferred Units, Class A Units, Class B Units, Class C Units, Class D Units and/or Class E Units.

 

Award Agreement ” shall mean any written agreement, contract, or other instrument or document (which may include provisions of an employment agreement to which the Company is a party) evidencing any Award granted hereunder.

 

Class A Unit ” shall mean a Class A Unit as defined in the LLC Agreement.

 

Class B Unit ” shall mean a Class B Unit as defined in the LLC Agreement.

 

Class C Unit ” shall mean a Class C Unit as defined in the LLC Agreement.

 

Class D Unit ” shall mean a Class D Unit as defined in the LLC Agreement.

 

Class E Unit ” shall mean a Class E Unit as defined in the LLC Agreement.

 

 “ Committee ” shall mean the Management Committee or any person or persons designated by the Management Committee to administer the Plan.

 

Company ” shall mean NMH Investment, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company, together with any successor thereto.

 

Effective Date ” shall mean December 14, 2006, the date on which the Plan was adopted by the Management Committee, or such later date as designated by the Management Committee.

 

LLC Agreement ” shall mean the Limited Liability Company Agreement of the Company, dated as of April 27, 2006, as amended from time to time.

 

Management Committee ” shall mean the Management Committee of the Company.

 



 

Participant ” shall mean any officer or other employee, non-employee director or consultant of the Company or its Subsidiaries eligible for an Award under Section 4 and selected by the Committee to receive an Award under the Plan.

 

Plan ” shall mean this NMH Investment, LLC Amended and Restated 2006 Unit Plan.

 

Preferred Unit ” shall mean a Preferred Unit as defined in the LLC Agreement.

 

 “ Subsidiary ” shall mean (i) any entity that, directly or indirectly, is controlled by the Company and (ii) any entity in which the Company has a significant equity interest, in either case as determined by the Committee; provided, however, that for purposes of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, the definition of “Subsidiary” shall be construed in a manner consistent with such Section 409A so as to avoid the imposition of any additional tax under such Section.

 

Unit ” shall mean a Preferred Unit, Class A Unit, Class B Unit, Class C Unit, Class D Unit or Class E Unit.

 

SECTION 3. Units Subject to the Plan .

 

The total number of Preferred Units which may be issued under the Plan is 65,000, the total number of Class A Units which may be issued under the Plan is 650,000, the total number of Class B Units which may be issued under the Plan is 192,500, the total number of Class C Units which may be issued under the Plan is 202,000, the total number of Class D Units which may be issued under the Plan is 214,000 and the total number of Class E Units which may be issued under the Plan is 6,375. Units which are subject to Awards which terminate or lapse without any payment in respect thereof may be granted again under the Plan.

 

SECTION 4. Administration .

 

(a)           The Plan shall be administered by the Committee. Subject to the terms of the Plan and applicable law, and in addition to other express powers and authorizations conferred on the Committee by the Plan, the Committee shall have full power and authority to: (i) designate Participants; (ii) determine the number and/or class of Units to be covered by an Award; (iii) determine the terms and conditions of any Award; (iv) determine whether, to what extent, and under what circumstances Awards may be settled, exercised, canceled, forfeited, or suspended; (v) interpret, administer, reconcile any inconsistency, correct any default and/or supply any omission in the Plan and any instrument or agreement relating to an Award made under the Plan; (vi) establish, amend, suspend, or waive such rules and regulations and appoint such agents as it shall deem appropriate for the proper administration of the Plan; and (vii) make any other determination and take any other action that the Committee deems necessary or desirable for the administration of the Plan.

 

(b)           All designations, determinations, interpretations, and other decisions under or with respect to the Plan or any Award shall be within the sole discretion of the Committee, may be made at any time and shall be final, conclusive, and binding upon all persons, including

 

2



 

the Company, any Subsidiary, any Participant, any holder or beneficiary of any Award, and any member of the Company.

 

SECTION 5. Eligibility . Any officer or other employee, non-employee director or consultant to the Company or any of its Subsidiaries (including any prospective officer, employee, non-employee director or consultant) shall be eligible to be designated a Participant.

 

SECTION 6. Awards .

 

(a)           Grant . Subject to the provisions of the Plan, the Committee shall have sole and complete authority to determine the Participants to whom Awards shall be granted, the purchase price, if any, of an Award, the number and class of Units to be covered by each Award and the conditions and limitations applicable to the Award.

 

(b)           Subject to LLC Agreement/Securityholders Agreement . As a condition to the grant of an Award, the Participant will be required to become a party to the LLC Agreement and a securityholders agreement with the Company (the “ Securityholders Agreement ”) and the Units acquired will be held subject to the terms and conditions of the LLC Agreement and the Securityholders Agreement.

 

(c)           Adjustments . In the event of any change in the outstanding Units or other extraordinary event that effects the Units after the Effective Date by reason of any extraordinary dividend, reorganization, recapitalization, merger, consolidation, spin-off, combination or transaction or exchange of Units or other exchange or any transaction similar to the foregoing, the Management Committee in its sole discretion and without liability to any person shall make such substitution or adjustment, if any, as it deems to be equitable, as to (i) the number or kind of Units or other securities issued or reserved for issuance pursuant to the Plan or pursuant to outstanding Awards and/or (ii) any other affected terms of such Awards.

 

SECTION 7. Amendment and Termination .

 

(a)           Amendments to the Plan . The Management Committee may amend, alter, suspend, discontinue, or terminate the Plan or any portion thereof at any time; provided that any such amendment, alteration, suspension, discontinuance, or termination that would be reasonably expected to have a material adverse effect on the rights of any Participant or other holder of an Award theretofore granted shall not to that extent be effective without the consent of the affected Participant.

 

(b)           Amendments to Awards . The Committee may waive any conditions or rights under, amend any terms of, or alter, suspend, discontinue, cancel or terminate, any Award theretofore granted, prospectively or retroactively; provided that any such waiver, amendment, alteration, suspension, discontinuance, cancellation or termination not expressly contemplated by the Plan that would be reasonably expected to have a material adverse effect on the rights of any outstanding Award shall not effective without the consent of the affected Participant.

 

3



 

SECTION 8. General Provisions .

 

(a)           No Rights to Awards . No person shall have any claim to be granted any Award, and there is no obligation for uniformity of treatment of Participants or beneficiaries of Awards. The terms and conditions of Awards and the Committee’s determinations and interpretations with respect thereto need not be the same with respect to each Participant (whether or not such Participants are similarly situated).

 

(b)           Certificates . All certificates, if any, evidencing Units or other securities of the Company or any Subsidiary delivered under the Plan shall be subject to such stop transfer orders and other restrictions as the Committee may deem advisable under the Plan or the rules, regulations, and other requirements of the Securities and Exchange Commission, any stock exchange upon which such securities are then listed, and any applicable Federal or state laws, and the Committee may cause a legend or legends to be put on any such certificates to make appropriate reference to such restrictions.

 

(c)           Withholding . A Participant may be required to pay to the Company or any Subsidiary and the Company or any Subsidiary shall have the right and is hereby authorized to withhold from any payment due or transfer made under any Award or under the Plan or from any compensation or other amount owing to a Participant the amount (in cash, securities, or other property) of any applicable withholding taxes in respect of an Award or any payment or transfer under an Award or under the Plan and to take such other action as may be necessary in the opinion of the Company to satisfy all obligations for the payment of such taxes.

 

(d)           No Right to Employment . The grant of an Award shall not be construed as giving a Participant the right to be retained in the employ of, or in any consulting relationship with, the Company or any Subsidiary. Further, the Company or a Subsidiary may at any time dismiss a Participant from employment or discontinue any consulting relationship, free from any liability or any claim under the Plan, unless otherwise expressly provided in the Plan or in any Award Agreement.

 

(e)           Governing Law . The validity, construction, and effect of the Plan shall be determined in accordance with the laws of the State of New York applicable to contracts made and to be performed therein.

 

(f)            Severability . If any provision of the Plan or any Award is or becomes or is deemed to be invalid, illegal, or unenforceable in any jurisdiction or as to any person or Award, or would disqualify the Plan or any Award under any law deemed applicable by the Committee, such provision shall be construed or deemed amended to conform the applicable laws, or if it cannot be construed or deemed amended without, in the determination of the Committee, materially altering the intent of the Plan or the Award, such provision shall be stricken as to such jurisdiction, person or Award and the remainder of the Plan and any such Award shall remain in full force and effect.

 

SECTION 9. Term of the Plan .

 

(a)           Effective Date . The Plan shall be effective as of the Effective Date.

 

4



 

(b)           Expiration Date . No Award shall be granted under the Plan after the tenth anniversary of the Effective Date. Unless otherwise expressly provided in the Plan or in an applicable Award Agreement, any Award granted hereunder may, and the authority of the Management Committee or Committee to amend, alter, adjust, suspend, discontinue, or terminate any such Award or to waive any conditions or rights under any such Award shall, continue after such date.

 

5




QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document


Exhibit 12.1

National Mentor Holdings, Inc.
Computation of earnings to fixed charges
Amounts in thousands, except ratio of earnings to fixed charges

 
  Predecessor(1)
   
  Pro forma
 
 
  Successor
 
 
   
   
   
   
  Period from
October 1
through
June 29,

  Period from
October 1
through
September 30,

 
 
  Year Ended September 30,
  Period from
June 30 through
September 30,

 
 
  2002
  2003
  2004
  2005
  2006
  2006
  2006
 
Earnings:                              
  Income (loss) before provision (benefit) for income taxes   1,816   10,404   18,606   24,268   (43,133 ) (5,886 ) (16,873 )
  Fixed Charges   8,668   17,624   29,353   32,836   54,743   14,077   55,621  
   
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
  Income before provision (benefit) for income taxes and fixed
charges
  10,484   28,028   47,959   57,104   11,610   8,191   38,748  

Fixed charges:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
  Interest expense (2)   8,668   17,624   29,353   32,836   54,743   14,077   55,621  

Ratio of earnings to fixed charges

 

1.2

 

1.6

 

1.6

 

1.7

 

(3)

 

(3)

 

(3)

 

(1)
On June 29, 2006, the Company changed ownership.

(2)
Interest expense includes amortization of debt issuance costs and the estimated portion of operating lease expense determined by management to represent the interest component of rent expense.

(3)
For the period from October 1, 2005 through June 29, 2006, the period from June 30, 2006 through September 30, 2006 and the pro forma period from October 1, 2005 through September 30, 2006, earnings were insufficient to cover fixed charges by $43.1 million, $5.9 million and $16.9 million, respectively.



QuickLinks


QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document


Exhibit 23.1


CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

        We consent to the reference to our firm under the captions "Experts" and "Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Data" and to the use of our report dated December 22, 2006, in Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement (Form S-4 No. 333-138362) and related prospectus of National Mentor Holdings, Inc. for the registration of $180,000,000 in 11 1 / 4 % Senior Subordinated Notes due 2014.

    /s/ Ernst & Young LLP

Boston, Massachusetts
January 8, 2007




QuickLinks

CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM